bb958cf25ddaad87e44131af6c173ae22dc76cf2
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 Initial support for the FreeBSD/riscv target and native configuration
550 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
551 Computer Laboratory (Department of Computer Science and Technology)
552 under DARPA contract HR0011-18-C-0016 ("ECATS"), as part of the DARPA
553 SSITH research programme.
554
555 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
556 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
557 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
558 Stafford Horne.
559
560 @node Sample Session
561 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
562
563 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
564 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
565 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
566
567 @iftex
568 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
569 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
570 @end iftex
571
572 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
573 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
574
575 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
576 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
577 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
578 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
579 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
580 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
581 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
582 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
583 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
584
585 @smallexample
586 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
587 $ @b{./m4}
588 @b{define(foo,0000)}
589
590 @b{foo}
591 0000
592 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
593
594 @b{bar}
595 0000
596 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
597
598 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
599 @b{baz}
600 @b{Ctrl-d}
601 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
602 @end smallexample
603
604 @noindent
605 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
606
607 @smallexample
608 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
609 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
610 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
611 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
612 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
613 the conditions.
614 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
615 for details.
616
617 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
618 (@value{GDBP})
619 @end smallexample
620
621 @noindent
622 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
623 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
624 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
625 that examples fit in this manual.
626
627 @smallexample
628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
633 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
634 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
635 @code{break} command.
636
637 @smallexample
638 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
639 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
640 @end smallexample
641
642 @noindent
643 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
644 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
645 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
646
647 @smallexample
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
649 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
650 @b{define(foo,0000)}
651
652 @b{foo}
653 0000
654 @end smallexample
655
656 @noindent
657 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
658 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
659 context where it stops.
660
661 @smallexample
662 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
663
664 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
665 at builtin.c:879
666 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
667 @end smallexample
668
669 @noindent
670 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
671 the next line of the current function.
672
673 @smallexample
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
675 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
676 : nil,
677 @end smallexample
678
679 @noindent
680 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
681 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
682 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
683 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
684
685 @smallexample
686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
687 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
688 at input.c:530
689 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
690 @end smallexample
691
692 @noindent
693 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
694 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
695 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
696 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
697 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
698 stack frame for each active subroutine.
699
700 @smallexample
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
702 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
703 at input.c:530
704 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
705 at builtin.c:882
706 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
707 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
708 at macro.c:71
709 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
710 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
711 @end smallexample
712
713 @noindent
714 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
715 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
716 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
717
718 @smallexample
719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
720 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
722 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
723 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
725 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
726 : xstrdup(rq);
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
728 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
729 @end smallexample
730
731 @noindent
732 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
733 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
734 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
735 (@code{print}) to see their values.
736
737 @smallexample
738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
739 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
741 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
742 @end smallexample
743
744 @noindent
745 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
746 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
747 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
748
749 @smallexample
750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
751 533 xfree(rquote);
752 534
753 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
754 : xstrdup (lq);
755 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
756 : xstrdup (rq);
757 537
758 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
759 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
760 540 @}
761 541
762 542 void
763 @end smallexample
764
765 @noindent
766 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
767 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
768
769 @smallexample
770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
771 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
773 540 @}
774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
775 $3 = 9
776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
777 $4 = 7
778 @end smallexample
779
780 @noindent
781 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
782 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
783 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
784 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
785 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
786 assignments.
787
788 @smallexample
789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
790 $5 = 7
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
792 $6 = 9
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
797 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
798 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
799 example that caused trouble initially:
800
801 @smallexample
802 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
803 Continuing.
804
805 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
806
807 baz
808 0000
809 @end smallexample
810
811 @noindent
812 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
813 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
814 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
815
816 @smallexample
817 @b{Ctrl-d}
818 Program exited normally.
819 @end smallexample
820
821 @noindent
822 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
823 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
824 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
825
826 @smallexample
827 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 @node Invocation
831 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
832
833 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
834 The essentials are:
835 @itemize @bullet
836 @item
837 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
838 @item
839 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
840 @end itemize
841
842 @menu
843 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
844 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
845 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
846 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
847 @end menu
848
849 @node Invoking GDB
850 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
851
852 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
853 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
854
855 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
856 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
857
858 The command-line options described here are designed
859 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
860 options may effectively be unavailable.
861
862 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
863 specifying an executable program:
864
865 @smallexample
866 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
867 @end smallexample
868
869 @noindent
870 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
871 specified:
872
873 @smallexample
874 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
875 @end smallexample
876
877 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
878 to debug a running process:
879
880 @smallexample
881 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
882 @end smallexample
883
884 @noindent
885 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
886 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
887
888 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
889 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
890 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
891 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
892 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
893
894 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
895 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
896 option processing.
897 @smallexample
898 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
899 @end smallexample
900 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
901 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
902
903 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
904 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
905 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
906
907 @smallexample
908 @value{GDBP} --silent
909 @end smallexample
910
911 @noindent
912 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
913 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
914
915 @noindent
916 Type
917
918 @smallexample
919 @value{GDBP} -help
920 @end smallexample
921
922 @noindent
923 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
924 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
925
926 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
927 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
928 @samp{-x} option is used.
929
930
931 @menu
932 * File Options:: Choosing files
933 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
934 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
935 @end menu
936
937 @node File Options
938 @subsection Choosing Files
939
940 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
941 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
942 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
943 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
944 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
945 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
946 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
947 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
948 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
949 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
950 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
951 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
952 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
953
954 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
955 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
956 argument and ignore it.
957
958 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
959 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
960 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
961 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
962 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
963
964 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
965 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
966 @c it.
967
968 @table @code
969 @item -symbols @var{file}
970 @itemx -s @var{file}
971 @cindex @code{--symbols}
972 @cindex @code{-s}
973 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
974
975 @item -exec @var{file}
976 @itemx -e @var{file}
977 @cindex @code{--exec}
978 @cindex @code{-e}
979 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
980 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
981
982 @item -se @var{file}
983 @cindex @code{--se}
984 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
985 file.
986
987 @item -core @var{file}
988 @itemx -c @var{file}
989 @cindex @code{--core}
990 @cindex @code{-c}
991 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
992
993 @item -pid @var{number}
994 @itemx -p @var{number}
995 @cindex @code{--pid}
996 @cindex @code{-p}
997 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
998
999 @item -command @var{file}
1000 @itemx -x @var{file}
1001 @cindex @code{--command}
1002 @cindex @code{-x}
1003 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
1004 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
1005 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1006
1007 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1008 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1009 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1010 @cindex @code{-ex}
1011 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1012
1013 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1014 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1015
1016 @smallexample
1017 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1018 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1019 @end smallexample
1020
1021 @item -init-command @var{file}
1022 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1023 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1024 @cindex @code{-ix}
1025 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1026 after loading gdbinit files).
1027 @xref{Startup}.
1028
1029 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1030 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1031 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1032 @cindex @code{-iex}
1033 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1034 after loading gdbinit files).
1035 @xref{Startup}.
1036
1037 @item -directory @var{directory}
1038 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1039 @cindex @code{--directory}
1040 @cindex @code{-d}
1041 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1042
1043 @item -r
1044 @itemx -readnow
1045 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1046 @cindex @code{-r}
1047 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1048 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1049 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1050
1051 @item --readnever
1052 @anchor{--readnever}
1053 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1054 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1055 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1056 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1057 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1058 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1059 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1060 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1061 @end table
1062
1063 @node Mode Options
1064 @subsection Choosing Modes
1065
1066 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1067 batch mode or quiet mode.
1068
1069 @table @code
1070 @anchor{-nx}
1071 @item -nx
1072 @itemx -n
1073 @cindex @code{--nx}
1074 @cindex @code{-n}
1075 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1076 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1077
1078 @table @code
1079 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1080 This is the system-wide init file.
1081 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1082 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1083 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1084 have been processed.
1085 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1086 This is the init file in your home directory.
1087 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1088 command options have been processed.
1089 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1090 This is the init file in the current directory.
1091 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1092 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1093 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1094 @end table
1095
1096 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1097 For documentation on how to write command files,
1098 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1099
1100 @anchor{-nh}
1101 @item -nh
1102 @cindex @code{--nh}
1103 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1104 in your home directory.
1105 @xref{Startup}.
1106
1107 @item -quiet
1108 @itemx -silent
1109 @itemx -q
1110 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1111 @cindex @code{--silent}
1112 @cindex @code{-q}
1113 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1114 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1115
1116 @item -batch
1117 @cindex @code{--batch}
1118 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1119 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1120 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1121 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1122 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1123 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1124 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1125
1126 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1127 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1128 make this more useful, the message
1129
1130 @smallexample
1131 Program exited normally.
1132 @end smallexample
1133
1134 @noindent
1135 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1136 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1137 mode.
1138
1139 @item -batch-silent
1140 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1141 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1142 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1143 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1144 for an interactive session.
1145
1146 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1147 messages, for example.
1148
1149 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1150 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1151
1152 @item -return-child-result
1153 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1154 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1155 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1156
1157 @itemize @bullet
1158 @item
1159 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1160 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1161 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1162 @item
1163 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1164 @item
1165 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1166 the exit code will be -1.
1167 @end itemize
1168
1169 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1170 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1171 interface.
1172
1173 @item -nowindows
1174 @itemx -nw
1175 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1176 @cindex @code{-nw}
1177 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1178 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1179 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1180
1181 @item -windows
1182 @itemx -w
1183 @cindex @code{--windows}
1184 @cindex @code{-w}
1185 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1186 used if possible.
1187
1188 @item -cd @var{directory}
1189 @cindex @code{--cd}
1190 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1191 instead of the current directory.
1192
1193 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1194 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1195 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1196 @cindex @code{-D}
1197 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1198 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1199 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1200
1201 @item -fullname
1202 @itemx -f
1203 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1204 @cindex @code{-f}
1205 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1206 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1207 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1208 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1209 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1210 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1211 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1212 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1213 frame.
1214
1215 @item -annotate @var{level}
1216 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1217 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1218 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1219 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1220 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1221 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1222 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1223 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1224 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1225
1226 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1227 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1228
1229 @item --args
1230 @cindex @code{--args}
1231 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1232 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1233 This option stops option processing.
1234
1235 @item -baud @var{bps}
1236 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1237 @cindex @code{--baud}
1238 @cindex @code{-b}
1239 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1240 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1241
1242 @item -l @var{timeout}
1243 @cindex @code{-l}
1244 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1245 for remote debugging.
1246
1247 @item -tty @var{device}
1248 @itemx -t @var{device}
1249 @cindex @code{--tty}
1250 @cindex @code{-t}
1251 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1252 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1253
1254 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1255 @item -tui
1256 @cindex @code{--tui}
1257 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1258 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1259 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1260 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1261 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1262 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1263
1264 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1265 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1266 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1267 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1268 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1269 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1270
1271 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi3}) causes
1272 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} version 3 (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1273 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 9.1. @sc{gdb/mi}
1274 version 2 (@code{mi2}), included in @value{GDBN} 6.0 and version 1 (@code{mi1}),
1275 included in @value{GDBN} 5.3, are also available. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi}
1276 interfaces are no longer supported.
1277
1278 @item -write
1279 @cindex @code{--write}
1280 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1281 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1282 (@pxref{Patching}).
1283
1284 @item -statistics
1285 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1286 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1287 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1288
1289 @item -version
1290 @cindex @code{--version}
1291 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1292 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1293
1294 @item -configuration
1295 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1296 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1297 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1298 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1299
1300 @end table
1301
1302 @node Startup
1303 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1304 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1305
1306 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1307
1308 @enumerate
1309 @item
1310 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1311 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1312
1313 @item
1314 @cindex init file
1315 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1316 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1317 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1318 that file.
1319
1320 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1321 @item
1322 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1323 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1324 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1325 that file.
1326
1327 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1328 @item
1329 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1330 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1331 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1332 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1333 gets loaded.
1334
1335 @item
1336 Processes command line options and operands.
1337
1338 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1339 @item
1340 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1341 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1342 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1343 This is only done if the current directory is
1344 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1345 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1346 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1347 @value{GDBN}.
1348
1349 @item
1350 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1351 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1352 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1353 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1354
1355 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1356 you must do something like the following:
1357
1358 @smallexample
1359 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1360 @end smallexample
1361
1362 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1363 off too late.
1364
1365 @item
1366 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1367 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1368 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1369
1370 @item
1371 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1372 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1373 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1374 @end enumerate
1375
1376 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1377 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1378 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1379 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1380 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1381 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1382
1383 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1384 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1385
1386 @cindex init file name
1387 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1388 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1389 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1390 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1391 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1392 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1393 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1394 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1395
1396
1397 @node Quitting GDB
1398 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1399 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1400 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1401
1402 @table @code
1403 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1404 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1405 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1406 @itemx q
1407 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1408 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1409 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1410 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1411 error code.
1412 @end table
1413
1414 @cindex interrupt
1415 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1416 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1417 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1418 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1419 until a time when it is safe.
1420
1421 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1422 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1423 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1424
1425 @node Shell Commands
1426 @section Shell Commands
1427
1428 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1429 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1430 just use the @code{shell} command.
1431
1432 @table @code
1433 @kindex shell
1434 @kindex !
1435 @cindex shell escape
1436 @item shell @var{command-string}
1437 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1438 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1439 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1440 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1441 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1442 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1443 @end table
1444
1445 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1446 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1447 @value{GDBN}:
1448
1449 @table @code
1450 @kindex make
1451 @cindex calling make
1452 @item make @var{make-args}
1453 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1454 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1455 @end table
1456
1457 @node Logging Output
1458 @section Logging Output
1459 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1460 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1461
1462 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1463 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1464
1465 @table @code
1466 @kindex set logging
1467 @item set logging on
1468 Enable logging.
1469 @item set logging off
1470 Disable logging.
1471 @cindex logging file name
1472 @item set logging file @var{file}
1473 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1474 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1475 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1476 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1477 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1478 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1479 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1480 @kindex show logging
1481 @item show logging
1482 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1483 @end table
1484
1485 @node Commands
1486 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1487
1488 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1489 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1490 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1491 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1492 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1493
1494 @menu
1495 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1496 * Completion:: Command completion
1497 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1498 @end menu
1499
1500 @node Command Syntax
1501 @section Command Syntax
1502
1503 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1504 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1505 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1506 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1507 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1508 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1509
1510 @cindex abbreviation
1511 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1512 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1513 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1514 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1515 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1516 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1517 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1518
1519 @cindex repeating commands
1520 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1521 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1522 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1523 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1524 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1525 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1526 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1527
1528 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1529 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1530 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1531
1532 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1533 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1534 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1535 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1536 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1537
1538 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1539 @cindex comment
1540 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1541 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1542 Files,,Command Files}).
1543
1544 @cindex repeating command sequences
1545 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1546 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1547 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1548 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1549 for editing.
1550
1551 @node Completion
1552 @section Command Completion
1553
1554 @cindex completion
1555 @cindex word completion
1556 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1557 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1558 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1559 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1560
1561 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1562 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1563 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1564 enter it). For example, if you type
1565
1566 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1567 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1568 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1569 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1570 @smallexample
1571 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1572 @end smallexample
1573
1574 @noindent
1575 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1576 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1577
1578 @smallexample
1579 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1580 @end smallexample
1581
1582 @noindent
1583 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1584 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1585 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1586 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1587 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1588 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1589
1590 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1591 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1592 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1593 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1594 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1595 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1596 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1597 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1598 example:
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1602 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1603 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1604 make_abs_section make_function_type
1605 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1606 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1607 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1608 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1609 @end smallexample
1610
1611 @noindent
1612 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1613 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1614 command.
1615
1616 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1617 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1618 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1619 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1620 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1621
1622 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1623 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1624 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1625
1626 @smallexample
1627 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1628 main
1629 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1630 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1631 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1632 @end smallexample
1633
1634 @noindent
1635 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1636
1637 @table @code
1638 @kindex set max-completions
1639 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1640 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1641 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1642 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1643 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1644 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1645 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1646 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1647 completion slow.
1648 @kindex show max-completions
1649 @item show max-completions
1650 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1651 during completion.
1652 @end table
1653
1654 @cindex quotes in commands
1655 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1656 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1657 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1658 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1659 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1660 @value{GDBN} commands.
1661
1662 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1663 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1664 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1665 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1666 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1667 Operators}).
1668
1669 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1670 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1671 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1672 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1673 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1674 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1675 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1676 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1677 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1678
1679 @smallexample
1680 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1681 func<int>() func<float>()
1682 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1683 @end smallexample
1684
1685 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1686 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1687 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1688 function:
1689
1690 @smallexample
1691 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1692 func<int>() func<float>()
1693 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1694 @end smallexample
1695
1696 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1697 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1698 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1699 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1700 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1701 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1702
1703 @smallexample
1704 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1705 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1706 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1707 bubble(double)
1708 @end smallexample
1709
1710 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1711 require quoting.
1712
1713 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1714 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1715 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1716 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1717
1718 @cindex completion of structure field names
1719 @cindex structure field name completion
1720 @cindex completion of union field names
1721 @cindex union field name completion
1722 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1723 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1724 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1725 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1726 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1727 left-hand-side:
1728
1729 @smallexample
1730 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1731 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1732 to_data to_isatty to_write
1733 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1734 to_flush to_read
1735 @end smallexample
1736
1737 @noindent
1738 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1739 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1740 follows:
1741
1742 @smallexample
1743 struct ui_file
1744 @{
1745 int *magic;
1746 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1747 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1748 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1749 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1750 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1751 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1752 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1753 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1754 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1755 void *to_data;
1756 @}
1757 @end smallexample
1758
1759
1760 @node Help
1761 @section Getting Help
1762 @cindex online documentation
1763 @kindex help
1764
1765 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1766 using the command @code{help}.
1767
1768 @table @code
1769 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1770 @item help
1771 @itemx h
1772 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1773 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1774
1775 @smallexample
1776 (@value{GDBP}) help
1777 List of classes of commands:
1778
1779 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1780 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1781 data -- Examining data
1782 files -- Specifying and examining files
1783 internals -- Maintenance commands
1784 obscure -- Obscure features
1785 running -- Running the program
1786 stack -- Examining the stack
1787 status -- Status inquiries
1788 support -- Support facilities
1789 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1790 stopping the program
1791 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1792
1793 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1794 commands in that class.
1795 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1796 documentation.
1797 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1798 (@value{GDBP})
1799 @end smallexample
1800 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1801
1802 @item help @var{class}
1803 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1804 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1805 help display for the class @code{status}:
1806
1807 @smallexample
1808 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1809 Status inquiries.
1810
1811 List of commands:
1812
1813 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1814 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1815 info -- Generic command for showing things
1816 about the program being debugged
1817 show -- Generic command for showing things
1818 about the debugger
1819
1820 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1821 documentation.
1822 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1823 (@value{GDBP})
1824 @end smallexample
1825
1826 @item help @var{command}
1827 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1828 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1829
1830 @kindex apropos
1831 @item apropos @var{args}
1832 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1833 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1834 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1835
1836 @smallexample
1837 apropos alias
1838 @end smallexample
1839
1840 @noindent
1841 results in:
1842
1843 @smallexample
1844 @c @group
1845 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1846 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1847 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1848 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1849 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1850 @c @end group
1851 @end smallexample
1852
1853 @kindex complete
1854 @item complete @var{args}
1855 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1856 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1857 command you want completed. For example:
1858
1859 @smallexample
1860 complete i
1861 @end smallexample
1862
1863 @noindent results in:
1864
1865 @smallexample
1866 @group
1867 if
1868 ignore
1869 info
1870 inspect
1871 @end group
1872 @end smallexample
1873
1874 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1875 @end table
1876
1877 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1878 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1879 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1880 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1881 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1882 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1883 Index}.
1884
1885 @c @group
1886 @table @code
1887 @kindex info
1888 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1889 @item info
1890 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1891 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1892 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1893 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1894 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1895 @w{@code{help info}}.
1896
1897 @kindex set
1898 @item set
1899 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1900 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1901 @code{set prompt $}.
1902
1903 @kindex show
1904 @item show
1905 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1906 @value{GDBN} itself.
1907 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1908 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1909 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1910 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1911
1912 @kindex info set
1913 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1914 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1915 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1916 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1917 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1918 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1919 @end table
1920 @c @end group
1921
1922 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1923 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1924
1925 @table @code
1926 @kindex show version
1927 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1928 @item show version
1929 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1930 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1931 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1932 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1933 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1934 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1935 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1936 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1937 @value{GDBN}.
1938
1939 @kindex show copying
1940 @kindex info copying
1941 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1942 @item show copying
1943 @itemx info copying
1944 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1945
1946 @kindex show warranty
1947 @kindex info warranty
1948 @item show warranty
1949 @itemx info warranty
1950 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1951 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1952
1953 @kindex show configuration
1954 @item show configuration
1955 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1956 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1957 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1958 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1959 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1960 your report.
1961
1962 @end table
1963
1964 @node Running
1965 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1966
1967 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1968 debugging information when you compile it.
1969
1970 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1971 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1972 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1973 kill a child process.
1974
1975 @menu
1976 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1977 * Starting:: Starting your program
1978 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1979 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1980
1981 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1982 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1983 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1984 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1985
1986 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1987 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1988 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1989 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1990 @end menu
1991
1992 @node Compilation
1993 @section Compiling for Debugging
1994
1995 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1996 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1997 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1998 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1999 and addresses in the executable code.
2000
2001 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
2002 the compiler.
2003
2004 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
2005 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2006 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2007 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2008 executables containing debugging information.
2009
2010 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2011 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2012 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2013 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2014 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2015
2016 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2017 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2018 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2019
2020 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2021 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2022 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2023 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2024 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2025 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2026
2027 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2028 gcc, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2029 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2030
2031 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2032 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2033 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2034 format in @value{GDBN}.
2035
2036 @need 2000
2037 @node Starting
2038 @section Starting your Program
2039 @cindex starting
2040 @cindex running
2041
2042 @table @code
2043 @kindex run
2044 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2045 @item run
2046 @itemx r
2047 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2048 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2049 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2050 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2051 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2052
2053 @end table
2054
2055 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2056 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2057 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2058 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2059 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2060 message like this one:
2061
2062 @smallexample
2063 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2064 Try "help target" or "continue".
2065 @end smallexample
2066
2067 @noindent
2068 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2069 first (@pxref{load}).
2070
2071 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2072 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2073 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2074 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2075 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2076 divided into four categories:
2077
2078 @table @asis
2079 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2080 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2081 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2082 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2083 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2084 the arguments.
2085 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2086 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2087 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2088 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2089 below for details).
2090
2091 @item The @emph{environment.}
2092 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2093 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2094 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2095 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2096
2097 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2098 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2099 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2100 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2101 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2102 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2103 Directory}.
2104
2105 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2106 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2107 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2108 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2109 set a different device for your program.
2110 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2111
2112 @cindex pipes
2113 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2114 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2115 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2116 wrong program.
2117 @end table
2118
2119 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2120 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2121 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2122 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2123 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2124
2125 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2126 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2127 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2128 your current breakpoints.
2129
2130 @table @code
2131 @kindex start
2132 @item start
2133 @cindex run to main procedure
2134 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2135 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2136 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2137 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2138 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2139 procedure, depending on the language used.
2140
2141 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2142 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2143 the @samp{run} command.
2144
2145 @cindex elaboration phase
2146 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2147 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2148 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2149 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2150 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2151 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2152 will remain to halt execution.
2153
2154 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2155 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2156 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2157 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2158 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2159
2160 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2161 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2162 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2163 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2164 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2165 use the @code{starti} command.
2166
2167 @kindex starti
2168 @item starti
2169 @cindex run to first instruction
2170 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2171 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2172 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2173 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2174 the start of the elaboration phase.
2175
2176 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2177 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2178 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2179 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2180 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2181 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2182 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2183 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2184 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2185 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2186 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2187 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2188
2189 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2190 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2191 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2192 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2193
2194 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2195 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2196 environment:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2200 (@value{GDBP}) run
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2204 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2205
2206 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2207 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2208 @item set startup-with-shell
2209 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2210 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2211 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2212 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2213 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2214 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2215 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2216 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2217 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2218 startup failures such as:
2219
2220 @smallexample
2221 (@value{GDBP}) run
2222 Starting program: ./a.out
2223 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2224 @end smallexample
2225
2226 @noindent
2227 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2228 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2229 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2230 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2231 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2232 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2233
2234 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2235 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2236 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2237 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2238 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2239 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2240
2241 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2242 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2243 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2244 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2245 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2246 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2247
2248 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2249 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2250 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2251
2252 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2253 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2254
2255 @smallexample
2256 (@value{GDBP}) run
2257 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2258 @end smallexample
2259
2260 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2261 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2262
2263 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2264 @code{target native} command. For example,
2265
2266 @smallexample
2267 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2268 (@value{GDBP}) run
2269 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2270 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2271 (@value{GDBP}) run
2272 Starting program: ./a.out
2273 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2274 @end smallexample
2275
2276 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2277 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2278 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2279 disconnect.
2280
2281 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2282 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2283 proc}, @code{info os}.
2284
2285 @kindex set disable-randomization
2286 @item set disable-randomization
2287 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2288 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2289 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2290 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2291 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2292
2293 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2294 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2295
2296 @smallexample
2297 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2298 @end smallexample
2299
2300 @item set disable-randomization off
2301 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2302 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2303 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2304 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2305 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2306 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2307
2308 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2309 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2310 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2311 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2312 a code at its expected addresses.
2313
2314 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2315 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2316 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2317 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2318 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2319 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2320 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2321 a randomly chosen address.
2322
2323 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2324 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2325 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2326 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2327 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2328
2329 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2330 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2331
2332 @item show disable-randomization
2333 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2334 the virtual address space of the started program.
2335
2336 @end table
2337
2338 @node Arguments
2339 @section Your Program's Arguments
2340
2341 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2342 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2343 @code{run} command.
2344 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2345 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2346 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2347 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2348 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2349
2350 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2351 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2352 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2353 the program, not by the shell.
2354
2355 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2356 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2357
2358 @table @code
2359 @kindex set args
2360 @item set args
2361 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2362 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2363 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2364 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2365 it again without arguments.
2366
2367 @kindex show args
2368 @item show args
2369 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2370 @end table
2371
2372 @node Environment
2373 @section Your Program's Environment
2374
2375 @cindex environment (of your program)
2376 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2377 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2378 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2379 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2380 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2381 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2382 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2383
2384 @table @code
2385 @kindex path
2386 @item path @var{directory}
2387 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2388 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2389 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2390 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2391 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2392 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2393 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2394
2395 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2396 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2397 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2398 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2399 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2400 @var{directory} to the search path.
2401 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2402 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2403
2404 @kindex show paths
2405 @item show paths
2406 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2407 environment variable).
2408
2409 @kindex show environment
2410 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2411 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2412 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2413 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2414 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2415
2416 @kindex set environment
2417 @anchor{set environment}
2418 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2419 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2420 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2421 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2422 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2423 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2424 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2425 null value.
2426 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2427 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2428
2429 For example, this command:
2430
2431 @smallexample
2432 set env USER = foo
2433 @end smallexample
2434
2435 @noindent
2436 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2437 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2438 are not actually required.)
2439
2440 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2441 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2442 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2443 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2444 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2445
2446 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2447 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2448 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2449
2450 @kindex unset environment
2451 @anchor{unset environment}
2452 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2453 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2454 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2455 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2456 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2457
2458 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2459 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2460 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2461 @end table
2462
2463 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2464 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2465 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2466 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2467 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2468 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2469 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2470 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2471 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2472 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2473
2474 @node Working Directory
2475 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2476
2477 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2478 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2479 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2480 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2481 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2482 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2483 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2484 debugging.
2485
2486 @table @code
2487 @kindex set cwd
2488 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2489 @anchor{set cwd command}
2490 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2491 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2492 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2493 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2494 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2495 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2496 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2497 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2498 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2499 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2500 fallback.
2501
2502 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2503 the @code{cd} command.
2504 @xref{cd command}.
2505
2506 @kindex show cwd
2507 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2508 @item show cwd
2509 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2510 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2511 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2512
2513 @kindex cd
2514 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2515 @anchor{cd command}
2516 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2517 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2518 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2519
2520 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2521 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2522 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2523 @xref{set cwd command}.
2524
2525 @kindex pwd
2526 @item pwd
2527 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2528 @end table
2529
2530 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2531 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2532 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2533 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2534 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2535 current working directory of the debuggee.
2536
2537 @node Input/Output
2538 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2539
2540 @cindex redirection
2541 @cindex i/o
2542 @cindex terminal
2543 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2544 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2545 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2546 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2547 running your program.
2548
2549 @table @code
2550 @kindex info terminal
2551 @item info terminal
2552 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2553 program is using.
2554 @end table
2555
2556 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2557 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2558
2559 @smallexample
2560 run > outfile
2561 @end smallexample
2562
2563 @noindent
2564 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2565
2566 @kindex tty
2567 @cindex controlling terminal
2568 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2569 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2570 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2571 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2572 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2573
2574 @smallexample
2575 tty /dev/ttyb
2576 @end smallexample
2577
2578 @noindent
2579 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2580 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2581 that as their controlling terminal.
2582
2583 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2584 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2585 terminal.
2586
2587 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2588 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2589 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2590 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2591
2592 @cindex inferior tty
2593 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2594 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2595 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2596 program.
2597
2598 @table @code
2599 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2600 @kindex set inferior-tty
2601 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2602 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2603 @value{GDBN}.
2604
2605 @item show inferior-tty
2606 @kindex show inferior-tty
2607 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2608 @end table
2609
2610 @node Attach
2611 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2612 @kindex attach
2613 @cindex attach
2614
2615 @table @code
2616 @item attach @var{process-id}
2617 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2618 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2619 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2620 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2621 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2622
2623 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2624 executing the command.
2625 @end table
2626
2627 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2628 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2629 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2630 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2631
2632 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2633 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2634 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2635 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2636 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2637 Specify Files}.
2638
2639 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2640 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2641 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2642 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2643 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2644 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2645 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2646
2647 @table @code
2648 @kindex detach
2649 @item detach
2650 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2651 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2652 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2653 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2654 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2655 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2656 executing the command.
2657 @end table
2658
2659 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2660 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2661 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2662 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2663 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2664 Messages}).
2665
2666 @node Kill Process
2667 @section Killing the Child Process
2668
2669 @table @code
2670 @kindex kill
2671 @item kill
2672 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2673 @end table
2674
2675 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2676 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2677 is running.
2678
2679 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2680 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2681 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2682 outside the debugger.
2683
2684 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2685 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2686 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2687 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2688 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2689 breakpoint settings).
2690
2691 @node Inferiors and Programs
2692 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2693
2694 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2695 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2696 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2697 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2698 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2699 from multiple executables.
2700
2701 @cindex inferior
2702 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2703 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2704 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2705 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2706 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2707 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2708 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2709 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2710 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2711 threads running in it.
2712
2713 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2714 inferiors}}:
2715
2716 @table @code
2717 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
2718 @item info inferiors
2719 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2720 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
2721 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
2722 the display to just the requested inferiors.
2723
2724 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2725
2726 @enumerate
2727 @item
2728 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2729
2730 @item
2731 the target system's inferior identifier
2732
2733 @item
2734 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2735
2736 @end enumerate
2737
2738 @noindent
2739 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2740 indicates the current inferior.
2741
2742 For example,
2743 @end table
2744 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2745
2746 @smallexample
2747 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2748 Num Description Executable
2749 2 process 2307 hello
2750 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2751 @end smallexample
2752
2753 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2754
2755 @table @code
2756 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2757 @item inferior @var{infno}
2758 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2759 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2760 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2761 @end table
2762
2763 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2764 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2765 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2766 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2767 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2768 information on convenience variables.
2769
2770 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2771 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2772 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2773 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2774 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2775 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2776
2777 @table @code
2778 @kindex add-inferior
2779 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2780 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2781 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2782 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2783 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2784 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2785
2786 @kindex clone-inferior
2787 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2788 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2789 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2790 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2791 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2792
2793 @smallexample
2794 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2795 Num Description Executable
2796 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2797 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2798 Added inferior 2.
2799 1 inferiors added.
2800 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2801 Num Description Executable
2802 2 <null> helloworld
2803 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2804 @end smallexample
2805
2806 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2807
2808 @kindex remove-inferiors
2809 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2810 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2811 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2812 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2813
2814 @end table
2815
2816 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2817 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2818 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2819 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2820
2821 @table @code
2822 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2823 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2824 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2825 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2826 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2827 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2828
2829 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2830 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2831 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2832 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2833 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2834 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2835 @end table
2836
2837 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2838 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2839 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2840 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2841
2842
2843 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2844 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2845
2846 @table @code
2847 @kindex set print inferior-events
2848 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2849 @item set print inferior-events
2850 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2851 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2852 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2853 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2854 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2855 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2856
2857 @kindex show print inferior-events
2858 @item show print inferior-events
2859 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2860 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2861 @end table
2862
2863 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2864 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2865 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2866
2867
2868 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2869 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2870 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2871 info program-spaces}} command.
2872
2873 @table @code
2874 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2875 @item maint info program-spaces
2876 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2877 @value{GDBN}.
2878
2879 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2880
2881 @enumerate
2882 @item
2883 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2884
2885 @item
2886 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2887 the @code{file} command.
2888
2889 @end enumerate
2890
2891 @noindent
2892 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2893 indicates the current program space.
2894
2895 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2896 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2897 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2898
2899 @smallexample
2900 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2901 Id Executable
2902 * 1 hello
2903 2 goodbye
2904 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2905 @end smallexample
2906
2907 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2908 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2909 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2910 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2911 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2912
2913 @smallexample
2914 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2915 Id Executable
2916 * 1 vfork-test
2917 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2918 @end smallexample
2919
2920 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2921 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2922 @end table
2923
2924 @node Threads
2925 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2926
2927 @cindex threads of execution
2928 @cindex multiple threads
2929 @cindex switching threads
2930 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2931 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2932 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2933 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2934 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2935 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2936 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2937
2938 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2939 programs:
2940
2941 @itemize @bullet
2942 @item automatic notification of new threads
2943 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2944 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2945 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all] @var{args}},
2946 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2947 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2948 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2949 messages on thread start and exit.
2950 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2951 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2952 isn't compatible with the program.
2953 @end itemize
2954
2955 @cindex focus of debugging
2956 @cindex current thread
2957 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2958 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2959 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2960 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2961 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2962
2963 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2964 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2965 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2966 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2967 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2968 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2969 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2970 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2971 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2972 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2973
2974 @smallexample
2975 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2976 @end smallexample
2977
2978 @noindent
2979 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2980 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2981 further qualifier.
2982
2983 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2984 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2985 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2986 @c program?
2987 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2988 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2989 @c threads ab initio?
2990
2991 @anchor{thread numbers}
2992 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2993 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2994 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2995 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2996 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2997 between threads of different inferiors.
2998
2999 @cindex qualified thread ID
3000 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
3001 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
3002 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
3003 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
3004 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
3005 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3006 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3007 inferior.
3008
3009 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3010 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3011 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3012 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3013
3014 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3015 @cindex thread ID lists
3016 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3017 argument. A list element can be:
3018
3019 @enumerate
3020 @item
3021 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3022 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3023 @samp{1}.
3024
3025 @item
3026 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3027 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3028 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3029
3030 @item
3031 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3032 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3033 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3034 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3035 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3036
3037 @end enumerate
3038
3039 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3040 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3041 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3042 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3043 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3044 7.1}.
3045
3046
3047 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3048 @cindex global thread number
3049 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3050 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3051 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3052 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3053 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3054 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3055
3056 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3057 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3058 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3059
3060 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3061 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3062 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3063 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3064 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3065 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3066 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3067 general information on convenience variables.
3068
3069 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3070 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3071 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3072
3073 @smallexample
3074 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3075 @end smallexample
3076
3077 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3078
3079 @smallexample
3080 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3081 @end smallexample
3082
3083 @table @code
3084 @kindex info threads
3085 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3086
3087 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3088 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3089 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3090 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3091
3092 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3093
3094 @enumerate
3095 @item
3096 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3097
3098 @item
3099 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3100 option was specified
3101
3102 @item
3103 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3104
3105 @item
3106 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3107 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3108 program itself.
3109
3110 @item
3111 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3112 @end enumerate
3113
3114 @noindent
3115 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3116 indicates the current thread.
3117
3118 For example,
3119 @end table
3120 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3121
3122 @smallexample
3123 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3124 Id Target Id Frame
3125 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3126 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3127 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3128 at threadtest.c:68
3129 @end smallexample
3130
3131 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3132 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3133 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3134
3135 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3136 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3137
3138 @smallexample
3139 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3140 Id GId Target Id Frame
3141 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3142 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3143 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3144 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3145 @end smallexample
3146
3147 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3148 Solaris-specific command:
3149
3150 @table @code
3151 @item maint info sol-threads
3152 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3153 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3154 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3155 @end table
3156
3157 @table @code
3158 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3159 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3160 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3161 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3162 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3163 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3164
3165 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3166 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3167
3168 @smallexample
3169 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3170 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3171 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3172 8 printf ("hello\n");
3173 @end smallexample
3174
3175 @noindent
3176 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3177 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3178 threads.
3179
3180 @kindex thread apply
3181 @cindex apply command to several threads
3182 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
3183 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3184 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3185 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3186 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3187 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3188 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3189 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3190
3191 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
3192 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a thread. @var{flag}
3193 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
3194 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
3195 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
3196
3197 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some thread information before the
3198 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
3199 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{thread apply}. The
3200 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
3201
3202 @table @code
3203 @item -c
3204 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
3205 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
3206 @code{thread apply} then continues.
3207 @item -s
3208 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
3209 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
3210 That is, the execution continues, but the thread information and errors
3211 are not printed.
3212 @item -q
3213 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the thread
3214 information.
3215 @end table
3216
3217 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
3218
3219 @kindex taas
3220 @cindex apply command to all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3221 @item taas @var{command}
3222 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s @var{command}}.
3223 Applies @var{command} on all threads, ignoring errors and empty output.
3224
3225 @kindex tfaas
3226 @cindex apply a command to all frames of all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3227 @item tfaas @var{command}
3228 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
3229 Applies @var{command} on all frames of all threads, ignoring errors
3230 and empty output. Note that the flag @code{-s} is specified twice:
3231 The first @code{-s} ensures that @code{thread apply} only shows the thread
3232 information of the threads for which @code{frame apply} produces
3233 some output. The second @code{-s} is needed to ensure that @code{frame
3234 apply} shows the frame information of a frame only if the
3235 @var{command} successfully produced some output.
3236
3237 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
3238 argument without knowing the thread or frame where this variable or argument
3239 is, using:
3240 @smallexample
3241 (@value{GDBP}) tfaas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
3242 @end smallexample
3243
3244
3245 @kindex thread name
3246 @cindex name a thread
3247 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3248 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3249 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3250 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3251
3252 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3253 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3254 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3255 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3256 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3257
3258 @kindex thread find
3259 @cindex search for a thread
3260 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3261 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3262 matches the supplied regular expression.
3263
3264 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3265 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3266 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3267 is the LWP id.
3268
3269 @smallexample
3270 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3271 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3272 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3273 Id Target Id Frame
3274 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3275 @end smallexample
3276
3277 @kindex set print thread-events
3278 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3279 @item set print thread-events
3280 @itemx set print thread-events on
3281 @itemx set print thread-events off
3282 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3283 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3284 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3285 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3286 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3287
3288 @kindex show print thread-events
3289 @item show print thread-events
3290 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3291 have started and exited.
3292 @end table
3293
3294 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3295 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3296 programs with multiple threads.
3297
3298 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3299 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3300
3301 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3302 @table @code
3303 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3304 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3305 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3306 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3307 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3308 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3309 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3310 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3311 macro.
3312
3313 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3314 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3315 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3316 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3317 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3318 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3319
3320 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3321 refers to the default system directories that are
3322 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3323 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3324 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3325
3326 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3327 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3328 was loaded in the inferior process.
3329
3330 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3331 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3332 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3333 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3334 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3335 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3336 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3337
3338 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3339 only on some platforms.
3340
3341 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3342 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3343 Display current libthread_db search path.
3344
3345 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3346 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3347 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3348 @item set debug libthread-db
3349 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3350 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3351 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3352 @end table
3353
3354 @node Forks
3355 @section Debugging Forks
3356
3357 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3358 @cindex multiple processes
3359 @cindex processes, multiple
3360 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3361 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3362 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3363 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3364 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3365 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3366 will cause it to terminate.
3367
3368 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3369 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3370 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3371 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3372 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3373 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3374 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3375 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3376 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3377 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3378
3379 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3380 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3381 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3382 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3383
3384 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3385 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3386 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3387
3388 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3389 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3390
3391 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3392 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3393
3394 @table @code
3395 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3396 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3397 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3398 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3399 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3400
3401 @table @code
3402 @item parent
3403 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3404 unimpeded. This is the default.
3405
3406 @item child
3407 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3408 unimpeded.
3409
3410 @end table
3411
3412 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3413 @item show follow-fork-mode
3414 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3415 @end table
3416
3417 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3418 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3419 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3420
3421 @table @code
3422 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3423 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3424 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3425 retain debugger control over them both.
3426
3427 @table @code
3428 @item on
3429 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3430 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3431 independently. This is the default.
3432
3433 @item off
3434 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3435 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3436 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3437 is held suspended.
3438
3439 @end table
3440
3441 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3442 @item show detach-on-fork
3443 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3444 @end table
3445
3446 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3447 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3448 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3449 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3450 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3451 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3452
3453 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3454 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3455 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3456 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3457 and Programs}.
3458
3459 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3460 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3461 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3462 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3463 the child process's @code{main}.
3464
3465 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3466 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3467
3468 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3469 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3470 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3471 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3472 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3473 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3474 command.
3475
3476 @table @code
3477 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3478 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3479
3480 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3481 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3482
3483 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3484
3485 @table @code
3486 @item new
3487 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3488 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3489 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3490 original inferior.
3491
3492 For example:
3493
3494 @smallexample
3495 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3496 (gdb) info inferior
3497 Id Description Executable
3498 * 1 <null> prog1
3499 (@value{GDBP}) run
3500 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3501 Program exited normally.
3502 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3503 Id Description Executable
3504 1 <null> prog1
3505 * 2 <null> prog2
3506 @end smallexample
3507
3508 @item same
3509 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3510 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3511 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3512 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3513 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3514
3515 For example:
3516
3517 @smallexample
3518 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3519 Id Description Executable
3520 * 1 <null> prog1
3521 (@value{GDBP}) run
3522 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3523 Program exited normally.
3524 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3525 Id Description Executable
3526 * 1 <null> prog2
3527 @end smallexample
3528
3529 @end table
3530 @end table
3531
3532 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3533 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3534
3535 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3536 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3537 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3538
3539 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3540 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3541
3542 @cindex checkpoint
3543 @cindex restart
3544 @cindex bookmark
3545 @cindex snapshot of a process
3546 @cindex rewind program state
3547
3548 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3549 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3550 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3551 later.
3552
3553 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3554 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3555 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3556 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3557 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3558
3559 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3560 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3561 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3562 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3563 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3564 start again from there.
3565
3566 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3567 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3568
3569 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3570
3571 @table @code
3572 @kindex checkpoint
3573 @item checkpoint
3574 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3575 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3576 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3577
3578 @kindex info checkpoints
3579 @item info checkpoints
3580 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3581 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3582 listed:
3583
3584 @table @code
3585 @item Checkpoint ID
3586 @item Process ID
3587 @item Code Address
3588 @item Source line, or label
3589 @end table
3590
3591 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3592 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3593 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3594 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3595 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3596 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3597 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3598
3599 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3600 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3601 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3602 the debugger.
3603
3604 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3605 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3606 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3607
3608 @end table
3609
3610 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3611 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3612 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3613 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3614 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3615 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3616 previously read data can be read again.
3617
3618 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3619 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3620 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3621 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3622 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3623 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3624
3625 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3626 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3627 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3628 different execution path this time.
3629
3630 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3631 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3632 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3633 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3634 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3635 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3636 potentially pose a problem.
3637
3638 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3639
3640 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3641 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3642 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3643 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3644 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3645 next.
3646
3647 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3648 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3649 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3650 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3651 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3652
3653 @node Stopping
3654 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3655
3656 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3657 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3658 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3659
3660 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3661 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3662 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3663 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3664 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3665 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3666 explicitly request this information at any time.
3667
3668 @table @code
3669 @kindex info program
3670 @item info program
3671 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3672 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3673 @end table
3674
3675 @menu
3676 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3677 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3678 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3679 Skipping over functions and files
3680 * Signals:: Signals
3681 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3682 @end menu
3683
3684 @node Breakpoints
3685 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3686
3687 @cindex breakpoints
3688 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3689 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3690 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3691 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3692 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3693 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3694 program.
3695
3696 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3697 the executable is run.
3698
3699 @cindex watchpoints
3700 @cindex data breakpoints
3701 @cindex memory tracing
3702 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3703 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3704 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3705 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3706 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3707 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3708 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3709 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3710 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3711 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3712 same commands.
3713
3714 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3715 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3716 Automatic Display}.
3717
3718 @cindex catchpoints
3719 @cindex breakpoint on events
3720 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3721 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3722 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3723 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3724 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3725 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3726 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3727
3728 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3729 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3730 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3731 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3732 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3733 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3734 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3735 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3736 enable it again.
3737
3738 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3739 @cindex breakpoint lists
3740 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3741 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3742 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3743 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3744 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3745 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3746 are operated on.
3747
3748 @menu
3749 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3750 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3751 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3752 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3753 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3754 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3755 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3756 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3757 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3758 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3759 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3760 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3761 @end menu
3762
3763 @node Set Breaks
3764 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3765
3766 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3767 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3768 @c
3769 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3770
3771 @kindex break
3772 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3773 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3774 @cindex latest breakpoint
3775 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3776 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3777 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3778 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3779 convenience variables.
3780
3781 @table @code
3782 @item break @var{location}
3783 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3784 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3785 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3786 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3787 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3788
3789 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3790 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3791 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3792 that situation.
3793
3794 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3795 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3796 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3797
3798 @item break
3799 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3800 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3801 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3802 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3803 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3804 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3805 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3806 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3807 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3808 inside loops.
3809
3810 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3811 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3812 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3813 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3814 existed when your program stopped.
3815
3816 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3817 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3818 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3819 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3820 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3821 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3822 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3823
3824 @kindex tbreak
3825 @item tbreak @var{args}
3826 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3827 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3828 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3829 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3830
3831 @kindex hbreak
3832 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3833 @item hbreak @var{args}
3834 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3835 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3836 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3837 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3838 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3839 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3840 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3841 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3842 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3843 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3844 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3845 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3846 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3847 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3848 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3849 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3850 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3851 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3852
3853 @kindex thbreak
3854 @item thbreak @var{args}
3855 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3856 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3857 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3858 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3859 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3860 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3861 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3862 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3863
3864 @kindex rbreak
3865 @cindex regular expression
3866 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3867 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3868 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3869 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3870 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3871 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3872 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3873 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3874 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3875
3876 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
3877 to print the list of all breakpoints it sets according to the
3878 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
3879 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
3880 language of the breakpoint's function, other values mean to use
3881 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
3882
3883 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3884 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3885 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3886 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3887 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3888 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3889
3890 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3891 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3892 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3893 classes.
3894
3895 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3896 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3897 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3898
3899 @smallexample
3900 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3901 @end smallexample
3902
3903 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3904 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3905 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3906 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3907 every function in a given file:
3908
3909 @smallexample
3910 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3911 @end smallexample
3912
3913 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3914 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3915
3916 @kindex info breakpoints
3917 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3918 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3919 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3920 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3921 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3922 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3923 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3924
3925 @table @emph
3926 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3927 @item Type
3928 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3929 @item Disposition
3930 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3931 @item Enabled or Disabled
3932 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3933 that are not enabled.
3934 @item Address
3935 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3936 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3937 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3938 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3939 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3940 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3941 @item What
3942 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3943 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3944 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3945 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3946 @end table
3947
3948 @noindent
3949 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3950 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3951 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3952 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3953 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3954 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3955
3956 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3957 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3958 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3959 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3960
3961 @noindent
3962 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3963 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3964 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3965 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3966 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3967
3968 @noindent
3969 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3970 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3971 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3972 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3973 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3974 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3975
3976 @noindent
3977 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3978 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3979
3980 @end table
3981
3982 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3983 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3984 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3985 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3986
3987 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3988 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3989 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3990 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3991
3992 @itemize @bullet
3993 @item
3994 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3995
3996 @item
3997 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3998 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3999
4000 @item
4001 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
4002 correspond to any number of instantiations.
4003
4004 @item
4005 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
4006 several places where that function is inlined.
4007 @end itemize
4008
4009 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
4010 the relevant locations.
4011
4012 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
4013 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
4014 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
4015 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
4016 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
4017 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
4018 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
4019
4020 For example:
4021
4022 @smallexample
4023 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4024 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4025 stop only if i==1
4026 breakpoint already hit 1 time
4027 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
4028 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
4029 @end smallexample
4030
4031 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
4032 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
4033 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
4034 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
4035 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
4036 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
4037 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
4038 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
4039 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
4040 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
4041 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
4042
4043 @cindex pending breakpoints
4044 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
4045 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
4046 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
4047 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
4048 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
4049 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
4050 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
4051 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
4052 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
4053 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
4054 is not yet resolved.
4055
4056 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
4057 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
4058 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
4059 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
4060 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
4061 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
4062
4063 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
4064 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
4065 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4066 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4067
4068 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4069 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4070 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4071
4072 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4073 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4074 address specification to an address:
4075
4076 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4077 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4078 @table @code
4079 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4080 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4081 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4082
4083 @item set breakpoint pending on
4084 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4085 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4086
4087 @item set breakpoint pending off
4088 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4089 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4090 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4091
4092 @item show breakpoint pending
4093 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4094 @end table
4095
4096 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4097 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4098 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4099
4100 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4101 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4102 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4103 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4104 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4105 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4106 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4107 breakpoints.
4108
4109 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4110
4111 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4112 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4113 @table @code
4114 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4115 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4116 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4117 breakpoint must be used.
4118
4119 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4120 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4121 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4122 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4123 @end table
4124
4125 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4126 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4127 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4128 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4129 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4130 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4131 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4132 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4133 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4134
4135 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4136 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4137 @table @code
4138 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4139 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4140 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4141 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4142
4143 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4144 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4145 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4146 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4147 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4148 @end table
4149
4150 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4151 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4152 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4153
4154 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4155 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4156
4157 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4158
4159 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4160 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4161 @table @code
4162 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4163 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4164 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4165 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4166 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4167
4168 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4169 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4170 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4171 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4172 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4173 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4174 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4175 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4176 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4177 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4178 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4179 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4180 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4181
4182 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4183 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4184 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4185 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4186 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4187 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4188 @end table
4189
4190
4191 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4192 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4193 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4194 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4195 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4196 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4197 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4198 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4199
4200
4201 @node Set Watchpoints
4202 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4203
4204 @cindex setting watchpoints
4205 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4206 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4207 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4208 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4209 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4210
4211 @itemize @bullet
4212 @item
4213 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4214
4215 @item
4216 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4217 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4218 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4219
4220 @item
4221 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4222 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4223 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4224 @end itemize
4225
4226 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4227 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4228 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4229 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4230 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4231 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4232 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4233 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4234 the expression changes.
4235
4236 @cindex software watchpoints
4237 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4238 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4239 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4240 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4241 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4242 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4243 culprit.)
4244
4245 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4246 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4247 slow down the running of your program.
4248
4249 @table @code
4250 @kindex watch
4251 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4252 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4253 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4254 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4255 to watch the value of a single variable:
4256
4257 @smallexample
4258 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4259 @end smallexample
4260
4261 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4262 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4263 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4264 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4265 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4266 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4267
4268 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4269 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4270 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4271 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4272 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4273 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4274 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4275 error.
4276
4277 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4278 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4279 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4280 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4281 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4282 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4283 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4284 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4285 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4286 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4287 Examples:
4288
4289 @smallexample
4290 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4291 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4292 @end smallexample
4293
4294 @kindex rwatch
4295 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4296 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4297 by the program.
4298
4299 @kindex awatch
4300 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4301 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4302 or written into by the program.
4303
4304 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4305 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4306 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4307 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4308 @end table
4309
4310 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4311 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4312 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4313 a never-changing value:
4314
4315 @smallexample
4316 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4317 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4318 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4319 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4320 @end smallexample
4321
4322 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4323 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4324 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4325 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4326 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4327 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4328
4329 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4330 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4331 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4332 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4333 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4334 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4335 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4336 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4337
4338 @table @code
4339 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4340 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4341 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4342
4343 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4344 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4345 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4346 @end table
4347
4348 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4349 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4350 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4351
4352 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4353
4354 @smallexample
4355 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4356 @end smallexample
4357
4358 @noindent
4359 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4360
4361 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4362 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4363 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4364 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4365 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4366 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4367 will print a message like this:
4368
4369 @smallexample
4370 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4371 @end smallexample
4372
4373 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4374 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4375 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4376 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4377 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4378 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4379 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4380 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4381
4382 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4383 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4384 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4385 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4386 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4387 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4388
4389 @smallexample
4390 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4391 @end smallexample
4392
4393 @noindent
4394 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4395
4396 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4397 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4398 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4399 expression with separately allocated resources.
4400
4401 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4402 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4403 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4404
4405 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4406 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4407 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4408 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4409 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4410 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4411 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4412 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4413 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4414
4415 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4416 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4417 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4418 watched expression from every thread.
4419
4420 @quotation
4421 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4422 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4423 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4424 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4425 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4426 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4427 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4428 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4429 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4430 @end quotation
4431
4432 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4433
4434 @node Set Catchpoints
4435 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4436 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4437 @cindex exception handlers
4438 @cindex event handling
4439
4440 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4441 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4442 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4443
4444 @table @code
4445 @kindex catch
4446 @item catch @var{event}
4447 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4448
4449 @table @code
4450 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4451 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4452 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4453 @kindex catch throw
4454 @kindex catch rethrow
4455 @kindex catch catch
4456 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4457 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4458
4459 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4460 regular expression will be caught.
4461
4462 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4463 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4464 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4465 exception being thrown.
4466
4467 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4468 @value{GDBN}:
4469
4470 @itemize @bullet
4471 @item
4472 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4473 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4474 supported.
4475
4476 @item
4477 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4478 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4479 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4480 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4481 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4482 built.
4483
4484 @item
4485 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4486 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4487
4488 @item
4489 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4490 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4491 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4492 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4493
4494 @item
4495 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4496 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4497 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4498 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4499 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4500 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4501 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4502 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4503 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4504
4505 @item
4506 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4507
4508 @item
4509 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4510 @end itemize
4511
4512 @item exception
4513 @kindex catch exception
4514 @cindex Ada exception catching
4515 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4516 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4517 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4518 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4519 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4520
4521 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4522 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4523 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4524 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4525 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4526 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4527 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4528 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4529
4530 @item handlers
4531 @kindex catch handlers
4532 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
4533 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
4534 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
4535 specified at the end of the command
4536 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
4537 only when this specific exception is handled.
4538 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
4539
4540 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
4541 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
4542 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
4543 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
4544 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
4545 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
4546 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
4547 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
4548 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4549
4550 @item exception unhandled
4551 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4552 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4553
4554 @item assert
4555 @kindex catch assert
4556 A failed Ada assertion.
4557
4558 @item exec
4559 @kindex catch exec
4560 @cindex break on fork/exec
4561 A call to @code{exec}.
4562
4563 @anchor{catch syscall}
4564 @item syscall
4565 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4566 @kindex catch syscall
4567 @cindex break on a system call.
4568 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4569 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4570 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4571 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4572 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4573 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4574 will be caught.
4575
4576 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4577 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4578 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4579 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4580
4581 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4582 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4583 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4584 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4585
4586 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4587 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4588 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4589 available choices.
4590
4591 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4592 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4593 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4594 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4595 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4596 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4597 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4598 behind the OS upgrades).
4599
4600 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4601 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4602 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4603 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4604 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4605 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4606 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4607 syscall groups available on your environment.
4608
4609 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4610 arguments to it:
4611
4612 @smallexample
4613 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4614 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4615 (@value{GDBP}) r
4616 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4617
4618 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4619 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4620 (@value{GDBP}) c
4621 Continuing.
4622
4623 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4624 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4625 (@value{GDBP})
4626 @end smallexample
4627
4628 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4629
4630 @smallexample
4631 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4632 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4633 (@value{GDBP}) r
4634 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4635
4636 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4637 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4638 (@value{GDBP}) c
4639 Continuing.
4640
4641 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4642 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4643 (@value{GDBP})
4644 @end smallexample
4645
4646 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4647 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4648 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4649
4650 @smallexample
4651 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4652 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4653 (@value{GDBP}) r
4654 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4655
4656 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4657 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4658 (@value{GDBP}) c
4659 Continuing.
4660
4661 Program exited normally.
4662 (@value{GDBP})
4663 @end smallexample
4664
4665 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4666
4667 @smallexample
4668 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4669 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4670 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4671 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4672 (@value{GDBP}) r
4673 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4674
4675 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4676 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4677
4678 (@value{GDBP}) c
4679 Continuing.
4680 @end smallexample
4681
4682 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4683 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4684 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4685 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4686
4687 @smallexample
4688 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4689 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4690 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4691 (@value{GDBP})
4692 @end smallexample
4693
4694 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4695 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4696 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4697 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4698 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4699 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4700
4701 @smallexample
4702 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4703 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4704 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4705 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4706 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4707 (@value{GDBP})
4708 @end smallexample
4709
4710 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4711
4712 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4713 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4714
4715 @smallexample
4716 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4717 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4718 @end smallexample
4719
4720 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4721
4722 @item fork
4723 @kindex catch fork
4724 A call to @code{fork}.
4725
4726 @item vfork
4727 @kindex catch vfork
4728 A call to @code{vfork}.
4729
4730 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4731 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4732 @kindex catch load
4733 @kindex catch unload
4734 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4735 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4736 matches one of the affected libraries.
4737
4738 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4739 @kindex catch signal
4740 The delivery of a signal.
4741
4742 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4743 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4744 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4745
4746 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4747 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4748 signal names.
4749
4750 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4751 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4752 will be caught.
4753
4754 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4755 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4756 catchpoint.
4757
4758 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4759 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4760 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4761 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4762 commands.
4763
4764 @end table
4765
4766 @item tcatch @var{event}
4767 @kindex tcatch
4768 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4769 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4770
4771 @end table
4772
4773 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4774
4775
4776 @node Delete Breaks
4777 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4778
4779 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4780 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4781 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4782 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4783 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4784 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4785
4786 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4787 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4788 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4789 their breakpoint numbers.
4790
4791 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4792 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4793 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4794
4795 @table @code
4796 @kindex clear
4797 @item clear
4798 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4799 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4800 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4801 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4802
4803 @item clear @var{location}
4804 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4805 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4806 most useful ones are listed below:
4807
4808 @table @code
4809 @item clear @var{function}
4810 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4811 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4812
4813 @item clear @var{linenum}
4814 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4815 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4816 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4817 @end table
4818
4819 @cindex delete breakpoints
4820 @kindex delete
4821 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4822 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4823 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4824 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4825 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4826 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4827 @end table
4828
4829 @node Disabling
4830 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4831
4832 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4833 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4834 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4835 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4836 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4837
4838 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4839 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4840 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4841 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4842 do not know which numbers to use.
4843
4844 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4845 affects all of its locations.
4846
4847 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4848 different states of enablement:
4849
4850 @itemize @bullet
4851 @item
4852 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4853 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4854 @item
4855 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4856 @item
4857 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4858 disabled.
4859 @item
4860 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4861 N times, then becomes disabled.
4862 @item
4863 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4864 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4865 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4866 @end itemize
4867
4868 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4869 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4870
4871 @table @code
4872 @kindex disable
4873 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4874 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4875 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4876 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4877 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4878 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4879 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4880
4881 @kindex enable
4882 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4883 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4884 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4885
4886 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4887 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4888 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4889
4890 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4891 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4892 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4893 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4894 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4895 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4896 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4897
4898 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4899 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4900 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4901 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4902 @end table
4903
4904 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4905 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4906 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4907 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4908 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4909 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4910 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4911 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4912 Stepping}.)
4913
4914 @node Conditions
4915 @subsection Break Conditions
4916 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4917 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4918
4919 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4920 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4921 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4922 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4923 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4924 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4925 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4926 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4927
4928 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4929 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4930 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4931 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4932 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4933
4934 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4935 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4936 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4937 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4938 one.
4939
4940 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4941 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4942 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4943 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4944 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4945 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4946 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4947 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4948 conditions for the
4949 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4950 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4951
4952 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4953 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4954 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4955 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4956 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4957 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4958
4959 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4960 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4961 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4962 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4963 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4964
4965 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4966 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4967 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4968 with the @code{condition} command.
4969
4970 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4971 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4972 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4973 catchpoint.
4974
4975 @table @code
4976 @kindex condition
4977 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4978 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4979 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4980 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4981 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4982 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4983 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4984 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4985 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4986 prints an error message:
4987
4988 @smallexample
4989 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4990 @end smallexample
4991
4992 @noindent
4993 @value{GDBN} does
4994 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4995 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4996 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4997
4998 @item condition @var{bnum}
4999 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
5000 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
5001 @end table
5002
5003 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
5004 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
5005 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
5006 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
5007 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
5008 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
5009 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
5010 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
5011 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
5012 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
5013 your program reaches it.
5014
5015 @table @code
5016 @kindex ignore
5017 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
5018 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
5019 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
5020 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
5021 takes no action.
5022
5023 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
5024 a count of zero.
5025
5026 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
5027 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
5028 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
5029 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
5030
5031 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
5032 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
5033 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
5034
5035 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
5036 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
5037 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5038 Variables}.
5039 @end table
5040
5041 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
5042
5043
5044 @node Break Commands
5045 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
5046
5047 @cindex breakpoint commands
5048 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
5049 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
5050 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
5051 enable other breakpoints.
5052
5053 @table @code
5054 @kindex commands
5055 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
5056 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5057 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
5058 @itemx end
5059 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
5060 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
5061 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
5062
5063 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
5064 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
5065
5066 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5067 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5068 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5069 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5070 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5071 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5072 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5073 Expressions}).
5074 @end table
5075
5076 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5077 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5078
5079 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5080 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5081 that resumes execution.
5082
5083 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5084 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5085 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5086 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5087 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5088
5089 @kindex silent
5090 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5091 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5092 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5093 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5094 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5095 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5096
5097 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5098 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5099 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5100
5101 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5102 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5103
5104 @smallexample
5105 break foo if x>0
5106 commands
5107 silent
5108 printf "x is %d\n",x
5109 cont
5110 end
5111 @end smallexample
5112
5113 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5114 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5115 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5116 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5117 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5118 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5119 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5120
5121 @smallexample
5122 break 403
5123 commands
5124 silent
5125 set x = y + 4
5126 cont
5127 end
5128 @end smallexample
5129
5130 @node Dynamic Printf
5131 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5132
5133 @cindex dynamic printf
5134 @cindex dprintf
5135 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5136 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5137 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5138 having to recompile it.
5139
5140 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5141 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5142 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5143 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5144 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5145 redirects to files and so forth.
5146
5147 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5148 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5149 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5150 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5151 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5152 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5153 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5154
5155 @table @code
5156 @kindex dprintf
5157 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5158 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5159 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5160 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5161
5162 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5163 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5164 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5165 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5166 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5167 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5168
5169 @table @code
5170 @item gdb
5171 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5172 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5173
5174 @item call
5175 @kindex dprintf-style call
5176 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5177 @code{printf}).
5178
5179 @item agent
5180 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5181 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5182 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5183 support running commands on the target.
5184 @end table
5185
5186 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5187 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5188 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5189 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5190 command.
5191
5192 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5193 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5194 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5195 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5196 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5197 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5198
5199 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5200 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5201 you could do the following:
5202
5203 @example
5204 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5205 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5206 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5207 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5208 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5209 (gdb) info break
5210 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5211 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5212 continue
5213 (gdb)
5214 @end example
5215
5216 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5217 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5218 the variable settings.
5219
5220 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5221 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5222 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5223 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5224 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5225 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5226
5227 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5228 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5229 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5230
5231 @end table
5232
5233 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5234 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5235 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5236 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5237 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5238 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5239
5240 @node Save Breakpoints
5241 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5242
5243 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5244 breakpoints}} command.
5245
5246 @table @code
5247 @kindex save breakpoints
5248 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5249 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5250 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5251 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5252 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5253 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5254 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5255 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5256 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5257 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5258 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5259 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5260 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5261 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5262 that can no longer be recreated.
5263 @end table
5264
5265 @node Static Probe Points
5266 @subsection Static Probe Points
5267
5268 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5269 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5270 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5271 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5272 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5273
5274 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5275 ELF-compatible systems:
5276
5277 @itemize @bullet
5278
5279 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5280 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5281 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5282 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5283 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5284 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5285 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5286 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5287
5288 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5289 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5290 C@t{++} languages.
5291 @end itemize
5292
5293 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5294 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5295 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5296 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5297 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5298 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5299 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5300 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5301 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5302
5303 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5304 probes}, with optional arguments:
5305
5306 @table @code
5307 @kindex info probes
5308 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5309 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5310 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5311 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5312
5313 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5314 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5315 probes from all providers are listed.
5316
5317 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5318 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5319 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5320
5321 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5322 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5323 given, all object files are considered.
5324
5325 @item info probes all
5326 List the available static probes, from all types.
5327 @end table
5328
5329 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5330 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5331 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5332 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5333 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5334
5335 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5336 commands, with optional arguments:
5337
5338 @table @code
5339 @kindex enable probes
5340 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5341 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5342 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5343 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5344
5345 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5346 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5347 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5348
5349 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5350 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5351 given, all object files are considered.
5352
5353 @kindex disable probes
5354 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5355 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5356 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5357 @end table
5358
5359 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5360 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5361 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5362 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5363 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5364 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5365 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5366 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5367 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5368 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5369 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5370 at the current probe point.
5371
5372 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5373 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5374 an error message.
5375
5376
5377 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5378 @node Error in Breakpoints
5379 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5380
5381 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5382 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5383
5384 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5385 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5386 @smallexample
5387 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5388 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5389 @end smallexample
5390
5391 @noindent
5392 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5393 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5394 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5395
5396 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5397 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5398
5399 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5400 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5401 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5402
5403 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5404 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5405 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5406 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5407
5408 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5409 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5410 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5411 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5412 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5413 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5414 first in the bundle.
5415
5416 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5417 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5418 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5419 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5420 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5421 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5422 is hit.
5423
5424 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5425 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5426
5427 @smallexample
5428 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5429 @end smallexample
5430
5431 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5432 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5433 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5434 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5435 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5436 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5437 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5438 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5439
5440 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5441 adjusted breakpoints:
5442
5443 @smallexample
5444 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5445 to 0x00010410.
5446 @end smallexample
5447
5448 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5449 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5450 frequently than expected.
5451
5452 @node Continuing and Stepping
5453 @section Continuing and Stepping
5454
5455 @cindex stepping
5456 @cindex continuing
5457 @cindex resuming execution
5458 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5459 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5460 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5461 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5462 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5463 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5464 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5465 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5466 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5467 handlers}).)
5468
5469 @table @code
5470 @kindex continue
5471 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5472 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5473 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5474 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5475 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5476 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5477 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5478 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5479 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5480 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5481
5482 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5483 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5484 @code{continue} is ignored.
5485
5486 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5487 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5488 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5489 @code{continue}.
5490 @end table
5491
5492 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5493 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5494 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5495 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5496
5497 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5498 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5499 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5500 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5501 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5502 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5503
5504 @table @code
5505 @kindex step
5506 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5507 @item step
5508 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5509 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5510 abbreviated @code{s}.
5511
5512 @quotation
5513 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5514 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5515 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5516 @c distinction here.
5517 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5518 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5519 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5520 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5521 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5522 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5523 below.
5524 @end quotation
5525
5526 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5527 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5528 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5529 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5530 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5531 called within the line.
5532
5533 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5534 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5535 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5536 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5537 was any debugging information about the routine.
5538
5539 @item step @var{count}
5540 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5541 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5542 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5543
5544 @kindex next
5545 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5546 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5547 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5548 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5549 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5550 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5551 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5552 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5553
5554 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5555
5556
5557 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5558 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5559 @c
5560 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5561 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5562 @c function are executed without stopping.
5563
5564 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5565 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5566 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5567
5568 @kindex set step-mode
5569 @item set step-mode
5570 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5571 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5572 @itemx set step-mode on
5573 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5574 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5575 information rather than stepping over it.
5576
5577 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5578 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5579 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5580
5581 @item set step-mode off
5582 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5583 debug information. This is the default.
5584
5585 @item show step-mode
5586 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5587 source line debug information.
5588
5589 @kindex finish
5590 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5591 @item finish
5592 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5593 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5594 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5595
5596 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5597 ,Returning from a Function}).
5598
5599 @kindex until
5600 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5601 @cindex run until specified location
5602 @item until
5603 @itemx u
5604 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5605 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5606 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5607 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5608 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5609 than the address of the jump.
5610
5611 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5612 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5613 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5614 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5615 through the next iteration.
5616
5617 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5618 stack frame.
5619
5620 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5621 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5622 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5623 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5624 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5625
5626 @smallexample
5627 (@value{GDBP}) f
5628 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5629 206 expand_input();
5630 (@value{GDBP}) until
5631 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5632 @end smallexample
5633
5634 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5635 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5636 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5637 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5638 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5639 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5640 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5641
5642 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5643 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5644 argument.
5645
5646 @item until @var{location}
5647 @itemx u @var{location}
5648 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5649 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5650 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5651 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5652 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5653 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5654 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5655 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5656 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5657 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5658 invocations have returned.
5659
5660 @smallexample
5661 94 int factorial (int value)
5662 95 @{
5663 96 if (value > 1) @{
5664 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5665 98 @}
5666 99 return (value);
5667 100 @}
5668 @end smallexample
5669
5670
5671 @kindex advance @var{location}
5672 @item advance @var{location}
5673 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5674 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5675 @ref{Specify Location}.
5676 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5677 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5678 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5679 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5680
5681
5682 @kindex stepi
5683 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5684 @item stepi
5685 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5686 @itemx si
5687 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5688
5689 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5690 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5691 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5692 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5693
5694 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5695
5696 @need 750
5697 @kindex nexti
5698 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5699 @item nexti
5700 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5701 @itemx ni
5702 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5703 proceed until the function returns.
5704
5705 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5706
5707 @end table
5708
5709 @anchor{range stepping}
5710 @cindex range stepping
5711 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5712 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5713 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5714 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5715 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5716 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5717 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5718 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5719 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5720 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5721 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5722 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5723 if necessary:
5724
5725 @table @code
5726 @kindex set range-stepping
5727 @kindex show range-stepping
5728 @item set range-stepping
5729 @itemx show range-stepping
5730 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5731
5732 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5733 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5734 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5735 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5736 default is @code{on}.
5737
5738 @end table
5739
5740 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5741 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5742 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5743
5744 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5745 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5746 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5747 a particular file when stepping.
5748
5749 For example, consider the following C function:
5750
5751 @smallexample
5752 101 int func()
5753 102 @{
5754 103 foo(boring());
5755 104 bar(boring());
5756 105 @}
5757 @end smallexample
5758
5759 @noindent
5760 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5761 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5762 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5763 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5764
5765 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5766 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5767 is called from many places.
5768
5769 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5770 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5771 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5772 @code{foo}.
5773
5774 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5775 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5776 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5777
5778 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5779 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5780 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5781 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5782 the underlying system.
5783 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5784 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5785
5786 @table @code
5787 @kindex skip
5788 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5789 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5790 that specify what to skip.
5791 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5792
5793 @table @code
5794 @item -file @var{file}
5795 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5796 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5797
5798 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5799 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5800 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5801 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5802 over when stepping.
5803
5804 @smallexample
5805 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5806 @end smallexample
5807
5808 @item -function @var{linespec}
5809 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5810 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5811 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5812 @xref{Specify Location}.
5813
5814 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5815 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5816 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5817 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5818
5819 This form is useful for complex function names.
5820 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5821 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5822 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5823 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5824 regular expression makes this easier.
5825
5826 @smallexample
5827 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5828 @end smallexample
5829
5830 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5831 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5832
5833 @smallexample
5834 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5835 @end smallexample
5836 @end table
5837
5838 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5839 will be skipped.
5840
5841 @kindex skip function
5842 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5843 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5844 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5845 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5846
5847 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5848 will be skipped.
5849
5850 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5851 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5852
5853 @kindex skip file
5854 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5855 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5856 will be skipped over when stepping.
5857
5858 @smallexample
5859 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5860 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5861 @end smallexample
5862
5863 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5864 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5865 @end table
5866
5867 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5868 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5869
5870 @table @code
5871 @kindex info skip
5872 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5873 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5874 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5875 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5876
5877 @table @emph
5878 @item Identifier
5879 A number identifying this skip.
5880 @item Enabled or Disabled
5881 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5882 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5883 @item Glob
5884 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5885 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5886 @item File
5887 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5888 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5889 @item RE
5890 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5891 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5892 @item Function
5893 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5894 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5895 @end table
5896
5897 @kindex skip delete
5898 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5899 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5900 skips.
5901
5902 @kindex skip enable
5903 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5904 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5905 skips.
5906
5907 @kindex skip disable
5908 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5909 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5910 skips.
5911
5912 @kindex set debug skip
5913 @item set debug skip @r{[}on|off@r{]}
5914 Set whether to print the debug output about skipping files and functions.
5915
5916 @kindex show debug skip
5917 @item show debug skip
5918 Show whether the debug output about skipping files and functions is printed.
5919
5920 @end table
5921
5922 @node Signals
5923 @section Signals
5924 @cindex signals
5925
5926 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5927 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5928 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5929 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5930 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5931 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5932 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5933 requested an alarm).
5934
5935 @cindex fatal signals
5936 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5937 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5938 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5939 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5940 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5941 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5942
5943 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5944 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5945 signal.
5946
5947 @cindex handling signals
5948 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5949 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5950 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5951 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5952 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5953
5954 @table @code
5955 @kindex info signals
5956 @kindex info handle
5957 @item info signals
5958 @itemx info handle
5959 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5960 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5961 the defined types of signals.
5962
5963 @item info signals @var{sig}
5964 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5965
5966 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5967
5968 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5969 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5970 for details about this command.
5971
5972 @kindex handle
5973 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5974 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5975 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5976 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5977 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5978 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5979 say what change to make.
5980 @end table
5981
5982 @c @group
5983 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5984 Their full names are:
5985
5986 @table @code
5987 @item nostop
5988 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5989 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5990
5991 @item stop
5992 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5993 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5994
5995 @item print
5996 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5997
5998 @item noprint
5999 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
6000 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
6001
6002 @item pass
6003 @itemx noignore
6004 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
6005 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
6006 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
6007
6008 @item nopass
6009 @itemx ignore
6010 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
6011 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
6012 @end table
6013 @c @end group
6014
6015 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
6016 program until you
6017 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
6018 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
6019 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
6020 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
6021 program sees that signal when you continue.
6022
6023 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
6024 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
6025 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
6026 erroneous signals.
6027
6028 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
6029 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
6030 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
6031 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
6032 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
6033 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
6034 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
6035 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
6036 Program a Signal}.
6037
6038 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
6039 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
6040
6041 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
6042 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
6043 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
6044 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
6045 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
6046 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
6047 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
6048 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
6049 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
6050 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
6051 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
6052 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
6053 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
6054
6055 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
6056
6057 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
6058 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
6059 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
6060 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
6061
6062 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
6063 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
6064 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
6065 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
6066
6067 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
6068 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
6069
6070 @smallexample
6071 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
6072 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
6073 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
6074 (@value{GDBP}) c
6075 Continuing.
6076
6077 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6078 main () sigusr1.c:28
6079 28 p = 0;
6080 (@value{GDBP}) si
6081 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6082 9 @{
6083 @end smallexample
6084
6085 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6086 program to receive the signal first:
6087
6088 @smallexample
6089 (@value{GDBP}) n
6090 28 p = 0;
6091 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6092 (@value{GDBP}) si
6093 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6094 9 @{
6095 (@value{GDBP})
6096 @end smallexample
6097
6098 @cindex extra signal information
6099 @anchor{extra signal information}
6100
6101 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6102 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6103 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6104 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6105 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6106 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6107 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6108 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6109 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6110 system header.
6111
6112 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6113 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6114
6115 @smallexample
6116 @group
6117 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6118 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6119 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6120 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6121 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6122 type = struct @{
6123 int si_signo;
6124 int si_errno;
6125 int si_code;
6126 union @{
6127 int _pad[28];
6128 struct @{...@} _kill;
6129 struct @{...@} _timer;
6130 struct @{...@} _rt;
6131 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6132 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6133 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6134 @} _sifields;
6135 @}
6136 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6137 type = struct @{
6138 void *si_addr;
6139 @}
6140 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6141 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6142 @end group
6143 @end smallexample
6144
6145 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6146
6147 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6148 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6149 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6150 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6151 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6152 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6153 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6154 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6155 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6156 information is displayed.
6157
6158 The usual output of a segfault is:
6159 @smallexample
6160 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6161 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6162 68 value = *(p + len);
6163 @end smallexample
6164
6165 While a bound violation is presented as:
6166 @smallexample
6167 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6168 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6169 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6170 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6171 68 value = *(p + len);
6172 @end smallexample
6173
6174 @node Thread Stops
6175 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6176
6177 @cindex stopped threads
6178 @cindex threads, stopped
6179
6180 @cindex continuing threads
6181 @cindex threads, continuing
6182
6183 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6184 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6185 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6186 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6187 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6188 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6189 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6190 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6191 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6192
6193 @menu
6194 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6195 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6196 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6197 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6198 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6199 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6200 @end menu
6201
6202 @node All-Stop Mode
6203 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6204
6205 @cindex all-stop mode
6206
6207 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6208 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6209 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6210 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6211 underfoot.
6212
6213 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6214 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6215 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6216
6217 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6218 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6219 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6220 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6221 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6222 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6223 stops.
6224
6225 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6226 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6227 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6228 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6229
6230 @cindex automatic thread selection
6231 @cindex switching threads automatically
6232 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6233 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6234 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6235 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6236 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6237 thread.
6238
6239 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6240 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6241
6242 @table @code
6243 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6244 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6245 @cindex lock scheduler
6246 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6247 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6248 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6249 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6250 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6251 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6252 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6253 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6254 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6255 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6256 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6257 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6258 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6259 @code{on} in replay mode.
6260
6261 @item show scheduler-locking
6262 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6263 @end table
6264
6265 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6266 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6267 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6268 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6269 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6270 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6271 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6272 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6273 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6274 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6275 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6276 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6277 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6278 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6279
6280 @table @code
6281 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6282 @item set schedule-multiple
6283 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6284 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6285 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6286 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6287 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6288 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6289
6290 @item show schedule-multiple
6291 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6292 multiple processes.
6293 @end table
6294
6295 @node Non-Stop Mode
6296 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6297
6298 @cindex non-stop mode
6299
6300 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6301 @c with more details.
6302
6303 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6304 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6305 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6306 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6307 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6308 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6309
6310 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6311 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6312 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6313 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6314 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6315 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6316 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6317 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6318 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6319 independently and simultaneously.
6320
6321 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6322 or attach to your program:
6323
6324 @smallexample
6325 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6326 set pagination off
6327
6328 # Finally, turn it on!
6329 set non-stop on
6330 @end smallexample
6331
6332 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6333
6334 @table @code
6335 @kindex set non-stop
6336 @item set non-stop on
6337 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6338 @item set non-stop off
6339 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6340 @kindex show non-stop
6341 @item show non-stop
6342 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6343 @end table
6344
6345 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6346 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6347 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6348 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6349 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6350 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6351 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6352 default.
6353
6354 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6355 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6356 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6357
6358 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6359 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6360 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6361 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6362 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6363
6364 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6365 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6366 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6367 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6368 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6369
6370 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6371
6372 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6373 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6374 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6375 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6376 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6377 previously current thread.
6378
6379 @node Background Execution
6380 @subsection Background Execution
6381
6382 @cindex foreground execution
6383 @cindex background execution
6384 @cindex asynchronous execution
6385 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6386
6387 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6388 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6389 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6390 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6391 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6392 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6393
6394 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6395 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6396
6397 @cindex @code{&}, background execution of commands
6398 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6399 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6400 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6401 are:
6402
6403 @table @code
6404 @kindex run&
6405 @item run
6406 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6407
6408 @item attach
6409 @kindex attach&
6410 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6411
6412 @item step
6413 @kindex step&
6414 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6415
6416 @item stepi
6417 @kindex stepi&
6418 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6419
6420 @item next
6421 @kindex next&
6422 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6423
6424 @item nexti
6425 @kindex nexti&
6426 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6427
6428 @item continue
6429 @kindex continue&
6430 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6431
6432 @item finish
6433 @kindex finish&
6434 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6435
6436 @item until
6437 @kindex until&
6438 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6439
6440 @end table
6441
6442 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6443 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6444 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6445 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6446 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6447 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6448
6449 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6450 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6451
6452 @table @code
6453 @kindex interrupt
6454 @item interrupt
6455 @itemx interrupt -a
6456
6457 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6458 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6459 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6460 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6461 @end table
6462
6463 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6464 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6465
6466 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6467 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6468 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6469
6470 @table @code
6471 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6472 @cindex thread breakpoints
6473 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6474 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6475 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6476 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6477 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6478 specify some source line.
6479
6480 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6481 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6482 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6483 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6484 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6485
6486 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6487 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6488 program.
6489
6490 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6491 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6492 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6493
6494 @smallexample
6495 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6496 @end smallexample
6497
6498 @end table
6499
6500 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6501 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6502 thread list. For example:
6503
6504 @smallexample
6505 (@value{GDBP}) c
6506 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6507 @end smallexample
6508
6509 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6510 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6511 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6512 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6513 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6514 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6515 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6516 command.
6517
6518 @node Interrupted System Calls
6519 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6520
6521 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6522 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6523 @cindex premature return from system calls
6524 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6525 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6526 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6527 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6528 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6529 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6530 stop execution.
6531
6532 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6533 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6534 style anyways.
6535
6536 For example, do not write code like this:
6537
6538 @smallexample
6539 sleep (10);
6540 @end smallexample
6541
6542 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6543 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6544
6545 Instead, write this:
6546
6547 @smallexample
6548 int unslept = 10;
6549 while (unslept > 0)
6550 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6551 @end smallexample
6552
6553 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6554 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6555 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6556 @value{GDBN}.
6557
6558 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6559 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6560 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6561 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6562
6563 @node Observer Mode
6564 @subsection Observer Mode
6565
6566 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6567 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6568 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6569 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6570 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6571
6572 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6573 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6574 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6575 mode.
6576
6577 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6578 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6579 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6580 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6581 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6582
6583 @table @code
6584
6585 @kindex observer
6586 @item set observer on
6587 @itemx set observer off
6588 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6589 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6590 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6591 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6592
6593 @item show observer
6594 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6595
6596 @kindex may-write-registers
6597 @item set may-write-registers on
6598 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6599 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6600 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6601 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6602
6603 @item show may-write-registers
6604 Show the current permission to write registers.
6605
6606 @kindex may-write-memory
6607 @item set may-write-memory on
6608 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6609 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6610 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6611 defaults to @code{on}.
6612
6613 @item show may-write-memory
6614 Show the current permission to write memory.
6615
6616 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6617 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6618 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6619 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6620 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6621 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6622
6623 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6624 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6625
6626 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6627 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6628 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6629 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6630 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6631 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6632 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6633
6634 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6635 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6636
6637 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6638 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6639 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6640 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6641 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6642 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6643 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6644
6645 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6646 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6647
6648 @kindex may-interrupt
6649 @item set may-interrupt on
6650 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6651 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6652 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6653 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6654 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6655
6656 @item show may-interrupt
6657 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6658
6659 @end table
6660
6661 @node Reverse Execution
6662 @chapter Running programs backward
6663 @cindex reverse execution
6664 @cindex running programs backward
6665
6666 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6667 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6668 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6669 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6670
6671 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6672 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6673 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6674 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6675 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6676 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6677
6678 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6679 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6680 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6681 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6682 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6683 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6684 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6685 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6686 prior values@footnote{
6687 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6688 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6689 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6690
6691 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6692 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6693 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6694 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6695 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6696 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6697 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6698 }.
6699
6700 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6701 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6702
6703 @table @code
6704 @kindex reverse-continue
6705 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6706 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6707 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6708 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6709 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6710 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6711 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6712
6713 @kindex reverse-step
6714 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6715 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6716 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6717 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6718
6719 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6720 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6721 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6722 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6723 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6724 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6725
6726 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6727 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6728
6729 @kindex reverse-stepi
6730 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6731 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6732 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6733 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6734 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6735 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6736 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6737
6738 @kindex reverse-next
6739 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6740 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6741 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6742 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6743 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6744 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6745 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6746 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6747 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6748 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6749
6750 @kindex reverse-nexti
6751 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6752 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6753 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6754 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6755 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6756 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6757 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6758 frame) is reached.
6759
6760 @kindex reverse-finish
6761 @item reverse-finish
6762 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6763 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6764 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6765 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6766
6767 @kindex set exec-direction
6768 @item set exec-direction
6769 Set the direction of target execution.
6770 @item set exec-direction reverse
6771 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6772 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6773 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6774 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6775 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6776 @item set exec-direction forward
6777 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6778 This is the default.
6779 @end table
6780
6781
6782 @node Process Record and Replay
6783 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6784 @cindex process record and replay
6785 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6786
6787 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6788 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6789 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6790
6791 @cindex replay mode
6792 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6793 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6794 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6795 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6796 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6797 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6798 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6799 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6800 execution log.
6801
6802 @cindex record mode
6803 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6804 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6805 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6806 for future replay.
6807
6808 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6809 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6810 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6811 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6812 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6813 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6814
6815 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6816 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6817 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6818 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6819
6820 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6821 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6822
6823 @table @code
6824 @kindex target record
6825 @kindex target record-full
6826 @kindex target record-btrace
6827 @kindex record
6828 @kindex record full
6829 @kindex record btrace
6830 @kindex record btrace bts
6831 @kindex record btrace pt
6832 @kindex record bts
6833 @kindex record pt
6834 @kindex rec
6835 @kindex rec full
6836 @kindex rec btrace
6837 @kindex rec btrace bts
6838 @kindex rec btrace pt
6839 @kindex rec bts
6840 @kindex rec pt
6841 @item record @var{method}
6842 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6843 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6844 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6845 recording methods are available:
6846
6847 @table @code
6848 @item full
6849 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6850 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6851 execution.
6852
6853 @item btrace @var{format}
6854 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6855 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6856 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6857 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6858 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6859 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6860 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6861
6862 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6863 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6864 formats are available:
6865
6866 @table @code
6867 @item bts
6868 @cindex branch trace store
6869 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6870 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6871 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6872
6873 @item pt
6874 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6875 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6876 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6877 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6878
6879 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6880 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6881 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6882
6883 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6884 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6885 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6886 buffer-size with care.
6887 @end table
6888
6889 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6890 @end table
6891
6892 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6893 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6894 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6895 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6896
6897 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6898 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6899 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6900 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6901 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6902
6903 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6904 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6905 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6906 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6907 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6908 does not support these two modes.
6909
6910 @kindex record stop
6911 @kindex rec s
6912 @item record stop
6913 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6914 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6915 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6916
6917 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6918 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6919 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6920 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6921 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6922
6923 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6924 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6925 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6926 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6927 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6928
6929 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6930 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6931
6932 @kindex record goto
6933 @item record goto
6934 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6935 ways to specify the location to go to:
6936
6937 @table @code
6938 @item record goto begin
6939 @itemx record goto start
6940 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6941
6942 @item record goto end
6943 Go to the end of the execution log.
6944
6945 @item record goto @var{n}
6946 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6947 @end table
6948
6949 @kindex record save
6950 @item record save @var{filename}
6951 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6952 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6953 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6954
6955 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6956
6957 @kindex record restore
6958 @item record restore @var{filename}
6959 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6960 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6961
6962 @kindex set record full
6963 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6964 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6965 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6966 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6967
6968 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6969 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6970 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6971 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6972 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6973 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6974 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6975 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6976
6977 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6978 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6979 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6980
6981 @kindex show record full
6982 @item show record full insn-number-max
6983 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6984 recording method.
6985
6986 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6987 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6988 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6989 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6990 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6991 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6992 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6993 oldest one to be deleted.
6994
6995 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6996 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6997
6998 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6999 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
7000
7001 @item set record full memory-query
7002 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
7003 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
7004 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
7005 case.
7006
7007 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
7008 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
7009 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
7010 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
7011 results.
7012
7013 @item show record full memory-query
7014 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
7015
7016 @kindex set record btrace
7017 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
7018 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
7019 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
7020 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
7021 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
7022 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
7023 You can use the following command for that:
7024
7025 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
7026 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
7027 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
7028 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
7029 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
7030 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
7031 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
7032 position.
7033
7034 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
7035 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
7036 errata when decoding the trace.
7037
7038 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
7039 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
7040 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
7041 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
7042 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
7043 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
7044 which the trace was recorded.
7045
7046 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
7047 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
7048 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
7049 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
7050 disable the workarounds.
7051
7052 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
7053 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{procesor identifier}}. In addition,
7054 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
7055 (default).
7056
7057 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
7058 identifiers are currently supported:
7059
7060 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
7061
7062 @item @code{intel}
7063 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
7064
7065 @end multitable
7066
7067 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
7068 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
7069
7070 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
7071 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
7072 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
7073
7074 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7075 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7076 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7077 supports.
7078
7079 @smallexample
7080 (gdb) info record
7081 Active record target: record-btrace
7082 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7083 Buffer size: 16kB.
7084 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7085 (gdb) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7086 (gdb) info record
7087 Active record target: record-btrace
7088 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7089 Buffer size: 16kB.
7090 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7091 @end smallexample
7092
7093 @kindex show record btrace
7094 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7095 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7096
7097 @item show record btrace cpu
7098 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7099 workarounds.
7100
7101 @kindex set record btrace bts
7102 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7103 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7104 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7105 format. Default is 64KB.
7106
7107 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7108 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7109 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7110 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7111 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7112 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7113 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7114
7115 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7116 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7117
7118 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7119 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7120
7121 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7122 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7123 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7124
7125 @kindex set record btrace pt
7126 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7127 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7128 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7129 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7130
7131 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7132 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7133 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7134 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7135 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7136 actual buffer size for each thread.
7137
7138 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7139 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7140
7141 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7142 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7143
7144 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7145 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7146 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7147
7148 @kindex info record
7149 @item info record
7150 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7151 method:
7152
7153 @table @code
7154 @item full
7155 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7156 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7157
7158 @itemize @bullet
7159 @item
7160 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7161 @item
7162 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7163 @item
7164 Highest recorded instruction number.
7165 @item
7166 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7167 @item
7168 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7169 @item
7170 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7171 @end itemize
7172
7173 @item btrace
7174 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7175
7176 @itemize @bullet
7177 @item
7178 Recording format.
7179 @item
7180 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7181 @item
7182 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7183 instructions.
7184 @item
7185 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7186 @end itemize
7187
7188 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7189 @itemize @bullet
7190 @item
7191 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7192 @end itemize
7193
7194 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7195 @itemize @bullet
7196 @item
7197 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7198 @end itemize
7199 @end table
7200
7201 @kindex record delete
7202 @kindex rec del
7203 @item record delete
7204 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7205 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7206 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7207 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7208
7209 @kindex record instruction-history
7210 @kindex rec instruction-history
7211 @item record instruction-history
7212 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7213 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7214 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7215 are printed in execution order.
7216
7217 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7218 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7219 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7220
7221 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7222 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7223 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7224 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7225 @code{/p} modifier.
7226
7227 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7228 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7229 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7230
7231 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7232 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7233
7234 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7235 disassemble:
7236
7237 @table @code
7238 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7239 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7240 @var{insn}.
7241
7242 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7243 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7244 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7245 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7246 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7247 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7248
7249 @item record instruction-history
7250 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7251
7252 @item record instruction-history -
7253 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7254
7255 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7256 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7257 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7258 number @var{end} is included.
7259 @end table
7260
7261 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7262
7263 @kindex set record
7264 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7265 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7266 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7267 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7268 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7269
7270 @kindex show record
7271 @item show record instruction-history-size
7272 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7273 instruction-history} command.
7274
7275 @kindex record function-call-history
7276 @kindex rec function-call-history
7277 @item record function-call-history
7278 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7279 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7280 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7281 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7282 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7283 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7284 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7285 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7286 given together.
7287
7288 @smallexample
7289 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7290 1 void foo (void)
7291 2 @{
7292 3 @}
7293 4
7294 5 void bar (void)
7295 6 @{
7296 7 ...
7297 8 foo ();
7298 9 ...
7299 10 @}
7300 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7301 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7302 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7303 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7304 @end smallexample
7305
7306 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7307 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7308 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7309 to print:
7310
7311 @table @code
7312 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7313 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7314
7315 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7316 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7317 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7318 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7319 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7320
7321 @item record function-call-history
7322 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7323
7324 @item record function-call-history -
7325 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7326
7327 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7328 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7329 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7330 @end table
7331
7332 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7333
7334 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7335 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7336 Define how many lines to print in the
7337 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7338 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7339
7340 @item show record function-call-history-size
7341 Show how many lines to print in the
7342 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7343 @end table
7344
7345
7346 @node Stack
7347 @chapter Examining the Stack
7348
7349 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7350 stopped and how it got there.
7351
7352 @cindex call stack
7353 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7354 is generated.
7355 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7356 the arguments of the call,
7357 and the local variables of the function being called.
7358 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7359 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7360 stack}.
7361
7362 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7363 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7364
7365 @cindex selected frame
7366 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7367 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7368 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7369 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7370 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7371 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7372
7373 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7374 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7375 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7376
7377 @menu
7378 * Frames:: Stack frames
7379 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7380 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7381 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7382 * Frame Apply:: Applying a command to several frames
7383 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7384
7385 @end menu
7386
7387 @node Frames
7388 @section Stack Frames
7389
7390 @cindex frame, definition
7391 @cindex stack frame
7392 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7393 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7394 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7395 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7396 which the function is executing.
7397
7398 @cindex initial frame
7399 @cindex outermost frame
7400 @cindex innermost frame
7401 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7402 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7403 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7404 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7405 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7406 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7407 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7408 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7409
7410 @cindex frame pointer
7411 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7412 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7413 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7414 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7415 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7416 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7417
7418 @cindex frame level
7419 @cindex frame number
7420 @value{GDBN} labels each existing stack frame with a @dfn{level}, a
7421 number that is zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that
7422 called it, and so on upward. These level numbers give you a way of
7423 designating stack frames in @value{GDBN} commands. The terms
7424 @dfn{frame number} and @dfn{frame level} can be used interchangeably to
7425 describe this number.
7426
7427 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7428 @c underflow problems.
7429 @cindex frameless execution
7430 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7431 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7432 @smallexample
7433 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7434 @end smallexample
7435 generates functions without a frame.)
7436 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7437 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7438 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7439 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7440 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7441 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7442 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7443
7444 @node Backtrace
7445 @section Backtraces
7446
7447 @cindex traceback
7448 @cindex call stack traces
7449 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7450 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7451 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7452 stack.
7453
7454 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7455 @kindex backtrace
7456 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7457 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7458 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7459 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7460 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7461 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7462
7463 @table @code
7464 @item backtrace [@var{args}@dots{}]
7465 @itemx bt [@var{args}@dots{}]
7466 Print the backtrace of the entire stack. The optional @var{args} can
7467 be one of the following:
7468
7469 @table @code
7470 @item @var{n}
7471 @itemx @var{n}
7472 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7473 number.
7474
7475 @item -@var{n}
7476 @itemx -@var{n}
7477 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7478 number.
7479
7480 @item full
7481 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
7482 with a number to limit the number of frames shown.
7483
7484 @item no-filters
7485 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7486 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7487 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7488 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7489 support.
7490
7491 @item hide
7492 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
7493 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
7494 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{hide}
7495 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
7496 @end table
7497 @end table
7498
7499 @kindex where
7500 @kindex info stack
7501 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7502 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7503
7504 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7505 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7506 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7507 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7508 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7509 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7510 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7511 multi-threaded program.
7512
7513 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7514 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7515 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7516 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7517 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7518 line number.
7519
7520 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7521 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7522
7523 @smallexample
7524 @group
7525 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7526 at builtin.c:993
7527 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7528 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7529 at macro.c:71
7530 (More stack frames follow...)
7531 @end group
7532 @end smallexample
7533
7534 @noindent
7535 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7536 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7537 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7538
7539 @noindent
7540 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7541 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7542 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7543 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7544 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7545
7546 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7547 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7548 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7549 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7550 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7551 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7552 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7553 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7554 such a backtrace might look like:
7555
7556 @smallexample
7557 @group
7558 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7559 at builtin.c:993
7560 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7561 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7562 at macro.c:71
7563 (More stack frames follow...)
7564 @end group
7565 @end smallexample
7566
7567 @noindent
7568 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7569 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7570
7571 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7572 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7573 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7574
7575 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7576 @cindex program entry point
7577 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7578 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7579 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7580 @code{main}@footnote{
7581 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7582 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7583 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7584 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7585 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7586 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7587
7588 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7589 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7590
7591 @table @code
7592 @item set backtrace past-main
7593 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7594 @kindex set backtrace
7595 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7596
7597 @item set backtrace past-main off
7598 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7599 default.
7600
7601 @item show backtrace past-main
7602 @kindex show backtrace
7603 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7604
7605 @item set backtrace past-entry
7606 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7607 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7608 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7609 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7610
7611 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7612 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7613 application. This is the default.
7614
7615 @item show backtrace past-entry
7616 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7617
7618 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7619 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7620 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7621 @cindex backtrace limit
7622 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7623 or zero means unlimited levels.
7624
7625 @item show backtrace limit
7626 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7627 @end table
7628
7629 You can control how file names are displayed.
7630
7631 @table @code
7632 @item set filename-display
7633 @itemx set filename-display relative
7634 @cindex filename-display
7635 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7636
7637 @item set filename-display basename
7638 Display only basename of a filename.
7639
7640 @item set filename-display absolute
7641 Display an absolute filename.
7642
7643 @item show filename-display
7644 Show the current way to display filenames.
7645 @end table
7646
7647 @node Selection
7648 @section Selecting a Frame
7649
7650 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7651 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7652 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7653 of the stack frame just selected.
7654
7655 @table @code
7656 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7657 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7658 @item frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7659 @item f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7660 The @command{frame} command allows different stack frames to be
7661 selected. The @var{frame-selection-spec} can be any of the following:
7662
7663 @table @code
7664 @kindex frame level
7665 @item @var{num}
7666 @item level @var{num}
7667 Select frame level @var{num}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7668 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7669 innermost one, and so on. The highest level frame is usually the one
7670 for @code{main}.
7671
7672 As this is the most common method of navigating the frame stack, the
7673 string @command{level} can be omitted. For example, the following two
7674 commands are equivalent:
7675
7676 @smallexample
7677 (@value{GDBP}) frame 3
7678 (@value{GDBP}) frame level 3
7679 @end smallexample
7680
7681 @kindex frame address
7682 @item address @var{stack-address}
7683 Select the frame with stack address @var{stack-address}. The
7684 @var{stack-address} for a frame can be seen in the output of
7685 @command{info frame}, for example:
7686
7687 @smallexample
7688 (gdb) info frame
7689 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7690 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
7691 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
7692 source language c++.
7693 Arglist at unknown address.
7694 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
7695 @end smallexample
7696
7697 The @var{stack-address} for this frame is @code{0x7fffffffda30} as
7698 indicated by the line:
7699
7700 @smallexample
7701 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7702 @end smallexample
7703
7704 @kindex frame function
7705 @item function @var{function-name}
7706 Select the stack frame for function @var{function-name}. If there are
7707 multiple stack frames for function @var{function-name} then the inner
7708 most stack frame is selected.
7709
7710 @kindex frame view
7711 @item view @var{stack-address} @r{[} @var{pc-addr} @r{]}
7712 View a frame that is not part of @value{GDBN}'s backtrace. The frame
7713 viewed has stack address @var{stack-addr}, and optionally, a program
7714 counter address of @var{pc-addr}.
7715
7716 This is useful mainly if the chaining of stack frames has been
7717 damaged by a bug, making it impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign
7718 numbers properly to all frames. In addition, this can be useful
7719 when your program has multiple stacks and switches between them.
7720
7721 When viewing a frame outside the current backtrace using
7722 @command{frame view} then you can always return to the original
7723 stack using one of the previous stack frame selection instructions,
7724 for example @command{frame level 0}.
7725
7726 @end table
7727
7728 @kindex up
7729 @item up @var{n}
7730 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7731 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7732 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7733
7734 @kindex down
7735 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7736 @item down @var{n}
7737 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7738 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7739 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7740 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7741 @end table
7742
7743 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7744 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7745 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7746 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7747
7748 @need 1000
7749 For example:
7750
7751 @smallexample
7752 @group
7753 (@value{GDBP}) up
7754 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7755 at env.c:10
7756 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7757 @end group
7758 @end smallexample
7759
7760 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7761 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7762 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7763 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7764 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7765 for details.
7766
7767 @table @code
7768 @kindex select-frame
7769 @item select-frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7770 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7771 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7772 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7773 output might be unnecessary and distracting. The
7774 @var{frame-selection-spec} is as for the @command{frame} command
7775 described in @ref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7776
7777 @kindex down-silently
7778 @kindex up-silently
7779 @item up-silently @var{n}
7780 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7781 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7782 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7783 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7784 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7785 distracting.
7786 @end table
7787
7788 @node Frame Info
7789 @section Information About a Frame
7790
7791 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7792 stack frame.
7793
7794 @table @code
7795 @item frame
7796 @itemx f
7797 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7798 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7799 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7800 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7801 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7802
7803 @kindex info frame
7804 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7805 @item info frame
7806 @itemx info f
7807 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7808 including:
7809
7810 @itemize @bullet
7811 @item
7812 the address of the frame
7813 @item
7814 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7815 @item
7816 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7817 @item
7818 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7819 @item
7820 the address of the frame's arguments
7821 @item
7822 the address of the frame's local variables
7823 @item
7824 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7825 @item
7826 which registers were saved in the frame
7827 @end itemize
7828
7829 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7830 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7831 the usual conventions.
7832
7833 @item info frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7834 @itemx info f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7835 Print a verbose description of the frame selected by
7836 @var{frame-selection-spec}. The @var{frame-selection-spec} is the
7837 same as for the @command{frame} command (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting
7838 a Frame}). The selected frame remains unchanged by this command.
7839
7840 @kindex info args
7841 @item info args [-q]
7842 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7843
7844 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
7845 printing header information and messages explaining why no argument
7846 have been printed.
7847
7848 @item info args [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
7849 Like @kbd{info args}, but only print the arguments selected
7850 with the provided regexp(s).
7851
7852 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose names
7853 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
7854
7855 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose
7856 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
7857 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
7858 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
7859 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
7860 of special characters or quotes.
7861
7862 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
7863 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
7864 @var{type_regexp}.
7865
7866 @item info locals [-q]
7867 @kindex info locals
7868 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7869 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7870 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7871
7872 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
7873 printing header information and messages explaining why no local variables
7874 have been printed.
7875
7876 @item info locals [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
7877 Like @kbd{info locals}, but only print the local variables selected
7878 with the provided regexp(s).
7879
7880 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose names
7881 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
7882
7883 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose
7884 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
7885 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
7886 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
7887 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
7888 of special characters or quotes.
7889
7890 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a local variable
7891 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
7892 @var{type_regexp}.
7893
7894 The command @kbd{info locals -q -t @var{type_regexp}} can usefully be
7895 combined with the commands @kbd{frame apply} and @kbd{thread apply}.
7896 For example, your program might use Resource Acquisition Is
7897 Initialization types (RAII) such as @code{lock_something_t}: each
7898 local variable of type @code{lock_something_t} automatically places a
7899 lock that is destroyed when the variable goes out of scope. You can
7900 then list all acquired locks in your program by doing
7901 @smallexample
7902 thread apply all -s frame apply all -s info locals -q -t lock_something_t
7903 @end smallexample
7904 @noindent
7905 or the equivalent shorter form
7906 @smallexample
7907 tfaas i lo -q -t lock_something_t
7908 @end smallexample
7909
7910 @end table
7911
7912 @node Frame Apply
7913 @section Applying a Command to Several Frames.
7914 @kindex frame apply
7915 @cindex apply command to several frames
7916 @table @code
7917 @item frame apply [all | @var{count} | @var{-count} | level @var{level}@dots{}] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
7918 The @code{frame apply} command allows you to apply the named
7919 @var{command} to one or more frames.
7920
7921 @table @code
7922 @item @code{all}
7923 Specify @code{all} to apply @var{command} to all frames.
7924
7925 @item @var{count}
7926 Use @var{count} to apply @var{command} to the innermost @var{count}
7927 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7928
7929 @item @var{-count}
7930 Use @var{-count} to apply @var{command} to the outermost @var{count}
7931 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7932
7933 @item @code{level}
7934 Use @code{level} to apply @var{command} to the set of frames identified
7935 by the @var{level} list. @var{level} is a frame level or a range of frame
7936 levels as @var{level1}-@var{level2}. The frame level is the number shown
7937 in the first field of the @samp{backtrace} command output.
7938 E.g., @samp{2-4 6-8 3} indicates to apply @var{command} for the frames
7939 at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on frame at level 3.
7940
7941 @end table
7942
7943 @end table
7944
7945 Note that the frames on which @code{frame apply} applies a command are
7946 also influenced by the @code{set backtrace} settings such as @code{set
7947 backtrace past-main} and @code{set backtrace limit N}. See
7948 @xref{Backtrace,,Backtraces}.
7949
7950 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
7951 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a frame. @var{flag}
7952 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
7953 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
7954 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
7955
7956 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some frame information before the
7957 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
7958 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{frame apply}. The
7959 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
7960
7961 @table @code
7962 @item -c
7963 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
7964 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
7965 @code{frame apply} then continues.
7966 @item -s
7967 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
7968 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
7969 That is, the execution continues, but the frame information and errors
7970 are not printed.
7971 @item -q
7972 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the frame
7973 information.
7974 @end table
7975
7976 The following example shows how the flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} are
7977 working when applying the command @code{p j} to all frames, where
7978 variable @code{j} can only be successfully printed in the outermost
7979 @code{#1 main} frame.
7980
7981 @smallexample
7982 @group
7983 (gdb) frame apply all p j
7984 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7985 No symbol "j" in current context.
7986 (gdb) frame apply all -c p j
7987 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7988 No symbol "j" in current context.
7989 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7990 $1 = 5
7991 (gdb) frame apply all -s p j
7992 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7993 $2 = 5
7994 (gdb)
7995 @end group
7996 @end smallexample
7997
7998 By default, @samp{frame apply}, prints the frame location
7999 information before the command output:
8000
8001 @smallexample
8002 @group
8003 (gdb) frame apply all p $sp
8004 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8005 $4 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8006 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8007 $5 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8008 (gdb)
8009 @end group
8010 @end smallexample
8011
8012 If flag @code{-q} is given, no frame information is printed:
8013 @smallexample
8014 @group
8015 (gdb) frame apply all -q p $sp
8016 $12 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8017 $13 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8018 (gdb)
8019 @end group
8020 @end smallexample
8021
8022 @table @code
8023
8024 @kindex faas
8025 @cindex apply a command to all frames (ignoring errors and empty output)
8026 @item faas @var{command}
8027 Shortcut for @code{frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
8028 Applies @var{command} on all frames, ignoring errors and empty output.
8029
8030 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
8031 argument without knowing the frame where this variable or argument
8032 is, using:
8033 @smallexample
8034 (@value{GDBP}) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
8035 @end smallexample
8036
8037 Note that the command @code{tfaas @var{command}} applies @var{command}
8038 on all frames of all threads. See @xref{Threads,,Threads}.
8039 @end table
8040
8041
8042 @node Frame Filter Management
8043 @section Management of Frame Filters.
8044 @cindex managing frame filters
8045
8046 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
8047 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
8048
8049 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
8050 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
8051
8052 @table @code
8053 @kindex info frame-filter
8054 @item info frame-filter
8055 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
8056 their name, priority and enabled status.
8057
8058 @kindex disable frame-filter
8059 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
8060 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8061 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8062 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8063 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8064 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8065 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
8066 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
8067 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8068 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
8069 may be enabled again later.
8070
8071 @kindex enable frame-filter
8072 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8073 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8074 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8075 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8076 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8077 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
8078 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
8079 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8080 @var{filter-dictionary}.
8081
8082 Example:
8083
8084 @smallexample
8085 (gdb) info frame-filter
8086
8087 global frame-filters:
8088 Priority Enabled Name
8089 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8090 100 Yes Reverse
8091
8092 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8093 Priority Enabled Name
8094 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8095
8096 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8097 Priority Enabled Name
8098 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
8099
8100 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
8101 (gdb) info frame-filter
8102
8103 global frame-filters:
8104 Priority Enabled Name
8105 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8106 100 Yes Reverse
8107
8108 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8109 Priority Enabled Name
8110 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8111
8112 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8113 Priority Enabled Name
8114 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8115
8116 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
8117 (gdb) info frame-filter
8118
8119 global frame-filters:
8120 Priority Enabled Name
8121 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8122 100 Yes Reverse
8123
8124 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8125 Priority Enabled Name
8126 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8127
8128 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8129 Priority Enabled Name
8130 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8131 @end smallexample
8132
8133 @kindex set frame-filter priority
8134 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
8135 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8136 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8137 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8138 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8139 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
8140
8141 @kindex show frame-filter priority
8142 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8143 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8144 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8145 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8146 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8147 dictionary resides.
8148
8149 Example:
8150
8151 @smallexample
8152 (gdb) info frame-filter
8153
8154 global frame-filters:
8155 Priority Enabled Name
8156 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8157 100 Yes Reverse
8158
8159 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8160 Priority Enabled Name
8161 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8162
8163 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8164 Priority Enabled Name
8165 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8166
8167 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
8168 (gdb) info frame-filter
8169
8170 global frame-filters:
8171 Priority Enabled Name
8172 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8173 50 Yes Reverse
8174
8175 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8176 Priority Enabled Name
8177 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8178
8179 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8180 Priority Enabled Name
8181 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8182 @end smallexample
8183 @end table
8184
8185 @node Source
8186 @chapter Examining Source Files
8187
8188 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
8189 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
8190 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
8191 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
8192 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
8193 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
8194 source files by explicit command.
8195
8196 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
8197 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
8198 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
8199
8200 @menu
8201 * List:: Printing source lines
8202 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
8203 * Edit:: Editing source files
8204 * Search:: Searching source files
8205 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
8206 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
8207 @end menu
8208
8209 @node List
8210 @section Printing Source Lines
8211
8212 @kindex list
8213 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
8214 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
8215 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
8216 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
8217 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
8218
8219 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
8220
8221 @table @code
8222 @item list @var{linenum}
8223 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
8224 current source file.
8225
8226 @item list @var{function}
8227 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
8228 @var{function}.
8229
8230 @item list
8231 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
8232 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
8233 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
8234 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
8235 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
8236
8237 @item list -
8238 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8239 @end table
8240
8241 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
8242 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
8243 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
8244
8245 @table @code
8246 @kindex set listsize
8247 @item set listsize @var{count}
8248 @itemx set listsize unlimited
8249 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
8250 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
8251 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
8252
8253 @kindex show listsize
8254 @item show listsize
8255 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
8256 @end table
8257
8258 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
8259 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
8260 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
8261 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
8262 each repetition moves up in the source file.
8263
8264 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
8265 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
8266 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
8267 to specify some source line.
8268
8269 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
8270
8271 @table @code
8272 @item list @var{location}
8273 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
8274
8275 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
8276 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
8277 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
8278 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
8279 the same source file as the first location.
8280
8281 @item list ,@var{last}
8282 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
8283
8284 @item list @var{first},
8285 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
8286
8287 @item list +
8288 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
8289
8290 @item list -
8291 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8292
8293 @item list
8294 As described in the preceding table.
8295 @end table
8296
8297 @node Specify Location
8298 @section Specifying a Location
8299 @cindex specifying location
8300 @cindex location
8301 @cindex source location
8302
8303 @menu
8304 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
8305 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
8306 * Address Locations:: Address locations
8307 @end menu
8308
8309 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
8310 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
8311 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
8312 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
8313 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
8314
8315 @node Linespec Locations
8316 @subsection Linespec Locations
8317 @cindex linespec locations
8318
8319 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
8320 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
8321 specifying a linespec:
8322
8323 @table @code
8324 @item @var{linenum}
8325 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
8326
8327 @item -@var{offset}
8328 @itemx +@var{offset}
8329 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
8330 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
8331 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
8332 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
8333 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
8334 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
8335 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
8336 linespec.
8337
8338 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
8339 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
8340 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
8341 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
8342 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
8343 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
8344 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
8345
8346 @item @var{function}
8347 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
8348 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
8349
8350 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8351 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8352 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8353 means in all packages.
8354
8355 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8356 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8357 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
8358
8359 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
8360 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8361 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
8362 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
8363
8364 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
8365
8366 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
8367 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
8368
8369 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
8370 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
8371 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
8372 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
8373 functions in different source files.
8374
8375 @item @var{label}
8376 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
8377 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
8378 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
8379 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
8380
8381 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
8382 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
8383 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
8384 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
8385 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
8386 specifies the location of such a static probe.
8387
8388 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
8389 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
8390 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
8391 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
8392 each one of those probes.
8393 @end table
8394
8395 @node Explicit Locations
8396 @subsection Explicit Locations
8397 @cindex explicit locations
8398
8399 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8400 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8401
8402 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8403 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8404 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8405 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8406 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8407
8408 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
8409 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
8410 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
8411 the symbol table to know.
8412
8413 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
8414 following table:
8415
8416 @table @code
8417 @item -source @var{filename}
8418 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8419 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8420 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8421 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8422 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8423
8424 @item -function @var{function}
8425 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8426 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8427 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8428 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8429
8430 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8431 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8432 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8433 means in all packages.
8434
8435 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8436 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8437 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8438 breakpoint on both symbols.
8439
8440 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8441
8442 @item -qualified
8443
8444 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8445 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8446
8447 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8448 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8449 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8450
8451 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8452 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8453 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8454
8455 @item -label @var{label}
8456 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8457 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8458 selected stack frame.
8459
8460 @item -line @var{number}
8461 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8462 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8463 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8464 relative to the current line.
8465 @end table
8466
8467 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8468 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8469
8470 @node Address Locations
8471 @subsection Address Locations
8472 @cindex address locations
8473
8474 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8475 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8476
8477 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8478 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8479 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8480 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8481 source files.
8482
8483 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8484 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8485 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8486 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8487 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8488 of @var{address}:
8489
8490 @table @code
8491 @item @var{expression}
8492 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8493
8494 @item @var{funcaddr}
8495 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8496 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8497 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8498 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8499 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8500 (although the Pascal form also works).
8501
8502 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8503 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8504
8505 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8506 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8507 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8508 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8509 functions with identical names in different source files.
8510 @end table
8511
8512 @node Edit
8513 @section Editing Source Files
8514 @cindex editing source files
8515
8516 @kindex edit
8517 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8518 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8519 The editing program of your choice
8520 is invoked with the current line set to
8521 the active line in the program.
8522 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8523 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8524
8525 @table @code
8526 @item edit @var{location}
8527 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8528 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8529 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8530 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8531 command most commonly used:
8532
8533 @table @code
8534 @item edit @var{number}
8535 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8536
8537 @item edit @var{function}
8538 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8539 @end table
8540
8541 @end table
8542
8543 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8544 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8545 @footnote{
8546 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8547 following command-line syntax:
8548 @smallexample
8549 ex +@var{number} file
8550 @end smallexample
8551 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8552 the file where to start editing.}.
8553 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8554 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8555 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8556 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8557 @smallexample
8558 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8559 export EDITOR
8560 gdb @dots{}
8561 @end smallexample
8562 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8563 @smallexample
8564 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8565 gdb @dots{}
8566 @end smallexample
8567
8568 @node Search
8569 @section Searching Source Files
8570 @cindex searching source files
8571
8572 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8573 regular expression.
8574
8575 @table @code
8576 @kindex search
8577 @kindex forward-search
8578 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8579 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8580 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8581 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8582 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8583 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8584 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8585 @code{fo}.
8586
8587 @kindex reverse-search
8588 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8589 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8590 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8591 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8592 this command as @code{rev}.
8593 @end table
8594
8595 @node Source Path
8596 @section Specifying Source Directories
8597
8598 @cindex source path
8599 @cindex directories for source files
8600 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8601 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8602 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8603 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8604 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8605 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8606 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8607
8608 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8609 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8610 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8611 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8612 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8613 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8614 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8615 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8616 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8617 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8618 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8619
8620 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8621 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8622 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8623 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8624 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8625 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8626
8627 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8628 source files.
8629
8630 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8631 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8632 each line is in the file.
8633
8634 @kindex directory
8635 @kindex dir
8636 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8637 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8638 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8639
8640 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8641 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8642
8643 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8644 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8645 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8646 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8647 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8648 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8649 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8650 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8651 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8652 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8653 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8654 name to look up the sources.
8655
8656 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8657 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8658 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8659 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8660 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8661 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8662 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8663 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8664
8665 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8666 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8667 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8668 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8669 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8670 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8671 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8672
8673 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8674 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8675 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8676 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8677 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8678 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8679 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8680 command.
8681
8682 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8683 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8684 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8685 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8686 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8687 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8688 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8689
8690 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8691 @cindex default source path substitution
8692 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8693 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8694 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8695 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8696 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8697 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8698 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8699 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8700 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8701 together.
8702
8703 @table @code
8704 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8705 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8706 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8707 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8708 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8709 part of absolute file names) or
8710 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8711 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8712
8713 @kindex cdir
8714 @kindex cwd
8715 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8716 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8717 @cindex compilation directory
8718 @cindex current directory
8719 @cindex working directory
8720 @cindex directory, current
8721 @cindex directory, compilation
8722 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8723 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8724 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8725 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8726 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8727 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8728
8729 @item directory
8730 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8731
8732 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8733 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8734
8735 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8736 @kindex set directories
8737 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8738 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8739
8740 @item show directories
8741 @kindex show directories
8742 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8743
8744 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8745 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8746 @kindex set substitute-path
8747 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8748 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8749 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8750
8751 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8752 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8753
8754 @smallexample
8755 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8756 @end smallexample
8757
8758 @noindent
8759 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8760 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8761 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8762
8763 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8764 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8765 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8766 the substitution.
8767
8768 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8769
8770 @smallexample
8771 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8772 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8773 @end smallexample
8774
8775 @noindent
8776 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8777 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8778 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8779 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8780
8781
8782 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8783 @kindex unset substitute-path
8784 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8785 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8786 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8787
8788 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8789
8790 @item show substitute-path [path]
8791 @kindex show substitute-path
8792 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8793 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8794
8795 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8796 rules.
8797
8798 @end table
8799
8800 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8801 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8802 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8803
8804 @enumerate
8805 @item
8806 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8807
8808 @item
8809 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8810 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8811 directories in one command.
8812 @end enumerate
8813
8814 @node Machine Code
8815 @section Source and Machine Code
8816 @cindex source line and its code address
8817
8818 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8819 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8820 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8821 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8822 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8823 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8824 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8825 well as hex.
8826
8827 @table @code
8828 @kindex info line
8829 @item info line
8830 @itemx info line @var{location}
8831 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8832 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8833 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
8834 information about the current source line is printed.
8835 @end table
8836
8837 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8838 the object code for the first line of function
8839 @code{m4_changequote}:
8840
8841 @smallexample
8842 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8843 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
8844 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
8845 @end smallexample
8846
8847 @noindent
8848 @cindex code address and its source line
8849 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8850 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8851 @smallexample
8852 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8853 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
8854 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
8855 @end smallexample
8856
8857 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8858 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8859 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8860 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8861 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8862 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8863 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8864 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8865 Variables}).
8866
8867 @cindex info line, repeated calls
8868 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
8869 specifying a location will display information about the next source
8870 line.
8871
8872 @table @code
8873 @kindex disassemble
8874 @cindex assembly instructions
8875 @cindex instructions, assembly
8876 @cindex machine instructions
8877 @cindex listing machine instructions
8878 @item disassemble
8879 @itemx disassemble /m
8880 @itemx disassemble /s
8881 @itemx disassemble /r
8882 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8883 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8884 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8885 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8886 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8887 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8888 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8889 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8890 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8891 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8892
8893 @table @code
8894 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8895 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8896 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8897 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8898 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8899 @end table
8900
8901 @noindent
8902 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8903 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8904
8905 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8906 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8907
8908 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8909 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8910 @end table
8911
8912 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8913 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8914
8915 @smallexample
8916 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8917 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8918 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8919 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8920 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8921 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8922 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8923 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8924 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8925 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8926 End of assembler dump.
8927 @end smallexample
8928
8929 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8930 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8931 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8932
8933 @smallexample
8934 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8935 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8936 5 @{
8937 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8938 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8939 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8940 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8941 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8942
8943 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8944 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8945 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8946
8947 7 return 0;
8948 8 @}
8949 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8950 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8951 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8952
8953 End of assembler dump.
8954 @end smallexample
8955
8956 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8957 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8958 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8959 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8960 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8961 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8962 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8963 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8964 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8965
8966 @file{foo.h}:
8967
8968 @smallexample
8969 int
8970 foo (int a)
8971 @{
8972 if (a < 0)
8973 return a * 2;
8974 if (a == 0)
8975 return 1;
8976 return a + 10;
8977 @}
8978 @end smallexample
8979
8980 @file{foo.c}:
8981
8982 @smallexample
8983 #include "foo.h"
8984 volatile int x, y;
8985 int
8986 main ()
8987 @{
8988 x = foo (y);
8989 return 0;
8990 @}
8991 @end smallexample
8992
8993 @smallexample
8994 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8995 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8996 5 @{
8997
8998 6 x = foo (y);
8999 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9000 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9001
9002 7 return 0;
9003 8 @}
9004 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9005 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9006 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9007 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9008
9009 End of assembler dump.
9010 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
9011 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9012 foo.c:
9013 5 @{
9014 6 x = foo (y);
9015 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9016
9017 foo.h:
9018 4 if (a < 0)
9019 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
9020 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
9021
9022 6 if (a == 0)
9023 7 return 1;
9024 8 return a + 10;
9025 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
9026 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
9027 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
9028 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
9029
9030 foo.c:
9031 6 x = foo (y);
9032 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9033
9034 7 return 0;
9035 8 @}
9036 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9037 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9038
9039 foo.h:
9040 5 return a * 2;
9041 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9042 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9043 End of assembler dump.
9044 @end smallexample
9045
9046 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
9047
9048 @smallexample
9049 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
9050 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
9051 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
9052 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
9053 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
9054 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
9055 End of assembler dump.
9056 @end smallexample
9057
9058 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
9059 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
9060 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
9061 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
9062
9063 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
9064 mnemonics or other syntax.
9065
9066 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
9067 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
9068 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
9069 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
9070 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
9071
9072 @table @code
9073 @kindex set disassembler-options
9074 @cindex disassembler options
9075 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
9076 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
9077 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
9078 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
9079 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
9080 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
9081 The default value is the empty string.
9082
9083 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
9084 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
9085 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, MIPS, PowerPC
9086 and S/390.
9087
9088 @kindex show disassembler-options
9089 @item show disassembler-options
9090 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
9091 @end table
9092
9093 @table @code
9094 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
9095 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
9096 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
9097 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
9098 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
9099 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
9100
9101 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
9102 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
9103 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
9104 assemblers for x86-based targets.
9105
9106 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
9107 @item show disassembly-flavor
9108 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
9109 @end table
9110
9111 @table @code
9112 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
9113 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
9114 @item set disassemble-next-line
9115 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
9116 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
9117 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
9118 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
9119 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
9120 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
9121 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
9122 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
9123 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
9124 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
9125 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
9126 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
9127 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
9128 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
9129 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
9130 instruction.
9131 @end table
9132
9133
9134 @node Data
9135 @chapter Examining Data
9136
9137 @cindex printing data
9138 @cindex examining data
9139 @kindex print
9140 @kindex inspect
9141 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
9142 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
9143 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
9144 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
9145 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
9146 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
9147
9148 @table @code
9149 @item print @var{expr}
9150 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
9151 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
9152 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
9153 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
9154 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
9155 Formats}.
9156
9157 @item print
9158 @itemx print /@var{f}
9159 @cindex reprint the last value
9160 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
9161 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
9162 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
9163 @end table
9164
9165 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
9166 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
9167 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9168
9169 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
9170 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
9171 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
9172 Table}.
9173
9174 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
9175 @kindex explore
9176 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
9177 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
9178 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
9179 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
9180 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
9181 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
9182 embedded in the higher level data types.
9183
9184 @table @code
9185 @item explore @var{arg}
9186 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
9187 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
9188 @end table
9189
9190 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
9191 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
9192 C program as
9193
9194 @smallexample
9195 struct SimpleStruct
9196 @{
9197 int i;
9198 double d;
9199 @};
9200
9201 struct ComplexStruct
9202 @{
9203 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
9204 int arr[10];
9205 @};
9206 @end smallexample
9207
9208 @noindent
9209 followed by variable declarations as
9210
9211 @smallexample
9212 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
9213 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
9214 @end smallexample
9215
9216 @noindent
9217 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
9218 @code{explore} command as follows.
9219
9220 @smallexample
9221 (gdb) explore cs
9222 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
9223 the following fields:
9224
9225 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
9226 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
9227
9228 Enter the field number of choice:
9229 @end smallexample
9230
9231 @noindent
9232 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
9233 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
9234 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
9235 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
9236 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
9237 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
9238 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
9239 field will be explored as if it were an array.
9240
9241 @smallexample
9242 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
9243 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
9244 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
9245 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
9246
9247 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
9248 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
9249
9250 Press enter to return to parent value:
9251 @end smallexample
9252
9253 @noindent
9254 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
9255 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
9256 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
9257 to explore.
9258
9259 @smallexample
9260 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
9261 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
9262
9263 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
9264
9265 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
9266
9267 Press enter to return to parent value:
9268 @end smallexample
9269
9270 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
9271 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
9272 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
9273 level data structure).
9274
9275 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
9276 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
9277 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
9278 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
9279 same example as above, your can explore the type
9280 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
9281 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
9282
9283 @smallexample
9284 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
9285 @end smallexample
9286
9287 @noindent
9288 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
9289 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
9290 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
9291 example.
9292
9293 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
9294 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
9295 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
9296 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
9297 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
9298
9299 @table @code
9300 @item explore value @var{expr}
9301 @cindex explore value
9302 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
9303 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
9304 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
9305 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
9306 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
9307
9308 @item explore type @var{arg}
9309 @cindex explore type
9310 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
9311 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
9312 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
9313 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
9314 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
9315 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
9316 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
9317 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
9318 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
9319 @end table
9320
9321 @menu
9322 * Expressions:: Expressions
9323 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
9324 * Variables:: Program variables
9325 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
9326 * Output Formats:: Output formats
9327 * Memory:: Examining memory
9328 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
9329 * Print Settings:: Print settings
9330 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
9331 * Value History:: Value history
9332 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
9333 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
9334 * Registers:: Registers
9335 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
9336 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
9337 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
9338 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
9339 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
9340 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
9341 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
9342 character set than GDB does
9343 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
9344 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
9345 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
9346 @end menu
9347
9348 @node Expressions
9349 @section Expressions
9350
9351 @cindex expressions
9352 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
9353 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
9354 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
9355 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
9356 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
9357 you compiled your program to include this information; see
9358 @ref{Compilation}.
9359
9360 @cindex arrays in expressions
9361 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
9362 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
9363 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
9364 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
9365 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
9366 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
9367
9368 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
9369 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
9370 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
9371 languages.
9372
9373 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
9374 expressions regardless of your programming language.
9375
9376 @cindex casts, in expressions
9377 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
9378 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
9379 at that address in memory.
9380 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
9381
9382 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
9383 to programming languages:
9384
9385 @table @code
9386 @item @@
9387 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
9388 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
9389
9390 @item ::
9391 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
9392 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
9393
9394 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
9395 @cindex type casting memory
9396 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
9397 @cindex casts, to view memory
9398 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
9399 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
9400 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
9401 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
9402 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
9403 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
9404 @end table
9405
9406 @node Ambiguous Expressions
9407 @section Ambiguous Expressions
9408 @cindex ambiguous expressions
9409
9410 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
9411 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
9412 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
9413 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
9414 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
9415 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
9416 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
9417
9418 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
9419 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
9420 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
9421 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
9422 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
9423 as well.
9424
9425 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9426 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9427 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9428 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9429 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9430 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9431 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9432 choices.
9433
9434 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9435 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9436 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9437
9438 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9439 @smallexample
9440 @group
9441 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9442 [0] cancel
9443 [1] all
9444 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9445 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9446 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9447 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9448 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9449 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9450 > 2 4 6
9451 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9452 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9453 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9454 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9455 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9456 breakpoints.
9457 (@value{GDBP})
9458 @end group
9459 @end smallexample
9460
9461 @table @code
9462 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9463 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9464 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9465
9466 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9467 is ambiguous.
9468
9469 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9470 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9471 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9472 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9473 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9474 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9475 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
9476 in the use of the menu.
9477
9478 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9479 when an ambiguity is detected.
9480
9481 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9482 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9483
9484 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9485 @item show multiple-symbols
9486 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9487 @end table
9488
9489 @node Variables
9490 @section Program Variables
9491
9492 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9493 in your program.
9494
9495 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9496 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9497
9498 @itemize @bullet
9499 @item
9500 global (or file-static)
9501 @end itemize
9502
9503 @noindent or
9504
9505 @itemize @bullet
9506 @item
9507 visible according to the scope rules of the
9508 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9509 @end itemize
9510
9511 @noindent This means that in the function
9512
9513 @smallexample
9514 foo (a)
9515 int a;
9516 @{
9517 bar (a);
9518 @{
9519 int b = test ();
9520 bar (b);
9521 @}
9522 @}
9523 @end smallexample
9524
9525 @noindent
9526 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9527 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9528 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9529 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9530
9531 @cindex variable name conflict
9532 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9533 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9534 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9535 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9536 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9537 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9538 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9539
9540 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9541 @ifnotinfo
9542 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9543 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9544 @end ifnotinfo
9545 @smallexample
9546 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9547 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9548 @end smallexample
9549
9550 @noindent
9551 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9552 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9553 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9554 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9555
9556 @smallexample
9557 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9558 @end smallexample
9559
9560 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9561 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9562 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9563 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9564 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9565
9566 @smallexample
9567 void
9568 foo (int a)
9569 @{
9570 if (a < 10)
9571 bar (a);
9572 else
9573 process (a); /* Stop here */
9574 @}
9575
9576 int
9577 bar (int a)
9578 @{
9579 foo (a + 5);
9580 @}
9581 @end smallexample
9582
9583 @noindent
9584 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9585 here is what you might see
9586 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9587
9588 @smallexample
9589 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9590 $1 = 10
9591 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9592 $2 = 5
9593 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9594 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9595 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9596 $3 = 5
9597 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9598 $4 = 0
9599 @end smallexample
9600
9601 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9602 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9603 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9604 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9605 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9606
9607 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9608 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9609 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9610 @code{some_global}.
9611
9612 @smallexample
9613 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9614 $1 = 23
9615 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9616 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9617 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9618 $2 = 27
9619 @end smallexample
9620
9621 @cindex wrong values
9622 @cindex variable values, wrong
9623 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9624 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9625 @quotation
9626 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9627 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9628 scope, and just before exit.
9629 @end quotation
9630 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9631 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9632 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9633 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9634 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9635 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9636 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9637 variable definitions may be gone.
9638
9639 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9640 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9641 when compiling.
9642
9643 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9644 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9645 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9646 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9647 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9648 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9649 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9650
9651 @smallexample
9652 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9653 @end smallexample
9654
9655 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9656 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9657 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9658 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9659 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9660
9661 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9662 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9663 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9664 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9665
9666 @cindex no debug info variables
9667 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9668 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9669 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9670 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9671 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9672 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9673 example, in a C program:
9674
9675 @smallexample
9676 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9677 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9678 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9679 $1 = 3.14
9680 @end smallexample
9681
9682 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9683 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9684 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9685 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9686 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9687
9688 @smallexample
9689 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9690 29 i++;
9691 (gdb) next
9692 30 e (i);
9693 (gdb) print i
9694 $1 = 31
9695 (gdb) print i@@entry
9696 $2 = 30
9697 @end smallexample
9698
9699 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9700 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9701 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9702 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9703 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9704 For program code
9705
9706 @smallexample
9707 char var0[] = "A";
9708 signed char var1[] = "A";
9709 @end smallexample
9710
9711 You get during debugging
9712 @smallexample
9713 (gdb) print var0
9714 $1 = "A"
9715 (gdb) print var1
9716 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9717 @end smallexample
9718
9719 @node Arrays
9720 @section Artificial Arrays
9721
9722 @cindex artificial array
9723 @cindex arrays
9724 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9725 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9726 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9727 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9728 program.
9729
9730 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9731 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9732 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9733 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9734 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9735 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9736 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9737 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9738 example. If a program says
9739
9740 @smallexample
9741 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9742 @end smallexample
9743
9744 @noindent
9745 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9746
9747 @smallexample
9748 p *array@@len
9749 @end smallexample
9750
9751 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9752 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9753 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9754 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9755 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9756
9757 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9758 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9759 The value need not be in memory:
9760 @smallexample
9761 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9762 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9763 @end smallexample
9764
9765 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9766 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9767 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9768 @smallexample
9769 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9770 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9771 @end smallexample
9772
9773 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9774 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9775 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9776 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9777 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9778 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9779 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9780 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9781 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9782 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9783
9784 @smallexample
9785 set $i = 0
9786 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9787 @key{RET}
9788 @key{RET}
9789 @dots{}
9790 @end smallexample
9791
9792 @node Output Formats
9793 @section Output Formats
9794
9795 @cindex formatted output
9796 @cindex output formats
9797 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9798 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9799 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9800 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9801 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9802
9803 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9804 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9805 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9806 letters supported are:
9807
9808 @table @code
9809 @item x
9810 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9811 hexadecimal.
9812
9813 @item d
9814 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9815
9816 @item u
9817 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9818
9819 @item o
9820 Print as integer in octal.
9821
9822 @item t
9823 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9824 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9825 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9826 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9827
9828 @item a
9829 @cindex unknown address, locating
9830 @cindex locate address
9831 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9832 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9833 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9834
9835 @smallexample
9836 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9837 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9838 @end smallexample
9839
9840 @noindent
9841 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9842 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9843
9844 @item c
9845 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9846 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9847 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9848 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9849
9850 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9851 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9852 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9853 data.
9854
9855 @item f
9856 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9857 using typical floating point syntax.
9858
9859 @item s
9860 @cindex printing strings
9861 @cindex printing byte arrays
9862 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9863 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9864 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9865 natural types.
9866
9867 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9868 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9869 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9870 array.
9871
9872 @item z
9873 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9874 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9875 to the size of the integer type.
9876
9877 @item r
9878 @cindex raw printing
9879 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9880 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9881 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9882 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9883 pretty-printer which might exist.
9884 @end table
9885
9886 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9887
9888 @smallexample
9889 p/x $pc
9890 @end smallexample
9891
9892 @noindent
9893 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9894 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9895
9896 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9897 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9898 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9899
9900 @node Memory
9901 @section Examining Memory
9902
9903 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9904 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9905
9906 @cindex examining memory
9907 @table @code
9908 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9909 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9910 @itemx x @var{addr}
9911 @itemx x
9912 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9913 @end table
9914
9915 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9916 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9917 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9918 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9919 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9920
9921 @table @r
9922 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9923 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9924 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9925 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9926 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9927 @c 4.1.2.
9928
9929 @item @var{f}, the display format
9930 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9931 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9932 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9933 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9934 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9935
9936 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9937 The unit size is any of
9938
9939 @table @code
9940 @item b
9941 Bytes.
9942 @item h
9943 Halfwords (two bytes).
9944 @item w
9945 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9946 @item g
9947 Giant words (eight bytes).
9948 @end table
9949
9950 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9951 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9952 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9953 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9954 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9955 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9956 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9957 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9958 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9959 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9960 be altered.
9961
9962 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9963 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9964 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9965 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9966 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9967 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9968 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9969 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9970 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9971 a value from memory).
9972 @end table
9973
9974 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9975 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9976 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9977 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9978 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9979
9980 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9981 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9982 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9983
9984 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9985 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9986 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9987 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9988 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9989
9990 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9991 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9992 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9993 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9994 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9995 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9996 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9997 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9998 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9999
10000 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
10001 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
10002 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
10003 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
10004 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
10005 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
10006
10007 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
10008 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
10009 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
10010 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
10011 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
10012 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
10013 for successive uses of @code{x}.
10014
10015 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
10016 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
10017
10018 @smallexample
10019 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
10020 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
10021 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
10022 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
10023 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
10024 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
10025 @end smallexample
10026
10027 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
10028 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
10029 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
10030 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
10031 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
10032 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
10033 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
10034 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
10035 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
10036
10037 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
10038 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
10039 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
10040
10041 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
10042 @cindex addressable memory unit
10043 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
10044 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
10045 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
10046 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
10047 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
10048 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
10049 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
10050 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
10051 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
10052
10053 @cindex remote memory comparison
10054 @cindex target memory comparison
10055 @cindex verify remote memory image
10056 @cindex verify target memory image
10057 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
10058 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
10059 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
10060 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
10061 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
10062 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
10063
10064 @table @code
10065 @kindex compare-sections
10066 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
10067 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
10068 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
10069 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
10070 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
10071 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
10072
10073 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
10074 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
10075 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
10076 @end table
10077
10078 @node Auto Display
10079 @section Automatic Display
10080 @cindex automatic display
10081 @cindex display of expressions
10082
10083 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
10084 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
10085 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
10086 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
10087 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
10088 The automatic display looks like this:
10089
10090 @smallexample
10091 2: foo = 38
10092 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
10093 @end smallexample
10094
10095 @noindent
10096 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
10097 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
10098 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
10099 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
10100 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
10101 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
10102
10103 @table @code
10104 @kindex display
10105 @item display @var{expr}
10106 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
10107 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10108
10109 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10110
10111 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
10112 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
10113 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
10114 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
10115 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
10116
10117 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
10118 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
10119 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
10120 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
10121 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
10122 @end table
10123
10124 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
10125 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
10126 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10127
10128 @table @code
10129 @kindex delete display
10130 @kindex undisplay
10131 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
10132 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10133 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
10134 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
10135 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
10136 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
10137 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10138
10139 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10140 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
10141
10142 @kindex disable display
10143 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10144 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
10145 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
10146 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
10147 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
10148 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
10149 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
10150 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10151
10152 @kindex enable display
10153 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10154 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
10155 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
10156 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
10157 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
10158 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
10159 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10160
10161 @item display
10162 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
10163 done when your program stops.
10164
10165 @kindex info display
10166 @item info display
10167 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
10168 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
10169 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
10170 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
10171 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
10172 @end table
10173
10174 @cindex display disabled out of scope
10175 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
10176 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
10177 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
10178 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
10179 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
10180 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
10181 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
10182 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
10183 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
10184 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
10185
10186 @node Print Settings
10187 @section Print Settings
10188
10189 @cindex format options
10190 @cindex print settings
10191 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
10192 and symbols are printed.
10193
10194 @noindent
10195 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
10196
10197 @table @code
10198 @kindex set print
10199 @item set print address
10200 @itemx set print address on
10201 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
10202 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
10203 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
10204 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
10205 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
10206 @code{set print address on}:
10207
10208 @smallexample
10209 @group
10210 (@value{GDBP}) f
10211 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
10212 at input.c:530
10213 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10214 @end group
10215 @end smallexample
10216
10217 @item set print address off
10218 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
10219 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
10220
10221 @smallexample
10222 @group
10223 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
10224 (@value{GDBP}) f
10225 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
10226 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10227 @end group
10228 @end smallexample
10229
10230 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
10231 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
10232 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
10233 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
10234
10235 @kindex show print
10236 @item show print address
10237 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
10238 @end table
10239
10240 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
10241 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
10242 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
10243 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
10244 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
10245 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
10246 it prints a symbolic address:
10247
10248 @table @code
10249 @item set print symbol-filename on
10250 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
10251 @cindex symbol, source file and line
10252 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
10253 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10254
10255 @item set print symbol-filename off
10256 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
10257 default.
10258
10259 @item show print symbol-filename
10260 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
10261 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10262 @end table
10263
10264 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
10265 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
10266 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
10267
10268 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
10269 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
10270
10271 @table @code
10272 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
10273 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
10274 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
10275 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
10276 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
10277 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
10278 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
10279 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
10280
10281 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
10282 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
10283 symbolic address.
10284 @end table
10285
10286 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
10287 @cindex pointer, finding referent
10288 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
10289 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
10290 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
10291 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
10292 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
10293 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
10294
10295 @smallexample
10296 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
10297 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
10298 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
10299 @end smallexample
10300
10301 @quotation
10302 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
10303 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
10304 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
10305 @end quotation
10306
10307 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
10308 @samp{set print symbol on}:
10309
10310 @table @code
10311 @item set print symbol on
10312 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
10313 one exists.
10314
10315 @item set print symbol off
10316 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
10317 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
10318 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
10319
10320 @item show print symbol
10321 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
10322 address.
10323 @end table
10324
10325 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
10326
10327 @table @code
10328 @item set print array
10329 @itemx set print array on
10330 @cindex pretty print arrays
10331 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
10332 but uses more space. The default is off.
10333
10334 @item set print array off
10335 Return to compressed format for arrays.
10336
10337 @item show print array
10338 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
10339 arrays.
10340
10341 @cindex print array indexes
10342 @item set print array-indexes
10343 @itemx set print array-indexes on
10344 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
10345 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
10346 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
10347
10348 @item set print array-indexes off
10349 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
10350
10351 @item show print array-indexes
10352 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
10353 arrays.
10354
10355 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
10356 @itemx set print elements unlimited
10357 @cindex number of array elements to print
10358 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
10359 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
10360 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
10361 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
10362 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
10363 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
10364 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
10365 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
10366
10367 @item show print elements
10368 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
10369 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
10370
10371 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
10372 @kindex set print frame-arguments
10373 @cindex printing frame argument values
10374 @cindex print all frame argument values
10375 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
10376 @cindex do not print frame argument values
10377 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
10378 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
10379 values are:
10380
10381 @table @code
10382 @item all
10383 The values of all arguments are printed.
10384
10385 @item scalars
10386 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
10387 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
10388 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
10389 only scalar arguments are shown:
10390
10391 @smallexample
10392 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
10393 at frame-args.c:23
10394 @end smallexample
10395
10396 @item none
10397 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
10398 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
10399
10400 @smallexample
10401 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
10402 at frame-args.c:23
10403 @end smallexample
10404 @end table
10405
10406 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
10407 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
10408 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
10409 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
10410 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
10411 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
10412 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
10413 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
10414 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
10415 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
10416
10417 @item show print frame-arguments
10418 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
10419
10420 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
10421 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
10422
10423 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
10424 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
10425 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10426 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10427 This is the default.
10428
10429 @item show print raw frame-arguments
10430 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10431
10432 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10433 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10434 @kindex set print entry-values
10435 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10436 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10437 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10438 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10439 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10440
10441 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10442 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10443 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10444 @code{no} setting.
10445
10446 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10447 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10448 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10449 this information.
10450
10451 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10452
10453 @table @code
10454 @item no
10455 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10456 point.
10457 @smallexample
10458 #0 equal (val=5)
10459 #0 different (val=6)
10460 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
10461 #0 born (val=10)
10462 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10463 @end smallexample
10464
10465 @item only
10466 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
10467 values are never printed.
10468 @smallexample
10469 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10470 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10471 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10472 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10473 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10474 @end smallexample
10475
10476 @item preferred
10477 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10478 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10479 value for such parameter.
10480 @smallexample
10481 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10482 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10483 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10484 #0 born (val=10)
10485 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10486 @end smallexample
10487
10488 @item if-needed
10489 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10490 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10491 parameter.
10492 @smallexample
10493 #0 equal (val=5)
10494 #0 different (val=6)
10495 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10496 #0 born (val=10)
10497 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10498 @end smallexample
10499
10500 @item both
10501 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10502 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10503 optimizations.
10504 @smallexample
10505 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10506 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10507 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10508 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10509 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10510 @end smallexample
10511
10512 @item compact
10513 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10514 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10515 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10516 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10517 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10518 @smallexample
10519 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10520 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10521 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10522 #0 born (val=10)
10523 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10524 @end smallexample
10525
10526 @item default
10527 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10528 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10529 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10530 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10531 @smallexample
10532 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10533 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10534 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10535 #0 born (val=10)
10536 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10537 @end smallexample
10538 @end table
10539
10540 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10541 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10542
10543 @item show print entry-values
10544 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10545 entry.
10546
10547 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10548 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10549 @cindex repeated array elements
10550 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10551 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10552 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10553 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10554 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10555 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10556 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10557 is 10.
10558
10559 @item show print repeats
10560 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10561 elements.
10562
10563 @item set print null-stop
10564 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10565 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10566 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10567 contain only short strings.
10568 The default is off.
10569
10570 @item show print null-stop
10571 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10572 @sc{null} character.
10573
10574 @item set print pretty on
10575 @cindex print structures in indented form
10576 @cindex indentation in structure display
10577 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10578 per line, like this:
10579
10580 @smallexample
10581 @group
10582 $1 = @{
10583 next = 0x0,
10584 flags = @{
10585 sweet = 1,
10586 sour = 1
10587 @},
10588 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10589 @}
10590 @end group
10591 @end smallexample
10592
10593 @item set print pretty off
10594 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10595
10596 @smallexample
10597 @group
10598 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10599 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10600 @end group
10601 @end smallexample
10602
10603 @noindent
10604 This is the default format.
10605
10606 @item show print pretty
10607 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10608
10609 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10610 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10611 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10612 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10613 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10614 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10615 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10616 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10617
10618 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10619 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10620 international character sets, and is the default.
10621
10622 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10623 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10624
10625 @item set print union on
10626 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10627 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10628 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10629
10630 @item set print union off
10631 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10632 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10633 instead.
10634
10635 @item show print union
10636 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10637 structures and other unions.
10638
10639 For example, given the declarations
10640
10641 @smallexample
10642 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10643 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10644 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10645 Bug_forms;
10646
10647 struct thing @{
10648 Species it;
10649 union @{
10650 Tree_forms tree;
10651 Bug_forms bug;
10652 @} form;
10653 @};
10654
10655 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10656 @end smallexample
10657
10658 @noindent
10659 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10660
10661 @smallexample
10662 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10663 @end smallexample
10664
10665 @noindent
10666 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10667
10668 @smallexample
10669 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10670 @end smallexample
10671
10672 @noindent
10673 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10674 and in Pascal.
10675 @end table
10676
10677 @need 1000
10678 @noindent
10679 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10680
10681 @table @code
10682 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10683 @item set print demangle
10684 @itemx set print demangle on
10685 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10686 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10687 linkage. The default is on.
10688
10689 @item show print demangle
10690 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10691
10692 @item set print asm-demangle
10693 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10694 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10695 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10696 The default is off.
10697
10698 @item show print asm-demangle
10699 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10700 or demangled form.
10701
10702 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10703 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10704 @kindex set demangle-style
10705 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10706 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to represent
10707 C@t{++} names. If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible
10708 formats. The default value is @var{auto}, which lets @value{GDBN} choose a
10709 decoding style by inspecting your program.
10710
10711 @item show demangle-style
10712 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10713
10714 @item set print object
10715 @itemx set print object on
10716 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10717 @cindex display derived types
10718 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10719 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10720 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10721 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10722 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10723 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10724 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10725
10726 @item set print object off
10727 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10728 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10729
10730 @item show print object
10731 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10732
10733 @item set print static-members
10734 @itemx set print static-members on
10735 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10736 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10737
10738 @item set print static-members off
10739 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10740
10741 @item show print static-members
10742 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10743
10744 @item set print pascal_static-members
10745 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10746 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10747 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10748 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10749
10750 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10751 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10752
10753 @item show print pascal_static-members
10754 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10755
10756 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10757 @item set print vtbl
10758 @itemx set print vtbl on
10759 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10760 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10761 @cindex VTBL display
10762 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10763 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10764 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10765
10766 @item set print vtbl off
10767 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10768
10769 @item show print vtbl
10770 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10771 @end table
10772
10773 @node Pretty Printing
10774 @section Pretty Printing
10775
10776 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10777 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10778 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10779
10780 @menu
10781 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10782 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10783 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10784 @end menu
10785
10786 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10787 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10788
10789 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10790 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10791 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10792
10793 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10794 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10795 pretty-printers with their names.
10796 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10797 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10798 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10799 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10800
10801 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10802 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10803 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10804 do anything special.
10805
10806 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10807
10808 @itemize @bullet
10809 @item
10810 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10811 all inferiors.
10812
10813 @item
10814 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10815 when debugging that program.
10816 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10817
10818 @item
10819 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10820 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10821 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10822 @end itemize
10823
10824 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10825 pretty-printers are selected,
10826
10827 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10828 for new types.
10829
10830 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10831 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10832
10833 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10834
10835 @smallexample
10836 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10837 $1 = @{
10838 static npos = 4294967295,
10839 _M_dataplus = @{
10840 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10841 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10842 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10843 @},
10844 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10845 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10846 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10847 @}
10848 @}
10849 @end smallexample
10850
10851 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10852
10853 @smallexample
10854 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10855 $2 = "abcd"
10856 @end smallexample
10857
10858 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10859 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10860 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10861
10862 @table @code
10863 @kindex info pretty-printer
10864 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10865 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10866 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10867
10868 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10869 whose pretty-printers to list.
10870 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10871 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10872 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10873 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10874 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10875
10876 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10877 to list.
10878
10879 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10880 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10881 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10882 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10883
10884 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10885 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10886 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10887 @end table
10888
10889 Example:
10890
10891 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10892 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10893 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10894 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10895
10896 @smallexample
10897 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10898 library1.so:
10899 foo
10900 library2.so:
10901 bar
10902 bar1
10903 bar2
10904 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10905 library2.so:
10906 bar
10907 bar1
10908 bar2
10909 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10910 1 printer disabled
10911 2 of 3 printers enabled
10912 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10913 library1.so:
10914 foo [disabled]
10915 library2.so:
10916 bar
10917 bar1
10918 bar2
10919 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar;bar1
10920 1 printer disabled
10921 1 of 3 printers enabled
10922 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10923 library1.so:
10924 foo [disabled]
10925 library2.so:
10926 bar
10927 bar1 [disabled]
10928 bar2
10929 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10930 1 printer disabled
10931 0 of 3 printers enabled
10932 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10933 library1.so:
10934 foo [disabled]
10935 library2.so:
10936 bar [disabled]
10937 bar1 [disabled]
10938 bar2
10939 @end smallexample
10940
10941 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10942 as can each individual subprinter.
10943
10944 @node Value History
10945 @section Value History
10946
10947 @cindex value history
10948 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10949 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10950 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10951 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10952 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10953 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10954 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10955 symbol table.
10956
10957 @cindex @code{$}
10958 @cindex @code{$$}
10959 @cindex history number
10960 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10961 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10962 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10963 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10964 history number.
10965
10966 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10967 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10968 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10969 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10970 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10971 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10972 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10973
10974 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10975 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10976
10977 @smallexample
10978 p *$
10979 @end smallexample
10980
10981 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10982 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10983
10984 @smallexample
10985 p *$.next
10986 @end smallexample
10987
10988 @noindent
10989 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10990 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10991
10992 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10993 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10994
10995 @smallexample
10996 print x
10997 set x=5
10998 @end smallexample
10999
11000 @noindent
11001 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
11002 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
11003
11004 @table @code
11005 @kindex show values
11006 @item show values
11007 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
11008 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
11009 values} does not change the history.
11010
11011 @item show values @var{n}
11012 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
11013
11014 @item show values +
11015 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
11016 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
11017 @end table
11018
11019 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
11020 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
11021
11022 @node Convenience Vars
11023 @section Convenience Variables
11024
11025 @cindex convenience variables
11026 @cindex user-defined variables
11027 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
11028 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
11029 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
11030 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
11031 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
11032
11033 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
11034 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
11035 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
11036 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
11037 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
11038
11039 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
11040 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
11041 For example:
11042
11043 @smallexample
11044 set $foo = *object_ptr
11045 @end smallexample
11046
11047 @noindent
11048 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
11049 @code{object_ptr}.
11050
11051 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
11052 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
11053 value with another assignment at any time.
11054
11055 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
11056 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
11057 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
11058 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
11059
11060 @table @code
11061 @kindex show convenience
11062 @cindex show all user variables and functions
11063 @item show convenience
11064 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
11065 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
11066 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
11067
11068 @kindex init-if-undefined
11069 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
11070 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
11071 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
11072 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
11073 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
11074 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
11075 override default values used in a command script.
11076
11077 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
11078 any side-effects do not occur.
11079 @end table
11080
11081 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
11082 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
11083 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
11084
11085 @smallexample
11086 set $i = 0
11087 print bar[$i++]->contents
11088 @end smallexample
11089
11090 @noindent
11091 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
11092
11093 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
11094 values likely to be useful.
11095
11096 @table @code
11097 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
11098 @item $_
11099 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
11100 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
11101 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
11102 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
11103 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
11104 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
11105 to the type of @code{$__}.
11106
11107 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
11108 @item $__
11109 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
11110 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
11111 to match the format in which the data was printed.
11112
11113 @item $_exitcode
11114 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
11115 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
11116 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
11117 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
11118
11119 @item $_exitsignal
11120 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11121 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
11122 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
11123 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
11124
11125 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
11126 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
11127 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
11128 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
11129 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
11130
11131 @smallexample
11132 #include <signal.h>
11133
11134 int
11135 main (int argc, char *argv[])
11136 @{
11137 raise (SIGALRM);
11138 return 0;
11139 @}
11140 @end smallexample
11141
11142 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
11143 or signalled would be:
11144
11145 @smallexample
11146 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
11147 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
11148 End with a line saying just ``end''.
11149 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
11150 >echo The program has exited\n
11151 >else
11152 >echo The program has signalled\n
11153 >end
11154 >end
11155 (@value{GDBP}) run
11156 Starting program:
11157
11158 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
11159 The program no longer exists.
11160 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11161 The program has signalled
11162 @end smallexample
11163
11164 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
11165 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
11166 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
11167 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
11168
11169 @smallexample
11170 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11171 The program has exited
11172 @end smallexample
11173
11174 @item $_exception
11175 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
11176 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
11177
11178 @item $_probe_argc
11179 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
11180 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11181
11182 @item $_sdata
11183 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
11184 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
11185 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
11186 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
11187 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
11188
11189 @item $_siginfo
11190 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
11191 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
11192 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
11193 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
11194 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
11195
11196 @item $_tlb
11197 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
11198 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
11199 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
11200 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
11201 @xref{General Query Packets}.
11202 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
11203
11204 @item $_inferior
11205 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
11206 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
11207
11208 @item $_thread
11209 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
11210
11211 @item $_gthread
11212 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
11213
11214 @item $_gdb_major
11215 @itemx $_gdb_minor
11216 @vindex $_gdb_major@r{, convenience variable}
11217 @vindex $_gdb_minor@r{, convenience variable}
11218 The major and minor version numbers of the running @value{GDBN}.
11219 Development snapshots and pretest versions have their minor version
11220 incremented by one; thus, @value{GDBN} pretest 9.11.90 will produce
11221 the value 12 for @code{$_gdb_minor}. These variables allow you to
11222 write scripts that work with different versions of @value{GDBN}
11223 without errors caused by features unavailable in some of those
11224 versions.
11225 @end table
11226
11227 @node Convenience Funs
11228 @section Convenience Functions
11229
11230 @cindex convenience functions
11231 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
11232 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
11233 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
11234 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
11235 @value{GDBN}.
11236
11237 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11238 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
11239
11240 @table @code
11241
11242 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
11243 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
11244 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
11245 returns zero.
11246
11247 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
11248 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
11249 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
11250 it is @code{void}:
11251
11252 @smallexample
11253 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11254 $1 = void
11255 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11256 $2 = 1
11257 (@value{GDBP}) run
11258 Starting program: ./a.out
11259 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
11260 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11261 $3 = 0
11262 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11263 $4 = 0
11264 @end smallexample
11265
11266 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
11267 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
11268 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
11269 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
11270 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
11271 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
11272 anymore.
11273
11274 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
11275 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
11276
11277 @smallexample
11278 void
11279 foo (void)
11280 @{
11281 @}
11282 @end smallexample
11283
11284 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
11285
11286 @smallexample
11287 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
11288 $1 = void
11289 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
11290 $2 = 1
11291 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
11292 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
11293 $3 = void
11294 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
11295 $4 = 1
11296 @end smallexample
11297
11298 @end table
11299
11300 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11301 @code{Python} support.
11302
11303 @table @code
11304
11305 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
11306 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
11307 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
11308 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
11309 Otherwise it returns zero.
11310
11311 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
11312 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
11313 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
11314 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11315 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
11316 regular expression support.
11317
11318 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
11319 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
11320 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
11321 Otherwise it returns zero.
11322
11323 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
11324 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
11325 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
11326
11327 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11328 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11329 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11330 Otherwise it returns zero.
11331
11332 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11333 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11334 The default is 1.
11335
11336 Example:
11337
11338 @smallexample
11339 (gdb) backtrace
11340 #0 bottom_func ()
11341 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
11342 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
11343 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
11344 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
11345 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
11346 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
11347 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
11348 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
11349 $1 = 1
11350 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
11351 $1 = 1
11352 @end smallexample
11353
11354 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11355 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11356 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
11357 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11358
11359 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11360 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11361 The default is 1.
11362
11363 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11364 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11365 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11366 Otherwise it returns zero.
11367
11368 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11369 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11370 The default is 1.
11371
11372 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
11373 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11374 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
11375 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11376
11377 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11378 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11379 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
11380 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11381
11382 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11383 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11384 The default is 1.
11385
11386 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
11387 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11388 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
11389 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11390
11391 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
11392 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
11393 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
11394
11395 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
11396 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
11397 an enumerated type:
11398
11399 @smallexample
11400 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
11401 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
11402 @end smallexample
11403
11404 @end table
11405
11406 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
11407 convenience functions.
11408
11409 @table @code
11410 @item help function
11411 @kindex help function
11412 @cindex show all convenience functions
11413 Print a list of all convenience functions.
11414 @end table
11415
11416 @node Registers
11417 @section Registers
11418
11419 @cindex registers
11420 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
11421 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
11422 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
11423 your machine.
11424
11425 @table @code
11426 @kindex info registers
11427 @item info registers
11428 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
11429 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11430
11431 @kindex info all-registers
11432 @cindex floating point registers
11433 @item info all-registers
11434 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
11435 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11436
11437 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
11438 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
11439 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggoup} can be any of those returned by
11440 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
11441
11442 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
11443 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
11444 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
11445 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
11446 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
11447 @end table
11448
11449 @anchor{standard registers}
11450 @cindex stack pointer register
11451 @cindex program counter register
11452 @cindex process status register
11453 @cindex frame pointer register
11454 @cindex standard registers
11455 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
11456 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
11457 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
11458 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
11459 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
11460 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
11461 register that contains the processor status. For example,
11462 you could print the program counter in hex with
11463
11464 @smallexample
11465 p/x $pc
11466 @end smallexample
11467
11468 @noindent
11469 or print the instruction to be executed next with
11470
11471 @smallexample
11472 x/i $pc
11473 @end smallexample
11474
11475 @noindent
11476 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
11477 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
11478 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
11479 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
11480 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
11481 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
11482 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
11483
11484 @smallexample
11485 set $sp += 4
11486 @end smallexample
11487
11488 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11489 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11490 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11491 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11492 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11493 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11494 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11495
11496 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11497 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11498 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11499 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11500 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11501 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11502 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11503
11504 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11505 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11506 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11507 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11508 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11509 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11510 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11511 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11512 prints the data in both formats.
11513
11514 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11515 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11516 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11517 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11518 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11519 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11520 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11521
11522 @smallexample
11523 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11524 $1 = @{
11525 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11526 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11527 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11528 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11529 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11530 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11531 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11532 @}
11533 @end smallexample
11534
11535 @noindent
11536 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11537 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11538 value to a @code{struct} member:
11539
11540 @smallexample
11541 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11542 @end smallexample
11543
11544 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11545 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11546 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11547 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11548 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11549 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11550
11551 @cindex caller-saved registers
11552 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11553 @cindex volatile registers
11554 @cindex <not saved> values
11555 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11556 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11557 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11558 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11559 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11560 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11561 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11562 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11563 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11564 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11565 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11566 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11567 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11568 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11569 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11570 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11571 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11572 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11573 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11574 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11575 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11576 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11577 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11578
11579 @node Floating Point Hardware
11580 @section Floating Point Hardware
11581 @cindex floating point
11582
11583 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11584 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11585
11586 @table @code
11587 @kindex info float
11588 @item info float
11589 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11590 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11591 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11592 the ARM and x86 machines.
11593 @end table
11594
11595 @node Vector Unit
11596 @section Vector Unit
11597 @cindex vector unit
11598
11599 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11600 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11601
11602 @table @code
11603 @kindex info vector
11604 @item info vector
11605 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11606 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11607 @end table
11608
11609 @node OS Information
11610 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11611 @cindex OS information
11612
11613 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11614 you debug your program.
11615
11616 @cindex auxiliary vector
11617 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11618 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11619 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11620 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11621 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11622 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11623 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11624 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11625 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11626 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11627 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11628 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11629
11630 @table @code
11631 @kindex info auxv
11632 @item info auxv
11633 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11634 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11635 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11636 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11637 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11638 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11639 an unrecognized tag.
11640 @end table
11641
11642 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11643 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11644 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11645 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11646 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11647 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11648 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11649
11650 @table @code
11651 @kindex info os
11652 @item info os @var{infotype}
11653
11654 Display OS information of the requested type.
11655
11656 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11657
11658 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11659 @table @code
11660 @kindex info os cpus
11661 @item cpus
11662 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11663 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11664 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11665 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11666 kernel initialization.
11667
11668 @kindex info os files
11669 @item files
11670 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11671 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11672 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11673 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11674
11675 @kindex info os modules
11676 @item modules
11677 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11678 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11679 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11680 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11681 in memory.
11682
11683 @kindex info os msg
11684 @item msg
11685 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11686 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11687 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11688 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11689 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11690 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11691 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11692 the message queue was last changed.
11693
11694 @kindex info os processes
11695 @item processes
11696 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11697 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11698 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11699 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11700 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11701 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11702
11703 @kindex info os procgroups
11704 @item procgroups
11705 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11706 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11707 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11708 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11709 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11710 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11711 and the process group leader is listed first.
11712
11713 @kindex info os semaphores
11714 @item semaphores
11715 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11716 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11717 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11718 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11719 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11720
11721 @kindex info os shm
11722 @item shm
11723 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11724 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11725 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11726 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11727 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11728 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11729 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11730
11731 @kindex info os sockets
11732 @item sockets
11733 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11734 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11735 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11736 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11737 connection.
11738
11739 @kindex info os threads
11740 @item threads
11741 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11742 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11743 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11744 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11745 process is not listed.
11746 @end table
11747
11748 @item info os
11749 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11750 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11751 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11752 types, this command will report an error.
11753 @end table
11754
11755 @node Memory Region Attributes
11756 @section Memory Region Attributes
11757 @cindex memory region attributes
11758
11759 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11760 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11761 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11762 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11763 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11764 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11765 user can override the fetched regions.
11766
11767 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11768 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11769 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11770 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11771 all memory.
11772
11773 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11774 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11775
11776 @table @code
11777 @kindex mem
11778 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11779 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11780 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11781 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11782 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11783 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11784
11785 @item mem auto
11786 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11787 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11788
11789 @kindex delete mem
11790 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11791 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11792 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11793
11794 @kindex disable mem
11795 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11796 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11797 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11798 It may be enabled again later.
11799
11800 @kindex enable mem
11801 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11802 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11803
11804 @kindex info mem
11805 @item info mem
11806 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11807 for each region:
11808
11809 @table @emph
11810 @item Memory Region Number
11811 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11812 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11813 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11814
11815 @item Lo Address
11816 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11817
11818 @item Hi Address
11819 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11820
11821 @item Attributes
11822 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11823 @end table
11824 @end table
11825
11826
11827 @subsection Attributes
11828
11829 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11830 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11831 write accesses to a memory region.
11832
11833 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11834 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11835 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11836
11837 @table @code
11838 @item ro
11839 Memory is read only.
11840 @item wo
11841 Memory is write only.
11842 @item rw
11843 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11844 @end table
11845
11846 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11847 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11848 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11849 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11850 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11851
11852 @table @code
11853 @item 8
11854 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11855 @item 16
11856 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11857 @item 32
11858 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11859 @item 64
11860 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11861 @end table
11862
11863 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11864 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11865 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11866 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11867 @c
11868 @c @table @code
11869 @c @item hwbreak
11870 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11871 @c @item swbreak (default)
11872 @c @end table
11873
11874 @subsubsection Data Cache
11875 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11876 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11877 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11878 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11879 registers.
11880
11881 @table @code
11882 @item cache
11883 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11884 @item nocache
11885 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11886 @end table
11887
11888 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11889 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11890 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11891 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11892 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11893
11894 @table @code
11895 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11896 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11897 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11898 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11899 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11900 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11901 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11902 The default value is @code{on}.
11903 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11904 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11905 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11906 @end table
11907
11908
11909 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11910 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11911 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11912 @c
11913 @c @table @code
11914 @c @item verify
11915 @c @item noverify (default)
11916 @c @end table
11917
11918 @node Dump/Restore Files
11919 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11920 @cindex dump/restore files
11921 @cindex append data to a file
11922 @cindex dump data to a file
11923 @cindex restore data from a file
11924
11925 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11926 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11927 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11928 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11929 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11930 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11931 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11932
11933 @table @code
11934
11935 @kindex dump
11936 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11937 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11938 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11939 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11940
11941 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11942 @table @code
11943 @item binary
11944 Raw binary form.
11945 @item ihex
11946 Intel hex format.
11947 @item srec
11948 Motorola S-record format.
11949 @item tekhex
11950 Tektronix Hex format.
11951 @item verilog
11952 Verilog Hex format.
11953 @end table
11954
11955 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11956 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11957 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11958 form.
11959
11960 @kindex append
11961 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11962 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11963 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11964 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11965 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11966
11967 @kindex restore
11968 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11969 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11970 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11971 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11972 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11973
11974 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11975 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11976 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11977 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11978 from that location.
11979
11980 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11981 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11982 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11983 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11984
11985 @end table
11986
11987 @node Core File Generation
11988 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11989 @cindex dump core from inferior
11990
11991 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11992 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11993 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11994 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11995 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11996 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11997 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11998
11999 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
12000 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
12001 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
12002
12003 @table @code
12004 @kindex gcore
12005 @kindex generate-core-file
12006 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
12007 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
12008 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
12009 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
12010 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
12011 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
12012
12013 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
12014 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
12015
12016 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
12017 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
12018 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
12019 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
12020 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
12021
12022 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
12023 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
12024 @item set use-coredump-filter on
12025 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
12026 Enable or disable the use of the file
12027 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
12028 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
12029 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
12030 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
12031
12032 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
12033 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
12034 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
12035 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
12036 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
12037 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
12038 about the bits that can be set in the
12039 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
12040 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
12041
12042 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
12043 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
12044 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
12045 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
12046 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
12047 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
12048 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
12049 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
12050
12051 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
12052 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
12053 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
12054 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
12055 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
12056 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
12057 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
12058
12059 The default value is @code{off}.
12060 @end table
12061
12062 @node Character Sets
12063 @section Character Sets
12064 @cindex character sets
12065 @cindex charset
12066 @cindex translating between character sets
12067 @cindex host character set
12068 @cindex target character set
12069
12070 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
12071 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
12072 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
12073 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
12074 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
12075 @dfn{target character set}.
12076
12077 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
12078 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
12079 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
12080 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
12081 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
12082 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
12083 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
12084 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
12085 character and string literals in expressions.
12086
12087 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
12088 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
12089 target-charset} command, described below.
12090
12091 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
12092 support:
12093
12094 @table @code
12095 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
12096 @kindex set target-charset
12097 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
12098 list of supported target character sets, type
12099 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12100
12101 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
12102 @kindex set host-charset
12103 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
12104
12105 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
12106 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
12107 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
12108 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
12109 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
12110
12111 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
12112 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12113 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
12114
12115 @item set charset @var{charset}
12116 @kindex set charset
12117 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
12118 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12119 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
12120 for both host and target.
12121
12122 @item show charset
12123 @kindex show charset
12124 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
12125
12126 @item show host-charset
12127 @kindex show host-charset
12128 Show the name of the current host character set.
12129
12130 @item show target-charset
12131 @kindex show target-charset
12132 Show the name of the current target character set.
12133
12134 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
12135 @kindex set target-wide-charset
12136 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
12137 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
12138 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
12139 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12140
12141 @item show target-wide-charset
12142 @kindex show target-wide-charset
12143 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
12144 @end table
12145
12146 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
12147 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
12148 @file{charset-test.c}:
12149
12150 @smallexample
12151 #include <stdio.h>
12152
12153 char ascii_hello[]
12154 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
12155 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
12156 char ibm1047_hello[]
12157 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
12158 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
12159
12160 main ()
12161 @{
12162 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12163 @}
12164 @end smallexample
12165
12166 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
12167 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
12168 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
12169
12170 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
12171
12172 @smallexample
12173 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
12174 $ gdb -nw charset-test
12175 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
12176 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12177 @dots{}
12178 (@value{GDBP})
12179 @end smallexample
12180
12181 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
12182 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
12183 strings:
12184
12185 @smallexample
12186 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12187 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
12188 (@value{GDBP})
12189 @end smallexample
12190
12191 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
12192 initial character set:
12193 @smallexample
12194 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
12195 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12196 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
12197 (@value{GDBP})
12198 @end smallexample
12199
12200 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
12201 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
12202 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
12203 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
12204 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
12205
12206 @smallexample
12207 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12208 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
12209 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12210 $2 = 72 'H'
12211 (@value{GDBP})
12212 @end smallexample
12213
12214 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
12215 literals you use in expressions:
12216
12217 @smallexample
12218 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12219 $3 = 43 '+'
12220 (@value{GDBP})
12221 @end smallexample
12222
12223 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
12224 character.
12225
12226 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
12227 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
12228 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
12229
12230 @smallexample
12231 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12232 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
12233 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12234 $5 = 200 '\310'
12235 (@value{GDBP})
12236 @end smallexample
12237
12238 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
12239 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
12240
12241 @smallexample
12242 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12243 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
12244 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12245 @end smallexample
12246
12247 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
12248 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
12249 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
12250 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
12251 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
12252
12253 @smallexample
12254 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
12255 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12256 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
12257 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
12258 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12259 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
12260 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12261 $7 = 72 '\110'
12262 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12263 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
12264 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12265 $9 = 200 'H'
12266 (@value{GDBP})
12267 @end smallexample
12268
12269 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
12270 string literals you use in expressions:
12271
12272 @smallexample
12273 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12274 $10 = 78 '+'
12275 (@value{GDBP})
12276 @end smallexample
12277
12278 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
12279 character.
12280
12281 @node Caching Target Data
12282 @section Caching Data of Targets
12283 @cindex caching data of targets
12284
12285 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
12286 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
12287 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
12288 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
12289 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
12290 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
12291 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
12292 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
12293 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
12294 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
12295 is executing.
12296 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
12297 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
12298 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
12299 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
12300 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
12301 in the code segment.
12302 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
12303 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
12304
12305 @table @code
12306 @kindex set remotecache
12307 @item set remotecache on
12308 @itemx set remotecache off
12309 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
12310 with old scripts.
12311
12312 @kindex show remotecache
12313 @item show remotecache
12314 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
12315
12316 @kindex set stack-cache
12317 @item set stack-cache on
12318 @itemx set stack-cache off
12319 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
12320 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
12321
12322 @kindex show stack-cache
12323 @item show stack-cache
12324 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
12325
12326 @kindex set code-cache
12327 @item set code-cache on
12328 @itemx set code-cache off
12329 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
12330 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
12331 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
12332
12333 @kindex show code-cache
12334 @item show code-cache
12335 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
12336 accesses.
12337
12338 @kindex info dcache
12339 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
12340 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
12341 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
12342 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
12343 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
12344 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
12345
12346 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
12347 printed in hex.
12348
12349 @item set dcache size @var{size}
12350 @cindex dcache size
12351 @kindex set dcache size
12352 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
12353
12354 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
12355 @cindex dcache line-size
12356 @kindex set dcache line-size
12357 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
12358 Must be a power of 2.
12359
12360 @item show dcache size
12361 @kindex show dcache size
12362 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
12363
12364 @item show dcache line-size
12365 @kindex show dcache line-size
12366 Show default size of dcache lines.
12367
12368 @end table
12369
12370 @node Searching Memory
12371 @section Search Memory
12372 @cindex searching memory
12373
12374 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
12375 @code{find} command.
12376
12377 @table @code
12378 @kindex find
12379 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12380 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12381 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
12382 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
12383 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
12384 @end table
12385
12386 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
12387 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
12388
12389 @table @r
12390 @item @var{s}, search query size
12391 The size of each search query value.
12392
12393 @table @code
12394 @item b
12395 bytes
12396 @item h
12397 halfwords (two bytes)
12398 @item w
12399 words (four bytes)
12400 @item g
12401 giant words (eight bytes)
12402 @end table
12403
12404 All values are interpreted in the current language.
12405 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
12406 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
12407 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
12408 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
12409
12410 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
12411 value's type in the current language.
12412 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
12413 pattern as a mixture of types.
12414 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
12415 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
12416 which is typically four bytes.
12417
12418 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
12419 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
12420 @end table
12421
12422 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
12423 (@code{"}).
12424 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
12425 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
12426
12427 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
12428 number of matches found.
12429
12430 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
12431 @samp{$_}.
12432 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
12433
12434 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
12435
12436 @smallexample
12437 void
12438 hello ()
12439 @{
12440 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
12441 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
12442 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
12443 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
12444 printf ("%s\n", hello);
12445 @}
12446 @end smallexample
12447
12448 @noindent
12449 you get during debugging:
12450
12451 @smallexample
12452 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
12453 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12454 1 pattern found
12455 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
12456 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12457 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12458 2 patterns found.
12459 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
12460 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12461 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12462 2 patterns found.
12463 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
12464 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12465 1 pattern found
12466 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
12467 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
12468 1 pattern found
12469 (gdb) print $numfound
12470 $1 = 1
12471 (gdb) print $_
12472 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
12473 @end smallexample
12474
12475 @node Value Sizes
12476 @section Value Sizes
12477
12478 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
12479 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
12480 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
12481 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
12482 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
12483
12484 @table @code
12485 @kindex set max-value-size
12486 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
12487 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
12488 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
12489 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
12490 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
12491
12492 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
12493 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
12494
12495 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
12496 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
12497 currently 16 bytes.
12498
12499 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
12500 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
12501 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
12502 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
12503 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
12504 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
12505 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
12506 size is less than @var{bytes}.
12507
12508 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12509
12510 @kindex show max-value-size
12511 @item show max-value-size
12512 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12513 allocate for the contents of a value.
12514 @end table
12515
12516 @node Optimized Code
12517 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12518 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12519 @cindex debugging optimized code
12520
12521 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12522 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12523 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12524 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12525 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12526 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12527 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12528
12529 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12530 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12531 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12532 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12533
12534 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12535 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12536 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12537 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12538 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12539 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12540
12541 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12542 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12543 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12544 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12545 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12546
12547 @menu
12548 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12549 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12550 @end menu
12551
12552 @node Inline Functions
12553 @section Inline Functions
12554 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12555
12556 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12557 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12558 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12559 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12560 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12561 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12562 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12563 @code{info frame} command.
12564
12565 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12566 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12567 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12568 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12569 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12570 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12571 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12572 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12573 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12574 local variables in the caller.
12575
12576 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12577 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12578 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12579 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12580 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12581 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12582 instructions are executed.
12583
12584 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12585 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12586 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12587 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12588
12589 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12590 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12591
12592 @itemize @bullet
12593 @item
12594 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12595 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12596 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12597 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12598 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12599 or inside the inlined function instead.
12600
12601 @item
12602 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12603 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12604 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12605 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12606
12607 @end itemize
12608
12609 @node Tail Call Frames
12610 @section Tail Call Frames
12611 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12612
12613 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12614 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12615 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12616 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12617 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12618
12619 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12620 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12621 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12622 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12623 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12624 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12625 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12626
12627 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12628 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12629 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12630 this information.
12631
12632 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12633 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12634
12635 @smallexample
12636 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12637 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12638 (gdb) info frame
12639 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12640 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12641 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12642 source language c++.
12643 Arglist at unknown address.
12644 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12645 @end smallexample
12646
12647 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12648 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12649 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12650 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12651 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12652 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12653
12654 @table @code
12655 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12656 @item set debug entry-values
12657 @kindex set debug entry-values
12658 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12659 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12660 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12661 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12662 result.
12663
12664 @item show debug entry-values
12665 @kindex show debug entry-values
12666 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12667 values at function entry and tail calls.
12668 @end table
12669
12670 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12671 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12672 reference by variable @code{x}):
12673
12674 @smallexample
12675 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12676 void (*x) (void) = c;
12677 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12678 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12679 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12680
12681 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12682 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12683 a () at t.c:3
12684 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12685 (gdb) bt
12686 #0 a () at t.c:3
12687 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12688 @end smallexample
12689
12690 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12691
12692 @smallexample
12693 int i;
12694 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12695 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12696 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12697 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12698 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12699 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12700 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12701 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12702
12703 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12704 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12705 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12706 (gdb) bt
12707 #0 f () at t.c:2
12708 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12709 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12710 @end smallexample
12711
12712 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12713 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12714
12715 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12716 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12717 @set ARROW @click{}
12718 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12719 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12720 @end ifset
12721 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12722 @set ARROW ->
12723 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12724 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12725 @end ifclear
12726
12727 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12728 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12729 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12730
12731 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12732 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12733 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12734 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12735 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12736 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12737
12738 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12739 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12740 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12741 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12742 omitted.
12743
12744 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12745 entry may fail:
12746
12747 @smallexample
12748 int v;
12749 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12750 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12751 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12752 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12753 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12754 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12755
12756 (gdb) bt
12757 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12758 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12759 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12760 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12761 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12762 @end smallexample
12763
12764 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12765 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12766 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12767 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12768 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12769
12770 @node Macros
12771 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12772
12773 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12774 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12775 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12776 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12777 where it was defined.
12778
12779 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12780 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12781 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12782 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12783
12784 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12785 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12786 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12787 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12788 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12789 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12790 see @ref{List}.
12791
12792 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12793 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12794 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12795
12796 @table @code
12797
12798 @kindex macro expand
12799 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12800 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12801 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12802 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12803 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12804 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12805 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12806 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12807 it can be any string of tokens.
12808
12809 @kindex macro exp1
12810 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12811 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12812 @cindex expand macro once
12813 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12814 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12815 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12816 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12817 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12818 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12819 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12820 can be any string of tokens.
12821
12822 @kindex info macro
12823 @cindex macro definition, showing
12824 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12825 @cindex macros, from debug info
12826 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12827 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12828 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12829 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12830 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12831 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12832
12833 @kindex info macros
12834 @item info macros @var{location}
12835 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12836 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12837 command-line where those definitions were established.
12838
12839 @kindex macro define
12840 @cindex user-defined macros
12841 @cindex defining macros interactively
12842 @cindex macros, user-defined
12843 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12844 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12845 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12846 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12847 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12848 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12849 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12850 @var{arglist}.
12851
12852 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12853 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12854 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12855 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12856 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12857
12858 @kindex macro undef
12859 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12860 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12861 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12862 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12863 in the program being debugged.
12864
12865 @kindex macro list
12866 @item macro list
12867 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12868 @end table
12869
12870 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12871 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12872 show our source files:
12873
12874 @smallexample
12875 $ cat sample.c
12876 #include <stdio.h>
12877 #include "sample.h"
12878
12879 #define M 42
12880 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12881
12882 main ()
12883 @{
12884 #define N 28
12885 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12886 #undef N
12887 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12888 #define N 1729
12889 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12890 @}
12891 $ cat sample.h
12892 #define Q <
12893 $
12894 @end smallexample
12895
12896 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12897 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12898 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12899 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12900 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12901 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12902 information.
12903
12904 @smallexample
12905 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12906 $
12907 @end smallexample
12908
12909 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12910
12911 @smallexample
12912 $ gdb -nw sample
12913 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12914 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12915 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12916 (@value{GDBP})
12917 @end smallexample
12918
12919 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12920 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12921 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12922
12923 @smallexample
12924 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12925 3
12926 4 #define M 42
12927 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12928 6
12929 7 main ()
12930 8 @{
12931 9 #define N 28
12932 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12933 11 #undef N
12934 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12935 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12936 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12937 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12938 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12939 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12940 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12941 #define Q <
12942 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12943 expands to: (42 + 1)
12944 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12945 expands to: once (M + 1)
12946 (@value{GDBP})
12947 @end smallexample
12948
12949 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12950 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12951 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12952 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12953
12954 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12955 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12956
12957 @smallexample
12958 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12959 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12960 (@value{GDBP}) run
12961 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12962
12963 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12964 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12965 (@value{GDBP})
12966 @end smallexample
12967
12968 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12969
12970 @smallexample
12971 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12972 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12973 #define N 28
12974 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12975 expands to: 28 < 42
12976 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12977 $1 = 1
12978 (@value{GDBP})
12979 @end smallexample
12980
12981 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12982 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12983 thereof) in force at each point:
12984
12985 @smallexample
12986 (@value{GDBP}) next
12987 Hello, world!
12988 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12989 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12990 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12991 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12992 (@value{GDBP}) next
12993 We're so creative.
12994 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12995 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12996 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12997 #define N 1729
12998 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12999 expands to: 1729 < 42
13000 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
13001 $2 = 0
13002 (@value{GDBP})
13003 @end smallexample
13004
13005 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
13006 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
13007 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
13008 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
13009
13010 @smallexample
13011 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
13012 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
13013 -D__STDC__=1
13014 (@value{GDBP})
13015 @end smallexample
13016
13017
13018 @node Tracepoints
13019 @chapter Tracepoints
13020 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
13021 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
13022
13023 @cindex tracepoints
13024 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
13025 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
13026 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
13027 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
13028 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
13029 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
13030 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
13031
13032 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
13033 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
13034 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
13035 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
13036 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
13037 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
13038 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
13039 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
13040 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
13041 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
13042 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
13043
13044 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
13045 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
13046 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
13047 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
13048 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
13049 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
13050 Packets}.
13051
13052 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
13053 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
13054 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
13055
13056 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
13057
13058 @menu
13059 * Set Tracepoints::
13060 * Analyze Collected Data::
13061 * Tracepoint Variables::
13062 * Trace Files::
13063 @end menu
13064
13065 @node Set Tracepoints
13066 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
13067
13068 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
13069 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
13070 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
13071 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
13072 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
13073 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
13074 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
13075
13076 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
13077 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
13078 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
13079 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
13080 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
13081 tracepoint was hit.
13082
13083 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
13084 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
13085 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
13086 either.
13087
13088 @cindex fast tracepoints
13089 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
13090 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
13091 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
13092
13093 @cindex static tracepoints
13094 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
13095 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
13096 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
13097 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
13098 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
13099 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
13100 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
13101 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
13102 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
13103 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
13104 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
13105 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
13106 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
13107 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
13108 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
13109 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
13110 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
13111 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
13112 static tracepoint marker.
13113
13114 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
13115 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
13116
13117 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
13118 conditions and actions.
13119
13120 @menu
13121 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
13122 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
13123 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
13124 * Tracepoint Conditions::
13125 * Trace State Variables::
13126 * Tracepoint Actions::
13127 * Listing Tracepoints::
13128 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
13129 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
13130 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
13131 @end menu
13132
13133 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
13134 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
13135
13136 @table @code
13137 @cindex set tracepoint
13138 @kindex trace
13139 @item trace @var{location}
13140 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
13141 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
13142 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
13143 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
13144 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
13145 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
13146 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
13147 in tracing}).
13148 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
13149 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
13150 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
13151 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
13152 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
13153 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
13154 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
13155 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
13156 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
13157 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
13158 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
13159 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
13160
13161 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
13162
13163 @smallexample
13164 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
13165
13166 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
13167
13168 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
13169
13170 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
13171
13172 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
13173 @end smallexample
13174
13175 @noindent
13176 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
13177
13178 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
13179 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
13180 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
13181 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
13182 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
13183 information on tracepoint conditions.
13184
13185 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13186 @cindex set fast tracepoint
13187 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
13188 @kindex ftrace
13189 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
13190 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
13191 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
13192 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
13193 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
13194 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
13195 message.
13196
13197 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
13198 @code{trace}.
13199
13200 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
13201 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
13202 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
13203 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
13204 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
13205 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
13206 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
13207 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
13208
13209 @example
13210 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
13211 @end example
13212
13213 @noindent
13214 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
13215 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
13216
13217 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13218 @cindex set static tracepoint
13219 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
13220 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
13221 @kindex strace
13222 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
13223 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
13224 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
13225 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
13226 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
13227
13228 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
13229 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
13230 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
13231 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
13232 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
13233 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
13234 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
13235 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
13236 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
13237 tracing engine:
13238
13239 @smallexample
13240 main ()
13241 @{
13242 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
13243 @}
13244 @end smallexample
13245
13246 @noindent
13247 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
13248 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
13249
13250 @smallexample
13251 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13252 Cnt Enb ID Address What
13253 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
13254 Data: "str %s"
13255 [etc...]
13256 @end smallexample
13257
13258 @noindent
13259 so you may probe the marker above with:
13260
13261 @smallexample
13262 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
13263 @end smallexample
13264
13265 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
13266 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
13267 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
13268 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
13269 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
13270 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
13271 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
13272 the @samp{Data:} field.
13273
13274 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
13275 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
13276 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
13277
13278 @vindex $tpnum
13279 @cindex last tracepoint number
13280 @cindex recent tracepoint number
13281 @cindex tracepoint number
13282 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
13283 of the most recently set tracepoint.
13284
13285 @kindex delete tracepoint
13286 @cindex tracepoint deletion
13287 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13288 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
13289 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
13290 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
13291
13292 Examples:
13293
13294 @smallexample
13295 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
13296
13297 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
13298 @end smallexample
13299
13300 @noindent
13301 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
13302 @end table
13303
13304 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13305 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13306
13307 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
13308
13309 @table @code
13310 @kindex disable tracepoint
13311 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13312 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
13313 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
13314 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
13315 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
13316 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
13317 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
13318 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
13319 next trace experiment.
13320
13321 @kindex enable tracepoint
13322 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13323 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
13324 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
13325 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
13326 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
13327 next time a trace experiment is run.
13328 @end table
13329
13330 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
13331 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
13332
13333 @table @code
13334 @kindex passcount
13335 @cindex tracepoint pass count
13336 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
13337 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
13338 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
13339 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
13340 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
13341 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
13342 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
13343 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
13344 user.
13345
13346 Examples:
13347
13348 @smallexample
13349 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
13350 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
13351
13352 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
13353 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
13354 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13355 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
13356 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
13357 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
13358 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
13359 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
13360 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
13361 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
13362 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
13363 @end smallexample
13364 @end table
13365
13366 @node Tracepoint Conditions
13367 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
13368 @cindex conditional tracepoints
13369 @cindex tracepoint conditions
13370
13371 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
13372 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
13373 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
13374 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
13375 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
13376 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
13377 is true.
13378
13379 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
13380 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
13381 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
13382 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
13383 just as with breakpoints.
13384
13385 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
13386 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
13387 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
13388 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
13389 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
13390 accesses, and so forth.
13391
13392 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
13393 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
13394 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
13395 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
13396 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
13397 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
13398 search through.
13399
13400 @smallexample
13401 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
13402 @end smallexample
13403
13404 @node Trace State Variables
13405 @subsection Trace State Variables
13406 @cindex trace state variables
13407
13408 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
13409 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
13410 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
13411 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
13412 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
13413 integers.
13414
13415 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
13416 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
13417 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
13418 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
13419
13420 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
13421 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
13422 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
13423 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
13424 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
13425 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
13426 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
13427 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
13428 variable with the same name.
13429
13430 @table @code
13431
13432 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
13433 @kindex tvariable
13434 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
13435 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
13436 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
13437 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
13438 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
13439 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
13440 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
13441 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
13442 value. The default initial value is 0.
13443
13444 @item info tvariables
13445 @kindex info tvariables
13446 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
13447 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
13448 currently running.
13449
13450 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
13451 @kindex delete tvariable
13452 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
13453 are specified.
13454
13455 @end table
13456
13457 @node Tracepoint Actions
13458 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
13459
13460 @table @code
13461 @kindex actions
13462 @cindex tracepoint actions
13463 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13464 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
13465 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
13466 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
13467 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
13468 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
13469 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
13470 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
13471 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
13472 @code{while-stepping}.
13473
13474 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
13475 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
13476 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
13477
13478 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
13479 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
13480 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
13481
13482 @smallexample
13483 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
13484
13485 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
13486
13487 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
13488 @end smallexample
13489
13490 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
13491 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
13492 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
13493 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
13494 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
13495 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
13496 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
13497 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
13498
13499 @smallexample
13500 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13501 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13502 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
13503 > collect bar,baz
13504 > collect $regs
13505 > while-stepping 12
13506 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13507 > end
13508 end
13509 @end smallexample
13510
13511 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13512 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13513 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13514 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13515 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13516 special arguments are supported:
13517
13518 @table @code
13519 @item $regs
13520 Collect all registers.
13521
13522 @item $args
13523 Collect all function arguments.
13524
13525 @item $locals
13526 Collect all local variables.
13527
13528 @item $_ret
13529 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13530 of a backtrace.
13531
13532 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13533 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13534 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13535 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13536 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13537 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13538
13539 @item $_probe_argc
13540 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13541 tracepoint is located.
13542 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13543
13544 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13545 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13546 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13547 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13548
13549 @item $_sdata
13550 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13551 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13552 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13553 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13554 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13555 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13556 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13557 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13558 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13559
13560 @smallexample
13561 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13562 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13563 @end smallexample
13564
13565 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13566 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13567 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13568 @value{GDBN}.
13569 @end table
13570
13571 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13572 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13573 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13574
13575 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13576 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13577 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13578 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13579 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13580 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13581 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13582 @samp{mystr}.
13583
13584 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13585 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13586
13587 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13588 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13589 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13590 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13591 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13592 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13593 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13594 action were used.
13595
13596 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13597 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13598 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13599 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13600 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13601 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13602
13603 @smallexample
13604 > while-stepping 12
13605 > collect $regs, myglobal
13606 > end
13607 >
13608 @end smallexample
13609
13610 @noindent
13611 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13612 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13613 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13614 @code{stepping}.
13615
13616 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13617 @kindex set default-collect
13618 @cindex default collection action
13619 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13620 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13621 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13622 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13623 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13624 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13625
13626 @item show default-collect
13627 @kindex show default-collect
13628 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13629 tracepoint hit.
13630
13631 @end table
13632
13633 @node Listing Tracepoints
13634 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13635
13636 @table @code
13637 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13638 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13639 @cindex information about tracepoints
13640 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13641 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13642 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13643 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13644 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13645 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13646
13647 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13648 tracing:
13649
13650 @itemize @bullet
13651 @item
13652 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13653
13654 @item
13655 the state about installed on target of each location
13656 @end itemize
13657
13658 @smallexample
13659 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13660 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13661 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13662 while-stepping 20
13663 collect globfoo, $regs
13664 end
13665 collect globfoo2
13666 end
13667 pass count 1200
13668 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13669 collect $eip
13670 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13671 installed on target
13672 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13673 installed on target
13674 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13675 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13676 not installed on target
13677 (@value{GDBP})
13678 @end smallexample
13679
13680 @noindent
13681 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13682 @end table
13683
13684 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13685 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13686
13687 @table @code
13688 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13689 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13690 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13691 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13692 program.
13693
13694 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13695
13696 @table @emph
13697 @item Count
13698 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13699 stable identifier.
13700 @item ID
13701 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13702 @item Enabled or Disabled
13703 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13704 that are not enabled.
13705 @item Address
13706 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13707 @item What
13708 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13709 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13710 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13711 will be left blank.
13712 @end table
13713
13714 @noindent
13715 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13716
13717 @table @emph
13718 @item Data
13719 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13720 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13721 marker call.
13722 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13723 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13724 @end table
13725
13726 @smallexample
13727 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13728 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13729 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13730 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13731 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13732 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13733 Data: str %s
13734 (@value{GDBP})
13735 @end smallexample
13736 @end table
13737
13738 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13739 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13740
13741 @table @code
13742 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13743 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13744 @cindex collected data discarded
13745 @item tstart
13746 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13747 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13748 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13749 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13750 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13751 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13752 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13753 information, and so forth.
13754
13755 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13756 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13757 @item tstop
13758 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13759 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13760 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13761 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13762 needs to be stopped quickly.
13763
13764 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13765 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13766 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13767
13768 @kindex tstatus
13769 @cindex status of trace data collection
13770 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13771 @item tstatus
13772 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13773 collection.
13774 @end table
13775
13776 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13777
13778 @smallexample
13779 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13781 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13782 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13783 > while-stepping 11
13784 > collect $regs
13785 > end
13786 > end
13787 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13788 [time passes @dots{}]
13789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13790 @end smallexample
13791
13792 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13793 @cindex disconnected tracing
13794 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13795 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13796 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13797 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13798 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13799 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13800 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13801 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13802
13803 @table @code
13804 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13805 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13806 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13807 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13808 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13809 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13810 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13811 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13812
13813 @item show disconnected-tracing
13814 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13815 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13816
13817 @end table
13818
13819 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13820 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13821 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13822 it will continue after reconnection.
13823
13824 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13825 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13826 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13827 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13828 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13829 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13830 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13831 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13832 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13833 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13834
13835 @cindex circular trace buffer
13836 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13837 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13838 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13839 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13840 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13841 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13842 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13843 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13844 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13845 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13846 the next run.
13847
13848 @table @code
13849 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13850 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13851 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13852 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13853 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13854 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13855 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13856
13857 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13858 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13859 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13860 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13861 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13862 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13863
13864 @end table
13865
13866 @table @code
13867 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13868 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13869 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13870 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13871 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13872 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13873 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13874 likes. This is also the default.
13875
13876 @item show trace-buffer-size
13877 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13878 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13879 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13880 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13881 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13882 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13883 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13884 @end table
13885
13886 @table @code
13887 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13888 @kindex set trace-user
13889
13890 @item show trace-user
13891 @kindex show trace-user
13892
13893 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13894 @kindex set trace-notes
13895 Set the trace run's notes.
13896
13897 @item show trace-notes
13898 @kindex show trace-notes
13899 Show the trace run's notes.
13900
13901 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13902 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13903 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13904 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13905 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13906
13907 @item show trace-stop-notes
13908 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13909 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13910
13911 @end table
13912
13913 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13914 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13915
13916 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13917 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13918 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13919 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13920 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13921 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13922 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13923 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13924 mentioned here.
13925
13926 @itemize @bullet
13927
13928 @item
13929 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13930 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13931 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13932 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13933 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13934 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13935 cannot be collected either.
13936
13937 @item
13938 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13939 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13940 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13941 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13942 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13943 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13944 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13945 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13946 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13947 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13948
13949 @item
13950 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13951 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13952 in a misleading way.
13953
13954 @item
13955 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13956 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13957 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13958 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13959 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13960 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13961 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13962 by @code{ptr}.
13963
13964 @item
13965 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13966 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13967 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13968 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13969 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13970 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13971 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13972 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13973 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13974 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13975 invalid address.
13976
13977 @item
13978 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13979 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13980 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13981 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13982 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13983 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13984 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13985 it to zero.
13986
13987 @end itemize
13988
13989 @node Analyze Collected Data
13990 @section Using the Collected Data
13991
13992 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13993 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13994 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13995 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13996 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13997 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13998 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13999 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
14000 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
14001 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
14002 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
14003 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
14004 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
14005 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
14006 the buffer will fail.
14007
14008 @menu
14009 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
14010 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
14011 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
14012 @end menu
14013
14014 @node tfind
14015 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
14016
14017 @kindex tfind
14018 @cindex select trace snapshot
14019 @cindex find trace snapshot
14020 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
14021 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
14022 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
14023 snapshot is selected.
14024
14025 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
14026
14027 @table @code
14028 @item tfind start
14029 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
14030 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
14031
14032 @item tfind none
14033 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
14034
14035 @item tfind end
14036 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
14037
14038 @item tfind
14039 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
14040 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
14041
14042 @item tfind -
14043 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
14044 retracing earlier steps.
14045
14046 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
14047 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
14048 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
14049 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
14050 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
14051
14052 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
14053 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
14054 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
14055 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
14056 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
14057
14058 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14059 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
14060 addresses (exclusive).
14061
14062 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14063 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
14064 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
14065
14066 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
14067 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
14068 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
14069 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
14070 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
14071 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
14072 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
14073 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
14074 @end table
14075
14076 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
14077 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
14078 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
14079 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
14080 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
14081 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
14082 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
14083 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
14084 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
14085 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
14086 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
14087 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
14088 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
14089 tracepoint as the current one.
14090
14091 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
14092 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
14093 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
14094 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
14095 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
14096
14097 @smallexample
14098 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14099 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14100 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
14101 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
14102 > tfind
14103 > end
14104
14105 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
14106 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
14107 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
14108 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
14109 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
14110 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
14111 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
14112 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
14113 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
14114 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
14115 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
14116 @end smallexample
14117
14118 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
14119 the buffer:
14120
14121 @smallexample
14122 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14123 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14124 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
14125 > tfind line
14126 > end
14127
14128 Frame 0, X = 1
14129 Frame 7, X = 2
14130 Frame 13, X = 255
14131 @end smallexample
14132
14133 @node tdump
14134 @subsection @code{tdump}
14135 @kindex tdump
14136 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
14137 @cindex tracepoint data, display
14138
14139 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
14140 the current trace snapshot.
14141
14142 @smallexample
14143 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
14144 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14145 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
14146 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
14147 > end
14148
14149 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14150
14151 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
14152 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
14153 at gdb_test.c:444
14154 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
14155
14156 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
14157 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
14158 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
14159 d1 0x18 24
14160 d2 0x80 128
14161 d3 0x33 51
14162 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
14163 d5 0x22 34
14164 d6 0xe0 224
14165 d7 0x380035 3670069
14166 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
14167 a1 0x3000668 50333288
14168 a2 0x100 256
14169 a3 0x322000 3284992
14170 a4 0x3000698 50333336
14171 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
14172 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
14173 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
14174 ps 0x0 0
14175 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
14176 fpcontrol 0x0 0
14177 fpstatus 0x0 0
14178 fpiaddr 0x0 0
14179 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
14180 p1 = (void *) 0x11
14181 p2 = (void *) 0x22
14182 p3 = (void *) 0x33
14183 p4 = (void *) 0x44
14184 p5 = (void *) 0x55
14185 p6 = (void *) 0x66
14186 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
14187
14188 (@value{GDBP})
14189 @end smallexample
14190
14191 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
14192 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
14193 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
14194 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
14195
14196 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
14197 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
14198 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
14199 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
14200 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
14201 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
14202 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
14203 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
14204 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
14205 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
14206
14207 @node save tracepoints
14208 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
14209 @kindex save tracepoints
14210 @kindex save-tracepoints
14211 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
14212
14213 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
14214 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
14215 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
14216 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
14217 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
14218 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
14219
14220 @node Tracepoint Variables
14221 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
14222 @cindex tracepoint variables
14223 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
14224
14225 @table @code
14226 @vindex $trace_frame
14227 @item (int) $trace_frame
14228 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
14229 snapshot is selected.
14230
14231 @vindex $tracepoint
14232 @item (int) $tracepoint
14233 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
14234
14235 @vindex $trace_line
14236 @item (int) $trace_line
14237 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
14238
14239 @vindex $trace_file
14240 @item (char []) $trace_file
14241 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
14242
14243 @vindex $trace_func
14244 @item (char []) $trace_func
14245 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
14246 @end table
14247
14248 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
14249 use @code{output} instead.
14250
14251 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
14252 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
14253 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
14254 which are managed by the target.
14255
14256 @smallexample
14257 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14258
14259 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
14260 > output $trace_file
14261 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
14262 > tfind
14263 > end
14264 @end smallexample
14265
14266 @node Trace Files
14267 @section Using Trace Files
14268 @cindex trace files
14269
14270 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
14271 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
14272 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
14273 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
14274 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
14275
14276 @table @code
14277
14278 @kindex tsave
14279 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
14280 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
14281 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
14282 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
14283 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
14284 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
14285 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
14286 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
14287 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
14288 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
14289 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
14290 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
14291 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
14292 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
14293 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
14294
14295 @kindex target tfile
14296 @kindex tfile
14297 @kindex target ctf
14298 @kindex ctf
14299 @item target tfile @var{filename}
14300 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
14301 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
14302 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
14303 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
14304 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
14305 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
14306 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
14307 the host.
14308
14309 @smallexample
14310 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
14311 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
14312 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
14313 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
14314 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
14315 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
14316 i = 0
14317 a = 0
14318 b = 1 '\001'
14319 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
14320 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
14321 (@value{GDBP}) p b
14322 $1 = 1
14323 @end smallexample
14324
14325 @end table
14326
14327 @node Overlays
14328 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
14329 @cindex overlays
14330
14331 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
14332 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
14333 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
14334 use overlays.
14335
14336 @menu
14337 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
14338 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
14339 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
14340 mapped by asking the inferior.
14341 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
14342 @end menu
14343
14344 @node How Overlays Work
14345 @section How Overlays Work
14346 @cindex mapped overlays
14347 @cindex unmapped overlays
14348 @cindex load address, overlay's
14349 @cindex mapped address
14350 @cindex overlay area
14351
14352 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
14353 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
14354 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
14355 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
14356 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
14357
14358 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
14359 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
14360 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
14361 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
14362 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
14363 largest overlay as well.
14364
14365 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
14366 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
14367 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
14368 there.
14369
14370 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
14371 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
14372 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
14373
14374 @smallexample
14375 @group
14376 Data Instruction Larger
14377 Address Space Address Space Address Space
14378 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
14379 | | | | | |
14380 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
14381 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
14382 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
14383 | and heap | | | | | |
14384 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
14385 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
14386 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
14387 | | | | | |
14388 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
14389 address | | | | | |
14390 | overlay | <-' | | |
14391 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
14392 | | <---. | | load address
14393 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
14394 | | | |
14395 +-----------+ | |
14396 +-----------+
14397 | |
14398 +-----------+
14399
14400 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
14401 @end group
14402 @end smallexample
14403
14404 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
14405 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
14406 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
14407 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
14408 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
14409 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
14410 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
14411 program and the overlay area.
14412
14413 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
14414 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
14415 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
14416 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
14417 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
14418 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
14419 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
14420
14421 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
14422 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
14423 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
14424
14425 @itemize @bullet
14426
14427 @item
14428 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
14429 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
14430 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
14431 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
14432
14433 @item
14434 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
14435 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
14436 your program's performance.
14437
14438 @item
14439 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
14440 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
14441 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
14442 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
14443 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
14444 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
14445 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
14446
14447 @item
14448 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
14449 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
14450 instruction and data spaces.
14451
14452 @end itemize
14453
14454 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
14455 improved in many ways:
14456
14457 @itemize @bullet
14458
14459 @item
14460 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
14461 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
14462 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
14463 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
14464 area in the usual way.
14465
14466 @item
14467 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
14468 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
14469
14470 @item
14471 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
14472 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
14473 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
14474 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
14475 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
14476 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
14477 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
14478
14479 @end itemize
14480
14481
14482 @node Overlay Commands
14483 @section Overlay Commands
14484
14485 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
14486 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
14487 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
14488 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
14489 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
14490 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
14491
14492 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
14493 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
14494
14495 @table @code
14496 @item overlay off
14497 @kindex overlay
14498 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
14499 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
14500 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
14501 overlay support is disabled.
14502
14503 @item overlay manual
14504 @cindex manual overlay debugging
14505 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14506 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14507 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14508 commands described below.
14509
14510 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14511 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14512 @cindex map an overlay
14513 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14514 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14515 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14516 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14517 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14518 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14519
14520 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14521 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14522 @cindex unmap an overlay
14523 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14524 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14525 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14526 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14527
14528 @item overlay auto
14529 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14530 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14531 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14532 Overlay Debugging}.
14533
14534 @item overlay load-target
14535 @itemx overlay load
14536 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14537 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14538 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14539 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14540 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14541 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14542
14543 @item overlay list-overlays
14544 @itemx overlay list
14545 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14546 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14547 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14548
14549 @end table
14550
14551 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14552 of the function the address falls in:
14553
14554 @smallexample
14555 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14556 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14557 @end smallexample
14558 @noindent
14559 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14560 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14561 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14562 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14563
14564 @smallexample
14565 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14566 No sections are mapped.
14567 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14568 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14569 @end smallexample
14570 @noindent
14571 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14572 name normally:
14573
14574 @smallexample
14575 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14576 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14577 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14578 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14579 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14580 @end smallexample
14581
14582 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14583 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14584 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14585 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14586 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14587
14588 @itemize @bullet
14589 @item
14590 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14591 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14592 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14593 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14594 @item
14595 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14596 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14597 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14598 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14599 breakpoints properly.
14600 @end itemize
14601
14602
14603 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14604 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14605 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14606
14607 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14608 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14609 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14610 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14611 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14612 current state of the overlays.
14613
14614 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14615 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14616
14617 @table @asis
14618
14619 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14620 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14621
14622 @smallexample
14623 struct
14624 @{
14625 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14626 unsigned long vma;
14627
14628 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14629 unsigned long size;
14630
14631 /* The overlay's load address. */
14632 unsigned long lma;
14633
14634 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14635 zero otherwise. */
14636 unsigned long mapped;
14637 @}
14638 @end smallexample
14639
14640 @item @code{_novlys}:
14641 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14642 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14643
14644 @end table
14645
14646 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14647 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14648 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14649 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14650 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14651 currently mapped.
14652
14653 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14654 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14655 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14656 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14657 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14658 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14659 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14660 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14661 are not being executed.
14662
14663 @node Overlay Sample Program
14664 @section Overlay Sample Program
14665 @cindex overlay example program
14666
14667 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14668 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14669 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14670 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14671 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14672 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14673 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14674
14675 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14676 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14677 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14678 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14679
14680 @table @file
14681 @item overlays.c
14682 The main program file.
14683 @item ovlymgr.c
14684 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14685 @item foo.c
14686 @itemx bar.c
14687 @itemx baz.c
14688 @itemx grbx.c
14689 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14690 @item d10v.ld
14691 @itemx m32r.ld
14692 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14693 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14694 @end table
14695
14696 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14697 cross-compiler like this:
14698
14699 @smallexample
14700 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14701 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14702 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14703 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14704 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14705 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14706 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14707 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14708 @end smallexample
14709
14710 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14711 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14712 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14713
14714
14715 @node Languages
14716 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14717 @cindex languages
14718
14719 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14720 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14721 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14722 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14723 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14724 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14725
14726 @cindex working language
14727 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14728 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14729 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14730 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14731 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14732 language}.
14733
14734 @menu
14735 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14736 * Show:: Displaying the language
14737 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14738 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14739 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14740 @end menu
14741
14742 @node Setting
14743 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14744
14745 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14746 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14747 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14748 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14749 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14750 are printed, etc.
14751
14752 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14753 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14754 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14755 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14756 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14757 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14758 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14759 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14760 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14761 Displaying the Language}.
14762
14763 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14764 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14765 another language. In that case, make the
14766 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14767 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14768 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14769
14770 @menu
14771 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14772 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14773 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14774 @end menu
14775
14776 @node Filenames
14777 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14778
14779 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14780 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14781
14782 @table @file
14783 @item .ada
14784 @itemx .ads
14785 @itemx .adb
14786 @itemx .a
14787 Ada source file.
14788
14789 @item .c
14790 C source file
14791
14792 @item .C
14793 @itemx .cc
14794 @itemx .cp
14795 @itemx .cpp
14796 @itemx .cxx
14797 @itemx .c++
14798 C@t{++} source file
14799
14800 @item .d
14801 D source file
14802
14803 @item .m
14804 Objective-C source file
14805
14806 @item .f
14807 @itemx .F
14808 Fortran source file
14809
14810 @item .mod
14811 Modula-2 source file
14812
14813 @item .s
14814 @itemx .S
14815 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14816 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14817 @end table
14818
14819 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14820 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14821
14822 @node Manually
14823 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14824
14825 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14826 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14827 your program.
14828
14829 @kindex set language
14830 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14831 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14832 a language, such as
14833 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14834 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14835
14836 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14837 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14838 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14839 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14840 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14841 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14842 command such as:
14843
14844 @smallexample
14845 print a = b + c
14846 @end smallexample
14847
14848 @noindent
14849 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14850 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14851 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14852 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14853
14854 @node Automatically
14855 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14856
14857 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14858 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14859 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14860 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14861 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14862 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14863 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14864 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14865 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14866
14867 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14868 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14869 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14870 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14871 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14872
14873 @node Show
14874 @section Displaying the Language
14875
14876 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14877 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14878
14879 @table @code
14880 @item show language
14881 @anchor{show language}
14882 @kindex show language
14883 Display the current working language. This is the
14884 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14885 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14886
14887 @item info frame
14888 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14889 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14890 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14891 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14892 information listed here.
14893
14894 @item info source
14895 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14896 Display the source language of this source file.
14897 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14898 information listed here.
14899 @end table
14900
14901 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14902 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14903 with a language explicitly:
14904
14905 @table @code
14906 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14907 @kindex set extension-language
14908 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14909 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14910
14911 @item info extensions
14912 @kindex info extensions
14913 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14914 @end table
14915
14916 @node Checks
14917 @section Type and Range Checking
14918
14919 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14920 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14921 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14922 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14923 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14924 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14925 errors when your program is running.
14926
14927 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14928 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14929 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14930 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14931
14932 @menu
14933 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14934 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14935 @end menu
14936
14937 @cindex type checking
14938 @cindex checks, type
14939 @node Type Checking
14940 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14941
14942 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14943 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14944 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14945 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14946
14947 @smallexample
14948 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14949
14950 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14951 $1 = 2
14952 @exdent but
14953 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14954 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14955 @end smallexample
14956
14957 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14958 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14959
14960 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14961 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14962 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14963 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14964 expressions like the second example above.
14965
14966 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14967 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14968 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14969 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14970 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14971 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14972
14973 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14974
14975 @kindex set check type
14976 @kindex show check type
14977 @table @code
14978 @item set check type on
14979 @itemx set check type off
14980 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14981 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14982 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14983
14984 @item show check type
14985 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14986 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14987 @end table
14988
14989 @cindex range checking
14990 @cindex checks, range
14991 @node Range Checking
14992 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14993
14994 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14995 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14996 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14997 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14998 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14999
15000 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
15001 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
15002 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
15003 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
15004
15005 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
15006 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
15007 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
15008 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
15009 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
15010 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
15011
15012 @smallexample
15013 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
15014 @end smallexample
15015
15016 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
15017 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
15018 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
15019
15020 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
15021
15022 @kindex set check range
15023 @kindex show check range
15024 @table @code
15025 @item set check range auto
15026 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
15027 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
15028 each language.
15029
15030 @item set check range on
15031 @itemx set check range off
15032 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
15033 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
15034 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
15035 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
15036
15037 @item set check range warn
15038 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
15039 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
15040 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
15041 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
15042 systems).
15043
15044 @item show range
15045 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
15046 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
15047 @end table
15048
15049 @node Supported Languages
15050 @section Supported Languages
15051
15052 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
15053 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
15054 @c This is false ...
15055 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
15056 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
15057 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
15058 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
15059 language.
15060
15061 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
15062 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
15063 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
15064 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
15065 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
15066 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
15067 language reference or tutorial.
15068
15069 @menu
15070 * C:: C and C@t{++}
15071 * D:: D
15072 * Go:: Go
15073 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
15074 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
15075 * Fortran:: Fortran
15076 * Pascal:: Pascal
15077 * Rust:: Rust
15078 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
15079 * Ada:: Ada
15080 @end menu
15081
15082 @node C
15083 @subsection C and C@t{++}
15084
15085 @cindex C and C@t{++}
15086 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
15087
15088 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
15089 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
15090 together.
15091
15092 @cindex C@t{++}
15093 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
15094 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
15095 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
15096 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
15097 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
15098 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
15099 compiler (@code{aCC}).
15100
15101 @menu
15102 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
15103 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
15104 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
15105 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
15106 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
15107 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
15108 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
15109 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
15110 @end menu
15111
15112 @node C Operators
15113 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
15114
15115 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
15116
15117 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15118 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15119 often defined on groups of types.
15120
15121 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
15122
15123 @itemize @bullet
15124
15125 @item
15126 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
15127 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
15128
15129 @item
15130 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
15131 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
15132
15133 @item
15134 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
15135
15136 @item
15137 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
15138
15139 @end itemize
15140
15141 @noindent
15142 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
15143 in order of increasing precedence:
15144
15145 @table @code
15146 @item ,
15147 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
15148 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
15149 expression being the last expression evaluated.
15150
15151 @item =
15152 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
15153 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
15154
15155 @item @var{op}=
15156 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
15157 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
15158 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
15159 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
15160 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
15161
15162 @item ?:
15163 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
15164 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
15165 should be of an integral type.
15166
15167 @item ||
15168 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15169
15170 @item &&
15171 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15172
15173 @item |
15174 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15175
15176 @item ^
15177 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15178
15179 @item &
15180 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15181
15182 @item ==@r{, }!=
15183 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
15184 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
15185
15186 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
15187 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
15188 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
15189 and non-zero for true.
15190
15191 @item <<@r{, }>>
15192 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
15193
15194 @item @@
15195 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15196
15197 @item +@r{, }-
15198 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
15199 pointer types.
15200
15201 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
15202 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
15203 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
15204 integral types.
15205
15206 @item ++@r{, }--
15207 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
15208 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
15209 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
15210 operation takes place.
15211
15212 @item *
15213 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
15214 @code{++}.
15215
15216 @item &
15217 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
15218
15219 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
15220 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
15221 to examine the address
15222 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
15223 stored.
15224
15225 @item -
15226 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
15227 precedence as @code{++}.
15228
15229 @item !
15230 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15231 @code{++}.
15232
15233 @item ~
15234 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15235 @code{++}.
15236
15237
15238 @item .@r{, }->
15239 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
15240 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
15241 pointer based on the stored type information.
15242 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
15243
15244 @item .*@r{, }->*
15245 Dereferences of pointers to members.
15246
15247 @item []
15248 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
15249 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15250
15251 @item ()
15252 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15253
15254 @item ::
15255 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
15256 and @code{class} types.
15257
15258 @item ::
15259 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
15260 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
15261 above.
15262 @end table
15263
15264 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
15265 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
15266 predefined meaning.
15267
15268 @node C Constants
15269 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
15270
15271 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
15272
15273 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
15274 following ways:
15275
15276 @itemize @bullet
15277 @item
15278 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
15279 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
15280 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
15281 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
15282 @code{long} value.
15283
15284 @item
15285 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
15286 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
15287 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
15288 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
15289 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
15290 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
15291 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
15292 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
15293 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
15294 constant.
15295
15296 @item
15297 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
15298 integral equivalents.
15299
15300 @item
15301 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
15302 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
15303 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
15304 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
15305 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
15306 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
15307 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
15308 @samp{\n} for newline.
15309
15310 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
15311 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
15312 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
15313 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15314
15315 @item
15316 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
15317 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
15318 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
15319 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
15320 characters.
15321
15322 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
15323 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
15324 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15325
15326 @item
15327 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
15328 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
15329
15330 @item
15331 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
15332 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
15333 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
15334 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
15335 @end itemize
15336
15337 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
15338 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
15339
15340 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
15341 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
15342
15343 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
15344 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
15345 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
15346 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
15347 @quotation
15348 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
15349 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
15350 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
15351 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
15352 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
15353 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
15354 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
15355 code. @xref{Compilation}.
15356 @end quotation
15357
15358 @enumerate
15359
15360 @cindex member functions
15361 @item
15362 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
15363
15364 @smallexample
15365 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
15366 @end smallexample
15367
15368 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
15369 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
15370 @item
15371 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
15372 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
15373 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
15374 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
15375 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
15376
15377 @cindex call overloaded functions
15378 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
15379 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
15380 @item
15381 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
15382 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
15383 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
15384 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
15385 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
15386 default arguments.
15387
15388 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
15389 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
15390 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
15391 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
15392 number of function arguments.
15393
15394 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
15395 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
15396 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
15397
15398 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
15399 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
15400 @smallexample
15401 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
15402 @end smallexample
15403
15404 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
15405 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
15406
15407 @cindex reference declarations
15408 @item
15409 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
15410 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
15411 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
15412
15413 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
15414 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
15415 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
15416 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
15417 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
15418
15419 @item
15420 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
15421 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
15422 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
15423 necessary, for example in an expression like
15424 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
15425 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
15426 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
15427
15428 @item
15429 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
15430 specification.
15431 @end enumerate
15432
15433 @node C Defaults
15434 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
15435
15436 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
15437
15438 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
15439 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
15440 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15441 selects the working language.
15442
15443 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
15444 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
15445 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
15446 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
15447 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
15448 for further details.
15449
15450 @node C Checks
15451 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
15452
15453 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
15454
15455 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
15456 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
15457 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
15458 constants to pointers.
15459
15460 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
15461 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
15462 that is not itself an array.
15463
15464 @node Debugging C
15465 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
15466
15467 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
15468 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
15469 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
15470 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
15471
15472 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
15473 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
15474 ,Expressions}.
15475
15476 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
15477 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
15478
15479 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
15480
15481 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
15482 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
15483
15484 @table @code
15485 @cindex break in overloaded functions
15486 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
15487 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
15488 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
15489 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
15490 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
15491
15492 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
15493 @item rbreak @var{regex}
15494 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
15495 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
15496 classes.
15497 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15498
15499 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
15500 @item catch throw
15501 @itemx catch rethrow
15502 @itemx catch catch
15503 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
15504 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
15505
15506 @cindex inheritance
15507 @item ptype @var{typename}
15508 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15509 @var{typename}.
15510 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15511
15512 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15513 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15514 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15515 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15516 multiple inheritance is in use.
15517
15518 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15519 @item demangle @var{name}
15520 Demangle @var{name}.
15521 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15522
15523 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15524 @item set print demangle
15525 @itemx show print demangle
15526 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15527 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15528 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15529 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15530 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15531
15532 @item set print object
15533 @itemx show print object
15534 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15535 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15536
15537 @item set print vtbl
15538 @itemx show print vtbl
15539 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15540 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15541 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15542 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15543
15544 @kindex set overload-resolution
15545 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15546 @item set overload-resolution on
15547 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15548 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15549 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15550 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15551 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15552 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15553
15554 @item set overload-resolution off
15555 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15556 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15557 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15558 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15559 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15560 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15561 argument types.
15562
15563 @kindex show overload-resolution
15564 @item show overload-resolution
15565 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15566
15567 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15568 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15569 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15570 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15571 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15572 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15573 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15574
15575 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
15576
15577 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
15578 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
15579 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
15580 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
15581 for more detail.
15582
15583 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
15584 function that returns a std::string:
15585
15586 @smallexample
15587 std::string function(int);
15588 @end smallexample
15589
15590 @noindent
15591 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
15592 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
15593
15594 @smallexample
15595 function[abi:cxx11](int)
15596 @end smallexample
15597
15598 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
15599 tag. For example:
15600
15601 @smallexample
15602 (gdb) b function(int)
15603 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
15604 (gdb) info breakpoints
15605 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
15606 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
15607 at main.cc:10
15608 @end smallexample
15609
15610 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
15611 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
15612 name, like:
15613
15614 @smallexample
15615 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
15616 @end smallexample
15617 @end table
15618
15619 @node Decimal Floating Point
15620 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15621 @cindex decimal floating point format
15622
15623 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15624 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15625 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15626 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15627
15628 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15629 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15630 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15631 configured target.
15632
15633 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15634 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15635 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15636
15637 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15638 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15639 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15640
15641 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15642 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15643 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15644
15645 @node D
15646 @subsection D
15647
15648 @cindex D
15649 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15650 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15651 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15652
15653 @node Go
15654 @subsection Go
15655
15656 @cindex Go (programming language)
15657 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15658 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15659
15660 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15661
15662 @table @code
15663 @cindex current Go package
15664 @item The current Go package
15665 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15666 specifying global variables and functions.
15667
15668 For example, given the program:
15669
15670 @example
15671 package main
15672 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15673 func main () @{
15674 // ...
15675 @}
15676 @end example
15677
15678 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15679
15680 @example
15681 (gdb) p myglob
15682 (gdb) p main.myglob
15683 @end example
15684
15685 @cindex builtin Go types
15686 @item Builtin Go types
15687 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15688 as a string.
15689
15690 @cindex builtin Go functions
15691 @item Builtin Go functions
15692 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15693 function and handles it internally.
15694
15695 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15696 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15697 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15698 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15699 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15700 @end table
15701
15702 @node Objective-C
15703 @subsection Objective-C
15704
15705 @cindex Objective-C
15706 This section provides information about some commands and command
15707 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15708 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15709 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15710
15711 @menu
15712 * Method Names in Commands::
15713 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15714 @end menu
15715
15716 @node Method Names in Commands
15717 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15718
15719 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15720 names as line specifications:
15721
15722 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15723 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15724 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15725 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15726 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15727 @itemize
15728 @item @code{clear}
15729 @item @code{break}
15730 @item @code{info line}
15731 @item @code{jump}
15732 @item @code{list}
15733 @end itemize
15734
15735 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15736
15737 @smallexample
15738 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15739 @end smallexample
15740
15741 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15742 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15743 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15744 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15745 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15746 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15747 debugged, enter:
15748
15749 @smallexample
15750 break -[Fruit create]
15751 @end smallexample
15752
15753 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15754 enter:
15755
15756 @smallexample
15757 list +[NSText initialize]
15758 @end smallexample
15759
15760 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15761 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15762 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15763 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15764
15765 @smallexample
15766 break create
15767 @end smallexample
15768
15769 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15770 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15771 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15772 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15773 none apply.
15774
15775 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15776 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15777
15778 @smallexample
15779 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15780 @end smallexample
15781
15782 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15783 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15784 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15785 @kindex print-object
15786 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15787
15788 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15789
15790 @smallexample
15791 print -[@var{object} hash]
15792 @end smallexample
15793
15794 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15795 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15796 @noindent
15797 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15798 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15799 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15800 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15801 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15802 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15803
15804 @node OpenCL C
15805 @subsection OpenCL C
15806
15807 @cindex OpenCL C
15808 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15809
15810 @menu
15811 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15812 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15813 * OpenCL C Operators::
15814 @end menu
15815
15816 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15817 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15818
15819 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15820 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15821 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15822 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15823 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15824
15825 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15826 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15827
15828 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15829 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15830 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15831 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15832
15833 @node OpenCL C Operators
15834 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15835
15836 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15837 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15838 vector data types.
15839
15840 @node Fortran
15841 @subsection Fortran
15842 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15843
15844 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15845 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15846
15847 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15848 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15849 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15850 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15851 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15852 underscore.
15853
15854 @menu
15855 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15856 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15857 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15858 @end menu
15859
15860 @node Fortran Operators
15861 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15862
15863 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15864
15865 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15866 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15867 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15868
15869 @table @code
15870 @item **
15871 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15872 of the second one.
15873
15874 @item :
15875 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15876 represent a section of array.
15877
15878 @item %
15879 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15880 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15881 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15882 union type.
15883 @end table
15884
15885 @node Fortran Defaults
15886 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15887
15888 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15889
15890 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15891 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15892 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15893 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15894
15895 @node Special Fortran Commands
15896 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15897
15898 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15899
15900 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15901 such as displaying common blocks.
15902
15903 @table @code
15904 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15905 @kindex info common
15906 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15907 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15908 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15909 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15910 printed.
15911 @end table
15912
15913 @node Pascal
15914 @subsection Pascal
15915
15916 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15917 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15918 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15919 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15920 syntax.
15921
15922 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15923 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15924 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15925
15926 @node Rust
15927 @subsection Rust
15928
15929 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15930 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15931 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15932 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15933
15934 @itemize @bullet
15935 @item
15936 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15937 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15938 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15939
15940 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15941 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15942 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15943 @samp{B}.
15944
15945 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15946 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15947
15948 @item
15949 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15950 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15951 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15952 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15953 @samp{K::x::y}.
15954
15955 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15956 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15957 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15958 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15959 scope.
15960
15961 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15962 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15963
15964 @item
15965 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15966 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15967
15968 @item
15969 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15970
15971 @item
15972 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15973 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15974 never be destroyed.
15975
15976 @item
15977 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15978 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15979 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15980
15981 @item
15982 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15983 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15984 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15985 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15986 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15987 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15988 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15989 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15990
15991 @item
15992 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15993 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15994 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15995 @itemize @bullet
15996
15997 @item
15998 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15999
16000 @item
16001 Operator overloading is not implemented.
16002
16003 @item
16004 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
16005 type names.
16006
16007 @item
16008 The type @code{Self} is not available.
16009
16010 @item
16011 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
16012 available in the crate.
16013 @end itemize
16014 @end itemize
16015
16016 @node Modula-2
16017 @subsection Modula-2
16018
16019 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
16020
16021 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
16022 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
16023 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
16024 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16025 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
16026 table.
16027
16028 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
16029 @menu
16030 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
16031 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
16032 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
16033 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
16034 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
16035 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
16036 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
16037 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16038 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16039 @end menu
16040
16041 @node M2 Operators
16042 @subsubsection Operators
16043 @cindex Modula-2 operators
16044
16045 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
16046 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
16047 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
16048 following definitions hold:
16049
16050 @itemize @bullet
16051
16052 @item
16053 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
16054 their subranges.
16055
16056 @item
16057 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
16058
16059 @item
16060 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
16061
16062 @item
16063 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
16064 @var{type}}.
16065
16066 @item
16067 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
16068
16069 @item
16070 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
16071
16072 @item
16073 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
16074 @end itemize
16075
16076 @noindent
16077 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
16078 increasing precedence:
16079
16080 @table @code
16081 @item ,
16082 Function argument or array index separator.
16083
16084 @item :=
16085 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
16086 @var{value}.
16087
16088 @item <@r{, }>
16089 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
16090 types.
16091
16092 @item <=@r{, }>=
16093 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
16094 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
16095 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
16096
16097 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
16098 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
16099 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
16100 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
16101 comment character.
16102
16103 @item IN
16104 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
16105 Same precedence as @code{<}.
16106
16107 @item OR
16108 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16109
16110 @item AND@r{, }&
16111 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16112
16113 @item @@
16114 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
16115
16116 @item +@r{, }-
16117 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
16118 and difference on set types.
16119
16120 @item *
16121 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
16122 on set types.
16123
16124 @item /
16125 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
16126 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
16127
16128 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
16129 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
16130 precedence as @code{*}.
16131
16132 @item -
16133 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
16134
16135 @item ^
16136 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
16137
16138 @item NOT
16139 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
16140 @code{^}.
16141
16142 @item .
16143 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
16144 precedence as @code{^}.
16145
16146 @item []
16147 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
16148
16149 @item ()
16150 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
16151 as @code{^}.
16152
16153 @item ::@r{, }.
16154 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
16155 @end table
16156
16157 @quotation
16158 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
16159 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
16160 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
16161 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
16162 @end quotation
16163
16164
16165 @node Built-In Func/Proc
16166 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
16167 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
16168
16169 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
16170 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
16171
16172 @table @var
16173
16174 @item a
16175 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
16176
16177 @item c
16178 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
16179
16180 @item i
16181 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
16182
16183 @item m
16184 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
16185 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
16186 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
16187
16188 @item n
16189 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
16190
16191 @item r
16192 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
16193
16194 @item t
16195 represents a type.
16196
16197 @item v
16198 represents a variable.
16199
16200 @item x
16201 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
16202 explanation of the function for details.
16203 @end table
16204
16205 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
16206
16207 @table @code
16208 @item ABS(@var{n})
16209 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
16210
16211 @item CAP(@var{c})
16212 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
16213 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
16214
16215 @item CHR(@var{i})
16216 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16217
16218 @item DEC(@var{v})
16219 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16220
16221 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
16222 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16223 new value.
16224
16225 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16226 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
16227 set.
16228
16229 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
16230 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
16231
16232 @item HIGH(@var{a})
16233 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
16234
16235 @item INC(@var{v})
16236 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16237
16238 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
16239 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16240 new value.
16241
16242 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16243 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
16244 there. Returns the new set.
16245
16246 @item MAX(@var{t})
16247 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
16248
16249 @item MIN(@var{t})
16250 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
16251
16252 @item ODD(@var{i})
16253 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
16254
16255 @item ORD(@var{x})
16256 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
16257 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
16258 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
16259 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
16260
16261 @item SIZE(@var{x})
16262 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16263 variable or a type.
16264
16265 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
16266 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
16267
16268 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
16269 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16270 variable or a type.
16271
16272 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
16273 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16274 @end table
16275
16276 @quotation
16277 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
16278 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
16279 an error.
16280 @end quotation
16281
16282 @cindex Modula-2 constants
16283 @node M2 Constants
16284 @subsubsection Constants
16285
16286 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
16287 ways:
16288
16289 @itemize @bullet
16290
16291 @item
16292 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
16293 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
16294 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
16295 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
16296
16297 @item
16298 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
16299 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
16300 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
16301 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
16302 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
16303 digits.
16304
16305 @item
16306 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
16307 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
16308 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
16309 followed by a @samp{C}.
16310
16311 @item
16312 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
16313 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
16314 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
16315 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
16316 sequences.
16317
16318 @item
16319 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
16320
16321 @item
16322 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
16323 @code{FALSE}.
16324
16325 @item
16326 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
16327
16328 @item
16329 Set constants are not yet supported.
16330 @end itemize
16331
16332 @node M2 Types
16333 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
16334 @cindex Modula-2 types
16335
16336 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
16337 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
16338 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
16339 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
16340 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
16341 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
16342
16343 The first example contains the following section of code:
16344
16345 @smallexample
16346 VAR
16347 s: SET OF CHAR ;
16348 r: [20..40] ;
16349 @end smallexample
16350
16351 @noindent
16352 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
16353 @code{r} and @code{s}.
16354
16355 @smallexample
16356 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16357 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
16358 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16359 SET OF CHAR
16360 (@value{GDBP}) print r
16361 21
16362 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
16363 [20..40]
16364 @end smallexample
16365
16366 @noindent
16367 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
16368
16369 @smallexample
16370 VAR
16371 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
16372 @end smallexample
16373
16374 @noindent
16375 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
16376
16377 @smallexample
16378 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16379 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
16380 @end smallexample
16381
16382 @noindent
16383 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
16384 expressions using the debugger.
16385
16386 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
16387 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
16388
16389 @smallexample
16390 VAR
16391 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
16392 @end smallexample
16393
16394 @smallexample
16395 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16396 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
16397 @end smallexample
16398
16399 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
16400 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
16401 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
16402 above.
16403
16404 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
16405
16406 @smallexample
16407 TYPE
16408 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
16409 t = [blue..yellow] ;
16410 VAR
16411 s: t ;
16412 BEGIN
16413 s := blue ;
16414 @end smallexample
16415
16416 @noindent
16417 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
16418 and value of a variable.
16419
16420 @smallexample
16421 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16422 $1 = blue
16423 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
16424 type = [blue..yellow]
16425 @end smallexample
16426
16427 @noindent
16428 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
16429 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
16430 their @code{C} counterparts.
16431
16432 @smallexample
16433 VAR
16434 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16435 BEGIN
16436 s[1] := 1 ;
16437 @end smallexample
16438
16439 @smallexample
16440 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16441 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
16442 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16443 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16444 @end smallexample
16445
16446 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
16447 pointer types as shown in this example:
16448
16449 @smallexample
16450 VAR
16451 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16452 BEGIN
16453 NEW(s) ;
16454 s^[1] := 1 ;
16455 @end smallexample
16456
16457 @noindent
16458 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
16459
16460 @smallexample
16461 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16462 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16463 @end smallexample
16464
16465 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
16466 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
16467 types:
16468
16469 @smallexample
16470 TYPE
16471 foo = RECORD
16472 f1: CARDINAL ;
16473 f2: CHAR ;
16474 f3: myarray ;
16475 END ;
16476
16477 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
16478 myrange = [-2..2] ;
16479 VAR
16480 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
16481 @end smallexample
16482
16483 @noindent
16484 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
16485 below.
16486
16487 @smallexample
16488 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16489 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
16490 f1 : CARDINAL;
16491 f2 : CHAR;
16492 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
16493 END
16494 @end smallexample
16495
16496 @node M2 Defaults
16497 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
16498 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
16499
16500 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
16501 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
16502 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16503 selected the working language.
16504
16505 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
16506 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
16507 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
16508 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
16509
16510 @node Deviations
16511 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
16512 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
16513
16514 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
16515 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
16516
16517 @itemize @bullet
16518 @item
16519 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
16520 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
16521 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
16522 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
16523 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
16524 returned a pointer.)
16525
16526 @item
16527 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
16528 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
16529 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
16530 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
16531
16532 @item
16533 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
16534 argument.
16535
16536 @item
16537 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
16538 @end itemize
16539
16540 @node M2 Checks
16541 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
16542 @cindex Modula-2 checks
16543
16544 @quotation
16545 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
16546 range checking.
16547 @end quotation
16548 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16549
16550 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16551
16552 @itemize @bullet
16553 @item
16554 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16555 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16556
16557 @item
16558 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16559 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16560 @end itemize
16561
16562 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16563 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16564
16565 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16566 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16567
16568 @node M2 Scope
16569 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16570 @cindex scope
16571 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16572 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16573 @ifinfo
16574 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16575 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16576 @end ifinfo
16577 @ifnotinfo
16578 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16579 @end ifnotinfo
16580
16581 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16582 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16583 similar syntax:
16584
16585 @smallexample
16586
16587 @var{module} . @var{id}
16588 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16589 @end smallexample
16590
16591 @noindent
16592 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16593 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16594 identifier within your program, except another module.
16595
16596 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16597 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16598 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16599 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16600
16601 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16602 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16603 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16604 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16605 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16606 @var{module}.
16607
16608 @node GDB/M2
16609 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16610
16611 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16612 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16613 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16614 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16615 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16616 analogue in Modula-2.
16617
16618 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16619 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16620 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16621 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16622 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16623 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16624
16625 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16626 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16627 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16628
16629 @node Ada
16630 @subsection Ada
16631 @cindex Ada
16632
16633 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16634 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16635 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16636 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16637 to be difficult.
16638
16639
16640 @cindex expressions in Ada
16641 @menu
16642 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16643 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16644 in @value{GDBN}.
16645 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16646 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16647 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16648 subprograms.
16649 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16650 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16651 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16652 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16653 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16654 Profile
16655 * Ada Settings:: New settable GDB parameters for Ada.
16656 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16657 @end menu
16658
16659 @node Ada Mode Intro
16660 @subsubsection Introduction
16661 @cindex Ada mode, general
16662
16663 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16664 syntax, with some extensions.
16665 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16666
16667 @itemize @bullet
16668 @item
16669 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16670 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16671 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16672 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16673
16674 @item
16675 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16676 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16677
16678 @item
16679 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16680 @end itemize
16681
16682 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16683 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16684 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16685 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16686 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16687
16688 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16689 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16690 was translated from an Ada source file.
16691
16692 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16693 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16694 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16695 middle (to allow based literals).
16696
16697 @node Omissions from Ada
16698 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16699 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16700
16701 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16702
16703 @itemize @bullet
16704 @item
16705 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16706
16707 @itemize @minus
16708 @item
16709 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16710 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16711
16712 @item
16713 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16714
16715 @item
16716 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16717
16718 @item
16719 @t{'Tag}.
16720
16721 @item
16722 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16723 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16724
16725 @item
16726 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16727 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16728
16729 @item
16730 @t{'Address}.
16731 @end itemize
16732
16733 @item
16734 The names in
16735 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16736 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16737 not currently available.
16738
16739 @item
16740 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16741 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16742 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16743 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16744 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16745 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16746 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16747 indeterminate values.
16748
16749 @item
16750 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16751 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16752 are not implemented.
16753
16754 @item
16755 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16756 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16757 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16758 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16759 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16760
16761 @smallexample
16762 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16763 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16764 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16765 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16766 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16767 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16768 @end smallexample
16769
16770 Changing a
16771 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16772 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16773 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16774 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16775 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16776 declared to have a type such as:
16777
16778 @smallexample
16779 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16780 Id : Integer;
16781 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16782 end record;
16783 @end smallexample
16784
16785 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16786 assignments:
16787
16788 @smallexample
16789 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16790 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16791 @end smallexample
16792
16793 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16794 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16795 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16796 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16797 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16798 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16799 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16800 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16801
16802 @item
16803 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16804
16805 @item
16806 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16807 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16808 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16809 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16810 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16811 the proper resolution.
16812
16813 @item
16814 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16815
16816 @item
16817 Entry calls are not implemented.
16818
16819 @item
16820 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16821 formats are not supported.
16822
16823 @item
16824 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16825
16826 @item
16827 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16828 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16829 context.
16830 Should your program
16831 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16832 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16833 @end itemize
16834
16835 @node Additions to Ada
16836 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16837 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16838
16839 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16840 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16841
16842 @itemize @bullet
16843 @item
16844 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16845 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16846 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16847 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16848 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16849 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16850 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16851 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16852
16853 @item
16854 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16855 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16856 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16857
16858 @item
16859 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16860 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16861
16862 @item
16863 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16864 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16865 @end itemize
16866
16867 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16868 additions specific to Ada:
16869
16870 @itemize @bullet
16871 @item
16872 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16873 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16874
16875 @smallexample
16876 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16877 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16878 @end smallexample
16879
16880 @item
16881 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16882 the value of its right-hand operand.
16883 This allows, for example,
16884 complex conditional breaks:
16885
16886 @smallexample
16887 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16888 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16889 @end smallexample
16890
16891 @item
16892 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16893 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16894 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16895 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16896 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16897 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16898 in strings. For example,
16899 @smallexample
16900 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16901 @end smallexample
16902 @noindent
16903 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16904 after each period.
16905
16906 @item
16907 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16908 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16909 to write
16910
16911 @smallexample
16912 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16913 @end smallexample
16914
16915 @item
16916 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16917 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16918 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16919 of 3 might print as
16920
16921 @smallexample
16922 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16923 @end smallexample
16924
16925 @noindent
16926 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16927 clause.
16928
16929 @item
16930 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16931 multi-character subsequence of
16932 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16933 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16934 in place of @t{a'length}.
16935
16936 @item
16937 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16938 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16939 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16940 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16941 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16942 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16943 For example,
16944 @smallexample
16945 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16946 @end smallexample
16947
16948 @item
16949 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16950 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16951 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16952 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16953 object.
16954
16955 @end itemize
16956
16957 @node Overloading support for Ada
16958 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16959 @cindex overloading, Ada
16960
16961 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16962 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16963 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16964 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16965 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16966 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16967
16968 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16969 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16970 use, for instance:
16971
16972 @smallexample
16973 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16974 Multiple matches for f
16975 [0] cancel
16976 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16977 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16978 >
16979 @end smallexample
16980
16981 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16982 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16983 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16984
16985 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16986 case:
16987
16988 @table @code
16989
16990 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16991 @item set ada print-signatures
16992 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16993 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16994 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16995
16996 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16997 @item show ada print-signatures
16998 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16999 overloads selection menu.
17000 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
17001
17002 @end table
17003
17004 @node Stopping Before Main Program
17005 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
17006
17007 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
17008 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
17009 before reaching the main procedure.
17010 As defined in the Ada Reference
17011 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
17012 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
17013 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
17014 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
17015
17016 @node Ada Exceptions
17017 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
17018
17019 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
17020
17021 @table @code
17022 @kindex info exceptions
17023 @item info exceptions
17024 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
17025 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
17026 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
17027 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
17028 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
17029 @end table
17030
17031 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
17032 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
17033 argument.
17034
17035 @smallexample
17036 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
17037 All defined Ada exceptions:
17038 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17039 program_error: 0x613d20
17040 storage_error: 0x613ce0
17041 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
17042 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17043 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
17044 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
17045 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17046 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17047 @end smallexample
17048
17049 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
17050 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
17051
17052 @node Ada Tasks
17053 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
17054 @cindex Ada, tasking
17055
17056 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
17057 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
17058
17059 @table @code
17060 @kindex info tasks
17061 @item info tasks
17062 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
17063
17064
17065 @smallexample
17066 @iftex
17067 @leftskip=0.5cm
17068 @end iftex
17069 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17070 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17071 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17072 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
17073 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
17074 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
17075
17076 @end smallexample
17077
17078 @noindent
17079 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
17080 task currently being inspected.
17081
17082 @table @asis
17083 @item ID
17084 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
17085
17086 @item TID
17087 The Ada task ID.
17088
17089 @item P-ID
17090 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
17091
17092 @item Pri
17093 The base priority of the task.
17094
17095 @item State
17096 Current state of the task.
17097
17098 @table @code
17099 @item Unactivated
17100 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
17101 executing.
17102
17103 @item Runnable
17104 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
17105 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
17106
17107 @item Terminated
17108 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
17109 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
17110 terminated themselves.
17111
17112 @item Child Activation Wait
17113 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
17114
17115 @item Accept Statement
17116 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
17117
17118 @item Waiting on entry call
17119 The task is waiting on an entry call.
17120
17121 @item Async Select Wait
17122 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
17123 select statement.
17124
17125 @item Delay Sleep
17126 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
17127 alternative open.
17128
17129 @item Child Termination Wait
17130 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
17131 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
17132 waiting on a terminate Phase.
17133
17134 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
17135 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
17136 finish terminating.
17137
17138 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
17139 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
17140 @end table
17141
17142 @item Name
17143 Name of the task in the program.
17144
17145 @end table
17146
17147 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
17148 @item info task @var{taskno}
17149 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
17150 the following example:
17151 @smallexample
17152 @iftex
17153 @leftskip=0.5cm
17154 @end iftex
17155 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17156 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17157 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17158 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
17159 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
17160 Ada Task: 0x807c468
17161 Name: task_1
17162 Thread: 0
17163 LWP: 0x1fac
17164 Parent: 1 (main_task)
17165 Base Priority: 15
17166 State: Runnable
17167 @end smallexample
17168
17169 @item task
17170 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
17171 @cindex current Ada task ID
17172 This command prints the ID of the current task.
17173
17174 @smallexample
17175 @iftex
17176 @leftskip=0.5cm
17177 @end iftex
17178 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17179 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17180 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17181 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17182 (@value{GDBP}) task
17183 [Current task is 2]
17184 @end smallexample
17185
17186 @item task @var{taskno}
17187 @cindex Ada task switching
17188 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
17189 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
17190 from the current task to the given task.
17191
17192 @smallexample
17193 @iftex
17194 @leftskip=0.5cm
17195 @end iftex
17196 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17197 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17198 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17199 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17200 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
17201 [Switching to task 1]
17202 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17203 (@value{GDBP}) bt
17204 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17205 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
17206 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
17207 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
17208 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
17209 @end smallexample
17210
17211 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
17212 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
17213 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
17214 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
17215 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
17216 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
17217 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
17218 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
17219 in @ref{Specify Location}.
17220
17221 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
17222 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
17223 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
17224 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
17225 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
17226
17227 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
17228 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
17229 program.
17230
17231 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
17232 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
17233 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
17234
17235 For example,
17236
17237 @smallexample
17238 @iftex
17239 @leftskip=0.5cm
17240 @end iftex
17241 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17242 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17243 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17244 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
17245 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17246 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
17247 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
17248 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
17249 (@value{GDBP}) cont
17250 Continuing.
17251 task # 1 running
17252 task # 2 running
17253
17254 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
17255 15 flush;
17256 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17257 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17258 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17259 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
17260 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17261 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
17262 @end smallexample
17263 @end table
17264
17265 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
17266 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17267 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
17268
17269 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
17270 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
17271 the platform being used.
17272 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
17273 switching is not supported.
17274
17275 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
17276 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
17277 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
17278 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
17279 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
17280 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
17281
17282 @node Ravenscar Profile
17283 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
17284 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
17285
17286 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
17287 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
17288 requirements.
17289
17290 @table @code
17291 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
17292 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
17293 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
17294 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17295 Profile. This is the default.
17296
17297 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
17298 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
17299 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17300 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
17301 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
17302 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
17303 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
17304
17305 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
17306 @item show ravenscar task-switching
17307 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
17308 using the Ravenscar Profile.
17309
17310 @end table
17311
17312 @node Ada Settings
17313 @subsubsection Ada Settings
17314 @cindex Ada settings
17315
17316 @table @code
17317 @kindex set varsize-limit
17318 @item set varsize-limit @var{size}
17319 Prevent @value{GDBN} from attempting to evaluate objects whose size
17320 is above the given limit (@var{size}) when those sizes are computed
17321 from run-time quantities. This is typically the case when the object
17322 has a variable size, such as an array whose bounds are not known at
17323 compile time for example. Setting @var{size} to @code{unlimited}
17324 removes the size limitation. By default, the limit is about 65KB.
17325
17326 The purpose of having such a limit is to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17327 trying to grab enormous chunks of virtual memory when asked to evaluate
17328 a quantity whose bounds have been corrupted or have not yet been fully
17329 initialized. The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions
17330 as well as to complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting
17331 a simple integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
17332 @code{x.y} is variable and exceeds @code{size}. On the other hand,
17333 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A(i)}, where
17334 @code{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
17335 succeed regardless of the bounds on @code{A}, as long as the component
17336 size is less than @var{size}.
17337
17338 @kindex show varsize-limit
17339 @item show varsize-limit
17340 Show the limit on types whose size is determined by run-time quantities.
17341 @end table
17342
17343 @node Ada Glitches
17344 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
17345 @cindex Ada, problems
17346
17347 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
17348 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
17349 @value{GDBN},
17350 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
17351 and the GNU Ada compiler.
17352
17353 @itemize @bullet
17354 @item
17355 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
17356 storage are invisible to the debugger.
17357
17358 @item
17359 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
17360 argument lists are treated as positional).
17361
17362 @item
17363 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
17364
17365 @item
17366 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
17367 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
17368 the host machine.
17369
17370 @item
17371 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
17372 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
17373 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
17374 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
17375 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
17376 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
17377 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
17378 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
17379 you can usually resolve the confusion
17380 by qualifying the problematic names with package
17381 @code{Standard} explicitly.
17382 @end itemize
17383
17384 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
17385 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
17386 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
17387 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
17388 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
17389 enabled.
17390
17391 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17392 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17393 @table @code
17394
17395 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
17396 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
17397 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
17398 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
17399 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
17400 This is the default.
17401
17402 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
17403 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
17404 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
17405 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
17406 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
17407 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
17408 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
17409
17410 @end table
17411
17412 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
17413 @cindex GNAT encoding
17414 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
17415 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
17416 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
17417 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
17418 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
17419 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
17420
17421 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
17422 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
17423 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
17424 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
17425 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
17426 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
17427 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
17428 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
17429
17430 @table @code
17431
17432 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
17433 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
17434 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
17435 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
17436
17437 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17438 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17439 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
17440
17441 @end table
17442
17443 @node Unsupported Languages
17444 @section Unsupported Languages
17445
17446 @cindex unsupported languages
17447 @cindex minimal language
17448 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
17449 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
17450 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
17451 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
17452 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
17453 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
17454
17455 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
17456 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
17457 language.
17458
17459 @node Symbols
17460 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
17461
17462 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
17463 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
17464 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
17465 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
17466 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
17467 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
17468 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17469
17470 @cindex symbol names
17471 @cindex names of symbols
17472 @cindex quoting names
17473 @anchor{quoting names}
17474 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
17475 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
17476 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
17477 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
17478 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
17479 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
17480 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
17481 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
17482
17483 @smallexample
17484 p 'foo.c'::x
17485 @end smallexample
17486
17487 @noindent
17488 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
17489
17490 @table @code
17491 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
17492 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
17493 @kindex set case-sensitive
17494 @item set case-sensitive on
17495 @itemx set case-sensitive off
17496 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
17497 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
17498 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
17499 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
17500 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
17501 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
17502 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
17503 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
17504 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
17505 case-insensitive matches.
17506
17507 @kindex show case-sensitive
17508 @item show case-sensitive
17509 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
17510 lookups.
17511
17512 @kindex set print type methods
17513 @item set print type methods
17514 @itemx set print type methods on
17515 @itemx set print type methods off
17516 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
17517 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17518 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17519 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17520 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
17521 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
17522
17523 @kindex show print type methods
17524 @item show print type methods
17525 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
17526 classes.
17527
17528 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
17529 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
17530 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
17531 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
17532 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
17533 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
17534 types defined in classes.
17535
17536 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
17537 @item show print type nested-type-limit
17538 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
17539 printing classes.
17540
17541 @kindex set print type typedefs
17542 @item set print type typedefs
17543 @itemx set print type typedefs on
17544 @itemx set print type typedefs off
17545
17546 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
17547 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17548 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17549 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17550 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
17551 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
17552 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
17553 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
17554 types.
17555
17556 @kindex show print type typedefs
17557 @item show print type typedefs
17558 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
17559 printing classes.
17560
17561 @kindex info address
17562 @cindex address of a symbol
17563 @item info address @var{symbol}
17564 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
17565 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
17566 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
17567 is always stored.
17568
17569 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
17570 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
17571 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
17572
17573 @kindex info symbol
17574 @cindex symbol from address
17575 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
17576 @item info symbol @var{addr}
17577 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
17578 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
17579 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
17580
17581 @smallexample
17582 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
17583 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
17584 @end smallexample
17585
17586 @noindent
17587 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
17588 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
17589
17590 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
17591 library containing the symbol is also printed:
17592
17593 @smallexample
17594 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17595 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17596 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17597 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17598 @end smallexample
17599
17600 @kindex demangle
17601 @cindex demangle
17602 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17603 Demangle @var{name}.
17604 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17605 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17606
17607 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17608 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17609
17610 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17611 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17612
17613 @kindex whatis
17614 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17615 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17616 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17617 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17618
17619 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17620 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17621 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17622
17623 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17624 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17625 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17626 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17627 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17628 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17629 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17630 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17631 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17632
17633 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17634 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17635 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17636 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17637 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17638 unroll it.
17639
17640 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17641 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17642 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17643
17644 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17645 Available flags are:
17646
17647 @table @code
17648 @item r
17649 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17650 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17651 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17652
17653 @item m
17654 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17655
17656 @item M
17657 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17658 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17659
17660 @item t
17661 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17662 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17663 names are substituted when printing other types.
17664
17665 @item T
17666 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17667 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17668
17669 @item o
17670 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
17671 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
17672
17673 For example, given the following declarations:
17674
17675 @smallexample
17676 struct tuv
17677 @{
17678 int a1;
17679 char *a2;
17680 int a3;
17681 @};
17682
17683 struct xyz
17684 @{
17685 int f1;
17686 char f2;
17687 void *f3;
17688 struct tuv f4;
17689 @};
17690
17691 union qwe
17692 @{
17693 struct tuv fff1;
17694 struct xyz fff2;
17695 @};
17696
17697 struct tyu
17698 @{
17699 int a1 : 1;
17700 int a2 : 3;
17701 int a3 : 23;
17702 char a4 : 2;
17703 int64_t a5;
17704 int a6 : 5;
17705 int64_t a7 : 3;
17706 @};
17707 @end smallexample
17708
17709 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
17710
17711 @smallexample
17712 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
17713 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
17714 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17715 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17716 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17717 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17718
17719 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17720 @}
17721 @end smallexample
17722
17723 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
17724 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
17725 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
17726 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
17727 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
17728 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
17729 its fields.
17730
17731 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
17732
17733 @smallexample
17734 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
17735 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
17736 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
17737 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17738 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17739 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17740 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17741
17742 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17743 @} fff1;
17744 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
17745 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
17746 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
17747 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
17748 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
17749 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
17750 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
17751 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17752 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
17753 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
17754
17755 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17756 @} f4;
17757
17758 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17759 @} fff2;
17760
17761 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17762 @}
17763 @end smallexample
17764
17765 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
17766 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
17767 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
17768 of these structures' fields.
17769
17770 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
17771 bitfields:
17772
17773 @smallexample
17774 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
17775 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
17776 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
17777 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
17778 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
17779 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
17780 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
17781 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17782 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
17783 /* 16:27 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
17784 /* 16:56 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
17785
17786 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17787 @}
17788 @end smallexample
17789
17790 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include how
17791 many bits are left to be used in each bitfield.
17792 @end table
17793
17794 @kindex ptype
17795 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17796 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17797 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17798 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17799
17800 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17801 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17802 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17803 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17804 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17805 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17806 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17807 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17808
17809 For example, for this variable declaration:
17810
17811 @smallexample
17812 typedef double real_t;
17813 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17814 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17815 complex_t var;
17816 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17817 @end smallexample
17818
17819 @noindent
17820 the two commands give this output:
17821
17822 @smallexample
17823 @group
17824 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17825 type = complex_t
17826 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17827 type = struct complex @{
17828 real_t real;
17829 double imag;
17830 @}
17831 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17832 type = struct complex
17833 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17834 type = struct complex
17835 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17836 type = struct complex @{
17837 real_t real;
17838 double imag;
17839 @}
17840 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17841 type = real_t *
17842 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17843 type = double *
17844 @end group
17845 @end smallexample
17846
17847 @noindent
17848 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17849 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17850
17851 @cindex incomplete type
17852 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17853 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17854 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17855 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17856 given these declarations:
17857
17858 @smallexample
17859 struct foo;
17860 struct foo *fooptr;
17861 @end smallexample
17862
17863 @noindent
17864 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17865
17866 @smallexample
17867 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17868 $1 = <incomplete type>
17869 @end smallexample
17870
17871 @noindent
17872 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17873 completely specified.
17874
17875 @cindex unknown type
17876 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17877 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17878 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17879 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17880 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17881 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17882 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17883 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17884
17885 @smallexample
17886 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17887 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17888 @end smallexample
17889
17890 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17891 of such variables.
17892
17893 @kindex info types
17894 @item info types @var{regexp}
17895 @itemx info types
17896 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17897 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17898 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17899 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17900 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17901 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17902 name is @code{value}.
17903
17904 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
17905 to print the type description according to the
17906 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
17907 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
17908 language of the type, other values mean to use
17909 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
17910
17911 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17912 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17913 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
17914
17915 @kindex info type-printers
17916 @item info type-printers
17917 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17918 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17919 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17920 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17921 type printers.
17922
17923 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17924
17925 @kindex enable type-printer
17926 @kindex disable type-printer
17927 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17928 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17929 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17930
17931 @kindex info scope
17932 @cindex local variables
17933 @item info scope @var{location}
17934 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17935 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17936 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17937 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17938 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17939
17940 @smallexample
17941 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17942 Scope for command_line_handler:
17943 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17944 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17945 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17946 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17947 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17948 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17949 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17950 @end smallexample
17951
17952 @noindent
17953 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17954 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17955 collect}.
17956
17957 @kindex info source
17958 @item info source
17959 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17960 the function containing the current point of execution:
17961 @itemize @bullet
17962 @item
17963 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17964 @item
17965 the directory it was compiled in,
17966 @item
17967 its length, in lines,
17968 @item
17969 which programming language it is written in,
17970 @item
17971 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17972 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17973 @item
17974 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17975 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17976 @item
17977 whether the debugging information includes information about
17978 preprocessor macros.
17979 @end itemize
17980
17981
17982 @kindex info sources
17983 @item info sources
17984 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17985 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17986 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17987
17988 @kindex info functions
17989 @item info functions [-q]
17990 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17991 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
17992 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
17993 number.
17994
17995 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
17996 to print the function name and type according to the
17997 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
17998 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
17999 language of the function, other values mean to use
18000 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
18001
18002 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
18003 printing header information and messages explaining why no functions
18004 have been printed.
18005
18006 @item info functions [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
18007 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types
18008 of the functions selected with the provided regexp(s).
18009
18010 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose names
18011 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
18012 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
18013 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
18014 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
18015 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
18016 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
18017
18018 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose
18019 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18020 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18021 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18022 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18023 of special characters or quotes.
18024 Thus, @samp{info fun -t '^int ('} finds the functions that return
18025 an integer; @samp{info fun -t '(.*int.*'} finds the functions that
18026 have an argument type containing int; @samp{info fun -t '^int (' ^step}
18027 finds the functions whose names start with @code{step} and that return
18028 int.
18029
18030 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a function
18031 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18032 @var{type_regexp}.
18033
18034
18035 @kindex info variables
18036 @item info variables [-q]
18037 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
18038 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
18039 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
18040 their respective source line numbers.
18041
18042 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
18043 to print the variable name and type according to the
18044 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
18045 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
18046 language of the variable, other values mean to use
18047 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
18048
18049 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
18050 printing header information and messages explaining why no variables
18051 have been printed.
18052
18053 @item info variables [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
18054 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the variables selected
18055 with the provided regexp(s).
18056
18057 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose names
18058 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
18059
18060 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose
18061 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18062 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18063 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18064 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18065 of special characters or quotes.
18066
18067 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
18068 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18069 @var{type_regexp}.
18070
18071 @kindex info classes
18072 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
18073 @item info classes
18074 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
18075 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
18076 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18077 expression.
18078
18079 @kindex info selectors
18080 @item info selectors
18081 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
18082 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
18083 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18084 expression.
18085
18086 @ignore
18087 This was never implemented.
18088 @kindex info methods
18089 @item info methods
18090 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
18091 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
18092 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
18093 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
18094 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
18095 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
18096 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
18097 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
18098 @end ignore
18099
18100 @cindex opaque data types
18101 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
18102 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
18103 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
18104 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
18105 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
18106 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
18107 another source file. The default is on.
18108
18109 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
18110 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
18111
18112 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
18113 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
18114 is printed as follows:
18115 @smallexample
18116 @{<no data fields>@}
18117 @end smallexample
18118
18119 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
18120 @item show opaque-type-resolution
18121 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
18122
18123 @kindex set print symbol-loading
18124 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
18125 @item set print symbol-loading
18126 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
18127 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
18128 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
18129 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
18130 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
18131 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
18132 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
18133 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
18134 can be annoying.
18135 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
18136 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
18137 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
18138 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
18139
18140 @kindex show print symbol-loading
18141 @item show print symbol-loading
18142 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
18143 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
18144
18145 @kindex maint print symbols
18146 @cindex symbol dump
18147 @kindex maint print psymbols
18148 @cindex partial symbol dump
18149 @kindex maint print msymbols
18150 @cindex minimal symbol dump
18151 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18152 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18153 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18154 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18155 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18156 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
18157 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
18158 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
18159 that objfile.
18160 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
18161 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
18162 @code{main}.
18163 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
18164 source file.
18165
18166 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
18167 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
18168 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
18169 tables.
18170 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
18171 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
18172 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
18173 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
18174 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
18175 ``ELF symbols''.
18176
18177 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
18178 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
18179
18180 @kindex maint info symtabs
18181 @kindex maint info psymtabs
18182 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
18183 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18184 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18185 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18186 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18187 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18188
18189 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
18190 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18191 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
18192 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
18193 structure in more detail. For example:
18194
18195 @smallexample
18196 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
18197 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18198 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18199 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18200 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
18201 readin no
18202 fullname (null)
18203 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
18204 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
18205 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
18206 dependencies (none)
18207 @}
18208 @}
18209 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18210 (@value{GDBP})
18211 @end smallexample
18212 @noindent
18213 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
18214 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
18215 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
18216 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
18217 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
18218
18219 @smallexample
18220 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
18221 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
18222 line 1574.
18223 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18224 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18225 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18226 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18227 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
18228 dirname (null)
18229 fullname (null)
18230 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
18231 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
18232 debugformat DWARF 2
18233 @}
18234 @}
18235 (@value{GDBP})
18236 @end smallexample
18237
18238 @kindex maint info line-table
18239 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
18240 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18241 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18242
18243 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
18244 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18245 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
18246
18247 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
18248 @cindex symbol cache size
18249 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
18250 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
18251 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
18252 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
18253 with different sizes.
18254
18255 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
18256 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
18257 Show the size of the symbol cache.
18258
18259 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
18260 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
18261 @item maint print symbol-cache
18262 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
18263 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
18264
18265 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18266 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
18267 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18268 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
18269 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
18270
18271 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
18272 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
18273 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
18274 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
18275 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
18276 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
18277
18278 @end table
18279
18280 @node Altering
18281 @chapter Altering Execution
18282
18283 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
18284 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
18285 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
18286 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
18287 program.
18288
18289 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
18290 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
18291 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
18292
18293 @menu
18294 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
18295 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
18296 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
18297 * Returning:: Returning from a function
18298 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
18299 * Patching:: Patching your program
18300 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18301 @end menu
18302
18303 @node Assignment
18304 @section Assignment to Variables
18305
18306 @cindex assignment
18307 @cindex setting variables
18308 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
18309 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
18310
18311 @smallexample
18312 print x=4
18313 @end smallexample
18314
18315 @noindent
18316 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
18317 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
18318 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
18319 information on operators in supported languages.
18320
18321 @kindex set variable
18322 @cindex variables, setting
18323 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
18324 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
18325 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
18326 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
18327 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
18328
18329 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
18330 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
18331 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
18332 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
18333 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
18334 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
18335 command @code{set width}:
18336
18337 @smallexample
18338 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
18339 type = double
18340 (@value{GDBP}) p width
18341 $4 = 13
18342 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
18343 Invalid syntax in expression.
18344 @end smallexample
18345
18346 @noindent
18347 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
18348 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
18349
18350 @smallexample
18351 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
18352 @end smallexample
18353
18354 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
18355 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
18356 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
18357 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
18358 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
18359 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
18360
18361 @smallexample
18362 @group
18363 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
18364 type = double
18365 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18366 $1 = 1
18367 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
18368 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18369 $2 = 1
18370 (@value{GDBP}) r
18371 The program being debugged has been started already.
18372 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
18373 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
18374 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
18375 Invalid bfd target.
18376 (@value{GDBP}) show g
18377 The current BFD target is "=4".
18378 @end group
18379 @end smallexample
18380
18381 @noindent
18382 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
18383 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
18384 @code{g}, use
18385
18386 @smallexample
18387 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
18388 @end smallexample
18389
18390 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
18391 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
18392 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
18393 same length or shorter.
18394 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
18395 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
18396
18397 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
18398 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
18399 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
18400 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
18401 and representation in memory), and
18402
18403 @smallexample
18404 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
18405 @end smallexample
18406
18407 @noindent
18408 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
18409
18410 @node Jumping
18411 @section Continuing at a Different Address
18412
18413 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
18414 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
18415 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
18416
18417 @table @code
18418 @kindex jump
18419 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
18420 @item jump @var{location}
18421 @itemx j @var{location}
18422 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
18423 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
18424 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
18425 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
18426 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
18427
18428 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
18429 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
18430 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
18431 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
18432 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
18433 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
18434 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
18435 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
18436 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
18437 @end table
18438
18439 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
18440 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
18441 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
18442 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
18443 example,
18444
18445 @smallexample
18446 set $pc = 0x485
18447 @end smallexample
18448
18449 @noindent
18450 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
18451 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
18452 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
18453
18454 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
18455 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
18456 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
18457 detail.
18458
18459 @c @group
18460 @node Signaling
18461 @section Giving your Program a Signal
18462 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
18463
18464 @table @code
18465 @kindex signal
18466 @item signal @var{signal}
18467 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
18468 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
18469 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
18470 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18471
18472 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
18473 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
18474 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18475 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
18476 signal.
18477
18478 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
18479 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
18480 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
18481 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
18482 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
18483 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
18484 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
18485 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
18486
18487 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
18488 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
18489 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
18490 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
18491 passes the signal directly to your program.
18492
18493 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
18494 after executing the command.
18495
18496 @kindex queue-signal
18497 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
18498 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
18499 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
18500 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
18501 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18502 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
18503 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
18504 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
18505 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
18506
18507 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
18508 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
18509 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
18510 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18511 @code{continue} command.
18512
18513 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
18514 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
18515 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
18516 (@pxref{Signals}).
18517 @end table
18518 @c @end group
18519
18520 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
18521 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
18522
18523 @node Returning
18524 @section Returning from a Function
18525
18526 @table @code
18527 @cindex returning from a function
18528 @kindex return
18529 @item return
18530 @itemx return @var{expression}
18531 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
18532 command. If you give an
18533 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
18534 value.
18535 @end table
18536
18537 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
18538 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
18539 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
18540 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
18541
18542 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
18543 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
18544 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
18545 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
18546 of functions.
18547
18548 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
18549 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
18550 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
18551 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
18552 selected stack frame returns naturally.
18553
18554 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
18555 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
18556 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
18557 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
18558 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
18559 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
18560 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
18561 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
18562 assignment into the right register(s).
18563
18564 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
18565 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
18566 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
18567 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
18568 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
18569 into a @code{long long int}:
18570
18571 @smallexample
18572 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
18573 29 return 31;
18574 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18575 Make func return now? (y or n) y
18576 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
18577 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
18578 (@value{GDBP})
18579 @end smallexample
18580
18581 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
18582 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
18583 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
18584 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
18585 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
18586 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
18587 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
18588 an appropriate cast explicitly:
18589
18590 @smallexample
18591 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
18592 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18593 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
18594 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
18595 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
18596 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
18597 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
18598 (@value{GDBP})
18599 @end smallexample
18600
18601 @node Calling
18602 @section Calling Program Functions
18603
18604 @table @code
18605 @cindex calling functions
18606 @cindex inferior functions, calling
18607 @item print @var{expr}
18608 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
18609 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
18610 debugged.
18611
18612 @kindex call
18613 @item call @var{expr}
18614 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
18615 returned values.
18616
18617 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
18618 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
18619 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
18620 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
18621 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
18622 value history.
18623 @end table
18624
18625 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
18626 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
18627 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
18628 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
18629
18630 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
18631 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
18632 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
18633 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
18634 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
18635 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
18636 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
18637 in that case is controlled by the
18638 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
18639
18640 @table @code
18641 @item set unwindonsignal
18642 @kindex set unwindonsignal
18643 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
18644 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
18645 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
18646 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
18647 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
18648 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
18649 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
18650 received.
18651
18652 @item show unwindonsignal
18653 @kindex show unwindonsignal
18654 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18655 @value{GDBN}.
18656
18657 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18658 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18659 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
18660 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
18661 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
18662 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
18663 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
18664 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
18665 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
18666 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
18667
18668 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18669 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18670 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18671 @value{GDBN}.
18672
18673 @end table
18674
18675 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
18676
18677 @cindex no debug info functions
18678 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
18679 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
18680 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
18681 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
18682 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
18683 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
18684
18685 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
18686 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
18687 declared return type. For example:
18688
18689 @smallexample
18690 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
18691 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
18692 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
18693 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
18694 @end smallexample
18695
18696 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
18697 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
18698 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
18699 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
18700
18701 @smallexample
18702 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
18703 @end smallexample
18704
18705 @noindent
18706 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
18707
18708 @smallexample
18709 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
18710 @end smallexample
18711
18712 @noindent
18713 these calls are equivalent:
18714
18715 @smallexample
18716 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
18717 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18718 @end smallexample
18719
18720 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
18721 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
18722 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
18723 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
18724 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
18725 float parameters, and no debug info:
18726
18727 @smallexample
18728 float
18729 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
18730 float v1, v2;
18731 @{
18732 return v1 * v2;
18733 @}
18734 @end smallexample
18735
18736 @noindent
18737 you call it like this:
18738
18739 @smallexample
18740 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18741 @end smallexample
18742
18743 @node Patching
18744 @section Patching Programs
18745
18746 @cindex patching binaries
18747 @cindex writing into executables
18748 @cindex writing into corefiles
18749
18750 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
18751 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
18752 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
18753 patching your program's binary.
18754
18755 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
18756 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
18757 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
18758 repairs.
18759
18760 @table @code
18761 @kindex set write
18762 @item set write on
18763 @itemx set write off
18764 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
18765 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
18766 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
18767
18768 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
18769 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
18770 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
18771
18772 @item show write
18773 @kindex show write
18774 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
18775 as well as reading.
18776 @end table
18777
18778 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
18779 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18780 @cindex injecting code
18781 @cindex writing into executables
18782 @cindex compiling code
18783
18784 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18785 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18786 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18787 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18788
18789 @table @code
18790 @kindex compile code
18791 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18792 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18793 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18794 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18795 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18796 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18797 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18798 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18799 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18800 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18801 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18802 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18803
18804 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18805 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18806 E.g.:
18807
18808 @smallexample
18809 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18810 @end smallexample
18811
18812 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18813 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18814 from actual source code. E.g.:
18815
18816 @smallexample
18817 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18818 @end smallexample
18819
18820 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18821 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18822 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18823 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18824 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18825 editor.
18826
18827 @smallexample
18828 compile code
18829 >printf ("hello\n");
18830 >printf ("world\n");
18831 >end
18832 @end smallexample
18833
18834 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18835 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18836 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18837 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18838 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18839 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18840 inferior symbols otherwise.
18841
18842 @kindex compile file
18843 @item compile file @var{filename}
18844 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18845 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18846
18847 @smallexample
18848 compile file /home/user/example.c
18849 @end smallexample
18850 @end table
18851
18852 @table @code
18853 @item compile print @var{expr}
18854 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18855 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18856 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18857 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18858 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18859 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18860 Formats}.
18861
18862 @item compile print
18863 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18864 @cindex reprint the last value
18865 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18866 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18867 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18868 multiple-line editor.
18869 @end table
18870
18871 @noindent
18872 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18873
18874 @table @code
18875 @anchor{set debug compile}
18876 @item set debug compile
18877 @cindex compile command debugging info
18878 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18879 injecting the code. The default is off.
18880
18881 @item show debug compile
18882 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18883 compiling and injecting the code.
18884
18885 @anchor{set debug compile-cplus-types}
18886 @item set debug compile-cplus-types
18887 @cindex compile C@t{++} type conversion
18888 Turns on or off the display of C@t{++} type conversion debugging information.
18889 The default is off.
18890
18891 @item show debug compile-cplus-types
18892 Displays the current state of displaying debugging information for
18893 C@t{++} type conversion.
18894 @end table
18895
18896 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18897
18898 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18899 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18900 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18901 injecting process.
18902
18903 @noindent
18904 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18905
18906 @table @asis
18907 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18908 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18909 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18910 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18911
18912 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18913 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18914 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18915 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18916 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18917 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18918 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18919 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18920
18921 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18922 @end table
18923
18924 @noindent
18925 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18926
18927 @table @code
18928 @item set compile-args
18929 @cindex compile command options override
18930 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18931 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18932 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18933 compilation.
18934
18935 @item show compile-args
18936 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18937 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18938 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18939 @end table
18940
18941 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18942
18943 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18944 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18945 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18946
18947 @table @asis
18948 @item C code examples and caveats
18949 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18950 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18951 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18952 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18953 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18954
18955 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18956 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18957 much like any other normal debugging session.
18958
18959 @smallexample
18960 void function1 (void)
18961 @{
18962 int i = 42;
18963 printf ("function 1\n");
18964 @}
18965
18966 void function2 (void)
18967 @{
18968 int j = 12;
18969 function1 ();
18970 @}
18971
18972 int main(void)
18973 @{
18974 int k = 6;
18975 int *p;
18976 function2 ();
18977 return 0;
18978 @}
18979 @end smallexample
18980
18981 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18982 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18983 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18984
18985 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18986 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18987 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18988 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18989 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18990
18991 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18992 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18993 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18994 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18995 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18996 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18997 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18998 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18999 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
19000 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
19001
19002 @smallexample
19003 compile code k = 3;
19004 @end smallexample
19005
19006 @noindent
19007 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
19008 something else in the example program changes it, or another
19009 @code{compile} command changes it.
19010
19011 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
19012 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
19013 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
19014 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
19015 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
19016
19017 @smallexample
19018 compile code j = 3;
19019 @end smallexample
19020
19021 @noindent
19022 will result in a compilation error message.
19023
19024 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
19025 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
19026 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
19027
19028 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
19029 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
19030 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
19031 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
19032
19033 @smallexample
19034 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
19035 @end smallexample
19036
19037 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
19038 command has completed:
19039
19040 @smallexample
19041 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
19042 @end smallexample
19043
19044 @noindent
19045 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
19046 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
19047 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
19048 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
19049 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
19050
19051 @smallexample
19052 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
19053 @end smallexample
19054
19055 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
19056 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
19057 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
19058 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
19059 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
19060 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
19061 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
19062 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
19063
19064 @smallexample
19065 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
19066 @end smallexample
19067
19068 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
19069 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
19070 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
19071 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
19072 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
19073 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
19074 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
19075
19076 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
19077 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
19078 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
19079 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
19080 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
19081 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
19082
19083 @smallexample
19084 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
19085 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19086 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
19087 Compilation failed.
19088 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19089 42
19090 @end smallexample
19091
19092 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
19093 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
19094 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
19095 will print to the console.
19096 @end table
19097
19098 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
19099
19100 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
19101 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
19102 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
19103 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
19104 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
19105 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
19106 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
19107 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
19108
19109
19110 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
19111 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
19112 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
19113 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
19114 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
19115 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
19116 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
19117
19118 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
19119 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
19120 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
19121 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
19122 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
19123 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
19124 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
19125
19126 @table @code
19127 @item set compile-gcc
19128 @cindex compile command driver filename override
19129 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
19130 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
19131 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
19132 default.
19133
19134 @item show compile-gcc
19135 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
19136 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
19137 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
19138 @end table
19139
19140 @node GDB Files
19141 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
19142
19143 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
19144 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
19145 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
19146 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
19147
19148 @menu
19149 * Files:: Commands to specify files
19150 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
19151 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
19152 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
19153 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
19154 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
19155 * Data Files:: GDB data files
19156 @end menu
19157
19158 @node Files
19159 @section Commands to Specify Files
19160
19161 @cindex symbol table
19162 @cindex core dump file
19163
19164 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
19165 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
19166 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
19167 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
19168
19169 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
19170 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
19171 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
19172 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
19173 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
19174 new files are useful.
19175
19176 @table @code
19177 @cindex executable file
19178 @kindex file
19179 @item file @var{filename}
19180 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
19181 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
19182 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
19183 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
19184 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
19185 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
19186 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
19187 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
19188
19189 @cindex unlinked object files
19190 @cindex patching object files
19191 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
19192 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
19193 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
19194 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
19195 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
19196 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
19197 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
19198 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
19199
19200 @item file
19201 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
19202 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
19203
19204 @kindex exec-file
19205 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
19206 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
19207 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
19208 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
19209 discard information on the executable file.
19210
19211 @kindex symbol-file
19212 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]]}
19213 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
19214 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
19215 table and program to run from the same file.
19216
19217 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19218 address of each section in the symbol file. This is useful if the
19219 program is relocated at runtime, such as the Linux kernel with kASLR
19220 enabled.
19221
19222 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
19223 program's symbol table.
19224
19225 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
19226 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
19227 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
19228 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
19229 @value{GDBN}.
19230
19231 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
19232 executing it once.
19233
19234 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
19235 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
19236 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
19237 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
19238 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
19239 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
19240 optimized code.
19241
19242 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
19243 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
19244 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
19245 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
19246 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
19247
19248 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
19249 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
19250 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
19251 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
19252 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
19253 Warnings and Messages}.)
19254
19255 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
19256 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
19257 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
19258 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
19259 in stabs format.
19260
19261 @kindex readnow
19262 @cindex reading symbols immediately
19263 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
19264 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19265 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19266 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
19267 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
19268 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
19269 entire symbol table available.
19270
19271 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
19272 @cindex never read symbols
19273 @cindex symbols, never read
19274 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19275 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19276 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
19277 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
19278 @xref{--readnever}.
19279
19280 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
19281 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
19282 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
19283 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
19284 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
19285 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
19286 @c files.
19287
19288 @kindex core-file
19289 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19290 @itemx core
19291 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
19292 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
19293 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
19294 executable file itself for other parts.
19295
19296 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
19297 to be used.
19298
19299 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
19300 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
19301 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
19302 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
19303 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
19304
19305 @kindex add-symbol-file
19306 @cindex dynamic linking
19307 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]} @r{[} @var{textaddress} @r{]} @r{[} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} @r{]}
19308 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
19309 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
19310 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
19311 into the program that is running. The @var{textaddress} parameter gives
19312 the memory address at which the file's text section has been loaded.
19313 You can additionally specify the base address of other sections using
19314 an arbitrary number of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs.
19315 If a section is omitted, @value{GDBN} will use its default addresses
19316 as found in @var{filename}. Any @var{address} or @var{textaddress}
19317 can be given as an expression.
19318
19319 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19320 address of each section, except those for which the address was
19321 specified explicitly.
19322
19323 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
19324 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
19325 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
19326 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
19327
19328 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
19329
19330 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
19331 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
19332 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
19333 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
19334 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
19335 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
19336 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
19337 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
19338 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
19339
19340 @itemize @bullet
19341 @item
19342 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
19343 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
19344 @item
19345 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
19346 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
19347 @item
19348 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
19349 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19350 @end itemize
19351
19352 @noindent
19353 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
19354 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
19355 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
19356 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
19357 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
19358 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
19359 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
19360 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
19361 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
19362 way.
19363
19364 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19365
19366 @kindex remove-symbol-file
19367 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
19368 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
19369 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
19370 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
19371 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
19372
19373 @smallexample
19374 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
19375 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
19376 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
19377 (y or n) y
19378 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
19379 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
19380 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
19381 (gdb)
19382 @end smallexample
19383
19384
19385 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19386
19387 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
19388 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
19389 @cindex load symbols from memory
19390 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
19391 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
19392 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
19393 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
19394 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
19395 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
19396 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
19397 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
19398 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
19399
19400 @kindex section
19401 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
19402 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
19403 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
19404 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
19405 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
19406 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
19407 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
19408 their addresses.
19409
19410 @kindex info files
19411 @kindex info target
19412 @item info files
19413 @itemx info target
19414 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
19415 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
19416 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
19417 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
19418 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
19419 current ones.
19420
19421 @kindex maint info sections
19422 @item maint info sections
19423 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
19424 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
19425 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
19426 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
19427 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
19428 may be arbitrarily combined):
19429
19430 @table @code
19431 @item ALLOBJ
19432 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
19433 @item @var{sections}
19434 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
19435 @item @var{section-flags}
19436 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
19437 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
19438 @table @code
19439 @item ALLOC
19440 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
19441 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
19442 @item LOAD
19443 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
19444 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
19445 @item RELOC
19446 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
19447 @item READONLY
19448 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
19449 @item CODE
19450 Section contains executable code only.
19451 @item DATA
19452 Section contains data only (no executable code).
19453 @item ROM
19454 Section will reside in ROM.
19455 @item CONSTRUCTOR
19456 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
19457 @item HAS_CONTENTS
19458 Section is not empty.
19459 @item NEVER_LOAD
19460 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
19461 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
19462 A notification to the linker that the section contains
19463 COFF shared library information.
19464 @item IS_COMMON
19465 Section contains common symbols.
19466 @end table
19467 @end table
19468 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
19469 @cindex read-only sections
19470 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
19471 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
19472 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
19473 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
19474 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
19475 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
19476 enhancement to debugging performance.
19477
19478 The default is off.
19479
19480 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
19481 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
19482 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
19483 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
19484
19485 @item show trust-readonly-sections
19486 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
19487 @end table
19488
19489 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
19490 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
19491 name and remembers it that way.
19492
19493 @cindex shared libraries
19494 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
19495 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
19496 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
19497 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
19498
19499 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
19500 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
19501
19502 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
19503 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
19504 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
19505 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
19506 debugging a core file).
19507
19508 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
19509 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
19510 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
19511
19512 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
19513 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
19514 particularly large or there are many of them.
19515
19516 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
19517 commands:
19518
19519 @table @code
19520 @kindex set auto-solib-add
19521 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
19522 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
19523 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
19524 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
19525 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
19526 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
19527 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
19528
19529 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
19530 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
19531 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
19532 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
19533 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
19534 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
19535 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
19536 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
19537 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
19538
19539 @kindex show auto-solib-add
19540 @item show auto-solib-add
19541 Display the current autoloading mode.
19542 @end table
19543
19544 @cindex load shared library
19545 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
19546 command:
19547
19548 @table @code
19549 @kindex info sharedlibrary
19550 @kindex info share
19551 @item info share @var{regex}
19552 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19553 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
19554 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
19555 all shared libraries that are loaded.
19556
19557 @kindex info dll
19558 @item info dll @var{regex}
19559 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
19560
19561 @kindex sharedlibrary
19562 @kindex share
19563 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19564 @itemx share @var{regex}
19565 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
19566 Unix regular expression.
19567 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
19568 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
19569 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
19570 loaded.
19571
19572 @item nosharedlibrary
19573 @kindex nosharedlibrary
19574 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
19575 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
19576 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
19577 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
19578 discarded.
19579 @end table
19580
19581 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
19582 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
19583 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
19584 Catchpoints}).
19585
19586 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
19587 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
19588 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
19589 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
19590
19591 @table @code
19592 @item set stop-on-solib-events
19593 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
19594 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
19595 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
19596 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
19597 shared library.
19598
19599 @item show stop-on-solib-events
19600 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
19601 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
19602 library events happen.
19603 @end table
19604
19605 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
19606 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
19607 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
19608 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
19609 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
19610 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
19611 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
19612 not.
19613
19614 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
19615 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
19616 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
19617 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
19618 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
19619
19620 @table @code
19621 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
19622 @cindex system root, alternate
19623 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
19624 @kindex set sysroot
19625 @item set sysroot @var{path}
19626 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
19627 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
19628 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
19629 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
19630 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
19631 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
19632 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
19633 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
19634 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
19635 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
19636 @var{path}.
19637
19638 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
19639 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
19640 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
19641 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
19642 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
19643 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
19644 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
19645 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
19646 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
19647 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
19648 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
19649 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
19650 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
19651 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
19652
19653 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
19654 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
19655 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
19656 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
19657 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
19658
19659 @smallexample
19660 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
19661 @end smallexample
19662
19663 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
19664 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
19665 system:
19666
19667 @smallexample
19668 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
19669 @end smallexample
19670
19671 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
19672 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
19673 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
19674 colons:
19675
19676 @smallexample
19677 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
19678 @end smallexample
19679
19680 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
19681 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
19682 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
19683 @samp{z}):
19684
19685 @smallexample
19686 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
19687 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19688 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19689 @end smallexample
19690
19691 @noindent
19692 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
19693 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
19694 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
19695
19696 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
19697 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
19698
19699 @smallexample
19700 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
19701 @end smallexample
19702
19703 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
19704 if you don't want or need to.
19705
19706 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
19707 sysroot}.
19708
19709 @cindex default system root
19710 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
19711 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
19712 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
19713 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19714 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
19715 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19716 location.
19717
19718 @kindex show sysroot
19719 @item show sysroot
19720 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
19721
19722 @kindex set solib-search-path
19723 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
19724 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19725 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
19726 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
19727 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
19728 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
19729 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
19730 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
19731 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
19732 of shared library symbols.
19733
19734 @kindex show solib-search-path
19735 @item show solib-search-path
19736 Display the current shared library search path.
19737
19738 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
19739 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
19740 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
19741 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
19742 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
19743
19744 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
19745 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
19746 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
19747 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
19748 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
19749 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
19750 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
19751 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
19752 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
19753 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
19754 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
19755 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
19756 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
19757 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
19758 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
19759 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
19760 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
19761 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
19762 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
19763 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
19764 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
19765 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
19766
19767 @table @code
19768 @item unix
19769 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
19770 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
19771 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
19772 the forward slash.
19773
19774 @item dos-based
19775 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
19776 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
19777 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
19778 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
19779 considered directory separators.
19780
19781 @item auto
19782 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
19783 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
19784 This is the default.
19785 @end table
19786 @end table
19787
19788 @cindex file name canonicalization
19789 @cindex base name differences
19790 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
19791 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
19792 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
19793 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
19794 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
19795 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
19796 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
19797 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
19798 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
19799 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
19800 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
19801 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
19802 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
19803 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
19804 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
19805
19806 @table @code
19807 @item set basenames-may-differ
19808 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
19809 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19810
19811 @item show basenames-may-differ
19812 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
19813 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19814 @end table
19815
19816 @node File Caching
19817 @section File Caching
19818 @cindex caching of opened files
19819 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19820
19821 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19822 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19823 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19824 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19825
19826 @table @code
19827 @kindex maint info bfds
19828 @item maint info bfds
19829 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19830 @value{GDBN}.
19831
19832 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19833 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19834 @kindex bfd caching
19835 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19836 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19837 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19838 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19839 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19840 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19841 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19842 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19843 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19844
19845 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19846 @kindex bfd caching
19847 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19848 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19849
19850 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19851 @kindex bfd caching
19852 @item show debug bfd-cache
19853 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19854 @end table
19855
19856 @node Separate Debug Files
19857 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19858 @cindex separate debugging information files
19859 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19860 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19861 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19862 @cindex global debugging information directories
19863 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19864 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19865
19866 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19867 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19868 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19869 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19870 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19871 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19872 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19873
19874 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19875 file:
19876
19877 @itemize @bullet
19878 @item
19879 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19880 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19881 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19882 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19883 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19884 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19885 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19886 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19887
19888 @item
19889 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19890 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19891 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19892 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19893 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19894 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld,
19895 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19896 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19897 below.
19898 @end itemize
19899
19900 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19901 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19902
19903 @itemize @bullet
19904 @item
19905 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19906 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19907 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19908 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19909 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19910
19911 @item
19912 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19913 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19914 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19915 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19916 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19917 hex characters, not 10.)
19918 @end itemize
19919
19920 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19921 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19922 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19923 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19924 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19925 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19926
19927 @itemize @minus
19928 @item
19929 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19930 @item
19931 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19932 @item
19933 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19934 @item
19935 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19936 @end itemize
19937
19938 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19939 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19940 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19941 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19942 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19943
19944 @table @code
19945
19946 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19947 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19948 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19949 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19950 concatenating them by a path separator.
19951
19952 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19953 @item show debug-file-directory
19954 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19955 information files.
19956
19957 @end table
19958
19959 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19960 @cindex debug link sections
19961 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19962 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19963
19964 @itemize
19965 @item
19966 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19967 a zero byte,
19968 @item
19969 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19970 boundary within the section, and
19971 @item
19972 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19973 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19974 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19975 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19976 @end itemize
19977
19978 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19979 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19980 described above.
19981
19982 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19983 @cindex build ID sections
19984 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19985 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19986 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19987 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19988 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19989 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19990 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19991 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19992 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19993
19994 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19995 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19996 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19997 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19998 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19999 in an ordinary executable.
20000
20001 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
20002 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
20003 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
20004 following commands:
20005
20006 @smallexample
20007 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
20008 @kbd{strip -g foo}
20009 @end smallexample
20010
20011 @noindent
20012 These commands remove the debugging
20013 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
20014 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
20015 two files:
20016
20017 @itemize @bullet
20018 @item
20019 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
20020 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
20021
20022 @smallexample
20023 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
20024 @end smallexample
20025
20026 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
20027 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
20028 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
20029 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
20030
20031 @item
20032 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
20033 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
20034 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
20035 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
20036 @end itemize
20037
20038 @noindent
20039
20040 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
20041 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
20042 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
20043
20044 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
20045 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
20046 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
20047 @c different ways!
20048 @ifhtml
20049 @display
20050 @html
20051 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
20052 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
20053 @end html
20054 @end display
20055 @end ifhtml
20056 @ifnothtml
20057 @display
20058 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
20059 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
20060 @end display
20061 @end ifnothtml
20062
20063 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
20064 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
20065 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
20066 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
20067 CRC.
20068
20069 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
20070 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
20071 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
20072 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
20073 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
20074
20075 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
20076 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
20077 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
20078 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
20079 @code{0xffffffff}.
20080
20081 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
20082 @smallexample
20083 unsigned long
20084 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
20085 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
20086 @{
20087 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
20088 @{
20089 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
20090 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
20091 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
20092 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
20093 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
20094 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
20095 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
20096 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
20097 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
20098 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
20099 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
20100 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
20101 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
20102 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
20103 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
20104 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
20105 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
20106 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
20107 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
20108 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
20109 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
20110 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
20111 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
20112 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
20113 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
20114 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
20115 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
20116 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
20117 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
20118 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
20119 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
20120 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
20121 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
20122 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
20123 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
20124 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
20125 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
20126 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
20127 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
20128 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
20129 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
20130 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
20131 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
20132 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
20133 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
20134 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
20135 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
20136 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
20137 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
20138 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
20139 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
20140 0x2d02ef8d
20141 @};
20142 unsigned char *end;
20143
20144 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20145 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
20146 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
20147 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20148 @}
20149 @end smallexample
20150
20151 @noindent
20152 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
20153
20154 @node MiniDebugInfo
20155 @section Debugging information in a special section
20156 @cindex separate debug sections
20157 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
20158
20159 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
20160 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
20161 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
20162 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
20163
20164 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
20165 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
20166 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
20167 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
20168 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
20169 debugging information might be included in the section.
20170
20171 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
20172 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
20173 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
20174
20175 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
20176 standard utilities:
20177
20178 @smallexample
20179 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
20180 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
20181 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20182 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
20183
20184 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
20185 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
20186 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
20187 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20188 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
20189 | sort > funcsyms
20190
20191 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
20192 # table.
20193 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
20194
20195 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
20196 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
20197
20198 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
20199 # removing some unnecessary sections.
20200 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
20201 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
20202
20203 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
20204 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
20205
20206 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
20207 # original binary.
20208 xz mini_debuginfo
20209 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
20210 @end smallexample
20211
20212 @node Index Files
20213 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
20214 @cindex index files
20215 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
20216
20217 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
20218 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
20219 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
20220 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
20221 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
20222 startup.
20223
20224 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
20225 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
20226 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
20227
20228 @smallexample
20229 $ gdb-add-index symfile
20230 @end smallexample
20231
20232 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
20233
20234 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
20235 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
20236
20237 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
20238 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
20239 using @command{objcopy}.
20240
20241 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
20242
20243 @table @code
20244 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
20245 @kindex save gdb-index
20246 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
20247 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
20248 default creates it produces a single file
20249 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
20250 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
20251 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
20252 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
20253 given @var{directory}.
20254 @end table
20255
20256 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
20257 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
20258
20259 @smallexample
20260 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
20261 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
20262 @end smallexample
20263
20264 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
20265
20266 @smallexample
20267 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
20268 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
20269 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
20270 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
20271 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
20272 @end smallexample
20273
20274 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
20275 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
20276 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
20277 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
20278 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
20279 The default is @code{off}.
20280 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
20281 @xref{Index Section Format}.
20282
20283 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
20284 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
20285
20286 @smallexample
20287 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20288 @end smallexample
20289
20290 Instead you must do, for example,
20291
20292 @smallexample
20293 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20294 @end smallexample
20295
20296 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
20297 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
20298 currently work for programs using Ada.
20299
20300 @subsection Automatic symbol index cache
20301
20302 It is possible for @value{GDBN} to automatically save a copy of this index in a
20303 cache on disk and retrieve it from there when loading the same binary in the
20304 future. This feature can be turned on with @kbd{set index-cache on}. The
20305 following commands can be used to tweak the behavior of the index cache.
20306
20307 @table @code
20308
20309 @item set index-cache on
20310 @itemx set index-cache off
20311 Enable or disable the use of the symbol index cache.
20312
20313 @item set index-cache directory @var{directory}
20314 @itemx show index-cache directory
20315 Set/show the directory where index files will be saved.
20316
20317 The default value for this directory depends on the host platform. On
20318 most systems, the index is cached in the @file{gdb} subdirectory of
20319 the directory pointed to by the @env{XDG_CACHE_HOME} environment
20320 variable, if it is defined, else in the @file{.cache/gdb} subdirectory
20321 of your home directory. However, on some systems, the default may
20322 differ according to local convention.
20323
20324 There is no limit on the disk space used by index cache. It is perfectly safe
20325 to delete the content of that directory to free up disk space.
20326
20327 @item show index-cache stats
20328 Print the number of cache hits and misses since the launch of @value{GDBN}.
20329
20330 @end table
20331
20332 @node Symbol Errors
20333 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
20334
20335 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
20336 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
20337 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
20338 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
20339 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
20340 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
20341 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
20342 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
20343 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
20344 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20345 Messages}).
20346
20347 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
20348
20349 @table @code
20350 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
20351
20352 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
20353 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
20354 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
20355 in its outer scope blocks.
20356
20357 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
20358 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
20359 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
20360 function.
20361
20362 @item block at @var{address} out of order
20363
20364 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
20365 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
20366 do so.
20367
20368 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
20369 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
20370 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
20371 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20372 Messages}.)
20373
20374 @item bad block start address patched
20375
20376 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
20377 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
20378 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
20379
20380 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
20381 starting on the previous source line.
20382
20383 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
20384
20385 @cindex foo
20386 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
20387 larger than the size of the string table.
20388
20389 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
20390 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
20391 with this name.
20392
20393 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
20394
20395 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
20396 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
20397 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
20398
20399 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
20400 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
20401 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
20402 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
20403 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
20404 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
20405
20406 @item stub type has NULL name
20407
20408 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
20409
20410 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
20411 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
20412 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
20413 it.
20414
20415 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
20416
20417 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
20418
20419 @end table
20420
20421 @node Data Files
20422 @section GDB Data Files
20423
20424 @cindex prefix for data files
20425 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
20426 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
20427
20428 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
20429 is currently using.
20430
20431 @table @code
20432 @kindex set data-directory
20433 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
20434 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
20435 to @var{directory}.
20436
20437 @kindex show data-directory
20438 @item show data-directory
20439 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
20440 @end table
20441
20442 @cindex default data directory
20443 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
20444 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
20445 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
20446 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
20447 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
20448 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
20449 location.
20450
20451 The data directory may also be specified with the
20452 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
20453 @xref{Mode Options}.
20454
20455 @node Targets
20456 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
20457
20458 @cindex debugging target
20459 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
20460
20461 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
20462 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
20463 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
20464 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
20465 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
20466 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
20467 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
20468 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
20469
20470 @cindex target architecture
20471 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
20472 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
20473 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
20474 command.
20475
20476 @table @code
20477 @kindex set architecture
20478 @kindex show architecture
20479 @item set architecture @var{arch}
20480 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
20481 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
20482 supported architectures.
20483
20484 @item show architecture
20485 Show the current target architecture.
20486
20487 @item set processor
20488 @itemx processor
20489 @kindex set processor
20490 @kindex show processor
20491 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
20492 and @code{show architecture}.
20493 @end table
20494
20495 @menu
20496 * Active Targets:: Active targets
20497 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
20498 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
20499 @end menu
20500
20501 @node Active Targets
20502 @section Active Targets
20503
20504 @cindex stacking targets
20505 @cindex active targets
20506 @cindex multiple targets
20507
20508 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
20509 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
20510 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
20511 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
20512 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
20513 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
20514 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
20515 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
20516 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
20517
20518 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
20519 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
20520 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
20521 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
20522
20523 @node Target Commands
20524 @section Commands for Managing Targets
20525
20526 @table @code
20527 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
20528 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
20529 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
20530 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
20531 protocol of the target machine.
20532
20533 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
20534 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
20535 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
20536
20537 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
20538 after executing the command.
20539
20540 @kindex help target
20541 @item help target
20542 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
20543 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
20544 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
20545
20546 @item help target @var{name}
20547 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
20548 select it.
20549
20550 @kindex set gnutarget
20551 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
20552 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
20553 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
20554 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
20555 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
20556 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
20557
20558 @quotation
20559 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
20560 you must know the actual BFD name.
20561 @end quotation
20562
20563 @noindent
20564 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
20565
20566 @kindex show gnutarget
20567 @item show gnutarget
20568 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
20569 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
20570 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
20571 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
20572 @end table
20573
20574 @cindex common targets
20575 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
20576 configuration):
20577
20578 @table @code
20579 @kindex target
20580 @item target exec @var{program}
20581 @cindex executable file target
20582 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
20583 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
20584
20585 @item target core @var{filename}
20586 @cindex core dump file target
20587 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
20588 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
20589
20590 @item target remote @var{medium}
20591 @cindex remote target
20592 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
20593 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
20594 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
20595
20596 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
20597 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
20598
20599 @smallexample
20600 target remote /dev/ttya
20601 @end smallexample
20602
20603 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
20604 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
20605 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
20606 clobbered by the download.
20607
20608 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20609 @cindex built-in simulator target
20610 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
20611 In general,
20612 @smallexample
20613 target sim
20614 load
20615 run
20616 @end smallexample
20617 @noindent
20618 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
20619 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
20620 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
20621 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
20622 Processors}.
20623
20624 @item target native
20625 @cindex native target
20626 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
20627 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
20628 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
20629 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
20630
20631 @end table
20632
20633 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
20634 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
20635
20636 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
20637 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
20638 various aspects of this process.
20639
20640 @table @code
20641
20642 @item set hash
20643 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20644 @cindex hash mark while downloading
20645 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
20646 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
20647 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
20648 monitor.
20649
20650 @item show hash
20651 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20652 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
20653
20654 @item set debug monitor
20655 @kindex set debug monitor
20656 @cindex display remote monitor communications
20657 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
20658 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20659
20660 @item show debug monitor
20661 @kindex show debug monitor
20662 Show the current status of displaying communications between
20663 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20664 @end table
20665
20666 @table @code
20667
20668 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20669 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20670 @anchor{load}
20671 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
20672 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
20673 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
20674 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
20675 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
20676 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
20677
20678 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
20679 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
20680 target is @dots{}}''
20681
20682 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
20683 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
20684 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
20685 specifies a fixed address.
20686 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
20687
20688 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
20689 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
20690 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
20691
20692 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
20693 load programs into flash memory.
20694
20695 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
20696 @end table
20697
20698 @table @code
20699
20700 @kindex flash-erase
20701 @item flash-erase
20702 @anchor{flash-erase}
20703
20704 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
20705
20706 @end table
20707
20708 @node Byte Order
20709 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
20710
20711 @cindex choosing target byte order
20712 @cindex target byte order
20713
20714 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
20715 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
20716 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
20717 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
20718 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
20719 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
20720
20721 @table @code
20722 @kindex set endian
20723 @item set endian big
20724 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
20725
20726 @item set endian little
20727 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
20728
20729 @item set endian auto
20730 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
20731 executable.
20732
20733 @item show endian
20734 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
20735
20736 @end table
20737
20738 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
20739 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
20740 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
20741 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
20742 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
20743 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
20744 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
20745 and @code{big} otherwise.
20746
20747 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
20748 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
20749 target system.
20750
20751
20752 @node Remote Debugging
20753 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
20754 @cindex remote debugging
20755
20756 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
20757 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
20758 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
20759 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
20760 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
20761
20762 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
20763 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
20764 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
20765 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
20766 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
20767 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
20768
20769 Other remote targets may be available in your
20770 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
20771
20772 @menu
20773 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
20774 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
20775 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
20776 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
20777 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
20778 @end menu
20779
20780 @node Connecting
20781 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
20782 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
20783 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
20784 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
20785 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
20786 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
20787 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
20788
20789 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
20790 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
20791 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
20792 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
20793
20794 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
20795
20796 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
20797 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
20798 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
20799 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
20800
20801 @table @asis
20802
20803 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
20804 @item Result of detach or program exit
20805 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
20806 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
20807 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
20808
20809 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
20810 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
20811 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
20812 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
20813
20814 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
20815 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
20816 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
20817 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
20818
20819 @item Specifying the program to debug
20820 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
20821 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
20822 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
20823 target.
20824
20825 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
20826 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
20827 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
20828
20829 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
20830 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
20831 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
20832 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
20833
20834 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
20835 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
20836 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
20837 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
20838 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
20839 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
20840 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
20841 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
20842 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
20843
20844 @item The @code{run} command
20845 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
20846 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
20847 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
20848 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
20849 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
20850
20851 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
20852 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
20853 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
20854 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
20855 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
20856
20857 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
20858 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
20859 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
20860 @code{target remote} mode.
20861
20862 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
20863 @item Attaching
20864 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
20865 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
20866 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20867
20868 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
20869 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
20870 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
20871 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
20872 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20873
20874 @end table
20875
20876 @anchor{Host and target files}
20877 @subsection Host and Target Files
20878 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
20879 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20880
20881 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20882 information for your program running on the target. This requires
20883 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20884 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20885 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20886
20887 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20888 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20889 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20890 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20891 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20892
20893 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20894 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20895 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20896 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20897 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20898 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20899 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20900 target libraries.
20901
20902 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20903 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20904 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20905 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20906 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20907 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20908 programs.
20909
20910 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
20911 @cindex remote connection commands
20912 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, a
20913 local Unix domain socket, or
20914 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20915 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20916 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20917 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20918 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20919 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20920
20921 @table @code
20922
20923 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20924 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20925 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20926 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20927 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20928
20929 @smallexample
20930 target remote /dev/ttyb
20931 @end smallexample
20932
20933 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20934 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20935 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20936 @code{target} command.
20937
20938 @item target remote @var{local-socket}
20939 @itemx target extended-remote @var{local-socket}
20940 @cindex local socket, @code{target remote}
20941 @cindex Unix domain socket
20942 Use @var{local-socket} to communicate with the target. For example,
20943 to use a local Unix domain socket bound to the file system entry @file{/tmp/gdb-socket0}:
20944
20945 @smallexample
20946 target remote /tmp/gdb-socket0
20947 @end smallexample
20948
20949 Note that this command has the same form as the command to connect
20950 to a serial line. @value{GDBN} will automatically determine which
20951 kind of file you have specified and will make the appropriate kind
20952 of connection.
20953 This feature is not available if the host system does not support
20954 Unix domain sockets.
20955
20956 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20957 @itemx target remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20958 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20959 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20960 @itemx target remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20961 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20962 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20963 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20964 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20965 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20966 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20967 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20968 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20969 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20970 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20971 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20972 The @var{host} may be either a host name, a numeric @acronym{IPv4}
20973 address, or a numeric @acronym{IPv6} address (with or without the
20974 square brackets to separate the address from the port); @var{port}
20975 must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be the target machine
20976 itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or it might be a
20977 terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the target.
20978
20979 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20980 @code{manyfarms}:
20981
20982 @smallexample
20983 target remote manyfarms:2828
20984 @end smallexample
20985
20986 To connect to port 2828 on a terminal server whose address is
20987 @code{2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334}, you can either use the
20988 square bracket syntax:
20989
20990 @smallexample
20991 target remote [2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334]:2828
20992 @end smallexample
20993
20994 @noindent
20995 or explicitly specify the @acronym{IPv6} protocol:
20996
20997 @smallexample
20998 target remote tcp6:2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334:2828
20999 @end smallexample
21000
21001 This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no
21002 visible separation between the hostname and the port number.
21003 Therefore, we recommend the user to provide @acronym{IPv6} addresses
21004 using square brackets for clarity. However, it is important to
21005 mention that for @value{GDBN} there is no ambiguity: the number after
21006 the last colon is considered to be the port number.
21007
21008 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
21009 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
21010 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
21011 port 1234 on your local machine:
21012
21013 @smallexample
21014 target remote :1234
21015 @end smallexample
21016 @noindent
21017
21018 Note that the colon is still required here.
21019
21020 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21021 @itemx target remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21022 @itemx target remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21023 @itemx target remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21024 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21025 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21026 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21027 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21028 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21029 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21030 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
21031 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
21032 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
21033
21034 @smallexample
21035 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
21036 @end smallexample
21037
21038 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
21039 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
21040 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
21041 cause havoc with your debugging session.
21042
21043 @item target remote | @var{command}
21044 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
21045 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
21046 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
21047 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
21048 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
21049 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
21050 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
21051 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
21052 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
21053
21054 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
21055 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
21056 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
21057
21058 @end table
21059
21060 @cindex interrupting remote programs
21061 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
21062 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
21063 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
21064 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
21065 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
21066 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
21067
21068 @smallexample
21069 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
21070 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
21071 @end smallexample
21072
21073 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
21074 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
21075 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
21076 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
21077
21078 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
21079 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
21080
21081 @table @code
21082 @kindex detach (remote)
21083 @item detach
21084 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
21085 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
21086 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
21087 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
21088 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
21089 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
21090 still connected to the target.
21091
21092 @kindex disconnect
21093 @item disconnect
21094 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
21095 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
21096 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
21097 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
21098 another target.
21099
21100 @cindex send command to remote monitor
21101 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
21102 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
21103 @kindex monitor
21104 @item monitor @var{cmd}
21105 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
21106 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
21107 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
21108 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
21109 and implement.
21110 @end table
21111
21112 @node File Transfer
21113 @section Sending files to a remote system
21114 @cindex remote target, file transfer
21115 @cindex file transfer
21116 @cindex sending files to remote systems
21117
21118 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
21119 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
21120 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
21121 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
21122 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
21123 the only way to upload or download files.
21124
21125 Not all remote targets support these commands.
21126
21127 @table @code
21128 @kindex remote put
21129 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21130 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21131 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21132
21133 @kindex remote get
21134 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21135 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21136 on the host system.
21137
21138 @kindex remote delete
21139 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
21140 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21141
21142 @end table
21143
21144 @node Server
21145 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
21146
21147 @kindex gdbserver
21148 @cindex remote connection without stubs
21149 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
21150 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
21151 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
21152 linking in the usual debugging stub.
21153
21154 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
21155 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
21156 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
21157 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
21158 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
21159 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
21160 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
21161 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
21162 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
21163 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
21164 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
21165 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
21166 choice for debugging.
21167
21168 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
21169 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
21170 protocol.
21171
21172 @quotation
21173 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
21174 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
21175 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
21176 target system with the same privileges as the user running
21177 @code{gdbserver}.
21178 @end quotation
21179
21180 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
21181 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
21182 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
21183 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
21184
21185 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
21186 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
21187 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
21188 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
21189 system does all the symbol handling.
21190
21191 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
21192 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
21193 syntax is:
21194
21195 @smallexample
21196 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
21197 @end smallexample
21198
21199 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
21200 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
21201 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
21202 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
21203 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
21204 @file{/dev/com1}:
21205
21206 @smallexample
21207 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
21208 @end smallexample
21209
21210 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
21211 with it.
21212
21213 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
21214
21215 @smallexample
21216 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
21217 @end smallexample
21218
21219 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
21220 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
21221 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
21222 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
21223 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
21224 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
21225 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
21226 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
21227 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
21228 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
21229 @code{target remote} command.
21230
21231 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
21232 with ssh:
21233
21234 @smallexample
21235 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
21236 @end smallexample
21237
21238 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
21239 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
21240 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
21241 You could elide it if you want to.
21242
21243 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
21244 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
21245 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
21246 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
21247
21248 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
21249 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
21250 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
21251 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
21252
21253 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
21254 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
21255
21256 @smallexample
21257 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
21258 @end smallexample
21259
21260 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
21261 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
21262
21263 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
21264 @value{GDBN} attach command
21265 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
21266
21267 @pindex pidof
21268 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
21269 @code{pidof} utility:
21270
21271 @smallexample
21272 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
21273 @end smallexample
21274
21275 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
21276 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
21277 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
21278
21279 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
21280
21281 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
21282 port.
21283
21284 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
21285 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
21286 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
21287 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
21288 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
21289 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
21290 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
21291 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
21292
21293 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
21294 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
21295 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
21296
21297 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
21298 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
21299 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
21300 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
21301 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
21302 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
21303 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
21304 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
21305 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
21306 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
21307 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
21308 instance closes its port after the first connection.
21309
21310 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
21311 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
21312
21313 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
21314 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
21315 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
21316 program. For more information,
21317 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
21318
21319 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21320 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
21321 status information about the debugging process.
21322 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21323 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
21324 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
21325 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
21326
21327 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
21328 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
21329 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
21330 Possible options are:
21331
21332 @table @code
21333 @item none
21334 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21335 @item all
21336 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21337 @item timestamps
21338 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21339 @end table
21340
21341 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21342 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21343
21344 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
21345 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
21346 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
21347 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
21348 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
21349
21350 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
21351 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
21352 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
21353 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
21354
21355 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
21356 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
21357 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
21358 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
21359
21360 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
21361 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
21362 environment:
21363
21364 @smallexample
21365 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
21366 @end smallexample
21367
21368 @cindex @option{--selftest}
21369 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
21370
21371 @smallexample
21372 $ gdbserver --selftest
21373 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
21374 @end smallexample
21375
21376 These tests are disabled in release.
21377 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
21378
21379 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
21380 @itemize
21381
21382 @item
21383 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
21384
21385 @item
21386 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
21387 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
21388 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
21389 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
21390 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
21391 @code{--with-sysroot}).
21392
21393 @item
21394 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21395 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
21396 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
21397 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
21398 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
21399 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
21400 program is already on the target.
21401
21402 @end itemize
21403
21404 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
21405 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
21406 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
21407
21408 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
21409 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
21410 Here are the available commands.
21411
21412 @table @code
21413 @item monitor help
21414 List the available monitor commands.
21415
21416 @item monitor set debug 0
21417 @itemx monitor set debug 1
21418 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
21419
21420 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
21421 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
21422 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
21423 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
21424
21425 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
21426 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
21427 Possible options are:
21428
21429 @table @code
21430 @item none
21431 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21432 @item all
21433 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21434 @item timestamps
21435 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21436 @end table
21437
21438 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21439 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21440
21441 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
21442 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
21443 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
21444 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
21445 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
21446 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
21447
21448 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
21449 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
21450
21451 @item monitor exit
21452 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
21453 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
21454 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
21455 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
21456 of a multi-process mode debug session.
21457
21458 @end table
21459
21460 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21461 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21462
21463 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
21464 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
21465
21466 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
21467 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
21468 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
21469 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
21470 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
21471 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
21472 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
21473 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
21474 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
21475 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
21476 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
21477 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
21478
21479 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
21480
21481 @table @code
21482 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
21483
21484 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
21485 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
21486 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
21487
21488 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
21489
21490 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
21491 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
21492 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
21493 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
21494 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
21495 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
21496
21497 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
21498
21499 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
21500 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
21501 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
21502 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
21503 command for that. For example:
21504
21505 @smallexample
21506 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
21507 @end smallexample
21508
21509 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
21510 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
21511 @end table
21512
21513 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
21514 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
21515 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
21516 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
21517 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
21518 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
21519 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
21520 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
21521 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
21522 @code{gdbserver} like so:
21523
21524 @smallexample
21525 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
21526 @end smallexample
21527
21528 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
21529
21530 @smallexample
21531 $ gdb myprogram
21532 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
21533 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
21534 (@value{GDBP}) b main
21535 (@value{GDBP}) continue
21536 @end smallexample
21537
21538 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
21539 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
21540 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
21541 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
21542 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
21543 tracing.
21544
21545 @node Remote Configuration
21546 @section Remote Configuration
21547
21548 @kindex set remote
21549 @kindex show remote
21550 This section documents the configuration options available when
21551 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
21552 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
21553 system-call-allowed}.
21554
21555 @table @code
21556 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
21557 @cindex address size for remote targets
21558 @cindex bits in remote address
21559 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
21560 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
21561 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
21562 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
21563
21564 @item show remoteaddresssize
21565 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
21566
21567 @item set serial baud @var{n}
21568 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
21569 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
21570 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
21571 remote targets.
21572
21573 @item show serial baud
21574 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
21575
21576 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
21577 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
21578 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
21579
21580 @item show serial parity
21581 Show the current parity of the serial port.
21582
21583 @item set remotebreak
21584 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21585 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
21586 @anchor{set remotebreak}
21587 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
21588 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
21589 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
21590 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
21591 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
21592
21593 @item show remotebreak
21594 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
21595 interrupt the remote program.
21596
21597 @item set remoteflow on
21598 @itemx set remoteflow off
21599 @kindex set remoteflow
21600 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
21601 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
21602
21603 @item show remoteflow
21604 @kindex show remoteflow
21605 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
21606
21607 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
21608 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
21609 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
21610 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
21611 @code{ascii}.
21612
21613 @item show remotelogbase
21614 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
21615 protocol.
21616
21617 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
21618 @cindex record serial communications on file
21619 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
21620 default is not to record at all.
21621
21622 @item show remotelogfile
21623 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
21624 serial communications.
21625
21626 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
21627 @cindex timeout for serial communications
21628 @cindex remote timeout
21629 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
21630 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
21631
21632 @item show remotetimeout
21633 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
21634 responses.
21635
21636 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
21637 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
21638 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
21639 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
21640 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
21641 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
21642 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware watchpoints
21643 or breakpoints. The @var{limit} can be set to 0 to disable hardware
21644 watchpoints or breakpoints, and @code{unlimited} for unlimited
21645 watchpoints or breakpoints.
21646
21647 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
21648 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
21649 Show the current limit for the number of hardware watchpoints or
21650 breakpoints that @value{GDBN} can use.
21651
21652 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
21653 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
21654 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
21655 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
21656 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum
21657 length of a remote hardware watchpoint. A @var{limit} of 0 disables
21658 hardware watchpoints and @code{unlimited} allows watchpoints of any
21659 length.
21660
21661 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
21662 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
21663 a remote hardware watchpoint.
21664
21665 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
21666 @itemx show remote exec-file
21667 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
21668 @cindex executable file, for remote target
21669 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
21670 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
21671 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
21672 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
21673
21674 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
21675 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21676 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
21677 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
21678 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
21679 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
21680 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
21681 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
21682 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
21683 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
21684
21685 @item show interrupt-sequence
21686 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
21687 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
21688 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
21689 also known as Magic SysRq g.
21690
21691 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
21692 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
21693 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
21694 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
21695 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
21696 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
21697
21698 @item show interrupt-on-connect
21699 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
21700 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
21701
21702 @kindex set tcp
21703 @kindex show tcp
21704 @item set tcp auto-retry on
21705 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
21706 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
21707 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
21708 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
21709 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
21710 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
21711 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
21712 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
21713
21714 @item set tcp auto-retry off
21715 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
21716
21717 @item show tcp auto-retry
21718 Show the current auto-retry setting.
21719
21720 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
21721 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
21722 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
21723 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
21724 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
21725 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
21726 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
21727 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
21728 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
21729 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
21730 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
21731
21732 @item show tcp connect-timeout
21733 Show the current connection timeout setting.
21734 @end table
21735
21736 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
21737 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
21738 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
21739 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
21740 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
21741 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
21742 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
21743 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
21744 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
21745
21746 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
21747 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
21748 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
21749 @value{GDBN} developers.
21750
21751 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
21752 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
21753 are:
21754
21755 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
21756 @item Command Name
21757 @tab Remote Packet
21758 @tab Related Features
21759
21760 @item @code{fetch-register}
21761 @tab @code{p}
21762 @tab @code{info registers}
21763
21764 @item @code{set-register}
21765 @tab @code{P}
21766 @tab @code{set}
21767
21768 @item @code{binary-download}
21769 @tab @code{X}
21770 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
21771
21772 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
21773 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
21774 @tab @code{info auxv}
21775
21776 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
21777 @tab @code{qSymbol}
21778 @tab Detecting multiple threads
21779
21780 @item @code{attach}
21781 @tab @code{vAttach}
21782 @tab @code{attach}
21783
21784 @item @code{verbose-resume}
21785 @tab @code{vCont}
21786 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
21787
21788 @item @code{run}
21789 @tab @code{vRun}
21790 @tab @code{run}
21791
21792 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
21793 @tab @code{Z0}
21794 @tab @code{break}
21795
21796 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
21797 @tab @code{Z1}
21798 @tab @code{hbreak}
21799
21800 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
21801 @tab @code{Z2}
21802 @tab @code{watch}
21803
21804 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
21805 @tab @code{Z3}
21806 @tab @code{rwatch}
21807
21808 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
21809 @tab @code{Z4}
21810 @tab @code{awatch}
21811
21812 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
21813 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
21814 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
21815
21816 @item @code{target-features}
21817 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
21818 @tab @code{set architecture}
21819
21820 @item @code{library-info}
21821 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
21822 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
21823
21824 @item @code{memory-map}
21825 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
21826 @tab @code{info mem}
21827
21828 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
21829 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
21830 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
21831
21832 @item @code{read-spu-object}
21833 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
21834 @tab @code{info spu}
21835
21836 @item @code{write-spu-object}
21837 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
21838 @tab @code{info spu}
21839
21840 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
21841 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
21842 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
21843
21844 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
21845 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
21846 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
21847
21848 @item @code{threads}
21849 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
21850 @tab @code{info threads}
21851
21852 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
21853 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
21854 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
21855
21856 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
21857 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
21858 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
21859
21860 @item @code{search-memory}
21861 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
21862 @tab @code{find}
21863
21864 @item @code{supported-packets}
21865 @tab @code{qSupported}
21866 @tab Remote communications parameters
21867
21868 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
21869 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
21870 @tab @code{catch syscall}
21871
21872 @item @code{pass-signals}
21873 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
21874 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21875
21876 @item @code{program-signals}
21877 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
21878 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21879
21880 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
21881 @tab @code{vFile:close}
21882 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21883
21884 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
21885 @tab @code{vFile:open}
21886 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21887
21888 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
21889 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
21890 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21891
21892 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
21893 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
21894 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21895
21896 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
21897 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
21898 @tab @code{remote delete}
21899
21900 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
21901 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
21902 @tab Host I/O
21903
21904 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
21905 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
21906 @tab Host I/O
21907
21908 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
21909 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
21910 @tab Host I/O
21911
21912 @item @code{noack-packet}
21913 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
21914 @tab Packet acknowledgment
21915
21916 @item @code{osdata}
21917 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
21918 @tab @code{info os}
21919
21920 @item @code{query-attached}
21921 @tab @code{qAttached}
21922 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
21923
21924 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
21925 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
21926 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
21927
21928 @item @code{trace-status}
21929 @tab @code{qTStatus}
21930 @tab @code{tstatus}
21931
21932 @item @code{traceframe-info}
21933 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
21934 @tab Traceframe info
21935
21936 @item @code{install-in-trace}
21937 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
21938 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
21939
21940 @item @code{disable-randomization}
21941 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
21942 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
21943
21944 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
21945 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
21946 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
21947
21948 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
21949 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
21950 @tab @code{set environment}
21951
21952 @item @code{environment-unset}
21953 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21954 @tab @code{unset environment}
21955
21956 @item @code{environment-reset}
21957 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21958 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21959
21960 @item @code{set-working-dir}
21961 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
21962 @tab @code{set cwd}
21963
21964 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21965 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21966 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21967
21968 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21969 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21970 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21971
21972 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
21973 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21974 @tab @code{break}
21975
21976 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21977 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21978 @tab @code{hbreak}
21979
21980 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
21981 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
21982 @tab @code{fork}
21983
21984 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
21985 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
21986 @tab @code{vfork}
21987
21988 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
21989 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
21990 @tab @code{exec}
21991
21992 @item @code{thread-events}
21993 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
21994 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21995
21996 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21997 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21998 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21999
22000 @end multitable
22001
22002 @node Remote Stub
22003 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
22004
22005 @cindex debugging stub, example
22006 @cindex remote stub, example
22007 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
22008 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
22009 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
22010 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
22011 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
22012 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
22013 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
22014 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
22015
22016 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
22017 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
22018 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
22019 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
22020 program, you need:
22021
22022 @enumerate
22023 @item
22024 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
22025 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
22026 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
22027
22028 @item
22029 A C subroutine library to support your program's
22030 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
22031
22032 @item
22033 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
22034 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
22035 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
22036 documentation.
22037 @end enumerate
22038
22039 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
22040 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
22041 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
22042
22043 @table @emph
22044 @item On the host,
22045 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
22046 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
22047 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
22048
22049 @item On the target,
22050 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
22051 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
22052 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
22053
22054 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
22055 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
22056 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
22057 @end table
22058
22059 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
22060 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
22061 @sc{sparc} boards.
22062
22063 @cindex remote serial stub list
22064 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
22065
22066 @table @code
22067
22068 @item i386-stub.c
22069 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
22070 @cindex Intel
22071 @cindex i386
22072 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
22073
22074 @item m68k-stub.c
22075 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
22076 @cindex Motorola 680x0
22077 @cindex m680x0
22078 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
22079
22080 @item sh-stub.c
22081 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
22082 @cindex Renesas
22083 @cindex SH
22084 For Renesas SH architectures.
22085
22086 @item sparc-stub.c
22087 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
22088 @cindex Sparc
22089 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
22090
22091 @item sparcl-stub.c
22092 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
22093 @cindex Fujitsu
22094 @cindex SparcLite
22095 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
22096
22097 @end table
22098
22099 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
22100 recently added stubs.
22101
22102 @menu
22103 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
22104 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
22105 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
22106 @end menu
22107
22108 @node Stub Contents
22109 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
22110
22111 @cindex remote serial stub
22112 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
22113 subroutines:
22114
22115 @table @code
22116 @item set_debug_traps
22117 @findex set_debug_traps
22118 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
22119 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
22120 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
22121 program's startup code.
22122
22123 @item handle_exception
22124 @findex handle_exception
22125 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
22126 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
22127 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
22128 run when a trap is triggered.
22129
22130 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
22131 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
22132 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
22133 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
22134 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
22135 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
22136 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
22137 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
22138 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
22139 machine.
22140
22141 @item breakpoint
22142 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
22143 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
22144 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
22145 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
22146 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
22147 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
22148 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
22149 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
22150 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
22151 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
22152 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
22153
22154 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
22155 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
22156 start of your debugging session.
22157 @end table
22158
22159 @node Bootstrapping
22160 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
22161
22162 @cindex remote stub, support routines
22163 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
22164 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
22165 debugging target machine.
22166
22167 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
22168 serial port.
22169
22170 @table @code
22171 @item int getDebugChar()
22172 @findex getDebugChar
22173 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
22174 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
22175 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22176
22177 @item void putDebugChar(int)
22178 @findex putDebugChar
22179 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
22180 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
22181 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22182 @end table
22183
22184 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
22185 @cindex interrupting remote targets
22186 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
22187 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
22188 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
22189 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
22190 remote system to stop.
22191
22192 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
22193 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
22194 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
22195 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
22196
22197 Other routines you need to supply are:
22198
22199 @table @code
22200 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
22201 @findex exceptionHandler
22202 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
22203 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
22204 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
22205 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
22206 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
22207 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
22208 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
22209 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
22210 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
22211 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
22212 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
22213 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
22214 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
22215
22216 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
22217 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
22218 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
22219 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
22220 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
22221
22222 @item void flush_i_cache()
22223 @findex flush_i_cache
22224 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
22225 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
22226 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
22227
22228 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
22229 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
22230 @end table
22231
22232 @noindent
22233 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
22234
22235 @table @code
22236 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
22237 @findex memset
22238 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
22239 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
22240 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
22241 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
22242 @end table
22243
22244 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
22245 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
22246 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
22247 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
22248
22249
22250 @node Debug Session
22251 @subsection Putting it All Together
22252
22253 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
22254 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
22255 steps.
22256
22257 @enumerate
22258 @item
22259 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
22260 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
22261 @display
22262 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
22263 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
22264 @end display
22265
22266 @item
22267 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
22268 procedure is called:
22269
22270 @smallexample
22271 set_debug_traps();
22272 breakpoint();
22273 @end smallexample
22274
22275 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
22276 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
22277 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
22278 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
22279 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
22280 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
22281 progress.
22282
22283 @item
22284 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
22285 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
22286
22287 @smallexample
22288 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
22289 @end smallexample
22290
22291 @noindent
22292 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
22293 function in your program, that function is called when
22294 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
22295 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
22296 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
22297
22298 @item
22299 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
22300 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
22301
22302 @item
22303 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
22304 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
22305
22306 @item
22307 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
22308 @c document that. FIXME.
22309 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
22310 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
22311
22312 @item
22313 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
22314 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
22315
22316 @end enumerate
22317
22318 @node Configurations
22319 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
22320
22321 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
22322 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
22323 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
22324
22325 There are three major categories of configurations: native
22326 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
22327 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
22328 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
22329 are quite different from each other.
22330
22331 @menu
22332 * Native::
22333 * Embedded OS::
22334 * Embedded Processors::
22335 * Architectures::
22336 @end menu
22337
22338 @node Native
22339 @section Native
22340
22341 This section describes details specific to particular native
22342 configurations.
22343
22344 @menu
22345 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
22346 * Process Information:: Process information
22347 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
22348 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
22349 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
22350 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
22351 * FreeBSD:: Features specific to FreeBSD
22352 @end menu
22353
22354 @node BSD libkvm Interface
22355 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
22356
22357 @cindex libkvm
22358 @cindex kernel memory image
22359 @cindex kernel crash dump
22360
22361 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
22362 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
22363 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
22364 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
22365 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
22366 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
22367 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
22368 @code{kvm} target:
22369
22370 @smallexample
22371 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
22372 @end smallexample
22373
22374 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
22375 argument:
22376
22377 @smallexample
22378 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
22379 @end smallexample
22380
22381 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
22382 available:
22383
22384 @table @code
22385 @kindex kvm
22386 @item kvm pcb
22387 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
22388
22389 @item kvm proc
22390 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
22391 modern FreeBSD systems.
22392 @end table
22393
22394 @node Process Information
22395 @subsection Process Information
22396 @cindex /proc
22397 @cindex examine process image
22398 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
22399
22400 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
22401 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
22402 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
22403 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
22404 to report information about the process running your program, or about
22405 any process running on your system.
22406
22407 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
22408 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
22409 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
22410 systems.
22411
22412 On FreeBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query process
22413 information.
22414
22415 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
22416 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
22417 information available from a live process. Process information is
22418 currently avaiable from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
22419 systems.
22420
22421 @table @code
22422 @kindex info proc
22423 @cindex process ID
22424 @item info proc
22425 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
22426 Summarize available information about a process. If a
22427 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
22428 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
22429 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
22430 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
22431 executable file's absolute file name.
22432
22433 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
22434 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
22435 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
22436 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
22437 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
22438 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
22439
22440 @item info proc cmdline
22441 @cindex info proc cmdline
22442 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
22443 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22444
22445 @item info proc cwd
22446 @cindex info proc cwd
22447 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
22448 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22449
22450 @item info proc exe
22451 @cindex info proc exe
22452 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
22453 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22454
22455 @item info proc files
22456 @cindex info proc files
22457 Show the file descriptors open by the process. For each open file
22458 descriptor, @value{GDBN} shows its number, type (file, directory,
22459 character device, socket), file pointer offset, and the name of the
22460 resource open on the descriptor. The resource name can be a file name
22461 (for files, directories, and devices) or a protocol followed by socket
22462 address (for network connections). This command is supported on
22463 FreeBSD.
22464
22465 This example shows the open file descriptors for a process using a
22466 tty for standard input and output as well as two network sockets:
22467
22468 @smallexample
22469 (gdb) info proc files 22136
22470 process 22136
22471 Open files:
22472
22473 FD Type Offset Flags Name
22474 text file - r-------- /usr/bin/ssh
22475 ctty chr - rw------- /dev/pts/20
22476 cwd dir - r-------- /usr/home/john
22477 root dir - r-------- /
22478 0 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22479 1 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22480 2 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22481 3 socket 0x0 rw----n-- tcp4 10.0.1.2:53014 -> 10.0.1.10:22
22482 4 socket 0x0 rw------- unix stream:/tmp/ssh-FIt89oAzOn5f/agent.2456
22483 @end smallexample
22484
22485 @item info proc mappings
22486 @cindex memory address space mappings
22487 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in a process. On
22488 Solaris and FreeBSD systems, each memory range includes information on
22489 whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
22490 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD systems, each memory range
22491 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
22492
22493 @item info proc stat
22494 @itemx info proc status
22495 @cindex process detailed status information
22496 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
22497 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
22498 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
22499 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
22500 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22501
22502 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
22503 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
22504
22505 For FreeBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for @code{info
22506 proc status}.
22507
22508 @item info proc all
22509 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
22510 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
22511
22512 @ignore
22513 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
22514 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
22515 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
22516 @kindex info proc times
22517 @item info proc times
22518 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
22519 its children.
22520
22521 @kindex info proc id
22522 @item info proc id
22523 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
22524 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
22525 @end ignore
22526
22527 @item set procfs-trace
22528 @kindex set procfs-trace
22529 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
22530 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
22531
22532 @item show procfs-trace
22533 @kindex show procfs-trace
22534 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
22535
22536 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
22537 @kindex set procfs-file
22538 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
22539 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
22540 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
22541 standard output.
22542
22543 @item show procfs-file
22544 @kindex show procfs-file
22545 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
22546
22547 @item proc-trace-entry
22548 @itemx proc-trace-exit
22549 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
22550 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
22551 @kindex proc-trace-entry
22552 @kindex proc-trace-exit
22553 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
22554 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
22555 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
22556 from the @code{syscall} interface.
22557
22558 @item info pidlist
22559 @kindex info pidlist
22560 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
22561 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
22562 processes and all the threads within each process.
22563
22564 @item info meminfo
22565 @kindex info meminfo
22566 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
22567 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
22568 @end table
22569
22570 @node DJGPP Native
22571 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
22572 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
22573 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
22574 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
22575
22576 @cindex DPMI
22577 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
22578 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
22579 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
22580 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
22581
22582 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
22583 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
22584 subsection describes those commands.
22585
22586 @table @code
22587 @kindex info dos
22588 @item info dos
22589 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
22590 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22591
22592 @kindex sysinfo
22593 @cindex MS-DOS system info
22594 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
22595 @item info dos sysinfo
22596 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
22597 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
22598 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
22599
22600 @cindex GDT
22601 @cindex LDT
22602 @cindex IDT
22603 @cindex segment descriptor tables
22604 @cindex descriptor tables display
22605 @item info dos gdt
22606 @itemx info dos ldt
22607 @itemx info dos idt
22608 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
22609 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
22610 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
22611 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
22612 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
22613 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
22614 rights.
22615
22616 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
22617 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
22618 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
22619 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
22620 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
22621
22622 @cindex garbled pointers
22623 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
22624 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
22625 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
22626 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
22627 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
22628 debugged program's data segment:
22629
22630 @smallexample
22631 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
22632 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
22633 @end smallexample
22634
22635 @noindent
22636 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
22637 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
22638
22639 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
22640 @item info dos pde
22641 @itemx info dos pte
22642 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
22643 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
22644 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
22645 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
22646 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
22647 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
22648 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
22649 that is currently in use.
22650
22651 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
22652 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
22653 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
22654 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
22655 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
22656 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
22657 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
22658
22659 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
22660 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
22661 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
22662 controller.
22663
22664 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
22665
22666 @cindex physical address from linear address
22667 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
22668 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
22669 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
22670 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
22671 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
22672 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
22673 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
22674
22675 @smallexample
22676 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
22677 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
22678 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
22679 @end smallexample
22680
22681 @noindent
22682 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
22683 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
22684 attributes of that page.
22685
22686 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
22687 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
22688 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
22689 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
22690 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
22691 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
22692
22693 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
22694 transfer buffer:
22695
22696 @smallexample
22697 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
22698 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
22699 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
22700 @end smallexample
22701
22702 @noindent
22703 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
22704 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
22705 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
22706 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
22707 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
22708
22709 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
22710 @end table
22711
22712 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
22713 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
22714 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
22715 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
22716
22717 @table @code
22718 @kindex set com1base
22719 @kindex set com1irq
22720 @kindex set com2base
22721 @kindex set com2irq
22722 @kindex set com3base
22723 @kindex set com3irq
22724 @kindex set com4base
22725 @kindex set com4irq
22726 @item set com1base @var{addr}
22727 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
22728 port.
22729
22730 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
22731 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
22732 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
22733
22734 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
22735 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
22736 other 3 COM ports.
22737
22738 @kindex show com1base
22739 @kindex show com1irq
22740 @kindex show com2base
22741 @kindex show com2irq
22742 @kindex show com3base
22743 @kindex show com3irq
22744 @kindex show com4base
22745 @kindex show com4irq
22746 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
22747 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
22748 lines used by the COM ports.
22749
22750 @item info serial
22751 @kindex info serial
22752 @cindex DOS serial port status
22753 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
22754 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
22755 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
22756 counts of various errors encountered so far.
22757 @end table
22758
22759
22760 @node Cygwin Native
22761 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
22762 @cindex MS Windows debugging
22763 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
22764 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
22765
22766 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
22767 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
22768
22769 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
22770 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
22771 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
22772 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
22773 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
22774 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
22775 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
22776 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
22777
22778 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
22779 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
22780 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
22781
22782 @table @code
22783 @kindex info w32
22784 @item info w32
22785 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
22786 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22787
22788 @item info w32 selector
22789 This command displays information returned by
22790 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
22791 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
22792 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
22793 Without argument, this command displays information
22794 about the six segment registers.
22795
22796 @item info w32 thread-information-block
22797 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
22798 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
22799 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
22800
22801 @kindex signal-event
22802 @item signal-event @var{id}
22803 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
22804 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
22805
22806 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
22807 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
22808 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
22809 (for x86_64 versions):
22810
22811 @itemize @minus
22812 @item
22813 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
22814 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
22815 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
22816
22817 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
22818 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
22819 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
22820 to attach.
22821
22822 @item
22823 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
22824 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
22825 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
22826 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
22827 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
22828 @end itemize
22829
22830 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
22831 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
22832 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
22833 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
22834 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
22835 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
22836 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
22837 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
22838 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
22839 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
22840 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
22841
22842 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
22843 @item show cygwin-exceptions
22844 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
22845 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
22846
22847 @kindex set new-console
22848 @item set new-console @var{mode}
22849 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
22850 be started in a new console on next start.
22851 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
22852 be started in the same console as the debugger.
22853
22854 @kindex show new-console
22855 @item show new-console
22856 Displays whether a new console is used
22857 when the debuggee is started.
22858
22859 @kindex set new-group
22860 @item set new-group @var{mode}
22861 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
22862 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
22863 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
22864 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
22865
22866 @kindex show new-group
22867 @item show new-group
22868 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
22869
22870 @kindex set debugevents
22871 @item set debugevents
22872 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
22873 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
22874 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
22875 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
22876 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
22877
22878 @kindex set debugexec
22879 @item set debugexec
22880 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
22881 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
22882
22883 @kindex set debugexceptions
22884 @item set debugexceptions
22885 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
22886 debuggee seen by the debugger.
22887
22888 @kindex set debugmemory
22889 @item set debugmemory
22890 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
22891 and writes by the debugger.
22892
22893 @kindex set shell
22894 @item set shell
22895 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
22896 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
22897
22898 @kindex show shell
22899 @item show shell
22900 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
22901
22902 @end table
22903
22904 @menu
22905 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
22906 @end menu
22907
22908 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
22909 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
22910 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
22911 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
22912
22913 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
22914 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
22915 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
22916 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
22917 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
22918 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
22919 ``minimal symbols''.
22920
22921 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
22922 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
22923 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
22924 program run once to completion.
22925
22926 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
22927
22928 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
22929 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
22930 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
22931 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
22932 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
22933 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
22934 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
22935 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
22936 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
22937
22938 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
22939 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
22940 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
22941 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
22942 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
22943 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
22944
22945 @smallexample
22946 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
22947 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
22948
22949 Non-debugging symbols:
22950 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
22951 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
22952 @end smallexample
22953
22954 @smallexample
22955 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
22956 All functions matching regular expression "!":
22957
22958 Non-debugging symbols:
22959 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
22960 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
22961 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
22962 [etc...]
22963 @end smallexample
22964
22965 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
22966
22967 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
22968 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
22969 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
22970 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
22971 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
22972 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
22973 a function within a DLL without a running program.
22974
22975 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
22976 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
22977 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
22978 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
22979 problem:
22980
22981 @smallexample
22982 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
22983 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22984 @end smallexample
22985
22986 @smallexample
22987 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
22988 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22989 @end smallexample
22990
22991 And two possible solutions:
22992
22993 @smallexample
22994 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
22995 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22996 @end smallexample
22997
22998 @smallexample
22999 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
23000 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
23001 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
23002 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
23003 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
23004 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
23005 @end smallexample
23006
23007 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
23008 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
23009 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
23010 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
23011 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
23012
23013 @smallexample
23014 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
23015 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
23016 @end smallexample
23017
23018 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
23019 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
23020 safe.
23021
23022 @node Hurd Native
23023 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
23024 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
23025
23026 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
23027 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
23028
23029 @table @code
23030 @item set signals
23031 @itemx set sigs
23032 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
23033 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23034 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
23035 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
23036 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
23037 @code{signals}.
23038
23039 @item show signals
23040 @itemx show sigs
23041 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
23042 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23043 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
23044
23045 @item set signal-thread
23046 @itemx set sigthread
23047 @kindex set signal-thread
23048 @kindex set sigthread
23049 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
23050 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
23051 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
23052 signal-thread}.
23053
23054 @item show signal-thread
23055 @itemx show sigthread
23056 @kindex show signal-thread
23057 @kindex show sigthread
23058 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
23059 delivered a signal.
23060
23061 @item set stopped
23062 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23063 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
23064 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
23065 continued by delivering a signal to it.
23066
23067 @item show stopped
23068 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23069 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
23070 stopped.
23071
23072 @item set exceptions
23073 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23074 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
23075 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
23076 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
23077 trapping on.
23078
23079 @item show exceptions
23080 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23081 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
23082
23083 @item set task pause
23084 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
23085 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23086 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23087 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
23088 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
23089 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
23090 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
23091 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
23092 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
23093
23094 @item show task pause
23095 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
23096 Show the current state of task suspension.
23097
23098 @item set task detach-suspend-count
23099 @cindex task suspend count
23100 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23101 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
23102 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
23103
23104 @item show task detach-suspend-count
23105 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
23106
23107 @item set task exception-port
23108 @itemx set task excp
23109 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23110 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
23111 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
23112 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
23113
23114 @item set noninvasive
23115 @cindex noninvasive task options
23116 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
23117 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
23118 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
23119 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
23120
23121 @item info send-rights
23122 @itemx info receive-rights
23123 @itemx info port-rights
23124 @itemx info port-sets
23125 @itemx info dead-names
23126 @itemx info ports
23127 @itemx info psets
23128 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23129 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23130 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23131 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23132 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23133 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
23134 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
23135 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
23136 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
23137
23138 @item set thread pause
23139 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
23140 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23141 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23142 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
23143 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
23144 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
23145 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
23146 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
23147 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
23148 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
23149 only the current thread.
23150
23151 @item show thread pause
23152 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
23153 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
23154
23155 @item set thread run
23156 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23157
23158 @item show thread run
23159 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23160
23161 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
23162 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23163 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23164 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
23165 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
23166 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
23167 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
23168
23169 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
23170 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
23171 detaching.
23172
23173 @item set thread exception-port
23174 @itemx set thread excp
23175 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
23176 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
23177 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
23178
23179 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
23180 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
23181 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
23182 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
23183
23184 @item set thread default
23185 @itemx show thread default
23186 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23187 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
23188 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
23189 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
23190 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
23191 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
23192 the non-default commands.
23193 @end table
23194
23195 @node Darwin
23196 @subsection Darwin
23197 @cindex Darwin
23198
23199 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
23200
23201 @table @code
23202 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
23203 @kindex set debug darwin
23204 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
23205 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
23206
23207 @item show debug darwin
23208 @kindex show debug darwin
23209 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
23210
23211 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
23212 @kindex set debug mach-o
23213 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
23214 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
23215 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
23216 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
23217 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
23218 usage.
23219
23220 @item show debug mach-o
23221 @kindex show debug mach-o
23222 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
23223
23224 @item set mach-exceptions on
23225 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
23226 @kindex set mach-exceptions
23227 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
23228 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
23229 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
23230 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
23231
23232 @item show mach-exceptions
23233 @kindex show mach-exceptions
23234 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
23235 @end table
23236
23237 @node FreeBSD
23238 @subsection FreeBSD
23239 @cindex FreeBSD
23240
23241 When the ABI of a system call is changed in the FreeBSD kernel, this
23242 is implemented by leaving a compatibility system call using the old
23243 ABI at the existing number and allocating a new system call number for
23244 the version using the new ABI. As a convenience, when a system call
23245 is caught by name (@pxref{catch syscall}), compatibility system calls
23246 are also caught.
23247
23248 For example, FreeBSD 12 introduced a new variant of the @code{kevent}
23249 system call and catching the @code{kevent} system call by name catches
23250 both variants:
23251
23252 @smallexample
23253 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall kevent
23254 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'freebsd11_kevent' [363] 'kevent' [560])
23255 (@value{GDBP})
23256 @end smallexample
23257
23258
23259 @node Embedded OS
23260 @section Embedded Operating Systems
23261
23262 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
23263 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
23264 architectures.
23265
23266 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
23267 various real-time operating systems.
23268
23269 @node Embedded Processors
23270 @section Embedded Processors
23271
23272 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
23273 configurations.
23274
23275 @cindex send command to simulator
23276 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
23277 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
23278
23279 @table @code
23280 @item sim @var{command}
23281 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
23282 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
23283 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
23284 acceptable commands.
23285 @end table
23286
23287
23288 @menu
23289 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
23290 * ARM:: ARM
23291 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
23292 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
23293 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
23294 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
23295 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
23296 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
23297 * CRIS:: CRIS
23298 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
23299 @end menu
23300
23301 @node ARC
23302 @subsection Synopsys ARC
23303 @cindex Synopsys ARC
23304 @cindex ARC specific commands
23305 @cindex ARC600
23306 @cindex ARC700
23307 @cindex ARC EM
23308 @cindex ARC HS
23309
23310 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
23311
23312 @table @code
23313 @item set debug arc
23314 @kindex set debug arc
23315 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
23316 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
23317
23318 @item show debug arc
23319 @kindex show debug arc
23320 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
23321
23322 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
23323 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
23324 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
23325
23326 @end table
23327
23328 @node ARM
23329 @subsection ARM
23330
23331 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
23332
23333 @table @code
23334 @item set arm disassembler
23335 @kindex set arm
23336 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
23337 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
23338
23339 @item show arm disassembler
23340 @kindex show arm
23341 Show the current disassembly style.
23342
23343 @item set arm apcs32
23344 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
23345 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
23346
23347 @item show arm apcs32
23348 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
23349
23350 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
23351 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
23352 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
23353
23354 @table @code
23355 @item auto
23356 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
23357 @item softfpa
23358 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
23359 processors.
23360 @item fpa
23361 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
23362 @item softvfp
23363 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
23364 @item vfp
23365 VFP co-processor.
23366 @end table
23367
23368 @item show arm fpu
23369 Show the current type of the FPU.
23370
23371 @item set arm abi
23372 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
23373
23374 @item show arm abi
23375 Show the currently used ABI.
23376
23377 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23378 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
23379 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
23380 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
23381 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
23382 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
23383 register).
23384
23385 @item show arm fallback-mode
23386 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
23387
23388 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23389 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
23390 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
23391 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
23392 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
23393
23394 @item show arm force-mode
23395 Show the current forced instruction mode.
23396
23397 @item set debug arm
23398 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
23399 target support subsystem.
23400
23401 @item show debug arm
23402 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23403 @end table
23404
23405 @table @code
23406 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
23407 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
23408
23409 @table @code
23410 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
23411 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
23412 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
23413 The default value is @code{all}.
23414
23415 @table @code
23416 @item none
23417 @item demon
23418 @item angel
23419 @item redboot
23420 @item all
23421 @end table
23422 @end table
23423 @end table
23424
23425 @node M68K
23426 @subsection M68k
23427
23428 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
23429
23430 @node MicroBlaze
23431 @subsection MicroBlaze
23432 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
23433 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
23434
23435 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
23436 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
23437 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
23438 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
23439 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
23440 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
23441 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
23442 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
23443 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
23444 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
23445 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
23446
23447 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
23448
23449 @table @code
23450 @item target remote :1234
23451 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
23452 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
23453
23454 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
23455 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
23456 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
23457
23458 @item load
23459 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
23460
23461 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
23462 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
23463
23464 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
23465 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
23466 @end table
23467
23468 @node MIPS Embedded
23469 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
23470
23471 @noindent
23472 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
23473
23474 @table @code
23475 @item set mipsfpu double
23476 @itemx set mipsfpu single
23477 @itemx set mipsfpu none
23478 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
23479 @itemx show mipsfpu
23480 @kindex set mipsfpu
23481 @kindex show mipsfpu
23482 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
23483 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
23484 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
23485 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
23486 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
23487 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
23488 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
23489 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
23490 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
23491 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
23492 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
23493 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
23494 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
23495
23496 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
23497 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
23498 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
23499
23500 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
23501 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
23502 @end table
23503
23504 @node OpenRISC 1000
23505 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
23506 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
23507
23508 @noindent
23509 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
23510 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
23511 FPGA's.
23512
23513 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
23514 a target:
23515
23516 @table @code
23517
23518 @kindex target sim
23519 @item target sim
23520
23521 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
23522 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
23523 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
23524 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
23525
23526 Example: @code{target sim}
23527
23528 @item set debug or1k
23529 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
23530 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
23531
23532 @item show debug or1k
23533 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23534 @end table
23535
23536 @node PowerPC Embedded
23537 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
23538
23539 @cindex DVC register
23540 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
23541 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
23542
23543 @smallexample
23544 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
23545 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
23546 @end smallexample
23547
23548 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
23549 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
23550 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
23551 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
23552 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
23553 or newer.
23554
23555 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
23556 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
23557 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
23558 watching variables of scalar types.
23559
23560 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
23561 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
23562
23563 @smallexample
23564 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
23565 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
23566 @end smallexample
23567
23568 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
23569 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
23570
23571 @cindex ranged breakpoint
23572 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
23573 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
23574 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
23575 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
23576 use the @code{break-range} command.
23577
23578 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
23579
23580 @table @code
23581 @kindex break-range
23582 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
23583 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
23584 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
23585 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
23586 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
23587 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
23588 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
23589 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
23590 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
23591
23592 @kindex set powerpc
23593 @item set powerpc soft-float
23594 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
23595 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
23596 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
23597 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23598
23599 @item set powerpc vector-abi
23600 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
23601 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
23602 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
23603 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
23604 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
23605 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
23606 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23607
23608 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
23609 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
23610 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
23611 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
23612 address of its first byte.
23613
23614 @end table
23615
23616 @node AVR
23617 @subsection Atmel AVR
23618 @cindex AVR
23619
23620 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
23621 following AVR-specific commands:
23622
23623 @table @code
23624 @item info io_registers
23625 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
23626 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
23627 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
23628 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
23629 @end table
23630
23631 @node CRIS
23632 @subsection CRIS
23633 @cindex CRIS
23634
23635 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
23636 following CRIS-specific commands:
23637
23638 @table @code
23639 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
23640 @cindex CRIS version
23641 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
23642 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
23643 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
23644
23645 @item show cris-version
23646 Show the current CRIS version.
23647
23648 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
23649 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
23650 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
23651 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
23652 @code{R59}.
23653
23654 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
23655 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
23656
23657 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
23658 @cindex CRIS mode
23659 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
23660 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
23661 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
23662
23663 @item show cris-mode
23664 Show the current CRIS mode.
23665 @end table
23666
23667 @node Super-H
23668 @subsection Renesas Super-H
23669 @cindex Super-H
23670
23671 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
23672 commands:
23673
23674 @table @code
23675 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
23676 @kindex set sh calling-convention
23677 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
23678 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
23679 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
23680 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
23681 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
23682 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
23683 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
23684 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
23685 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
23686 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
23687
23688 @item show sh calling-convention
23689 @kindex show sh calling-convention
23690 Show the current calling convention setting.
23691
23692 @end table
23693
23694
23695 @node Architectures
23696 @section Architectures
23697
23698 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
23699 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
23700
23701 @menu
23702 * AArch64::
23703 * i386::
23704 * Alpha::
23705 * MIPS::
23706 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
23707 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23708 * PowerPC::
23709 * Nios II::
23710 * Sparc64::
23711 * S12Z::
23712 @end menu
23713
23714 @node AArch64
23715 @subsection AArch64
23716 @cindex AArch64 support
23717
23718 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
23719 following special commands:
23720
23721 @table @code
23722 @item set debug aarch64
23723 @kindex set debug aarch64
23724 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
23725 messages are to be displayed.
23726
23727 @item show debug aarch64
23728 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
23729
23730 @end table
23731
23732 @subsubsection AArch64 SVE.
23733 @cindex AArch64 SVE.
23734
23735 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, if the Scalable Vector
23736 Extension (SVE) is present, then @value{GDBN} will provide the vector registers
23737 @code{$z0} through @code{$z31}, vector predicate registers @code{$p0} through
23738 @code{$p15}, and the @code{$ffr} register. In addition, the pseudo register
23739 @code{$vg} will be provided. This is the vector granule for the current thread
23740 and represents the number of 64-bit chunks in an SVE @code{z} register.
23741
23742 If the vector length changes, then the @code{$vg} register will be updated,
23743 but the lengths of the @code{z} and @code{p} registers will not change. This
23744 is a known limitation of @value{GDBN} and does not affect the execution of the
23745 target process.
23746
23747
23748 @node i386
23749 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
23750
23751 @table @code
23752 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
23753 @kindex set struct-convention
23754 @cindex struct return convention
23755 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
23756 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
23757 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
23758 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
23759 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
23760 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
23761 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
23762 be returned in a register.
23763
23764 @item show struct-convention
23765 @kindex show struct-convention
23766 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
23767 from functions.
23768 @end table
23769
23770
23771 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
23772 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
23773
23774 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
23775 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
23776 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
23777 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
23778 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
23779 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
23780 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
23781
23782 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
23783 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
23784 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
23785 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
23786 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
23787 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
23788
23789 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
23790 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
23791 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
23792
23793 @smallexample
23794 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
23795 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
23796 @end smallexample
23797
23798 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
23799 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
23800 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
23801 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
23802 the pointer.
23803
23804 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
23805 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
23806 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
23807 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
23808 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
23809
23810 @table @code
23811 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
23812 @kindex show mpx bound
23813 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
23814
23815 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
23816 @kindex set mpx bound
23817 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
23818 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
23819 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
23820 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
23821 @end table
23822
23823 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
23824 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
23825 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
23826 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
23827
23828 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
23829 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
23830 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
23831 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
23832 function.
23833
23834 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
23835 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
23836 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
23837 continuing the execution. For example:
23838
23839 @smallexample
23840 $ break *upper
23841 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
23842 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
23843 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
23844 $ print $bnd0
23845 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
23846 @end smallexample
23847
23848 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
23849 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
23850 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
23851
23852 @node Alpha
23853 @subsection Alpha
23854
23855 See the following section.
23856
23857 @node MIPS
23858 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
23859
23860 @cindex stack on Alpha
23861 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
23862 @cindex Alpha stack
23863 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
23864 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
23865 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
23866 find the beginning of a function.
23867
23868 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
23869 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
23870 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
23871 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
23872 commands:
23873
23874 @table @code
23875 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
23876 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
23877 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
23878 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
23879 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
23880 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
23881 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
23882 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
23883
23884 @item show heuristic-fence-post
23885 Display the current limit.
23886 @end table
23887
23888 @noindent
23889 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
23890 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
23891
23892 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
23893 programs:
23894
23895 @table @code
23896 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
23897 @kindex set mips abi
23898 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
23899 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
23900 values of @var{arg} are:
23901
23902 @table @samp
23903 @item auto
23904 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
23905 default).
23906 @item o32
23907 @item o64
23908 @item n32
23909 @item n64
23910 @item eabi32
23911 @item eabi64
23912 @end table
23913
23914 @item show mips abi
23915 @kindex show mips abi
23916 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23917
23918 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
23919 @kindex set mips compression
23920 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
23921 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
23922 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
23923 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
23924 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
23925 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
23926 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
23927 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
23928 provided by the executable.
23929
23930 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
23931 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
23932 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
23933 identified as such.
23934
23935 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
23936 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
23937 implicitly from an executable.
23938
23939 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
23940 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
23941 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
23942 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
23943 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
23944
23945 @item show mips compression
23946 @kindex show mips compression
23947 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
23948 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23949
23950 @item set mipsfpu
23951 @itemx show mipsfpu
23952 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
23953
23954 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
23955 @kindex set mips mask-address
23956 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
23957 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
23958 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
23959 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
23960 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
23961
23962 @item show mips mask-address
23963 @kindex show mips mask-address
23964 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
23965 not.
23966
23967 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23968 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23969 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
23970 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
23971 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
23972 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
23973
23974 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23975 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23976 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
23977
23978 @item set debug mips
23979 @kindex set debug mips
23980 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
23981 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23982
23983 @item show debug mips
23984 @kindex show debug mips
23985 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
23986 @end table
23987
23988
23989 @node HPPA
23990 @subsection HPPA
23991 @cindex HPPA support
23992
23993 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
23994 following special commands:
23995
23996 @table @code
23997 @item set debug hppa
23998 @kindex set debug hppa
23999 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
24000 messages are to be displayed.
24001
24002 @item show debug hppa
24003 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
24004
24005 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
24006 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
24007 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
24008 given @var{address}.
24009
24010 @end table
24011
24012
24013 @node SPU
24014 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
24015 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
24016 @cindex SPU
24017
24018 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
24019 it provides the following special commands:
24020
24021 @table @code
24022 @item info spu event
24023 @kindex info spu
24024 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
24025 and pending event status.
24026
24027 @item info spu signal
24028 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
24029 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
24030 notification channels.
24031
24032 @item info spu mailbox
24033 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
24034 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
24035 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
24036
24037 @item info spu dma
24038 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
24039 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
24040 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
24041
24042 @item info spu proxydma
24043 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
24044 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
24045 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
24046
24047 @end table
24048
24049 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
24050 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
24051 special commands:
24052
24053 @table @code
24054 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
24055 @kindex set spu
24056 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
24057 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
24058 function. The default is @code{off}.
24059
24060 @item show spu stop-on-load
24061 @kindex show spu
24062 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
24063
24064 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
24065 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
24066 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
24067 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
24068 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
24069 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
24070
24071 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
24072 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
24073
24074 @end table
24075
24076 @node PowerPC
24077 @subsection PowerPC
24078 @cindex PowerPC architecture
24079
24080 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
24081 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
24082 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
24083 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
24084 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
24085
24086 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
24087 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
24088 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
24089
24090 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
24091 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
24092
24093 @node Nios II
24094 @subsection Nios II
24095 @cindex Nios II architecture
24096
24097 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
24098 it provides the following special commands:
24099
24100 @table @code
24101
24102 @item set debug nios2
24103 @kindex set debug nios2
24104 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
24105 target code in @value{GDBN}.
24106
24107 @item show debug nios2
24108 @kindex show debug nios2
24109 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
24110 @end table
24111
24112 @node Sparc64
24113 @subsection Sparc64
24114 @cindex Sparc64 support
24115 @cindex Application Data Integrity
24116 @subsubsection ADI Support
24117
24118 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
24119 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
24120 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
24121 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
24122 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
24123 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
24124 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
24125 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
24126 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
24127 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
24128 signal.
24129
24130 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
24131 ADI-enabled.
24132
24133 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
24134 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
24135
24136
24137 @table @code
24138 @kindex adi examine
24139 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
24140
24141 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
24142 cacheline.
24143
24144 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
24145 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
24146 block size, to display.
24147
24148 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24149 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
24150
24151 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
24152
24153 @smallexample
24154 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24155 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
24156 @end smallexample
24157
24158 @kindex adi assign
24159 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
24160
24161 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
24162 to an address.
24163
24164 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
24165 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
24166 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
24167
24168 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24169 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
24170
24171 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
24172
24173 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
24174 variable "shmaddr":
24175
24176 @smallexample
24177 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
24178 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24179 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
24180 @end smallexample
24181
24182 @end table
24183
24184 @node S12Z
24185 @subsection S12Z
24186 @cindex S12Z support
24187
24188 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the S12Z architecture,
24189 it provides the following special command:
24190
24191 @table @code
24192 @item maint info bdccsr
24193 @kindex maint info bdccsr@r{, S12Z}
24194 This command displays the current value of the microprocessor's
24195 BDCCSR register.
24196 @end table
24197
24198
24199 @node Controlling GDB
24200 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
24201
24202 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
24203 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
24204 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
24205 described here.
24206
24207 @menu
24208 * Prompt:: Prompt
24209 * Editing:: Command editing
24210 * Command History:: Command history
24211 * Screen Size:: Screen size
24212 * Output Styling:: Output styling
24213 * Numbers:: Numbers
24214 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
24215 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
24216 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
24217 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
24218 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
24219 @end menu
24220
24221 @node Prompt
24222 @section Prompt
24223
24224 @cindex prompt
24225
24226 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
24227 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
24228 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
24229 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
24230 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
24231 which one you are talking to.
24232
24233 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
24234 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
24235 or a prompt that does not.
24236
24237 @table @code
24238 @kindex set prompt
24239 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
24240 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
24241
24242 @kindex show prompt
24243 @item show prompt
24244 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
24245 @end table
24246
24247 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
24248 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
24249 are:
24250
24251 @table @code
24252 @kindex set extended-prompt
24253 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
24254 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
24255 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
24256 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
24257 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
24258 is displayed.
24259
24260 For example:
24261
24262 @smallexample
24263 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
24264 @end smallexample
24265
24266 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
24267 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
24268
24269 @kindex show extended-prompt
24270 @item show extended-prompt
24271 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
24272 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
24273 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
24274 @end table
24275
24276 @node Editing
24277 @section Command Editing
24278 @cindex readline
24279 @cindex command line editing
24280
24281 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
24282 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
24283 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
24284 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
24285 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
24286 debugging sessions.
24287
24288 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
24289 command @code{set}.
24290
24291 @table @code
24292 @kindex set editing
24293 @cindex editing
24294 @item set editing
24295 @itemx set editing on
24296 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
24297
24298 @item set editing off
24299 Disable command line editing.
24300
24301 @kindex show editing
24302 @item show editing
24303 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
24304 @end table
24305
24306 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24307 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
24308 @end ifset
24309 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24310 @xref{Command Line Editing},
24311 @end ifclear
24312 for more details about the Readline
24313 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
24314 encouraged to read that chapter.
24315
24316 @node Command History
24317 @section Command History
24318 @cindex command history
24319
24320 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
24321 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
24322 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
24323 history facility.
24324
24325 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
24326 package, to provide the history facility.
24327 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24328 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
24329 @end ifset
24330 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24331 @xref{Using History Interactively},
24332 @end ifclear
24333 for the detailed description of the History library.
24334
24335 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
24336 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
24337 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
24338 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
24339 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
24340 pressed on a line by itself.
24341
24342 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
24343 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
24344 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
24345 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
24346
24347 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
24348 history.
24349
24350 @table @code
24351 @cindex history substitution
24352 @cindex history file
24353 @kindex set history filename
24354 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
24355 @item set history filename @var{fname}
24356 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
24357 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
24358 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
24359 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
24360 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
24361 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
24362 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
24363 is not set.
24364
24365 @cindex save command history
24366 @kindex set history save
24367 @item set history save
24368 @itemx set history save on
24369 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
24370 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
24371
24372 @item set history save off
24373 Stop recording command history in a file.
24374
24375 @cindex history size
24376 @kindex set history size
24377 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
24378 @item set history size @var{size}
24379 @itemx set history size unlimited
24380 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
24381 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
24382 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
24383 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
24384 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
24385 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
24386
24387 @cindex remove duplicate history
24388 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
24389 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
24390 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
24391 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
24392 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
24393 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
24394 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
24395 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
24396 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
24397
24398 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
24399 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
24400
24401 @end table
24402
24403 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
24404 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24405 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
24406 @end ifset
24407 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24408 @xref{Event Designators},
24409 @end ifclear
24410 for more details.
24411
24412 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
24413 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
24414 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
24415 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
24416 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
24417 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
24418 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
24419 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
24420
24421 The commands to control history expansion are:
24422
24423 @table @code
24424 @item set history expansion on
24425 @itemx set history expansion
24426 @kindex set history expansion
24427 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
24428
24429 @item set history expansion off
24430 Disable history expansion.
24431
24432 @c @group
24433 @kindex show history
24434 @item show history
24435 @itemx show history filename
24436 @itemx show history save
24437 @itemx show history size
24438 @itemx show history expansion
24439 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
24440 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
24441 @c @end group
24442 @end table
24443
24444 @table @code
24445 @kindex show commands
24446 @cindex show last commands
24447 @cindex display command history
24448 @item show commands
24449 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
24450
24451 @item show commands @var{n}
24452 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
24453
24454 @item show commands +
24455 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
24456 @end table
24457
24458 @node Screen Size
24459 @section Screen Size
24460 @cindex size of screen
24461 @cindex screen size
24462 @cindex pagination
24463 @cindex page size
24464 @cindex pauses in output
24465
24466 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
24467 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
24468 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
24469 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
24470 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
24471 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
24472 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
24473 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
24474 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
24475 following line.
24476
24477 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
24478 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
24479 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
24480 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
24481 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
24482 width} commands:
24483
24484 @table @code
24485 @kindex set height
24486 @kindex set width
24487 @kindex show width
24488 @kindex show height
24489 @item set height @var{lpp}
24490 @itemx set height unlimited
24491 @itemx show height
24492 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
24493 @itemx set width unlimited
24494 @itemx show width
24495 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
24496 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
24497 commands display the current settings.
24498
24499 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
24500 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
24501 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
24502 buffer.
24503
24504 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
24505 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
24506
24507 @item set pagination on
24508 @itemx set pagination off
24509 @kindex set pagination
24510 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
24511 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
24512 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
24513 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
24514
24515 @item show pagination
24516 @kindex show pagination
24517 Show the current pagination mode.
24518 @end table
24519
24520 @node Output Styling
24521 @section Output Styling
24522 @cindex styling
24523 @cindex colors
24524
24525 @kindex set style
24526 @kindex show style
24527 @value{GDBN} can style its output on a capable terminal. This is
24528 enabled by default on most systems, but disabled by default when in
24529 batch mode (@pxref{Mode Options}). Various style settings are available;
24530 and styles can also be disabled entirely.
24531
24532 @table @code
24533 @item set style enabled @samp{on|off}
24534 Enable or disable all styling. The default is host-dependent, with
24535 most hosts defaulting to @samp{on}.
24536
24537 @item show style enabled
24538 Show the current state of styling.
24539
24540 @item set style sources @samp{on|off}
24541 Enable or disable source code styling. This affects whether source
24542 code, such as the output of the @code{list} command, is styled. Note
24543 that source styling only works if styling in general is enabled, and
24544 if @value{GDBN} was linked with the GNU Source Highlight library. The
24545 default is @samp{on}.
24546
24547 @item show style sources
24548 Show the current state of source code styling.
24549 @end table
24550
24551 Subcommands of @code{set style} control specific forms of styling.
24552 These subcommands all follow the same pattern: each style-able object
24553 can be styled with a foreground color, a background color, and an
24554 intensity.
24555
24556 For example, the style of file names can be controlled using the
24557 @code{set style filename} group of commands:
24558
24559 @table @code
24560 @item set style filename background @var{color}
24561 Set the background to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
24562 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
24563 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{blue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
24564 and@samp{white}.
24565
24566 @item set style filename foreground @var{color}
24567 Set the foreground to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
24568 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
24569 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{blue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
24570 and@samp{white}.
24571
24572 @item set style filename intensity @var{value}
24573 Set the intensity to @var{value}. Valid intensities are @samp{normal}
24574 (the default), @samp{bold}, and @samp{dim}.
24575 @end table
24576
24577 The style-able objects are:
24578 @table @code
24579 @item filename
24580 Control the styling of file names. By default, this style's
24581 foreground color is green.
24582
24583 @item function
24584 Control the styling of function names. These are managed with the
24585 @code{set style function} family of commands. By default, this
24586 style's foreground color is yellow.
24587
24588 @item variable
24589 Control the styling of variable names. These are managed with the
24590 @code{set style variable} family of commands. By default, this style's
24591 foreground color is cyan.
24592
24593 @item address
24594 Control the styling of addresses. These are managed with the
24595 @code{set style address} family of commands. By default, this style's
24596 foreground color is blue.
24597 @end table
24598
24599 @node Numbers
24600 @section Numbers
24601 @cindex number representation
24602 @cindex entering numbers
24603
24604 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
24605 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
24606 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
24607 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
24608 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
24609 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
24610 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
24611 both input and output with the commands described below.
24612
24613 @table @code
24614 @kindex set input-radix
24615 @item set input-radix @var{base}
24616 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
24617 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24618 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
24619 example, any of
24620
24621 @smallexample
24622 set input-radix 012
24623 set input-radix 10.
24624 set input-radix 0xa
24625 @end smallexample
24626
24627 @noindent
24628 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
24629 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
24630 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
24631 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
24632 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
24633 change the radix.
24634
24635 @kindex set output-radix
24636 @item set output-radix @var{base}
24637 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
24638 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24639 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
24640
24641 @kindex show input-radix
24642 @item show input-radix
24643 Display the current default base for numeric input.
24644
24645 @kindex show output-radix
24646 @item show output-radix
24647 Display the current default base for numeric display.
24648
24649 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
24650 @itemx show radix
24651 @kindex set radix
24652 @kindex show radix
24653 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
24654 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
24655 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
24656 default value of 10.
24657
24658 @end table
24659
24660 @node ABI
24661 @section Configuring the Current ABI
24662
24663 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
24664 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
24665 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
24666 current ABI.
24667
24668 @cindex OS ABI
24669 @kindex set osabi
24670 @kindex show osabi
24671 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
24672
24673 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
24674 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
24675 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
24676 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
24677 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
24678 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
24679 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
24680 platform provides.
24681
24682 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
24683 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
24684 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
24685 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
24686
24687 @table @code
24688 @item show osabi
24689 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
24690
24691 @item set osabi
24692 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
24693
24694 @item set osabi @var{abi}
24695 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
24696 @end table
24697
24698 @cindex float promotion
24699
24700 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
24701 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
24702 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
24703 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
24704 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
24705 @code{double} and then passed.
24706
24707 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
24708 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
24709 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
24710
24711 @table @code
24712 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
24713 @item set coerce-float-to-double
24714 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
24715 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
24716 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
24717
24718 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
24719 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
24720 functions.
24721
24722 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
24723 @item show coerce-float-to-double
24724 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
24725 @end table
24726
24727 @kindex set cp-abi
24728 @kindex show cp-abi
24729 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
24730 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
24731 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
24732 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
24733 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
24734 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
24735 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
24736 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
24737 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
24738 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
24739 ``auto''.
24740
24741 @table @code
24742 @item show cp-abi
24743 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
24744
24745 @item set cp-abi
24746 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
24747
24748 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
24749 @itemx set cp-abi auto
24750 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
24751 @end table
24752
24753 @node Auto-loading
24754 @section Automatically loading associated files
24755 @cindex auto-loading
24756
24757 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
24758 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
24759 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
24760 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
24761 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
24762 sources).
24763
24764 @menu
24765 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24766 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
24767
24768 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
24769 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
24770 @end menu
24771
24772 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
24773 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
24774 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24775
24776 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
24777 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
24778 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24779
24780 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
24781 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
24782
24783 @table @code
24784 @anchor{set auto-load off}
24785 @kindex set auto-load off
24786 @item set auto-load off
24787 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
24788 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
24789 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
24790 @smallexample
24791 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
24792 @end smallexample
24793
24794 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
24795 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
24796 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
24797 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
24798 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
24799 @code{set auto-load no}.
24800
24801 @anchor{show auto-load}
24802 @kindex show auto-load
24803 @item show auto-load
24804 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
24805 or disabled.
24806
24807 @smallexample
24808 (gdb) show auto-load
24809 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
24810 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
24811 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
24812 is on.
24813 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
24814 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24815 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24816 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
24817 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24818 @end smallexample
24819
24820 @anchor{info auto-load}
24821 @kindex info auto-load
24822 @item info auto-load
24823 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
24824 not.
24825
24826 @smallexample
24827 (gdb) info auto-load
24828 gdb-scripts:
24829 Loaded Script
24830 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
24831 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
24832 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
24833 loaded.
24834 python-scripts:
24835 Loaded Script
24836 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
24837 @end smallexample
24838 @end table
24839
24840 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
24841
24842 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
24843 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
24844 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
24845 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
24846 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
24847 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
24848 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
24849 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24850 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24851 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24852 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24853 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24854 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24855 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
24856 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24857 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
24858 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24859 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
24860 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24861 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
24862 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24863 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
24864 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24865 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
24866 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24867 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24868 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24869 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
24870 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24871 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
24872 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
24873 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24874 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
24875 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24876 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
24877 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24878 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
24879 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
24880 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
24881 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
24882 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
24883 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
24884 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
24885 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
24886 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
24887 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
24888 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
24889 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
24890 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
24891 @end multitable
24892
24893 @node Init File in the Current Directory
24894 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
24895 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
24896
24897 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
24898 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
24899 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
24900
24901 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
24902 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24903
24904 @table @code
24905 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
24906 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
24907 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
24908 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
24909 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
24910
24911 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
24912 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
24913 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
24914 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24915 current directory is enabled or disabled.
24916
24917 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24918 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
24919 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
24920 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24921 current directory have been auto-loaded.
24922 @end table
24923
24924 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
24925 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
24926 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
24927
24928 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
24929
24930 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
24931 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
24932
24933 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
24934 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
24935 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
24936 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
24937 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
24938 library.
24939
24940 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
24941 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24942
24943 @table @code
24944 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
24945 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
24946 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
24947 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
24948
24949 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
24950 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
24951 @item show auto-load libthread-db
24952 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
24953 enabled or disabled.
24954
24955 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
24956 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
24957 @item info auto-load libthread-db
24958 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
24959 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
24960 @end table
24961
24962 @node Auto-loading safe path
24963 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
24964 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
24965
24966 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
24967 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
24968 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
24969 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
24970 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
24971
24972 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
24973 get loaded:
24974
24975 @smallexample
24976 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
24977 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
24978 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
24979 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24980 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24981 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
24982 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24983 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24984 @end smallexample
24985
24986 @noindent
24987 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
24988 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
24989
24990 @smallexample
24991 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
24992 @end smallexample
24993
24994 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
24995
24996 @table @code
24997 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
24998 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
24999 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25000 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
25001 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
25002 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
25003 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
25004 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
25005 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
25006 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
25007
25008 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25009 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25010 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25011
25012 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
25013 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
25014 @item show auto-load safe-path
25015 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
25016 scripts.
25017
25018 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
25019 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
25020 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
25021 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
25022 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
25023 by the host platform path separator in use.
25024 @end table
25025
25026 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
25027 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
25028 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
25029 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
25030 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
25031
25032 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
25033 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
25034 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
25035 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
25036 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
25037 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
25038 init file in the current directory
25039 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
25040
25041 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
25042 example, you could use one of the following ways:
25043
25044 @table @asis
25045 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
25046 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
25047 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
25048 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
25049
25050 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
25051 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
25052 @value{GDBN} session.
25053
25054 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
25055 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
25056 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
25057 from trusted sources.
25058
25059 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
25060 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
25061 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
25062 trusted sources.
25063 @end table
25064
25065 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
25066 also suppresses any such warning messages:
25067
25068 @table @asis
25069 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
25070 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
25071
25072 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
25073 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
25074 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
25075 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
25076 @end table
25077
25078 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
25079 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
25080 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
25081 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
25082 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
25083 recommended to be entered.
25084
25085 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
25086 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
25087 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
25088
25089 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
25090 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
25091 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
25092 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
25093 be printed.
25094
25095 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
25096 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
25097 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
25098
25099 @smallexample
25100 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
25101 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
25102 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
25103 for objfile "/tmp/true".
25104 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
25105 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
25106 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
25107 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
25108 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
25109 @end smallexample
25110
25111 @table @code
25112 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
25113 @kindex set debug auto-load
25114 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
25115 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
25116
25117 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
25118 @kindex show debug auto-load
25119 @item show debug auto-load
25120 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
25121 on or off.
25122 @end table
25123
25124 @node Messages/Warnings
25125 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
25126
25127 @cindex verbose operation
25128 @cindex optional warnings
25129 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
25130 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
25131 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
25132 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
25133
25134 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
25135 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
25136 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25137
25138 @table @code
25139 @kindex set verbose
25140 @item set verbose on
25141 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25142
25143 @item set verbose off
25144 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25145
25146 @kindex show verbose
25147 @item show verbose
25148 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
25149 @end table
25150
25151 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
25152 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
25153 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
25154 Symbol Files}).
25155
25156 @table @code
25157
25158 @kindex set complaints
25159 @item set complaints @var{limit}
25160 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
25161 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
25162 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
25163 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
25164
25165 @kindex show complaints
25166 @item show complaints
25167 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
25168
25169 @end table
25170
25171 @anchor{confirmation requests}
25172 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
25173 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
25174 you try to run a program which is already running:
25175
25176 @smallexample
25177 (@value{GDBP}) run
25178 The program being debugged has been started already.
25179 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
25180 @end smallexample
25181
25182 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
25183 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
25184
25185 @table @code
25186
25187 @kindex set confirm
25188 @cindex flinching
25189 @cindex confirmation
25190 @cindex stupid questions
25191 @item set confirm off
25192 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
25193 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
25194 automatically disables confirmation requests.
25195
25196 @item set confirm on
25197 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
25198
25199 @kindex show confirm
25200 @item show confirm
25201 Displays state of confirmation requests.
25202
25203 @end table
25204
25205 @cindex command tracing
25206 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
25207 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
25208 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
25209 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
25210
25211 @table @code
25212 @kindex set trace-commands
25213 @cindex command scripts, debugging
25214 @item set trace-commands on
25215 Enable command tracing.
25216 @item set trace-commands off
25217 Disable command tracing.
25218 @item show trace-commands
25219 Display the current state of command tracing.
25220 @end table
25221
25222 @node Debugging Output
25223 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
25224 @cindex optional debugging messages
25225
25226 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
25227 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
25228 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
25229 section documents those commands.
25230
25231 @table @code
25232 @kindex set exec-done-display
25233 @item set exec-done-display
25234 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
25235 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
25236 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
25237 @kindex show exec-done-display
25238 @item show exec-done-display
25239 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
25240 notification.
25241 @kindex set debug
25242 @cindex ARM AArch64
25243 @item set debug aarch64
25244 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
25245 The default is off.
25246 @kindex show debug
25247 @item show debug aarch64
25248 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25249 ARM AArch64.
25250 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
25251 @cindex architecture debugging info
25252 @item set debug arch
25253 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
25254 @item show debug arch
25255 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
25256 @item set debug aix-solib
25257 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
25258 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
25259 support module. The default is off.
25260 @item show debug aix-thread
25261 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
25262 @item set debug aix-thread
25263 @cindex AIX threads
25264 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
25265 module.
25266 @item show debug aix-thread
25267 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
25268 @item set debug check-physname
25269 @cindex physname
25270 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
25271 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
25272 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
25273 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
25274 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
25275 both ways and display any discrepancies.
25276 @item show debug check-physname
25277 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
25278 @item set debug coff-pe-read
25279 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
25280 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
25281 exported symbols. The default is off.
25282 @item show debug coff-pe-read
25283 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25284 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25285 @item set debug dwarf-die
25286 @cindex DWARF DIEs
25287 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
25288 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
25289 A value of zero turns off the display.
25290 @item show debug dwarf-die
25291 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
25292 @item set debug dwarf-line
25293 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
25294 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25295 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
25296 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25297 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25298 @item show debug dwarf-line
25299 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
25300 @item set debug dwarf-read
25301 @cindex DWARF Reading
25302 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25303 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
25304 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25305 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25306 @item show debug dwarf-read
25307 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
25308 @item set debug displaced
25309 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
25310 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
25311 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
25312 @item show debug displaced
25313 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
25314 related to displaced stepping.
25315 @item set debug event
25316 @cindex event debugging info
25317 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
25318 default is off.
25319 @item show debug event
25320 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
25321 info.
25322 @item set debug expression
25323 @cindex expression debugging info
25324 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
25325 expression parsing. The default is off.
25326 @item show debug expression
25327 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
25328 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
25329 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
25330 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
25331 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
25332 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
25333 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
25334 @item set debug fbsd-nat
25335 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
25336 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
25337 @item show debug fbsd-nat
25338 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
25339 @item set debug frame
25340 @cindex frame debugging info
25341 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
25342 default is off.
25343 @item show debug frame
25344 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
25345 info.
25346 @item set debug gnu-nat
25347 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
25348 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
25349 @item show debug gnu-nat
25350 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
25351 @item set debug infrun
25352 @cindex inferior debugging info
25353 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
25354 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
25355 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
25356 @item show debug infrun
25357 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
25358 @item set debug jit
25359 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
25360 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
25361 @item show debug jit
25362 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
25363 @item set debug lin-lwp
25364 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
25365 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
25366 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
25367 @item show debug lin-lwp
25368 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
25369 @item set debug linux-namespaces
25370 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
25371 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
25372 @item show debug linux-namespaces
25373 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
25374 @item set debug mach-o
25375 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
25376 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
25377 processing. The default is off.
25378 @item show debug mach-o
25379 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25380 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25381 @item set debug notification
25382 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
25383 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
25384 The default is off.
25385 @item show debug notification
25386 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
25387 @item set debug observer
25388 @cindex observer debugging info
25389 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
25390 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
25391 @item show debug observer
25392 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
25393 @item set debug overload
25394 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
25395 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
25396 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
25397 is off.
25398 @item show debug overload
25399 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
25400 debugging info.
25401 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
25402 @cindex debug expression parser
25403 @item set debug parser
25404 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
25405 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
25406 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
25407 details. The default is off.
25408 @item show debug parser
25409 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
25410 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
25411 @cindex serial connections, debugging
25412 @cindex debug remote protocol
25413 @cindex remote protocol debugging
25414 @cindex display remote packets
25415 @item set debug remote
25416 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
25417 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
25418 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
25419 @item show debug remote
25420 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
25421
25422 @item set debug separate-debug-file
25423 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
25424 @item show debug separate-debug-file
25425 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
25426
25427 @item set debug serial
25428 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
25429 default is off.
25430 @item show debug serial
25431 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
25432 info.
25433 @item set debug solib-frv
25434 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
25435 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
25436 @item show debug solib-frv
25437 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
25438 messages.
25439 @item set debug symbol-lookup
25440 @cindex symbol lookup
25441 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
25442 The default is 0 (off).
25443 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25444 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25445 @item show debug symbol-lookup
25446 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
25447 @item set debug symfile
25448 @cindex symbol file functions
25449 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
25450 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
25451 @item show debug symfile
25452 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
25453 @item set debug symtab-create
25454 @cindex symbol table creation
25455 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
25456 The default is 0 (off).
25457 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25458 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25459 @item show debug symtab-create
25460 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
25461 @item set debug target
25462 @cindex target debugging info
25463 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
25464 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
25465 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
25466 value of large memory transfers.
25467 @item show debug target
25468 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
25469 info.
25470 @item set debug timestamp
25471 @cindex timestampping debugging info
25472 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
25473 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
25474 message.
25475 @item show debug timestamp
25476 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
25477 debugging info.
25478 @item set debug varobj
25479 @cindex variable object debugging info
25480 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
25481 info. The default is off.
25482 @item show debug varobj
25483 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
25484 debugging info.
25485 @item set debug xml
25486 @cindex XML parser debugging
25487 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
25488 @item show debug xml
25489 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
25490 @end table
25491
25492 @node Other Misc Settings
25493 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
25494 @cindex miscellaneous settings
25495
25496 @table @code
25497 @kindex set interactive-mode
25498 @item set interactive-mode
25499 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
25500 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
25501 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
25502 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
25503 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
25504 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
25505 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
25506 is, non-interactively otherwise.
25507
25508 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
25509 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
25510 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
25511 inside a cygwin window.
25512
25513 @kindex show interactive-mode
25514 @item show interactive-mode
25515 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
25516 @end table
25517
25518 @node Extending GDB
25519 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
25520 @cindex extending GDB
25521
25522 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
25523 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
25524 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
25525 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
25526 being debugged.
25527
25528 @menu
25529 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
25530 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
25531 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
25532 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
25533 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
25534 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
25535 @end menu
25536
25537 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
25538 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
25539 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
25540 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
25541 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25542 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
25543
25544 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
25545 setting:
25546
25547 @table @code
25548 @kindex set script-extension
25549 @kindex show script-extension
25550 @item set script-extension off
25551 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25552
25553 @item set script-extension soft
25554 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25555 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
25556 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
25557 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
25558
25559 @item set script-extension strict
25560 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25561 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
25562 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
25563
25564 @item show script-extension
25565 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
25566
25567 @end table
25568
25569 @node Sequences
25570 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
25571
25572 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
25573 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
25574 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
25575 files.
25576
25577 @menu
25578 * Define:: How to define your own commands
25579 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
25580 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
25581 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
25582 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
25583 @end menu
25584
25585 @node Define
25586 @subsection User-defined Commands
25587
25588 @cindex user-defined command
25589 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
25590 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
25591 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
25592 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
25593 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
25594 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
25595
25596 @smallexample
25597 define adder
25598 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25599 end
25600 @end smallexample
25601
25602 @noindent
25603 To execute the command use:
25604
25605 @smallexample
25606 adder 1 2 3
25607 @end smallexample
25608
25609 @noindent
25610 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
25611 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
25612 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
25613 functions calls.
25614
25615 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
25616 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
25617 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
25618 been passed.
25619
25620 @smallexample
25621 define adder
25622 if $argc == 2
25623 print $arg0 + $arg1
25624 end
25625 if $argc == 3
25626 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25627 end
25628 end
25629 @end smallexample
25630
25631 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
25632 to process a variable number of arguments:
25633
25634 @smallexample
25635 define adder
25636 set $i = 0
25637 set $sum = 0
25638 while $i < $argc
25639 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
25640 set $i = $i + 1
25641 end
25642 print $sum
25643 end
25644 @end smallexample
25645
25646 @table @code
25647
25648 @kindex define
25649 @item define @var{commandname}
25650 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
25651 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
25652 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
25653 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
25654 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
25655 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
25656
25657 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
25658 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
25659 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25660
25661 @kindex document
25662 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
25663 @item document @var{commandname}
25664 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
25665 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
25666 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
25667 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
25668 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
25669 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
25670
25671 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
25672 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
25673 does not change the documentation.
25674
25675 @kindex dont-repeat
25676 @cindex don't repeat command
25677 @item dont-repeat
25678 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
25679 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
25680 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
25681
25682 @kindex help user-defined
25683 @item help user-defined
25684 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
25685 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
25686 included (if any).
25687
25688 @kindex show user
25689 @item show user
25690 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
25691 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
25692 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
25693 definitions for all user-defined commands.
25694 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
25695
25696 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
25697 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
25698 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
25699 @item show max-user-call-depth
25700 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
25701 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
25702 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
25703 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
25704 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
25705 @end table
25706
25707 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
25708 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
25709
25710 When user-defined commands are executed, the
25711 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
25712 stops execution of the user-defined command.
25713
25714 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
25715 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
25716 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
25717 messages when used in a user-defined command.
25718
25719 @node Hooks
25720 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
25721 @cindex command hooks
25722 @cindex hooks, for commands
25723 @cindex hooks, pre-command
25724
25725 @kindex hook
25726 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
25727 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
25728 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
25729 before that command.
25730
25731 @cindex hooks, post-command
25732 @kindex hookpost
25733 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
25734 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
25735 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
25736 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
25737 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
25738
25739 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
25740 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
25741
25742 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
25743 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
25744
25745 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
25746 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
25747 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
25748 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
25749 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
25750
25751 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
25752 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
25753 you could define:
25754
25755 @smallexample
25756 define hook-stop
25757 handle SIGALRM nopass
25758 end
25759
25760 define hook-run
25761 handle SIGALRM pass
25762 end
25763
25764 define hook-continue
25765 handle SIGALRM pass
25766 end
25767 @end smallexample
25768
25769 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
25770 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
25771 you could define:
25772
25773 @smallexample
25774 define hook-echo
25775 echo <<<---
25776 end
25777
25778 define hookpost-echo
25779 echo --->>>\n
25780 end
25781
25782 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
25783 <<<---Hello World--->>>
25784 (@value{GDBP})
25785
25786 @end smallexample
25787
25788 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
25789 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
25790 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
25791 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
25792 @c or not?
25793 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
25794 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
25795 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
25796
25797 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
25798 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
25799 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
25800
25801 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
25802 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
25803
25804 @node Command Files
25805 @subsection Command Files
25806
25807 @cindex command files
25808 @cindex scripting commands
25809 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
25810 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
25811 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
25812 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
25813 terminal.
25814
25815 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
25816 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
25817 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
25818 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
25819 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
25820
25821 @table @code
25822 @kindex source
25823 @cindex execute commands from a file
25824 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
25825 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
25826 @end table
25827
25828 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
25829 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
25830 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
25831 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
25832 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
25833
25834 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
25835 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
25836 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
25837 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
25838 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
25839 is not relevant to scripts.
25840
25841 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
25842 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
25843 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
25844 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
25845 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25846 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
25847 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
25848 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
25849 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25850 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
25851 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
25852 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
25853 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
25854 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
25855
25856 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
25857 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
25858 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
25859
25860 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
25861 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
25862 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
25863 when called from command files.
25864
25865 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
25866 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
25867 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
25868 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
25869 the next command.
25870
25871 @smallexample
25872 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
25873 @end smallexample
25874
25875 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
25876 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
25877 would be directed to @file{log}.
25878
25879 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
25880 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
25881 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
25882 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
25883 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
25884 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
25885 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
25886 conditionally, etc.
25887
25888 @table @code
25889 @kindex if
25890 @kindex else
25891 @item if
25892 @itemx else
25893 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
25894 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
25895 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
25896 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
25897 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
25898 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
25899 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25900
25901 @kindex while
25902 @item while
25903 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
25904 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
25905 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
25906 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
25907 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
25908 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
25909
25910 @kindex loop_break
25911 @item loop_break
25912 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
25913 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
25914 line.
25915
25916 @kindex loop_continue
25917 @item loop_continue
25918 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
25919 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
25920 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
25921 the controlling expression.
25922
25923 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
25924 @item end
25925 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
25926 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
25927 @end table
25928
25929
25930 @node Output
25931 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
25932
25933 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
25934 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
25935 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
25936 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
25937 want.
25938
25939 @table @code
25940 @kindex echo
25941 @item echo @var{text}
25942 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
25943 @c because it is not in ANSI.
25944 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
25945 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
25946 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
25947 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
25948 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
25949 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
25950 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
25951 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
25952 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
25953
25954 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
25955 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
25956
25957 @smallexample
25958 echo This is some text\n\
25959 which is continued\n\
25960 onto several lines.\n
25961 @end smallexample
25962
25963 produces the same output as
25964
25965 @smallexample
25966 echo This is some text\n
25967 echo which is continued\n
25968 echo onto several lines.\n
25969 @end smallexample
25970
25971 @kindex output
25972 @item output @var{expression}
25973 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
25974 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
25975 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
25976 on expressions.
25977
25978 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
25979 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
25980 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
25981 Formats}, for more information.
25982
25983 @kindex printf
25984 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25985 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25986 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
25987 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
25988 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
25989 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
25990 executing the code below:
25991
25992 @smallexample
25993 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
25994 @end smallexample
25995
25996 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
25997 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
25998 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
25999 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
26000 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
26001 printed.
26002
26003 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
26004
26005 @smallexample
26006 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
26007 @end smallexample
26008
26009 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
26010 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
26011 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
26012
26013 @itemize @bullet
26014 @item
26015 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
26016
26017 @item
26018 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
26019 width.
26020
26021 @item
26022 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
26023 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
26024
26025 @item
26026 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
26027 supported.
26028
26029 @item
26030 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
26031
26032 @item
26033 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
26034 @end itemize
26035
26036 @noindent
26037 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
26038 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
26039 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
26040 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
26041
26042 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
26043 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
26044 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
26045 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
26046 supported.
26047
26048 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
26049 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
26050 together with a floating point specifier.
26051 letters:
26052
26053 @itemize @bullet
26054 @item
26055 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
26056
26057 @item
26058 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
26059
26060 @item
26061 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
26062 @end itemize
26063
26064 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
26065 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
26066 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
26067
26068 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
26069 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
26070
26071 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
26072 @smallexample
26073 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
26074 @end smallexample
26075
26076 @anchor{eval}
26077 @kindex eval
26078 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
26079 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
26080 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
26081
26082 @end table
26083
26084 @node Auto-loading sequences
26085 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
26086 @cindex native script auto-loading
26087
26088 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
26089 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
26090 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
26091 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
26092
26093 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
26094 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
26095
26096 @table @code
26097 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
26098 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
26099 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
26100 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
26101
26102 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
26103 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
26104 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
26105 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
26106 disabled.
26107
26108 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
26109 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
26110 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
26111 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
26112 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
26113 auto-loaded.
26114 @end table
26115
26116 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
26117 matching names are printed.
26118
26119 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
26120 @include python.texi
26121
26122 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
26123 @include guile.texi
26124
26125 @node Auto-loading extensions
26126 @section Auto-loading extensions
26127 @cindex auto-loading extensions
26128
26129 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
26130 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
26131 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
26132 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
26133 section of modern file formats like ELF.
26134
26135 @menu
26136 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26137 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26138 * Which flavor to choose?::
26139 @end menu
26140
26141 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
26142 debugging commands and features.
26143
26144 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
26145 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
26146 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
26147 for more information.
26148 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
26149 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
26150
26151 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26152 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26153
26154 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
26155 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26156 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26157 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26158 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26159
26160 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
26161 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
26162 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
26163 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
26164
26165 @table @code
26166 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26167 GDB's own command language
26168 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26169 Python
26170 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26171 Guile
26172 @end table
26173
26174 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
26175 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
26176 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
26177 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
26178 script in the specified extension language.
26179
26180 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
26181 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
26182
26183 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
26184 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26185
26186 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
26187 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
26188 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
26189 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
26190 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
26191 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
26192
26193 @table @code
26194 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
26195 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
26196 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
26197 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
26198 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
26199 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
26200
26201 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
26202 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
26203
26204 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
26205 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
26206 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
26207 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
26208
26209 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
26210 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
26211 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
26212 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
26213 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
26214 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
26215 platform.
26216
26217 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
26218 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
26219 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
26220
26221 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
26222 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
26223 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
26224 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
26225
26226 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
26227 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
26228 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
26229 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
26230 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
26231 @end table
26232
26233 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
26234 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
26235 @var{objfile} is opened.
26236 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
26237 is evaluated more than once.
26238
26239 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
26240 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26241 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26242
26243 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
26244 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
26245 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26246 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
26247 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
26248 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
26249 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26250
26251 The following entries are supported:
26252
26253 @table @code
26254 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
26255 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
26256 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
26257 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
26258 @end table
26259
26260 @subsubsection Script File Entries
26261
26262 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
26263 in the current directory and then along the source search path
26264 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
26265 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
26266 directory is not relevant to scripts.
26267
26268 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
26269 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
26270
26271 @example
26272 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
26273 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
26274 asm("\
26275 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
26276 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
26277 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
26278 .popsection \n\
26279 ");
26280 @end example
26281
26282 @noindent
26283 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
26284 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
26285
26286 @example
26287 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
26288 @end example
26289
26290 The script name may include directories if desired.
26291
26292 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26293 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26294
26295 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
26296 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
26297 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
26298 will remove duplicates.
26299
26300 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
26301
26302 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
26303 itself instead of loading it from a file.
26304 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
26305 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
26306 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
26307 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
26308 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
26309 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
26310 on its name.
26311
26312 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
26313 testsuite.
26314
26315 @example
26316 #include "symcat.h"
26317 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
26318 asm(
26319 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
26320 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
26321 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
26322 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
26323 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
26324 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
26325 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
26326 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
26327 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
26328 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
26329 ".byte 0\n"
26330 ".popsection\n"
26331 );
26332 @end example
26333
26334 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
26335 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26336 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
26337 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
26338
26339 @node Which flavor to choose?
26340 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
26341
26342 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
26343 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
26344
26345 @noindent
26346 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
26347
26348 @itemize @bullet
26349 @item
26350 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
26351
26352 @item
26353 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
26354
26355 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
26356 in the source search path.
26357 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
26358 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
26359
26360 @item
26361 Doesn't require source code additions.
26362 @end itemize
26363
26364 @noindent
26365 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
26366
26367 @itemize @bullet
26368 @item
26369 Works with static linking.
26370
26371 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
26372 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
26373 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
26374 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
26375 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
26376
26377 @item
26378 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
26379
26380 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
26381 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
26382
26383 @item
26384 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
26385
26386 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
26387 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
26388 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
26389 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
26390 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
26391 top of the source tree to the source search path.
26392 @end itemize
26393
26394 @node Multiple Extension Languages
26395 @section Multiple Extension Languages
26396
26397 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
26398 and generally do not interfere with each other.
26399 There are some things to be aware of, however.
26400
26401 @subsection Python comes first
26402
26403 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
26404 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
26405 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
26406 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
26407 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
26408 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
26409 pretty-printed form of a value).
26410 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
26411 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
26412 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
26413
26414 @node Aliases
26415 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
26416 @cindex aliases for commands
26417
26418 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
26419 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
26420 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
26421 that involves less typing.
26422
26423 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
26424 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
26425 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
26426
26427 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
26428 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
26429 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
26430
26431 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
26432
26433 @table @code
26434
26435 @kindex alias
26436 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
26437
26438 @end table
26439
26440 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
26441 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
26442 underscores.
26443
26444 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
26445 that is being aliased.
26446
26447 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
26448 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
26449 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
26450
26451 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
26452 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
26453
26454 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
26455 of a command so that there is less to type.
26456 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
26457 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
26458 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
26459 The following will accomplish this.
26460
26461 @smallexample
26462 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
26463 @end smallexample
26464
26465 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
26466 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
26467 for it with the @samp{document} command.
26468 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
26469
26470 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
26471 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
26472 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
26473 of a command.
26474
26475 @smallexample
26476 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
26477 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
26478 (gdb) set p elms 20
26479 (gdb) show p elms
26480 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
26481 @end smallexample
26482
26483 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
26484 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
26485 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
26486
26487 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
26488 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
26489
26490 @smallexample
26491 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
26492 @end smallexample
26493
26494 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
26495 alias for a more complex command.
26496 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
26497
26498 @smallexample
26499 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
26500 (gdb) spe 20
26501 @end smallexample
26502
26503 @node Interpreters
26504 @chapter Command Interpreters
26505 @cindex command interpreters
26506
26507 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
26508 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
26509 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
26510
26511 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
26512 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
26513 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
26514 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
26515
26516 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
26517 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
26518 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
26519 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
26520
26521 @table @code
26522 @item console
26523 @cindex console interpreter
26524 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
26525 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
26526 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
26527
26528 @item mi
26529 @cindex mi interpreter
26530 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi3}). Used primarily
26531 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
26532 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
26533 Interface}.
26534
26535 @item mi3
26536 @cindex mi3 interpreter
26537 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 9.1.
26538
26539 @item mi2
26540 @cindex mi2 interpreter
26541 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 6.0.
26542
26543 @item mi1
26544 @cindex mi1 interpreter
26545 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 5.1.
26546
26547 @end table
26548
26549 @cindex invoke another interpreter
26550
26551 @kindex interpreter-exec
26552 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
26553 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
26554 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
26555
26556 @smallexample
26557 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
26558 @end smallexample
26559
26560 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
26561 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
26562
26563 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
26564 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
26565 permanently.
26566
26567 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
26568
26569 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
26570 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
26571 device (usually a tty).
26572
26573 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
26574 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
26575 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
26576 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
26577 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
26578 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
26579 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
26580 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
26581 the separate MI interpreter.
26582
26583 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
26584 @code{new-ui} command:
26585
26586 @kindex new-ui
26587 @cindex new user interface
26588 @smallexample
26589 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
26590 @end smallexample
26591
26592 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
26593 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
26594 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
26595 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
26596 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
26597 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
26598
26599 @smallexample
26600 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
26601 @end smallexample
26602
26603 @noindent
26604 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
26605
26606 @node TUI
26607 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
26608 @cindex TUI
26609 @cindex Text User Interface
26610
26611 @menu
26612 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
26613 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
26614 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
26615 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
26616 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
26617 @end menu
26618
26619 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
26620 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
26621 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
26622 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
26623 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
26624 is available.
26625
26626 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
26627 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
26628 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
26629 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
26630 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
26631 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
26632
26633 @node TUI Overview
26634 @section TUI Overview
26635
26636 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
26637
26638 @table @emph
26639 @item command
26640 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
26641 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
26642 managed using readline.
26643
26644 @item source
26645 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
26646 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
26647
26648 @item assembly
26649 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
26650
26651 @item register
26652 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
26653 when their values change.
26654 @end table
26655
26656 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
26657 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
26658 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
26659 indicates the breakpoint type:
26660
26661 @table @code
26662 @item B
26663 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26664
26665 @item b
26666 Breakpoint which was never hit.
26667
26668 @item H
26669 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26670
26671 @item h
26672 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
26673 @end table
26674
26675 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
26676
26677 @table @code
26678 @item +
26679 Breakpoint is enabled.
26680
26681 @item -
26682 Breakpoint is disabled.
26683 @end table
26684
26685 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
26686 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
26687 changes.
26688
26689 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
26690 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
26691 layouts:
26692
26693 @itemize @bullet
26694 @item
26695 source only,
26696
26697 @item
26698 assembly only,
26699
26700 @item
26701 source and assembly,
26702
26703 @item
26704 source and registers, or
26705
26706 @item
26707 assembly and registers.
26708 @end itemize
26709
26710 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
26711
26712 @table @emph
26713 @item target
26714 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
26715 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
26716
26717 @item process
26718 Gives the current process or thread number.
26719 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
26720
26721 @item function
26722 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
26723 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
26724 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
26725 the string @code{??} is displayed.
26726
26727 @item line
26728 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
26729 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
26730
26731 @item pc
26732 Indicates the current program counter address.
26733 @end table
26734
26735 @node TUI Keys
26736 @section TUI Key Bindings
26737 @cindex TUI key bindings
26738
26739 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
26740 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
26741 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
26742 @end ifset
26743 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
26744 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
26745 @end ifclear
26746 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
26747 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
26748
26749 @table @kbd
26750 @kindex C-x C-a
26751 @item C-x C-a
26752 @kindex C-x a
26753 @itemx C-x a
26754 @kindex C-x A
26755 @itemx C-x A
26756 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
26757 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
26758 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
26759 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
26760 The screen is then refreshed.
26761
26762 @kindex C-x 1
26763 @item C-x 1
26764 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
26765 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
26766 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
26767
26768 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
26769
26770 @kindex C-x 2
26771 @item C-x 2
26772 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
26773 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
26774 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
26775 previous layout and the new one.
26776
26777 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
26778
26779 @kindex C-x o
26780 @item C-x o
26781 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
26782 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
26783 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
26784
26785 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
26786
26787 @kindex C-x s
26788 @item C-x s
26789 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
26790 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
26791 @end table
26792
26793 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
26794
26795 @table @asis
26796 @kindex PgUp
26797 @item @key{PgUp}
26798 Scroll the active window one page up.
26799
26800 @kindex PgDn
26801 @item @key{PgDn}
26802 Scroll the active window one page down.
26803
26804 @kindex Up
26805 @item @key{Up}
26806 Scroll the active window one line up.
26807
26808 @kindex Down
26809 @item @key{Down}
26810 Scroll the active window one line down.
26811
26812 @kindex Left
26813 @item @key{Left}
26814 Scroll the active window one column left.
26815
26816 @kindex Right
26817 @item @key{Right}
26818 Scroll the active window one column right.
26819
26820 @kindex C-L
26821 @item @kbd{C-L}
26822 Refresh the screen.
26823 @end table
26824
26825 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
26826 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
26827 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
26828 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
26829 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
26830
26831 @node TUI Single Key Mode
26832 @section TUI Single Key Mode
26833 @cindex TUI single key mode
26834
26835 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
26836 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
26837 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
26838
26839 @table @kbd
26840 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26841 @item c
26842 continue
26843
26844 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26845 @item d
26846 down
26847
26848 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26849 @item f
26850 finish
26851
26852 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26853 @item n
26854 next
26855
26856 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26857 @item o
26858 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
26859
26860 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26861 @item q
26862 exit the SingleKey mode.
26863
26864 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26865 @item r
26866 run
26867
26868 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26869 @item s
26870 step
26871
26872 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26873 @item i
26874 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
26875
26876 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26877 @item u
26878 up
26879
26880 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26881 @item v
26882 info locals
26883
26884 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26885 @item w
26886 where
26887 @end table
26888
26889 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
26890 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
26891 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
26892 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
26893 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
26894 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
26895
26896
26897 @node TUI Commands
26898 @section TUI-specific Commands
26899 @cindex TUI commands
26900
26901 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
26902 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
26903 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
26904 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
26905
26906 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
26907 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
26908 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
26909 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
26910 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
26911
26912 @table @code
26913 @item tui enable
26914 @kindex tui enable
26915 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
26916 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
26917 otherwise a default layout is used.
26918
26919 @item tui disable
26920 @kindex tui disable
26921 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
26922
26923 @item info win
26924 @kindex info win
26925 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
26926
26927 @item layout @var{name}
26928 @kindex layout
26929 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
26930 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
26931 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
26932
26933 @table @code
26934 @item next
26935 Display the next layout.
26936
26937 @item prev
26938 Display the previous layout.
26939
26940 @item src
26941 Display the source and command windows.
26942
26943 @item asm
26944 Display the assembly and command windows.
26945
26946 @item split
26947 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
26948
26949 @item regs
26950 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
26951 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
26952 register, assembler, and command windows.
26953 @end table
26954
26955 @item focus @var{name}
26956 @kindex focus
26957 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
26958 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
26959
26960 @table @code
26961 @item next
26962 Make the next window active for scrolling.
26963
26964 @item prev
26965 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
26966
26967 @item src
26968 Make the source window active for scrolling.
26969
26970 @item asm
26971 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
26972
26973 @item regs
26974 Make the register window active for scrolling.
26975
26976 @item cmd
26977 Make the command window active for scrolling.
26978 @end table
26979
26980 @item refresh
26981 @kindex refresh
26982 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
26983
26984 @item tui reg @var{group}
26985 @kindex tui reg
26986 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
26987 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
26988 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
26989 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
26990 following groups are available on most targets:
26991 @table @code
26992 @item next
26993 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26994 through all of the available register groups.
26995
26996 @item prev
26997 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26998 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
26999 @var{next}.
27000
27001 @item general
27002 Display the general registers.
27003 @item float
27004 Display the floating point registers.
27005 @item system
27006 Display the system registers.
27007 @item vector
27008 Display the vector registers.
27009 @item all
27010 Display all registers.
27011 @end table
27012
27013 @item update
27014 @kindex update
27015 Update the source window and the current execution point.
27016
27017 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
27018 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
27019 @kindex winheight
27020 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
27021 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
27022 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
27023 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
27024 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
27025 @end table
27026
27027 @node TUI Configuration
27028 @section TUI Configuration Variables
27029 @cindex TUI configuration variables
27030
27031 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
27032
27033 @table @code
27034 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
27035 @kindex set tui border-kind
27036 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
27037 The possible values are the following:
27038 @table @code
27039 @item space
27040 Use a space character to draw the border.
27041
27042 @item ascii
27043 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
27044
27045 @item acs
27046 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
27047 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
27048 @end table
27049
27050 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
27051 @kindex set tui border-mode
27052 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
27053 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
27054 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
27055 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
27056 @table @code
27057 @item normal
27058 Use normal attributes to display the border.
27059
27060 @item standout
27061 Use standout mode.
27062
27063 @item reverse
27064 Use reverse video mode.
27065
27066 @item half
27067 Use half bright mode.
27068
27069 @item half-standout
27070 Use half bright and standout mode.
27071
27072 @item bold
27073 Use extra bright or bold mode.
27074
27075 @item bold-standout
27076 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
27077 @end table
27078
27079 @item set tui tab-width @var{nchars}
27080 @kindex set tui tab-width
27081 @kindex tabset
27082 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
27083 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
27084 assembly windows.
27085 @end table
27086
27087 @node Emacs
27088 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
27089
27090 @cindex Emacs
27091 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
27092 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
27093 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
27094 @value{GDBN}.
27095
27096 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
27097 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
27098 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
27099 created Emacs buffer.
27100 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
27101
27102 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
27103 things:
27104
27105 @itemize @bullet
27106 @item
27107 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
27108 the GUD buffer.
27109
27110 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
27111 and output done by the program you are debugging.
27112
27113 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
27114 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
27115 in this way.
27116
27117 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
27118 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
27119 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
27120 stop.
27121
27122 @item
27123 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
27124
27125 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
27126 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
27127 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
27128 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
27129 and the source.
27130
27131 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
27132 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
27133 @end itemize
27134
27135 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
27136 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
27137 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
27138 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
27139
27140 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
27141 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
27142 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
27143 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
27144 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
27145 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
27146 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
27147 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
27148 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
27149
27150 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
27151 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
27152 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
27153 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
27154
27155 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
27156 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
27157 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
27158 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
27159 one you want.
27160
27161 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
27162 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
27163
27164 @table @kbd
27165 @item C-h m
27166 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
27167
27168 @item C-c C-s
27169 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
27170 update the display window to show the current file and location.
27171
27172 @item C-c C-n
27173 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
27174 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
27175 to show the current file and location.
27176
27177 @item C-c C-i
27178 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
27179 display window accordingly.
27180
27181 @item C-c C-f
27182 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
27183 @code{finish} command.
27184
27185 @item C-c C-r
27186 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
27187 command.
27188
27189 @item C-c <
27190 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
27191 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
27192 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
27193
27194 @item C-c >
27195 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
27196 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
27197 @end table
27198
27199 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
27200 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
27201
27202 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
27203 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
27204 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
27205 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
27206 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
27207 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
27208 speedbar displays watch expressions.
27209
27210 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
27211 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
27212 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
27213 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
27214 frame.
27215
27216 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
27217 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
27218 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
27219 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
27220 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
27221 to correspond properly with the code.
27222
27223 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
27224 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
27225 Emacs Manual}).
27226
27227 @node GDB/MI
27228 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
27229
27230 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
27231
27232 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
27233 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
27234 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
27235 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
27236 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
27237 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
27238
27239 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
27240 in the form of a reference manual.
27241
27242 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
27243 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
27244 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
27245
27246 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
27247
27248 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
27249 This chapter uses the following notation:
27250
27251 @itemize @bullet
27252 @item
27253 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
27254
27255 @item
27256 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
27257 it may or may not be given.
27258
27259 @item
27260 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27261 may repeat zero or more times.
27262
27263 @item
27264 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27265 may repeat one or more times.
27266
27267 @item
27268 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
27269 @end itemize
27270
27271 @ignore
27272 @heading Dependencies
27273 @end ignore
27274
27275 @menu
27276 * GDB/MI General Design::
27277 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
27278 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
27279 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
27280 * GDB/MI Output Records::
27281 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
27282 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
27283 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
27284 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27285 * GDB/MI Program Context::
27286 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
27287 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
27288 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
27289 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
27290 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
27291 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
27292 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
27293 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
27294 * GDB/MI File Commands::
27295 @ignore
27296 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
27297 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
27298 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
27299 @end ignore
27300 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
27301 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
27302 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
27303 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
27304 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
27305 @end menu
27306
27307 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27308 @node GDB/MI General Design
27309 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
27310 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
27311
27312 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
27313 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
27314 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
27315 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
27316 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
27317 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
27318 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
27319 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
27320 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
27321 a command and reported as part of that command response.
27322
27323 The important examples of notifications are:
27324 @itemize @bullet
27325
27326 @item
27327 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
27328 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
27329 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
27330 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
27331 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
27332 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
27333 command itself was successfully executed.
27334
27335 @item
27336 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
27337 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
27338 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
27339 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
27340 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
27341 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
27342
27343 @item
27344 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
27345 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
27346 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
27347 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
27348 orthogonal frontend design.
27349
27350 @end itemize
27351
27352 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
27353 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
27354 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
27355 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
27356 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
27357 the user interface.
27358
27359
27360 @menu
27361 * Context management::
27362 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
27363 * Thread groups::
27364 @end menu
27365
27366 @node Context management
27367 @subsection Context management
27368
27369 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
27370
27371 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
27372 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
27373 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
27374 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
27375 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
27376 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
27377 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
27378 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
27379 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
27380
27381 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
27382 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
27383 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
27384 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
27385 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
27386 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
27387 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
27388 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
27389 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
27390 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
27391 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
27392
27393 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
27394 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
27395 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
27396 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
27397 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
27398 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
27399 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
27400 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
27401 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
27402 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
27403
27404 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
27405 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
27406 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
27407 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
27408 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
27409 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
27410 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
27411 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
27412 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
27413 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
27414 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
27415 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
27416 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
27417 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
27418 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
27419 @samp{--frame} options.
27420
27421 @subsubsection Language
27422
27423 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
27424 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
27425 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
27426 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
27427 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
27428 For instance:
27429
27430 @smallexample
27431 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
27432 ^done,value="4"
27433 (gdb)
27434 @end smallexample
27435
27436 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
27437 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
27438 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
27439
27440 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
27441 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
27442
27443 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
27444 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
27445 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
27446 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
27447 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
27448 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
27449 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
27450 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
27451 @code{-list-target-features} command.
27452
27453 @table @code
27454 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
27455 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
27456 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
27457
27458 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
27459 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
27460 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
27461
27462 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
27463 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
27464 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
27465 MI commands even while the target is running.
27466
27467 @item -gdb-show mi-async
27468 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
27469 @end table
27470
27471 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
27472 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
27473 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
27474 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
27475 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
27476 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
27477
27478 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
27479 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
27480 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
27481 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
27482 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
27483 are running.
27484
27485 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
27486 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
27487 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
27488 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
27489 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
27490 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
27491 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
27492 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
27493 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
27494 @samp{--thread} option).
27495
27496 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
27497 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
27498 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
27499 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
27500
27501 @node Thread groups
27502 @subsection Thread groups
27503 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
27504 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
27505 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
27506 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
27507 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
27508
27509 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
27510 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
27511 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
27512 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
27513 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
27514 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
27515 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
27516 into processes.
27517
27518 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
27519 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
27520 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
27521 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
27522 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
27523 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
27524 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
27525 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
27526 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
27527 the members of specific thread group.
27528
27529 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
27530 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
27531 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
27532 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
27533 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
27534 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
27535 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
27536 after attaching to that thread group.
27537
27538 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
27539 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
27540 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
27541 such thread groups.
27542
27543 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27544 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
27545 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
27546
27547 @menu
27548 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
27549 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
27550 @end menu
27551
27552 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
27553 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
27554
27555 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
27556 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
27557 @table @code
27558 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
27559 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
27560
27561 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
27562 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
27563 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
27564
27565 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
27566 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
27567 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
27568
27569 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27570 "any sequence of digits"
27571
27572 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
27573 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
27574
27575 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
27576 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
27577
27578 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
27579 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
27580
27581 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
27582 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
27583 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
27584
27585 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
27586 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
27587
27588 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27589 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27590 @end table
27591
27592 @noindent
27593 Notes:
27594
27595 @itemize @bullet
27596 @item
27597 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
27598 output is described below.
27599
27600 @item
27601 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
27602 finishes.
27603
27604 @item
27605 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
27606 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
27607 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
27608 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
27609 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
27610 @end itemize
27611
27612 Pragmatics:
27613
27614 @itemize @bullet
27615 @item
27616 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
27617
27618 @item
27619 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
27620 @end itemize
27621
27622 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
27623 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
27624
27625 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
27626 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
27627 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
27628 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
27629 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
27630 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
27631
27632 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
27633 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
27634 @var{token}.
27635
27636 @table @code
27637 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
27638 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
27639
27640 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
27641 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
27642
27643 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
27644 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
27645
27646 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
27647 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
27648
27649 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
27650 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
27651
27652 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
27653 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
27654
27655 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
27656 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
27657
27658 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
27659 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
27660
27661 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
27662 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
27663
27664 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
27665 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
27666 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
27667
27668 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
27669 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
27670
27671 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
27672 @code{ @var{string} }
27673
27674 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
27675 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
27676
27677 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
27678 @code{@var{c-string}}
27679
27680 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
27681 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
27682
27683 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
27684 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
27685 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
27686
27687 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
27688 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
27689
27690 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
27691 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
27692
27693 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
27694 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
27695
27696 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
27697 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
27698
27699 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27700 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27701
27702 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27703 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
27704 @end table
27705
27706 @noindent
27707 Notes:
27708
27709 @itemize @bullet
27710 @item
27711 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
27712
27713 @item
27714 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
27715 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
27716 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
27717 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
27718 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
27719 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
27720 prior command.
27721
27722 @item
27723 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27724 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
27725 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
27726 prefixed by @samp{+}.
27727
27728 @item
27729 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27730 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
27731 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
27732 @samp{*}.
27733
27734 @item
27735 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27736 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
27737 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
27738 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
27739
27740 @item
27741 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27742 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
27743 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
27744 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
27745
27746 @item
27747 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27748 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
27749 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
27750
27751 @item
27752 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27753 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
27754 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
27755 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
27756
27757 @item
27758 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27759 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
27760 @var{values}.
27761
27762
27763 @end itemize
27764
27765 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
27766 details about the various output records.
27767
27768 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27769 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
27770 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
27771
27772 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
27773 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
27774
27775 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
27776 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
27777 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
27778 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
27779 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
27780 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
27781
27782 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
27783 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
27784 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
27785
27786 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27787 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
27788 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
27789 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
27790
27791 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
27792 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
27793
27794 Since @sc{gdb/mi} is used by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}, changes
27795 to the MI interface may break existing usage. This section describes how the
27796 protocol changes and how to request previous version of the protocol when it
27797 does.
27798
27799 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
27800 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
27801 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
27802 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
27803
27804 @itemize @bullet
27805 @item
27806 New MI commands may be added.
27807
27808 @item
27809 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
27810
27811 @item
27812 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
27813 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
27814
27815 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
27816 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
27817
27818 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
27819 @c resolve inconsistencies.
27820 @end itemize
27821
27822 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
27823 will be increased by one. The new versions of the MI protocol are not compatible
27824 with the old versions. Old versions of MI remain available, allowing front ends
27825 to keep using them until they are modified to use the latest MI version.
27826
27827 Since @code{--interpreter=mi} always points to the latest MI version, it is
27828 recommended that front ends request a specific version of MI when launching
27829 @value{GDBN} (e.g. @code{--interpreter=mi2}) to make sure they get an
27830 interpreter with the MI version they expect.
27831
27832 The following table gives a summary of the the released versions of the MI
27833 interface: the version number, the version of GDB in which it first appeared
27834 and the breaking changes compared to the previous version.
27835
27836 @multitable @columnfractions .05 .05 .9
27837 @headitem MI version @tab GDB version @tab Breaking changes
27838
27839 @item
27840 @center 1
27841 @tab
27842 @center 5.1
27843 @tab
27844 None
27845
27846 @item
27847 @center 2
27848 @tab
27849 @center 6.0
27850 @tab
27851
27852 @itemize
27853 @item
27854 The @code{-environment-pwd}, @code{-environment-directory} and
27855 @code{-environment-path} commands now returns values using the MI output
27856 syntax, rather than CLI output syntax.
27857
27858 @item
27859 @code{-var-list-children}'s @code{children} result field is now a list, rather
27860 than a tuple.
27861
27862 @item
27863 @code{-var-update}'s @code{changelist} result field is now a list, rather than
27864 a tuple.
27865 @end itemize
27866
27867 @item
27868 @center 3
27869 @tab
27870 @center 9.1
27871 @tab
27872
27873 @itemize
27874 @item
27875 The output of information about multi-location breakpoints has changed in the
27876 responses to the @code{-break-insert} and @code{-break-info} commands, as well
27877 as in the @code{=breakpoint-created} and @code{=breakpoint-modified} events.
27878 The multiple locations are now placed in a @code{locations} field, whose value
27879 is a list.
27880 @end itemize
27881
27882 @end multitable
27883
27884 If your front end cannot yet migrate to a more recent version of the
27885 MI protocol, you can nevertheless selectively enable specific features
27886 available in those recent MI versions, using the following commands:
27887
27888 @table @code
27889
27890 @item -fix-multi-location-breakpoint-output
27891 Use the output for multi-location breakpoints which was introduced by
27892 MI 3, even when using MI versions 2 or 1. This command has no
27893 effect when using MI version 3 or later.
27894
27895 @end table
27896
27897 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
27898 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
27899 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
27900 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
27901 @cindex mailing lists
27902
27903 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27904 @node GDB/MI Output Records
27905 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
27906
27907 @menu
27908 * GDB/MI Result Records::
27909 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
27910 * GDB/MI Async Records::
27911 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
27912 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
27913 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
27914 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
27915 @end menu
27916
27917 @node GDB/MI Result Records
27918 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
27919
27920 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27921 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
27922 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
27923 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
27924
27925 @table @code
27926 @findex ^done
27927 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
27928 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
27929 values.
27930
27931 @item "^running"
27932 @findex ^running
27933 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
27934 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
27935 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
27936 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
27937 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
27938 which threads are resumed.
27939
27940 @item "^connected"
27941 @findex ^connected
27942 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
27943
27944 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
27945 @findex ^error
27946 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
27947 the corresponding error message.
27948
27949 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
27950 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
27951 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
27952
27953 @table @samp
27954 @item "undefined-command"
27955 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
27956 @end table
27957
27958 @item "^exit"
27959 @findex ^exit
27960 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
27961
27962 @end table
27963
27964 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
27965 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
27966
27967 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
27968 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27969 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
27970 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
27971 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
27972
27973 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
27974 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
27975 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
27976 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
27977 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
27978
27979 @table @code
27980 @item "~" @var{string-output}
27981 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
27982 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
27983
27984 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
27985 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
27986 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
27987 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
27988
27989 @item "&" @var{string-output}
27990 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
27991 internals.
27992 @end table
27993
27994 @node GDB/MI Async Records
27995 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
27996
27997 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27998 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
27999 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
28000 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
28001 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
28002 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
28003
28004 The following is the list of possible async records:
28005
28006 @table @code
28007
28008 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
28009 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
28010 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
28011 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
28012 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
28013 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
28014 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
28015 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
28016 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
28017 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
28018 it run freely.
28019
28020 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
28021 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
28022 following values:
28023
28024 @table @code
28025 @item breakpoint-hit
28026 A breakpoint was reached.
28027 @item watchpoint-trigger
28028 A watchpoint was triggered.
28029 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
28030 A read watchpoint was triggered.
28031 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
28032 An access watchpoint was triggered.
28033 @item function-finished
28034 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
28035 @item location-reached
28036 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
28037 @item watchpoint-scope
28038 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
28039 @item end-stepping-range
28040 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
28041 similar CLI command was accomplished.
28042 @item exited-signalled
28043 The inferior exited because of a signal.
28044 @item exited
28045 The inferior exited.
28046 @item exited-normally
28047 The inferior exited normally.
28048 @item signal-received
28049 A signal was received by the inferior.
28050 @item solib-event
28051 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
28052 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
28053 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
28054 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
28055 @item fork
28056 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
28057 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28058 @item vfork
28059 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
28060 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28061 @item syscall-entry
28062 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
28063 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28064 @item syscall-return
28065 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
28066 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28067 @item exec
28068 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
28069 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28070 @end table
28071
28072 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
28073 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
28074 Depending on whether all-stop
28075 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
28076 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
28077 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
28078 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
28079 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
28080 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
28081 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
28082 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
28083 if such information is not available.
28084
28085 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
28086 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
28087 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
28088 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
28089 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
28090 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
28091 cannot be used in any way.
28092
28093 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
28094 A thread group became associated with a running program,
28095 either because the program was just started or the thread group
28096 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
28097 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
28098 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
28099
28100 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
28101 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
28102 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
28103 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
28104 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
28105 only when the inferior exited with some code.
28106
28107 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
28108 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
28109 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
28110 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
28111 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
28112
28113 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
28114 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
28115 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
28116 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
28117 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
28118 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
28119 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
28120 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
28121 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
28122
28123 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
28124 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
28125
28126 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
28127 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
28128 that thread.
28129
28130 @item =library-loaded,...
28131 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
28132 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
28133 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
28134 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
28135 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
28136 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
28137 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
28138 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
28139 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
28140 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
28141 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
28142 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
28143 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
28144 to this library.
28145
28146 @item =library-unloaded,...
28147 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
28148 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
28149 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
28150 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
28151 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
28152 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
28153 thread groups.
28154
28155 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
28156 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
28157 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
28158 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
28159 frame is @var{tpnum}.
28160
28161 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
28162 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
28163 initial value @var{initial}.
28164
28165 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
28166 @itemx =tsv-deleted
28167 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
28168 trace state variables are deleted.
28169
28170 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
28171 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
28172 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
28173 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
28174 value of trace state variable is known.
28175
28176 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
28177 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
28178 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
28179 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
28180 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
28181 user.
28182
28183 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
28184 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
28185 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
28186
28187 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
28188 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
28189
28190 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
28191 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
28192 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
28193 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
28194 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
28195
28196 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
28197 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
28198 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
28199 for existing method and format values.
28200
28201 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
28202 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
28203 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
28204 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
28205 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
28206 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
28207
28208 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
28209 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
28210 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
28211 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
28212 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
28213 executable code.
28214 @end table
28215
28216 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
28217 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
28218
28219 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
28220 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
28221 following fields:
28222
28223 @table @code
28224 @item number
28225 The breakpoint number.
28226
28227 @item type
28228 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
28229 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
28230
28231 @item catch-type
28232 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
28233 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
28234
28235 @item disp
28236 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
28237 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
28238 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
28239
28240 @item enabled
28241 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
28242 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
28243 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
28244
28245 @item addr
28246 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
28247 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
28248 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
28249 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
28250 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
28251
28252 @item func
28253 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
28254 If not known, this field is not present.
28255
28256 @item filename
28257 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
28258 If not known, this field is not present.
28259
28260 @item fullname
28261 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
28262 known. If not known, this field is not present.
28263
28264 @item line
28265 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
28266 If not known, this field is not present.
28267
28268 @item at
28269 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
28270 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
28271 by a symbol name.
28272
28273 @item pending
28274 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
28275 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
28276
28277 @item evaluated-by
28278 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
28279 @samp{target}.
28280
28281 @item thread
28282 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
28283 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
28284
28285 @item task
28286 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
28287 field will hold the task identifier.
28288
28289 @item cond
28290 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
28291
28292 @item ignore
28293 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
28294
28295 @item enable
28296 The enable count of the breakpoint.
28297
28298 @item traceframe-usage
28299 FIXME.
28300
28301 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
28302 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
28303
28304 @item mask
28305 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
28306
28307 @item pass
28308 A tracepoint's pass count.
28309
28310 @item original-location
28311 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
28312 This field is optional.
28313
28314 @item times
28315 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
28316
28317 @item installed
28318 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
28319 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
28320 is not.
28321
28322 @item what
28323 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
28324
28325 @item locations
28326 This field is present if the breakpoint has multiple locations. It is also
28327 exceptionally present if the breakpoint is enabled and has a single, disabled
28328 location.
28329
28330 The value is a list of locations. The format of a location is decribed below.
28331
28332 @end table
28333
28334 A location in a multi-location breakpoint is represented as a tuple with the
28335 following fields:
28336
28337 @table @code
28338
28339 @item number
28340 The location number as a dotted pair, like @samp{1.2}. The first digit is the
28341 number of the parent breakpoint. The second digit is the number of the
28342 location within that breakpoint.
28343
28344 @item enabled
28345 This indicates whether the location is enabled, in which case the
28346 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
28347 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
28348
28349 @item addr
28350 The address of this location as an hexidecimal number.
28351
28352 @item func
28353 If known, the function in which the location appears.
28354 If not known, this field is not present.
28355
28356 @item file
28357 The name of the source file which contains this location, if known.
28358 If not known, this field is not present.
28359
28360 @item fullname
28361 The full file name of the source file which contains this location, if
28362 known. If not known, this field is not present.
28363
28364 @item line
28365 The line number at which this location appears, if known.
28366 If not known, this field is not present.
28367
28368 @item thread-groups
28369 The thread groups this location is in.
28370
28371 @end table
28372
28373 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
28374 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
28375
28376 @smallexample
28377 -> -break-insert main
28378 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28379 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28380 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28381 times="0"@}
28382 <- (gdb)
28383 @end smallexample
28384
28385 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
28386 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
28387
28388 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
28389 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
28390 fields:
28391
28392 @table @code
28393 @item level
28394 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
28395 zero. This field is always present.
28396
28397 @item func
28398 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
28399 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
28400
28401 @item addr
28402 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
28403
28404 @item file
28405 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
28406 address. This field may be absent.
28407
28408 @item line
28409 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
28410 may be absent.
28411
28412 @item from
28413 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
28414 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
28415
28416 @end table
28417
28418 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
28419 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
28420
28421 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
28422 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
28423 stated otherwise.
28424
28425 @table @code
28426 @item id
28427 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
28428
28429 @item target-id
28430 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
28431
28432 @item details
28433 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
28434 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
28435 frontend. This field is optional.
28436
28437 @item name
28438 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
28439 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
28440 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
28441 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
28442 field is omitted.
28443
28444 @item state
28445 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
28446 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
28447
28448 @item frame
28449 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
28450 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
28451 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
28452
28453 @item core
28454 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
28455 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
28456 @end table
28457
28458 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
28459 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
28460
28461 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
28462 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
28463 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
28464 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
28465 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
28466 the @code{exception-message} field.
28467
28468 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28469 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
28470 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
28471 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
28472
28473 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
28474 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
28475 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
28476 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
28477
28478 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
28479 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
28480
28481 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
28482
28483 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
28484 information of the breakpoint.
28485
28486 @smallexample
28487 -> -break-insert main
28488 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28489 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28490 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28491 times="0"@}
28492 <- (gdb)
28493 @end smallexample
28494
28495 @subheading Program Execution
28496
28497 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
28498 reason that execution stopped.
28499
28500 @smallexample
28501 -> -exec-run
28502 <- ^running
28503 <- (gdb)
28504 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
28505 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
28506 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
28507 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",
28508 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28509 <- (gdb)
28510 -> -exec-continue
28511 <- ^running
28512 <- (gdb)
28513 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28514 <- (gdb)
28515 @end smallexample
28516
28517 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
28518
28519 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
28520
28521 @smallexample
28522 -> (gdb)
28523 <- -gdb-exit
28524 <- ^exit
28525 @end smallexample
28526
28527 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
28528 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
28529 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
28530 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
28531 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
28532 fails to exit in reasonable time.
28533
28534 @subheading A Bad Command
28535
28536 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
28537
28538 @smallexample
28539 -> -rubbish
28540 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
28541 <- (gdb)
28542 @end smallexample
28543
28544
28545 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28546 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
28547 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
28548
28549 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
28550 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
28551
28552 @subheading Motivation
28553
28554 The motivation for this collection of commands.
28555
28556 @subheading Introduction
28557
28558 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
28559
28560 @subheading Commands
28561
28562 For each command in the block, the following is described:
28563
28564 @subsubheading Synopsis
28565
28566 @smallexample
28567 -command @var{args}@dots{}
28568 @end smallexample
28569
28570 @subsubheading Result
28571
28572 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28573
28574 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
28575
28576 @subsubheading Example
28577
28578 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
28579 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
28580
28581
28582 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28583 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
28584 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
28585
28586 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
28587 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
28588 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28589 breakpoints.
28590
28591 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
28592 @findex -break-after
28593
28594 @subsubheading Synopsis
28595
28596 @smallexample
28597 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
28598 @end smallexample
28599
28600 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
28601 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
28602 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
28603 @samp{-break-list} command below.
28604
28605 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28606
28607 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
28608
28609 @subsubheading Example
28610
28611 @smallexample
28612 (gdb)
28613 -break-insert main
28614 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28615 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28616 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28617 times="0"@}
28618 (gdb)
28619 -break-after 1 3
28620 ~
28621 ^done
28622 (gdb)
28623 -break-list
28624 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28625 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28626 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28627 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28628 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28629 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28630 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28631 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28632 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28633 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28634 (gdb)
28635 @end smallexample
28636
28637 @ignore
28638 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
28639 @findex -break-catch
28640 @end ignore
28641
28642 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
28643 @findex -break-commands
28644
28645 @subsubheading Synopsis
28646
28647 @smallexample
28648 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
28649 @end smallexample
28650
28651 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
28652 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
28653 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
28654 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
28655 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
28656 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
28657
28658 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28659
28660 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
28661
28662 @subsubheading Example
28663
28664 @smallexample
28665 (gdb)
28666 -break-insert main
28667 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28668 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28669 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28670 times="0"@}
28671 (gdb)
28672 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
28673 ^done
28674 (gdb)
28675 @end smallexample
28676
28677 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
28678 @findex -break-condition
28679
28680 @subsubheading Synopsis
28681
28682 @smallexample
28683 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
28684 @end smallexample
28685
28686 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
28687 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
28688 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
28689 command below).
28690
28691 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28692
28693 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
28694
28695 @subsubheading Example
28696
28697 @smallexample
28698 (gdb)
28699 -break-condition 1 1
28700 ^done
28701 (gdb)
28702 -break-list
28703 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28704 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28705 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28706 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28707 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28708 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28709 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28710 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28711 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28712 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28713 (gdb)
28714 @end smallexample
28715
28716 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
28717 @findex -break-delete
28718
28719 @subsubheading Synopsis
28720
28721 @smallexample
28722 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28723 @end smallexample
28724
28725 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
28726 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
28727
28728 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28729
28730 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
28731
28732 @subsubheading Example
28733
28734 @smallexample
28735 (gdb)
28736 -break-delete 1
28737 ^done
28738 (gdb)
28739 -break-list
28740 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28741 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28742 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28743 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28744 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28745 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28746 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28747 body=[]@}
28748 (gdb)
28749 @end smallexample
28750
28751 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
28752 @findex -break-disable
28753
28754 @subsubheading Synopsis
28755
28756 @smallexample
28757 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28758 @end smallexample
28759
28760 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
28761 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
28762
28763 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28764
28765 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
28766
28767 @subsubheading Example
28768
28769 @smallexample
28770 (gdb)
28771 -break-disable 2
28772 ^done
28773 (gdb)
28774 -break-list
28775 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28776 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28777 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28778 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28779 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28780 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28781 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28782 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28783 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28784 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28785 (gdb)
28786 @end smallexample
28787
28788 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
28789 @findex -break-enable
28790
28791 @subsubheading Synopsis
28792
28793 @smallexample
28794 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28795 @end smallexample
28796
28797 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
28798
28799 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28800
28801 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
28802
28803 @subsubheading Example
28804
28805 @smallexample
28806 (gdb)
28807 -break-enable 2
28808 ^done
28809 (gdb)
28810 -break-list
28811 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28812 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28813 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28814 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28815 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28816 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28817 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28818 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28819 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28820 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28821 (gdb)
28822 @end smallexample
28823
28824 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
28825 @findex -break-info
28826
28827 @subsubheading Synopsis
28828
28829 @smallexample
28830 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
28831 @end smallexample
28832
28833 @c REDUNDANT???
28834 Get information about a single breakpoint.
28835
28836 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
28837 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
28838 table.
28839
28840 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28841
28842 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
28843
28844 @subsubheading Example
28845 N.A.
28846
28847 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
28848 @findex -break-insert
28849 @anchor{-break-insert}
28850
28851 @subsubheading Synopsis
28852
28853 @smallexample
28854 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
28855 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28856 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
28857 @end smallexample
28858
28859 @noindent
28860 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
28861
28862 @table @var
28863 @item linespec location
28864 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
28865
28866 @item explicit location
28867 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
28868 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
28869 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
28870
28871 @table @samp
28872 @item --source @var{filename}
28873 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
28874 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
28875
28876 @item --function @var{function}
28877 The name of a function or method.
28878
28879 @item --label @var{label}
28880 The name of a label.
28881
28882 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
28883 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
28884 @end table
28885
28886 @item address location
28887 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
28888 @end table
28889
28890 @noindent
28891 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28892
28893 @table @samp
28894 @item -t
28895 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28896 @item -h
28897 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
28898 @item -f
28899 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
28900 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28901 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28902 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28903 cannot be parsed.
28904 @item -d
28905 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28906 @item -a
28907 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
28908 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
28909 @item -c @var{condition}
28910 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28911 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28912 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
28913 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28914 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28915 @var{thread-id}.
28916 @end table
28917
28918 @subsubheading Result
28919
28920 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28921 resulting breakpoint.
28922
28923 Note: this format is open to change.
28924 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28925
28926 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28927
28928 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
28929 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
28930
28931 @subsubheading Example
28932
28933 @smallexample
28934 (gdb)
28935 -break-insert main
28936 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
28937 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28938 times="0"@}
28939 (gdb)
28940 -break-insert -t foo
28941 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
28942 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28943 times="0"@}
28944 (gdb)
28945 -break-list
28946 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28947 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28948 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28949 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28950 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28951 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28952 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28953 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28954 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
28955 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28956 times="0"@},
28957 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28958 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
28959 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28960 times="0"@}]@}
28961 (gdb)
28962 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
28963 @c ~int foo(int, int);
28964 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
28965 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28966 @c times="0"@}
28967 @c (gdb)
28968 @end smallexample
28969
28970 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
28971 @findex -dprintf-insert
28972
28973 @subsubheading Synopsis
28974
28975 @smallexample
28976 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
28977 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28978 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
28979 [ @var{argument} ]
28980 @end smallexample
28981
28982 @noindent
28983 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
28984 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
28985
28986 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28987
28988 @table @samp
28989 @item -t
28990 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28991 @item -f
28992 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
28993 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28994 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28995 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28996 cannot be parsed.
28997 @item -d
28998 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28999 @item -c @var{condition}
29000 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29001 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
29002 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
29003 to @var{ignore-count}.
29004 @item -p @var{thread-id}
29005 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
29006 @var{thread-id}.
29007 @end table
29008
29009 @subsubheading Result
29010
29011 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
29012 resulting breakpoint.
29013
29014 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
29015
29016 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29017
29018 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
29019
29020 @subsubheading Example
29021
29022 @smallexample
29023 (gdb)
29024 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
29025 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29026 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
29027 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
29028 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
29029 original-location="foo"@}
29030 (gdb)
29031 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
29032 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29033 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
29034 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
29035 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
29036 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
29037 (gdb)
29038 @end smallexample
29039
29040 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
29041 @findex -break-list
29042
29043 @subsubheading Synopsis
29044
29045 @smallexample
29046 -break-list
29047 @end smallexample
29048
29049 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
29050
29051 @table @samp
29052 @item Number
29053 number of the breakpoint
29054 @item Type
29055 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
29056 @item Disposition
29057 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
29058 or @samp{nokeep}
29059 @item Enabled
29060 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
29061 @item Address
29062 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
29063 @item What
29064 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
29065 name, line number
29066 @item Thread-groups
29067 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
29068 @item Times
29069 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
29070 @end table
29071
29072 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
29073 @code{body} field is an empty list.
29074
29075 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29076
29077 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
29078
29079 @subsubheading Example
29080
29081 @smallexample
29082 (gdb)
29083 -break-list
29084 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29085 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29086 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29087 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29088 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29089 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29090 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29091 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29092 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
29093 times="0"@},
29094 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29095 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29096 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29097 (gdb)
29098 @end smallexample
29099
29100 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
29101
29102 @smallexample
29103 (gdb)
29104 -break-list
29105 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
29106 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29107 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29108 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29109 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29110 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29111 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29112 body=[]@}
29113 (gdb)
29114 @end smallexample
29115
29116 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
29117 @findex -break-passcount
29118
29119 @subsubheading Synopsis
29120
29121 @smallexample
29122 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
29123 @end smallexample
29124
29125 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
29126 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
29127 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
29128 command @samp{passcount}.
29129
29130 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
29131 @findex -break-watch
29132
29133 @subsubheading Synopsis
29134
29135 @smallexample
29136 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
29137 @end smallexample
29138
29139 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
29140 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
29141 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
29142 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
29143 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
29144 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
29145 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
29146 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
29147
29148 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
29149 breakpoints inserted.
29150
29151 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29152
29153 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
29154 @samp{rwatch}.
29155
29156 @subsubheading Example
29157
29158 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
29159
29160 @smallexample
29161 (gdb)
29162 -break-watch x
29163 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
29164 (gdb)
29165 -exec-continue
29166 ^running
29167 (gdb)
29168 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
29169 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
29170 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
29171 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29172 (gdb)
29173 @end smallexample
29174
29175 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
29176 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
29177 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
29178
29179 @smallexample
29180 (gdb)
29181 -break-watch C
29182 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
29183 (gdb)
29184 -exec-continue
29185 ^running
29186 (gdb)
29187 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
29188 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
29189 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29190 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29191 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
29192 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29193 (gdb)
29194 -exec-continue
29195 ^running
29196 (gdb)
29197 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
29198 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
29199 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29200 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29201 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29202 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29203 (gdb)
29204 @end smallexample
29205
29206 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
29207 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
29208 deleted.
29209
29210 @smallexample
29211 (gdb)
29212 -break-watch C
29213 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
29214 (gdb)
29215 -break-list
29216 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29217 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29218 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29219 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29220 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29221 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29222 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29223 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29224 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29225 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29226 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
29227 times="1"@},
29228 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
29229 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29230 (gdb)
29231 -exec-continue
29232 ^running
29233 (gdb)
29234 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
29235 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
29236 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29237 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29238 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
29239 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29240 (gdb)
29241 -break-list
29242 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29243 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29244 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29245 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29246 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29247 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29248 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29249 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29250 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29251 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29252 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
29253 times="1"@},
29254 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
29255 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
29256 (gdb)
29257 -exec-continue
29258 ^running
29259 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
29260 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
29261 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29262 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29263 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29264 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29265 (gdb)
29266 -break-list
29267 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29268 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29269 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29270 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29271 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29272 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29273 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29274 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29275 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29276 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29277 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
29278 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
29279 (gdb)
29280 @end smallexample
29281
29282
29283 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29284 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29285 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
29286
29287 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
29288 catchpoints.
29289
29290 @menu
29291 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
29292 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
29293 @end menu
29294
29295 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29296 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
29297
29298 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
29299 @findex -catch-load
29300
29301 @subsubheading Synopsis
29302
29303 @smallexample
29304 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
29305 @end smallexample
29306
29307 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
29308 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
29309 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
29310 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
29311 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
29312
29313
29314 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29315
29316 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
29317
29318 @subsubheading Example
29319
29320 @smallexample
29321 -catch-load -t foo.so
29322 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
29323 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
29324 (gdb)
29325 @end smallexample
29326
29327
29328 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
29329 @findex -catch-unload
29330
29331 @subsubheading Synopsis
29332
29333 @smallexample
29334 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
29335 @end smallexample
29336
29337 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
29338 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
29339 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
29340 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
29341 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
29342
29343 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29344
29345 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
29346
29347 @subsubheading Example
29348
29349 @smallexample
29350 -catch-unload -d bar.so
29351 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
29352 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
29353 (gdb)
29354 @end smallexample
29355
29356 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29357 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
29358
29359 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
29360 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
29361
29362 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
29363 @findex -catch-assert
29364
29365 @subsubheading Synopsis
29366
29367 @smallexample
29368 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
29369 @end smallexample
29370
29371 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
29372
29373 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29374
29375 @table @samp
29376 @item -c @var{condition}
29377 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29378 @item -d
29379 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29380 @item -t
29381 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29382 @end table
29383
29384 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29385
29386 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
29387
29388 @subsubheading Example
29389
29390 @smallexample
29391 -catch-assert
29392 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29393 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
29394 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
29395 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
29396 (gdb)
29397 @end smallexample
29398
29399 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
29400 @findex -catch-exception
29401
29402 @subsubheading Synopsis
29403
29404 @smallexample
29405 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29406 [ -t ] [ -u ]
29407 @end smallexample
29408
29409 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
29410 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29411 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29412 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29413 catchpoints.
29414
29415 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29416
29417 @table @samp
29418 @item -c @var{condition}
29419 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29420 @item -d
29421 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29422 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29423 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
29424 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
29425 @item -t
29426 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29427 @item -u
29428 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
29429 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
29430 @end table
29431
29432 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29433
29434 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
29435 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
29436
29437 @subsubheading Example
29438
29439 @smallexample
29440 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
29441 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29442 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
29443 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
29444 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
29445 (gdb)
29446 @end smallexample
29447
29448 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
29449 @findex -catch-handlers
29450
29451 @subsubheading Synopsis
29452
29453 @smallexample
29454 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29455 [ -t ]
29456 @end smallexample
29457
29458 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
29459 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29460 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29461 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29462 catchpoints.
29463
29464 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29465
29466 @table @samp
29467 @item -c @var{condition}
29468 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29469 @item -d
29470 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29471 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29472 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
29473 @item -t
29474 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29475 @end table
29476
29477 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29478
29479 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
29480
29481 @subsubheading Example
29482
29483 @smallexample
29484 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
29485 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29486 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
29487 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
29488 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
29489 (gdb)
29490 @end smallexample
29491
29492 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29493 @node GDB/MI Program Context
29494 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
29495
29496 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
29497 @findex -exec-arguments
29498
29499
29500 @subsubheading Synopsis
29501
29502 @smallexample
29503 -exec-arguments @var{args}
29504 @end smallexample
29505
29506 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
29507 @samp{-exec-run}.
29508
29509 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29510
29511 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
29512
29513 @subsubheading Example
29514
29515 @smallexample
29516 (gdb)
29517 -exec-arguments -v word
29518 ^done
29519 (gdb)
29520 @end smallexample
29521
29522
29523 @ignore
29524 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
29525 @findex -exec-show-arguments
29526
29527 @subsubheading Synopsis
29528
29529 @smallexample
29530 -exec-show-arguments
29531 @end smallexample
29532
29533 Print the arguments of the program.
29534
29535 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29536
29537 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
29538
29539 @subsubheading Example
29540 N.A.
29541 @end ignore
29542
29543
29544 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
29545 @findex -environment-cd
29546
29547 @subsubheading Synopsis
29548
29549 @smallexample
29550 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
29551 @end smallexample
29552
29553 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
29554
29555 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29556
29557 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
29558
29559 @subsubheading Example
29560
29561 @smallexample
29562 (gdb)
29563 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29564 ^done
29565 (gdb)
29566 @end smallexample
29567
29568
29569 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
29570 @findex -environment-directory
29571
29572 @subsubheading Synopsis
29573
29574 @smallexample
29575 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29576 @end smallexample
29577
29578 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
29579 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
29580 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
29581 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29582 occurs as normal.
29583 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29584 multiple directories in a single command
29585 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29586 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29587 If blanks are needed as
29588 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29589 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29590 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29591 character must not be used
29592 in any directory name.
29593 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
29594
29595 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29596
29597 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
29598
29599 @subsubheading Example
29600
29601 @smallexample
29602 (gdb)
29603 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29604 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29605 (gdb)
29606 -environment-directory ""
29607 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29608 (gdb)
29609 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
29610 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
29611 (gdb)
29612 -environment-directory -r
29613 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
29614 (gdb)
29615 @end smallexample
29616
29617
29618 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
29619 @findex -environment-path
29620
29621 @subsubheading Synopsis
29622
29623 @smallexample
29624 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29625 @end smallexample
29626
29627 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
29628 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
29629 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
29630 supplied in addition to the
29631 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29632 occurs as normal.
29633 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29634 multiple directories in a single command
29635 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29636 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29637 If blanks are needed as
29638 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29639 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29640 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29641 character must not be used
29642 in any directory name.
29643 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
29644
29645
29646 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29647
29648 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
29649
29650 @subsubheading Example
29651
29652 @smallexample
29653 (gdb)
29654 -environment-path
29655 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
29656 (gdb)
29657 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
29658 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
29659 (gdb)
29660 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
29661 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
29662 (gdb)
29663 @end smallexample
29664
29665
29666 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
29667 @findex -environment-pwd
29668
29669 @subsubheading Synopsis
29670
29671 @smallexample
29672 -environment-pwd
29673 @end smallexample
29674
29675 Show the current working directory.
29676
29677 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29678
29679 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
29680
29681 @subsubheading Example
29682
29683 @smallexample
29684 (gdb)
29685 -environment-pwd
29686 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
29687 (gdb)
29688 @end smallexample
29689
29690 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29691 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
29692 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
29693
29694
29695 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
29696 @findex -thread-info
29697
29698 @subsubheading Synopsis
29699
29700 @smallexample
29701 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
29702 @end smallexample
29703
29704 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
29705 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
29706 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
29707 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
29708 current thread.
29709
29710 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29711
29712 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
29713 about all threads.
29714
29715 @subsubheading Result
29716
29717 The result contains the following attributes:
29718
29719 @table @samp
29720 @item threads
29721 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
29722 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
29723
29724 @item current-thread-id
29725 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
29726 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
29727 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
29728 the command.
29729
29730 @end table
29731
29732 @subsubheading Example
29733
29734 @smallexample
29735 -thread-info
29736 ^done,threads=[
29737 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
29738 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
29739 args=[]@},state="running"@},
29740 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
29741 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
29742 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
29743 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29744 state="running"@}],
29745 current-thread-id="1"
29746 (gdb)
29747 @end smallexample
29748
29749 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
29750 @findex -thread-list-ids
29751
29752 @subsubheading Synopsis
29753
29754 @smallexample
29755 -thread-list-ids
29756 @end smallexample
29757
29758 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
29759 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
29760 threads.
29761
29762 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
29763 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
29764
29765 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29766
29767 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
29768
29769 @subsubheading Example
29770
29771 @smallexample
29772 (gdb)
29773 -thread-list-ids
29774 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29775 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
29776 (gdb)
29777 @end smallexample
29778
29779
29780 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
29781 @findex -thread-select
29782
29783 @subsubheading Synopsis
29784
29785 @smallexample
29786 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
29787 @end smallexample
29788
29789 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
29790 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
29791 topmost frame for that thread.
29792
29793 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
29794 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
29795
29796 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29797
29798 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
29799
29800 @subsubheading Example
29801
29802 @smallexample
29803 (gdb)
29804 -exec-next
29805 ^running
29806 (gdb)
29807 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
29808 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
29809 (gdb)
29810 -thread-list-ids
29811 ^done,
29812 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29813 number-of-threads="3"
29814 (gdb)
29815 -thread-select 3
29816 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
29817 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
29818 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
29819 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29820 (gdb)
29821 @end smallexample
29822
29823 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29824 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
29825 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
29826
29827 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
29828 @findex -ada-task-info
29829
29830 @subsubheading Synopsis
29831
29832 @smallexample
29833 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
29834 @end smallexample
29835
29836 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
29837 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
29838
29839 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29840
29841 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
29842 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
29843
29844 @subsubheading Result
29845
29846 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
29847 defined for each Ada task:
29848
29849 @table @samp
29850 @item current
29851 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
29852
29853 @item id
29854 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
29855
29856 @item task-id
29857 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
29858
29859 @item thread-id
29860 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
29861 task.
29862
29863 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
29864 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
29865 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
29866
29867 @item parent-id
29868 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
29869 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
29870
29871 @item priority
29872 The base priority of the task.
29873
29874 @item state
29875 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
29876 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
29877
29878 @item name
29879 The name of the task.
29880
29881 @end table
29882
29883 @subsubheading Example
29884
29885 @smallexample
29886 -ada-task-info
29887 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
29888 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
29889 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
29890 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
29891 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
29892 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
29893 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
29894 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
29895 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
29896 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
29897 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
29898 (gdb)
29899 @end smallexample
29900
29901 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29902 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
29903 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
29904
29905 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
29906 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
29907 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
29908 other cases.
29909
29910 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
29911 @findex -exec-continue
29912
29913 @subsubheading Synopsis
29914
29915 @smallexample
29916 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
29917 @end smallexample
29918
29919 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
29920 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
29921 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
29922 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
29923 @itemize @bullet
29924 @item
29925 breakpoints or watchpoints
29926 @item
29927 signals or exceptions
29928 @item
29929 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
29930 @item
29931 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
29932 @end itemize
29933 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
29934 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
29935 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
29936 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
29937 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
29938 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
29939
29940 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29941
29942 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
29943
29944 @subsubheading Example
29945
29946 @smallexample
29947 -exec-continue
29948 ^running
29949 (gdb)
29950 @@Hello world
29951 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
29952 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
29953 line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29954 (gdb)
29955 @end smallexample
29956
29957
29958 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
29959 @findex -exec-finish
29960
29961 @subsubheading Synopsis
29962
29963 @smallexample
29964 -exec-finish [--reverse]
29965 @end smallexample
29966
29967 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
29968 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
29969 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
29970 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
29971 function was called.
29972
29973 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29974
29975 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
29976
29977 @subsubheading Example
29978
29979 Function returning @code{void}.
29980
29981 @smallexample
29982 -exec-finish
29983 ^running
29984 (gdb)
29985 @@hello from foo
29986 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29987 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29988 (gdb)
29989 @end smallexample
29990
29991 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
29992 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
29993 value itself.
29994
29995 @smallexample
29996 -exec-finish
29997 ^running
29998 (gdb)
29999 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
30000 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
30001 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30002 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30003 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
30004 (gdb)
30005 @end smallexample
30006
30007
30008 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
30009 @findex -exec-interrupt
30010
30011 @subsubheading Synopsis
30012
30013 @smallexample
30014 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
30015 @end smallexample
30016
30017 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
30018 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
30019 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
30020 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
30021 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
30022
30023 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
30024 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
30025 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
30026 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
30027
30028 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
30029 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
30030 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
30031 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
30032
30033 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30034
30035 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
30036
30037 @subsubheading Example
30038
30039 @smallexample
30040 (gdb)
30041 111-exec-continue
30042 111^running
30043
30044 (gdb)
30045 222-exec-interrupt
30046 222^done
30047 (gdb)
30048 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
30049 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30050 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30051 (gdb)
30052
30053 (gdb)
30054 -exec-interrupt
30055 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
30056 (gdb)
30057 @end smallexample
30058
30059 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
30060 @findex -exec-jump
30061
30062 @subsubheading Synopsis
30063
30064 @smallexample
30065 -exec-jump @var{location}
30066 @end smallexample
30067
30068 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
30069 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
30070 different forms of @var{location}.
30071
30072 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30073
30074 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
30075
30076 @subsubheading Example
30077
30078 @smallexample
30079 -exec-jump foo.c:10
30080 *running,thread-id="all"
30081 ^running
30082 @end smallexample
30083
30084
30085 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
30086 @findex -exec-next
30087
30088 @subsubheading Synopsis
30089
30090 @smallexample
30091 -exec-next [--reverse]
30092 @end smallexample
30093
30094 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
30095 of the next source line is reached.
30096
30097 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
30098 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
30099 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
30100 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
30101 source line where the function was called.
30102
30103
30104 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30105
30106 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
30107
30108 @subsubheading Example
30109
30110 @smallexample
30111 -exec-next
30112 ^running
30113 (gdb)
30114 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
30115 (gdb)
30116 @end smallexample
30117
30118
30119 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
30120 @findex -exec-next-instruction
30121
30122 @subsubheading Synopsis
30123
30124 @smallexample
30125 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
30126 @end smallexample
30127
30128 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
30129 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
30130 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
30131 printed as well.
30132
30133 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
30134 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
30135 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
30136 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
30137 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
30138
30139 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30140
30141 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
30142
30143 @subsubheading Example
30144
30145 @smallexample
30146 (gdb)
30147 -exec-next-instruction
30148 ^running
30149
30150 (gdb)
30151 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30152 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
30153 (gdb)
30154 @end smallexample
30155
30156
30157 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
30158 @findex -exec-return
30159
30160 @subsubheading Synopsis
30161
30162 @smallexample
30163 -exec-return
30164 @end smallexample
30165
30166 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
30167 Displays the new current frame.
30168
30169 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30170
30171 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
30172
30173 @subsubheading Example
30174
30175 @smallexample
30176 (gdb)
30177 200-break-insert callee4
30178 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
30179 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
30180 (gdb)
30181 000-exec-run
30182 000^running
30183 (gdb)
30184 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
30185 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
30186 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30187 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30188 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30189 (gdb)
30190 205-break-delete
30191 205^done
30192 (gdb)
30193 111-exec-return
30194 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
30195 args=[@{name="strarg",
30196 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
30197 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30198 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
30199 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30200 (gdb)
30201 @end smallexample
30202
30203
30204 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
30205 @findex -exec-run
30206
30207 @subsubheading Synopsis
30208
30209 @smallexample
30210 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
30211 @end smallexample
30212
30213 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
30214 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
30215 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
30216 the program has exited exceptionally.
30217
30218 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
30219 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
30220 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
30221 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
30222 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
30223
30224 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
30225 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
30226 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
30227 (@pxref{Starting}).
30228
30229 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30230
30231 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
30232
30233 @subsubheading Examples
30234
30235 @smallexample
30236 (gdb)
30237 -break-insert main
30238 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
30239 (gdb)
30240 -exec-run
30241 ^running
30242 (gdb)
30243 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
30244 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
30245 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30246 (gdb)
30247 @end smallexample
30248
30249 @noindent
30250 Program exited normally:
30251
30252 @smallexample
30253 (gdb)
30254 -exec-run
30255 ^running
30256 (gdb)
30257 x = 55
30258 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
30259 (gdb)
30260 @end smallexample
30261
30262 @noindent
30263 Program exited exceptionally:
30264
30265 @smallexample
30266 (gdb)
30267 -exec-run
30268 ^running
30269 (gdb)
30270 x = 55
30271 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
30272 (gdb)
30273 @end smallexample
30274
30275 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
30276 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
30277
30278 @smallexample
30279 (gdb)
30280 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
30281 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
30282 @end smallexample
30283
30284
30285 @c @subheading -exec-signal
30286
30287
30288 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
30289 @findex -exec-step
30290
30291 @subsubheading Synopsis
30292
30293 @smallexample
30294 -exec-step [--reverse]
30295 @end smallexample
30296
30297 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
30298 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
30299 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
30300 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
30301 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
30302 previously executed source line.
30303
30304 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30305
30306 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
30307
30308 @subsubheading Example
30309
30310 Stepping into a function:
30311
30312 @smallexample
30313 -exec-step
30314 ^running
30315 (gdb)
30316 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30317 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
30318 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
30319 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30320 (gdb)
30321 @end smallexample
30322
30323 Regular stepping:
30324
30325 @smallexample
30326 -exec-step
30327 ^running
30328 (gdb)
30329 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
30330 (gdb)
30331 @end smallexample
30332
30333
30334 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
30335 @findex -exec-step-instruction
30336
30337 @subsubheading Synopsis
30338
30339 @smallexample
30340 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
30341 @end smallexample
30342
30343 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
30344 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
30345 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
30346 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
30347 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
30348 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
30349 as well.
30350
30351 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30352
30353 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
30354
30355 @subsubheading Example
30356
30357 @smallexample
30358 (gdb)
30359 -exec-step-instruction
30360 ^running
30361
30362 (gdb)
30363 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30364 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30365 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30366 (gdb)
30367 -exec-step-instruction
30368 ^running
30369
30370 (gdb)
30371 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30372 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30373 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30374 (gdb)
30375 @end smallexample
30376
30377
30378 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
30379 @findex -exec-until
30380
30381 @subsubheading Synopsis
30382
30383 @smallexample
30384 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
30385 @end smallexample
30386
30387 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
30388 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
30389 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
30390 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
30391
30392 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30393
30394 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
30395
30396 @subsubheading Example
30397
30398 @smallexample
30399 (gdb)
30400 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
30401 ^running
30402 (gdb)
30403 x = 55
30404 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
30405 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6",
30406 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30407 (gdb)
30408 @end smallexample
30409
30410 @ignore
30411 @subheading -file-clear
30412 Is this going away????
30413 @end ignore
30414
30415 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30416 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
30417 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
30418
30419 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
30420 @findex -enable-frame-filters
30421
30422 @smallexample
30423 -enable-frame-filters
30424 @end smallexample
30425
30426 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
30427 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
30428 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30429 request that this functionality be enabled.
30430
30431 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30432
30433 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30434 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30435
30436 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
30437 @findex -stack-info-frame
30438
30439 @subsubheading Synopsis
30440
30441 @smallexample
30442 -stack-info-frame
30443 @end smallexample
30444
30445 Get info on the selected frame.
30446
30447 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30448
30449 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
30450 (without arguments).
30451
30452 @subsubheading Example
30453
30454 @smallexample
30455 (gdb)
30456 -stack-info-frame
30457 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30458 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30459 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30460 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30461 (gdb)
30462 @end smallexample
30463
30464 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
30465 @findex -stack-info-depth
30466
30467 @subsubheading Synopsis
30468
30469 @smallexample
30470 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
30471 @end smallexample
30472
30473 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
30474 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
30475
30476 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30477
30478 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30479
30480 @subsubheading Example
30481
30482 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
30483
30484 @smallexample
30485 (gdb)
30486 -stack-info-depth
30487 ^done,depth="12"
30488 (gdb)
30489 -stack-info-depth 4
30490 ^done,depth="4"
30491 (gdb)
30492 -stack-info-depth 12
30493 ^done,depth="12"
30494 (gdb)
30495 -stack-info-depth 11
30496 ^done,depth="11"
30497 (gdb)
30498 -stack-info-depth 13
30499 ^done,depth="12"
30500 (gdb)
30501 @end smallexample
30502
30503 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
30504 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
30505 @findex -stack-list-arguments
30506
30507 @subsubheading Synopsis
30508
30509 @smallexample
30510 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30511 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30512 @end smallexample
30513
30514 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
30515 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
30516 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
30517 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
30518 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
30519 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
30520 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
30521 which case only existing frames will be returned.
30522
30523 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30524 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30525 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30526 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30527 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30528 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30529
30530 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
30531 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
30532 are still displayed, however.
30533
30534 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
30535 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30536
30537 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30538
30539 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
30540 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
30541 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
30542
30543 @subsubheading Example
30544
30545 @smallexample
30546 (gdb)
30547 -stack-list-frames
30548 ^done,
30549 stack=[
30550 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30551 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30552 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30553 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30554 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30555 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30556 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30557 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30558 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
30559 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30560 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22",
30561 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30562 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
30563 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30564 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27",
30565 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30566 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
30567 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30568 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32",
30569 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30570 (gdb)
30571 -stack-list-arguments 0
30572 ^done,
30573 stack-args=[
30574 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30575 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
30576 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
30577 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
30578 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30579 (gdb)
30580 -stack-list-arguments 1
30581 ^done,
30582 stack-args=[
30583 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30584 frame=@{level="1",
30585 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30586 frame=@{level="2",args=[
30587 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30588 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30589 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
30590 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30591 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
30592 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
30593 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30594 (gdb)
30595 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
30596 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
30597 (gdb)
30598 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
30599 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
30600 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30601 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
30602 (gdb)
30603 @end smallexample
30604
30605 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
30606
30607
30608 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
30609 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
30610 @findex -stack-list-frames
30611
30612 @subsubheading Synopsis
30613
30614 @smallexample
30615 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30616 @end smallexample
30617
30618 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
30619 following info:
30620
30621 @table @samp
30622 @item @var{level}
30623 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
30624 @item @var{addr}
30625 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
30626 @item @var{func}
30627 Function name.
30628 @item @var{file}
30629 File name of the source file where the function lives.
30630 @item @var{fullname}
30631 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
30632 @item @var{line}
30633 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
30634 @item @var{from}
30635 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
30636 if the frame's function is not known.
30637 @item @var{arch}
30638 Frame's architecture.
30639 @end table
30640
30641 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
30642 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
30643 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
30644 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
30645 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
30646 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
30647 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
30648 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30649 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30650
30651 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30652
30653 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
30654
30655 @subsubheading Example
30656
30657 Full stack backtrace:
30658
30659 @smallexample
30660 (gdb)
30661 -stack-list-frames
30662 ^done,stack=
30663 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
30664 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",
30665 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30666 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30667 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30668 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30669 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30670 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30671 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30672 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30673 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30674 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30675 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30676 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30677 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30678 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30679 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30680 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30681 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30682 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30683 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30684 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30685 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30686 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30687 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30688 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30689 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30690 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30691 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30692 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30693 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30694 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30695 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30696 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
30697 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",
30698 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30699 (gdb)
30700 @end smallexample
30701
30702 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
30703
30704 @smallexample
30705 (gdb)
30706 -stack-list-frames 3 5
30707 ^done,stack=
30708 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30709 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30710 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30711 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30712 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30713 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30714 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30715 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30716 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30717 (gdb)
30718 @end smallexample
30719
30720 Show a single frame:
30721
30722 @smallexample
30723 (gdb)
30724 -stack-list-frames 3 3
30725 ^done,stack=
30726 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30727 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30728 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30729 (gdb)
30730 @end smallexample
30731
30732
30733 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
30734 @findex -stack-list-locals
30735 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
30736
30737 @subsubheading Synopsis
30738
30739 @smallexample
30740 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30741 @end smallexample
30742
30743 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
30744 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30745 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30746 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30747 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30748 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
30749 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
30750 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
30751 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30752 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30753
30754 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30755 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
30756 variables are still displayed, however.
30757
30758 This command is deprecated in favor of the
30759 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30760
30761 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30762
30763 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
30764
30765 @subsubheading Example
30766
30767 @smallexample
30768 (gdb)
30769 -stack-list-locals 0
30770 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
30771 (gdb)
30772 -stack-list-locals --all-values
30773 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
30774 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
30775 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
30776 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
30777 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
30778 (gdb)
30779 @end smallexample
30780
30781 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
30782 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
30783 @findex -stack-list-variables
30784
30785 @subsubheading Synopsis
30786
30787 @smallexample
30788 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30789 @end smallexample
30790
30791 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
30792 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30793 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30794 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30795 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30796 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30797 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30798
30799 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30800 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
30801 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
30802
30803 @subsubheading Example
30804
30805 @smallexample
30806 (gdb)
30807 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
30808 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
30809 (gdb)
30810 @end smallexample
30811
30812
30813 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
30814 @findex -stack-select-frame
30815
30816 @subsubheading Synopsis
30817
30818 @smallexample
30819 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
30820 @end smallexample
30821
30822 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
30823 the stack.
30824
30825 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
30826 option to every command.
30827
30828 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30829
30830 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
30831 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
30832
30833 @subsubheading Example
30834
30835 @smallexample
30836 (gdb)
30837 -stack-select-frame 2
30838 ^done
30839 (gdb)
30840 @end smallexample
30841
30842 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30843 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
30844 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
30845
30846 @ignore
30847
30848 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30849
30850 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
30851 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
30852 used by @code{Insight}.
30853
30854 The two main reasons for that are:
30855
30856 @enumerate 1
30857 @item
30858 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
30859
30860 @item
30861 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
30862 now).
30863 @end enumerate
30864
30865 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
30866 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
30867 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
30868 hints about their use.
30869
30870 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
30871 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
30872 least, the following operations:
30873
30874 @itemize @bullet
30875 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
30876 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
30877 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
30878 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
30879 @end itemize
30880
30881 @end ignore
30882
30883 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
30884
30885 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30886
30887 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
30888 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
30889 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
30890 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
30891 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
30892 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
30893 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
30894 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
30895 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
30896 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
30897 object, or to change display format.
30898
30899 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
30900 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
30901 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
30902 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
30903 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
30904 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
30905 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
30906 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
30907 child will be created.
30908
30909 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
30910 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
30911 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
30912 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
30913 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
30914
30915 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
30916 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
30917 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
30918 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
30919 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
30920 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
30921 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
30922 variables that frontend has created.
30923
30924 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
30925 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
30926 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
30927 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
30928 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
30929 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
30930 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
30931 implicitly updated.
30932
30933 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
30934 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
30935 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
30936 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
30937 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
30938 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
30939 frame. Consider this example:
30940
30941 @smallexample
30942 void do_work(...)
30943 @{
30944 struct work_state state;
30945
30946 if (...)
30947 do_work(...);
30948 @}
30949 @end smallexample
30950
30951 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
30952 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
30953 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
30954 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
30955 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
30956
30957 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
30958 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
30959 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
30960 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
30961 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
30962 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
30963
30964 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
30965 access this functionality:
30966
30967 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
30968 @item @strong{Operation}
30969 @tab @strong{Description}
30970
30971 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
30972 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
30973 @item @code{-var-create}
30974 @tab create a variable object
30975 @item @code{-var-delete}
30976 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
30977 @item @code{-var-set-format}
30978 @tab set the display format of this variable
30979 @item @code{-var-show-format}
30980 @tab show the display format of this variable
30981 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
30982 @tab tells how many children this object has
30983 @item @code{-var-list-children}
30984 @tab return a list of the object's children
30985 @item @code{-var-info-type}
30986 @tab show the type of this variable object
30987 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
30988 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
30989 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
30990 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
30991 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
30992 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
30993 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
30994 @tab get the value of this variable
30995 @item @code{-var-assign}
30996 @tab set the value of this variable
30997 @item @code{-var-update}
30998 @tab update the variable and its children
30999 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
31000 @tab set frozeness attribute
31001 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
31002 @tab set range of children to display on update
31003 @end multitable
31004
31005 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
31006 how it can be used.
31007
31008 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
31009
31010 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
31011 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
31012
31013 @smallexample
31014 -enable-pretty-printing
31015 @end smallexample
31016
31017 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
31018 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
31019 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
31020 request that this functionality be enabled.
31021
31022 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
31023
31024 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
31025 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
31026
31027 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
31028 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
31029
31030 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
31031 @findex -var-create
31032
31033 @subsubheading Synopsis
31034
31035 @smallexample
31036 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
31037 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
31038 @end smallexample
31039
31040 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
31041 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
31042 register.
31043
31044 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
31045 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
31046 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
31047 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
31048 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
31049
31050 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
31051 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
31052 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
31053 object must be created.
31054
31055 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
31056 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
31057
31058 @itemize @bullet
31059 @item
31060 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
31061
31062 @item
31063 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
31064
31065 @item
31066 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
31067 @end itemize
31068
31069 @cindex dynamic varobj
31070 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
31071 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
31072 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
31073 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
31074 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
31075 compatibility for existing clients.
31076
31077 @subsubheading Result
31078
31079 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
31080 are:
31081
31082 @table @samp
31083 @item name
31084 The name of the varobj.
31085
31086 @item numchild
31087 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
31088 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
31089 @samp{has_more} attribute.
31090
31091 @item value
31092 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
31093 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
31094 will not be interesting.
31095
31096 @item type
31097 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
31098 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
31099 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
31100 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
31101 @emph{declared} one.
31102
31103 @item thread-id
31104 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
31105 thread's global identifier.
31106
31107 @item has_more
31108 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
31109 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
31110
31111 @item dynamic
31112 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31113 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31114 then this attribute will not be present.
31115
31116 @item displayhint
31117 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31118 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31119 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31120 @end table
31121
31122 Typical output will look like this:
31123
31124 @smallexample
31125 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
31126 has_more="@var{has_more}"
31127 @end smallexample
31128
31129
31130 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
31131 @findex -var-delete
31132
31133 @subsubheading Synopsis
31134
31135 @smallexample
31136 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
31137 @end smallexample
31138
31139 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
31140 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
31141
31142 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
31143
31144
31145 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
31146 @findex -var-set-format
31147
31148 @subsubheading Synopsis
31149
31150 @smallexample
31151 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
31152 @end smallexample
31153
31154 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
31155 @var{format-spec}.
31156
31157 @anchor{-var-set-format}
31158 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
31159
31160 @smallexample
31161 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
31162 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
31163 @end smallexample
31164
31165 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
31166 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
31167 for pointers, etc.).
31168
31169 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
31170 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
31171 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
31172 zero-hexadecimal format.
31173
31174 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
31175 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
31176
31177 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
31178 @findex -var-show-format
31179
31180 @subsubheading Synopsis
31181
31182 @smallexample
31183 -var-show-format @var{name}
31184 @end smallexample
31185
31186 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
31187
31188 @smallexample
31189 @var{format} @expansion{}
31190 @var{format-spec}
31191 @end smallexample
31192
31193
31194 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
31195 @findex -var-info-num-children
31196
31197 @subsubheading Synopsis
31198
31199 @smallexample
31200 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
31201 @end smallexample
31202
31203 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
31204
31205 @smallexample
31206 numchild=@var{n}
31207 @end smallexample
31208
31209 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
31210 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
31211 be available.
31212
31213
31214 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
31215 @findex -var-list-children
31216
31217 @subsubheading Synopsis
31218
31219 @smallexample
31220 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
31221 @end smallexample
31222 @anchor{-var-list-children}
31223
31224 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
31225 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
31226 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
31227 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
31228 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
31229 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
31230 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
31231 and unions.
31232
31233 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
31234 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
31235 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
31236 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
31237 reported.
31238
31239 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
31240 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
31241 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
31242 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
31243 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
31244 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
31245 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
31246 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
31247 the visible items.
31248
31249 For each child the following results are returned:
31250
31251 @table @var
31252
31253 @item name
31254 Name of the variable object created for this child.
31255
31256 @item exp
31257 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
31258 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
31259
31260 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
31261 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
31262
31263 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
31264 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
31265 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
31266 type and value are not present.
31267
31268 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
31269 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
31270 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
31271
31272 @item numchild
31273 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
31274 0.
31275
31276 @item type
31277 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
31278 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
31279 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
31280 @emph{declared} one.
31281
31282 @item value
31283 If values were requested, this is the value.
31284
31285 @item thread-id
31286 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
31287 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
31288
31289 @item frozen
31290 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
31291
31292 @item displayhint
31293 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31294 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31295 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31296
31297 @item dynamic
31298 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31299 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31300 then this attribute will not be present.
31301
31302 @end table
31303
31304 The result may have its own attributes:
31305
31306 @table @samp
31307 @item displayhint
31308 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31309 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31310 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31311
31312 @item has_more
31313 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
31314 remaining after the end of the selected range.
31315 @end table
31316
31317 @subsubheading Example
31318
31319 @smallexample
31320 (gdb)
31321 -var-list-children n
31322 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
31323 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
31324 (gdb)
31325 -var-list-children --all-values n
31326 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
31327 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
31328 @end smallexample
31329
31330
31331 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
31332 @findex -var-info-type
31333
31334 @subsubheading Synopsis
31335
31336 @smallexample
31337 -var-info-type @var{name}
31338 @end smallexample
31339
31340 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
31341 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
31342 @value{GDBN} CLI:
31343
31344 @smallexample
31345 type=@var{typename}
31346 @end smallexample
31347
31348
31349 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
31350 @findex -var-info-expression
31351
31352 @subsubheading Synopsis
31353
31354 @smallexample
31355 -var-info-expression @var{name}
31356 @end smallexample
31357
31358 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
31359 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
31360 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
31361
31362 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
31363 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
31364
31365 @smallexample
31366 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
31367 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
31368 @end smallexample
31369
31370 @noindent
31371 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
31372 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
31373
31374 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
31375 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
31376 is of limited use.
31377
31378 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
31379 @findex -var-info-path-expression
31380
31381 @subsubheading Synopsis
31382
31383 @smallexample
31384 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
31385 @end smallexample
31386
31387 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
31388 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
31389 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
31390 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
31391 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
31392 watchpoint from a variable object.
31393
31394 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
31395 and will give an error when invoked on one.
31396
31397 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
31398 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
31399 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
31400 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
31401 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
31402 @smallexample
31403 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
31404 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
31405 @end smallexample
31406
31407 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
31408 @findex -var-show-attributes
31409
31410 @subsubheading Synopsis
31411
31412 @smallexample
31413 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
31414 @end smallexample
31415
31416 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
31417
31418 @smallexample
31419 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
31420 @end smallexample
31421
31422 @noindent
31423 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
31424
31425 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
31426 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
31427
31428 @subsubheading Synopsis
31429
31430 @smallexample
31431 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
31432 @end smallexample
31433
31434 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
31435 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
31436 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
31437 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
31438 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
31439 the current display format will be used. The current display format
31440 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
31441
31442 @smallexample
31443 value=@var{value}
31444 @end smallexample
31445
31446 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
31447 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
31448
31449 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
31450 @findex -var-assign
31451
31452 @subsubheading Synopsis
31453
31454 @smallexample
31455 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
31456 @end smallexample
31457
31458 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
31459 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
31460 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
31461 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
31462
31463 @subsubheading Example
31464
31465 @smallexample
31466 (gdb)
31467 -var-assign var1 3
31468 ^done,value="3"
31469 (gdb)
31470 -var-update *
31471 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
31472 (gdb)
31473 @end smallexample
31474
31475 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
31476 @findex -var-update
31477
31478 @subsubheading Synopsis
31479
31480 @smallexample
31481 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
31482 @end smallexample
31483
31484 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
31485 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
31486 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
31487 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
31488 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
31489 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
31490 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
31491 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
31492 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
31493 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
31494 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
31495 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
31496 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
31497
31498 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
31499 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
31500 diagnostic.
31501
31502 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
31503 only the selected range of children will be reported.
31504
31505 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
31506 @samp{changelist}.
31507
31508 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
31509
31510 @table @samp
31511 @item name
31512 The name of the varobj.
31513
31514 @item value
31515 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
31516 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
31517
31518 @item in_scope
31519 @anchor{-var-update}
31520 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
31521
31522 @table @code
31523 @item "true"
31524 The variable object's current value is valid.
31525
31526 @item "false"
31527 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
31528 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
31529 scope.
31530
31531 @item "invalid"
31532 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
31533 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
31534 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
31535 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
31536 objects.
31537 @end table
31538
31539 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
31540 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
31541
31542 @item type_changed
31543 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
31544 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
31545 be @samp{false}.
31546
31547 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
31548 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
31549 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
31550 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
31551 unset.
31552
31553 @item new_type
31554 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
31555 hold the new type.
31556
31557 @item new_num_children
31558 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
31559 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
31560
31561 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
31562 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
31563 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
31564 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
31565 children which may be available.
31566
31567 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
31568 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
31569 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
31570 only happen at the end of the update range).
31571
31572 @item displayhint
31573 The display hint, if any.
31574
31575 @item has_more
31576 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
31577 available outside the varobj's update range.
31578
31579 @item dynamic
31580 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31581 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31582 then this attribute will not be present.
31583
31584 @item new_children
31585 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
31586 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
31587 be listed in this attribute.
31588 @end table
31589
31590 @subsubheading Example
31591
31592 @smallexample
31593 (gdb)
31594 -var-assign var1 3
31595 ^done,value="3"
31596 (gdb)
31597 -var-update --all-values var1
31598 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
31599 type_changed="false"@}]
31600 (gdb)
31601 @end smallexample
31602
31603 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
31604 @findex -var-set-frozen
31605 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
31606
31607 @subsubheading Synopsis
31608
31609 @smallexample
31610 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
31611 @end smallexample
31612
31613 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
31614 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
31615 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
31616 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
31617 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
31618 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
31619 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
31620 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
31621 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
31622 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
31623 @code{-var-update} does.
31624
31625 @subsubheading Example
31626
31627 @smallexample
31628 (gdb)
31629 -var-set-frozen V 1
31630 ^done
31631 (gdb)
31632 @end smallexample
31633
31634 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
31635 @findex -var-set-update-range
31636 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
31637
31638 @subsubheading Synopsis
31639
31640 @smallexample
31641 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
31642 @end smallexample
31643
31644 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
31645 @code{-var-update}.
31646
31647 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
31648 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
31649 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
31650 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
31651
31652 @subsubheading Example
31653
31654 @smallexample
31655 (gdb)
31656 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
31657 ^done
31658 @end smallexample
31659
31660 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
31661 @findex -var-set-visualizer
31662 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
31663
31664 @subsubheading Synopsis
31665
31666 @smallexample
31667 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
31668 @end smallexample
31669
31670 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
31671
31672 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
31673 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
31674
31675 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
31676 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
31677 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
31678 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
31679 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
31680 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
31681 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
31682
31683 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
31684 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
31685 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
31686 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
31687
31688 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
31689 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
31690 can be used to check this.
31691
31692 @subsubheading Example
31693
31694 Resetting the visualizer:
31695
31696 @smallexample
31697 (gdb)
31698 -var-set-visualizer V None
31699 ^done
31700 @end smallexample
31701
31702 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
31703
31704 @smallexample
31705 (gdb)
31706 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
31707 ^done
31708 @end smallexample
31709
31710 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
31711 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
31712
31713 @smallexample
31714 (gdb)
31715 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
31716 ^done
31717 @end smallexample
31718
31719 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31720 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
31721 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
31722
31723 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
31724 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
31725 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
31726 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
31727
31728 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
31729 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
31730
31731 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
31732 @c @subheading -data-assign
31733 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
31734 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
31735 @c set variable
31736 @c @subsubheading Example
31737 @c N.A.
31738
31739 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
31740 @findex -data-disassemble
31741
31742 @subsubheading Synopsis
31743
31744 @smallexample
31745 -data-disassemble
31746 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
31747 | [ -a @var{addr} ]
31748 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
31749 -- @var{mode}
31750 @end smallexample
31751
31752 @noindent
31753 Where:
31754
31755 @table @samp
31756 @item @var{start-addr}
31757 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
31758 @item @var{end-addr}
31759 is the end address
31760 @item @var{addr}
31761 is an address anywhere within (or the name of) the function to
31762 disassemble. If an address is specified, the whole function
31763 surrounding that address will be disassembled. If a name is
31764 specified, the whole function with that name will be disassembled.
31765 @item @var{filename}
31766 is the name of the file to disassemble
31767 @item @var{linenum}
31768 is the line number to disassemble around
31769 @item @var{lines}
31770 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
31771 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
31772 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
31773 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
31774 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
31775 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
31776 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
31777 are displayed.
31778 @item @var{mode}
31779 is one of:
31780 @itemize @bullet
31781 @item 0 disassembly only
31782 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
31783 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
31784 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
31785 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
31786 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
31787 @end itemize
31788
31789 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
31790 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
31791 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
31792 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
31793 @end table
31794
31795 @subsubheading Result
31796
31797 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
31798 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
31799 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
31800
31801 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
31802 following fields:
31803
31804 @table @code
31805 @item address
31806 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
31807
31808 @item func-name
31809 The name of the function this instruction is within.
31810
31811 @item offset
31812 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
31813
31814 @item inst
31815 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
31816
31817 @item opcodes
31818 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
31819 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
31820
31821 @end table
31822
31823 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
31824 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
31825
31826 @table @code
31827 @item line
31828 The line number within @samp{file}.
31829
31830 @item file
31831 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
31832 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
31833 used.
31834
31835 @item fullname
31836 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
31837 using the source file search path
31838 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
31839 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
31840
31841 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
31842 present in the debug information.
31843
31844 @item line_asm_insn
31845 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
31846 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
31847 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
31848 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
31849 @samp{opcodes}.
31850
31851 @end table
31852
31853 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
31854 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
31855 adjust its format.
31856
31857 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31858
31859 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
31860
31861 @subsubheading Example
31862
31863 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
31864
31865 @smallexample
31866 (gdb)
31867 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
31868 ^done,
31869 asm_insns=[
31870 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31871 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31872 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31873 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31874 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
31875 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
31876 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
31877 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31878 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
31879 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
31880 (gdb)
31881 @end smallexample
31882
31883 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
31884 @code{main}.
31885
31886 @smallexample
31887 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
31888 ^done,asm_insns=[
31889 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31890 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31891 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31892 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31893 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31894 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31895 [@dots{}]
31896 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
31897 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
31898 (gdb)
31899 @end smallexample
31900
31901 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
31902
31903 @smallexample
31904 (gdb)
31905 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
31906 ^done,asm_insns=[
31907 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31908 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31909 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31910 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31911 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31912 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
31913 (gdb)
31914 @end smallexample
31915
31916 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
31917
31918 @smallexample
31919 (gdb)
31920 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
31921 ^done,asm_insns=[
31922 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
31923 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31924 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31925 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
31926 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
31927 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
31928 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31929 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31930 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
31931 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31932 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31933 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
31934 (gdb)
31935 @end smallexample
31936
31937
31938 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
31939 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
31940
31941 @subsubheading Synopsis
31942
31943 @smallexample
31944 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
31945 @end smallexample
31946
31947 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
31948 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
31949 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
31950
31951 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31952
31953 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
31954 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
31955 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
31956
31957 @subsubheading Example
31958
31959 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
31960 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
31961 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
31962 output.
31963
31964 @smallexample
31965 211-data-evaluate-expression A
31966 211^done,value="1"
31967 (gdb)
31968 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
31969 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
31970 (gdb)
31971 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
31972 411^done,value="4"
31973 (gdb)
31974 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
31975 511^done,value="4"
31976 (gdb)
31977 @end smallexample
31978
31979
31980 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
31981 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
31982
31983 @subsubheading Synopsis
31984
31985 @smallexample
31986 -data-list-changed-registers
31987 @end smallexample
31988
31989 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
31990
31991 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31992
31993 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
31994 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
31995
31996 @subsubheading Example
31997
31998 On a PPC MBX board:
31999
32000 @smallexample
32001 (gdb)
32002 -exec-continue
32003 ^running
32004
32005 (gdb)
32006 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
32007 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
32008 line="5",arch="powerpc"@}
32009 (gdb)
32010 -data-list-changed-registers
32011 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
32012 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
32013 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
32014 (gdb)
32015 @end smallexample
32016
32017
32018 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
32019 @findex -data-list-register-names
32020
32021 @subsubheading Synopsis
32022
32023 @smallexample
32024 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
32025 @end smallexample
32026
32027 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
32028 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
32029 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
32030 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
32031 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
32032 include empty register names.
32033
32034 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32035
32036 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
32037 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
32038 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
32039
32040 @subsubheading Example
32041
32042 For the PPC MBX board:
32043 @smallexample
32044 (gdb)
32045 -data-list-register-names
32046 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
32047 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
32048 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
32049 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
32050 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
32051 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
32052 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
32053 (gdb)
32054 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
32055 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
32056 (gdb)
32057 @end smallexample
32058
32059 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
32060 @findex -data-list-register-values
32061
32062 @subsubheading Synopsis
32063
32064 @smallexample
32065 -data-list-register-values
32066 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
32067 @end smallexample
32068
32069 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
32070 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
32071 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
32072 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
32073 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
32074 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
32075
32076 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
32077
32078 @table @code
32079 @item x
32080 Hexadecimal
32081 @item o
32082 Octal
32083 @item t
32084 Binary
32085 @item d
32086 Decimal
32087 @item r
32088 Raw
32089 @item N
32090 Natural
32091 @end table
32092
32093 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32094
32095 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
32096 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
32097
32098 @subsubheading Example
32099
32100 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
32101 don't appear in the actual output):
32102
32103 @smallexample
32104 (gdb)
32105 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
32106 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
32107 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
32108 (gdb)
32109 -data-list-register-values x
32110 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
32111 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
32112 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
32113 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
32114 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
32115 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
32116 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
32117 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
32118 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
32119 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
32120 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
32121 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
32122 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
32123 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
32124 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
32125 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
32126 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
32127 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
32128 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
32129 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
32130 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
32131 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
32132 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
32133 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
32134 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
32135 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
32136 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
32137 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
32138 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
32139 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
32140 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
32141 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
32142 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
32143 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
32144 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
32145 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
32146 (gdb)
32147 @end smallexample
32148
32149
32150 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
32151 @findex -data-read-memory
32152
32153 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
32154
32155 @subsubheading Synopsis
32156
32157 @smallexample
32158 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
32159 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
32160 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
32161 @end smallexample
32162
32163 @noindent
32164 where:
32165
32166 @table @samp
32167 @item @var{address}
32168 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
32169 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
32170 quoted using the C convention.
32171
32172 @item @var{word-format}
32173 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
32174 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
32175 ,Output Formats}).
32176
32177 @item @var{word-size}
32178 The size of each memory word in bytes.
32179
32180 @item @var{nr-rows}
32181 The number of rows in the output table.
32182
32183 @item @var{nr-cols}
32184 The number of columns in the output table.
32185
32186 @item @var{aschar}
32187 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
32188 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
32189 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
32190 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
32191
32192 @item @var{byte-offset}
32193 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
32194 @end table
32195
32196 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
32197 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
32198 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
32199 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
32200 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
32201 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
32202 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
32203 @samp{addr}.
32204
32205 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
32206 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
32207 @samp{prev-page}.
32208
32209 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32210
32211 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
32212 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
32213
32214 @subsubheading Example
32215
32216 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
32217 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
32218 word. Display each word in hex.
32219
32220 @smallexample
32221 (gdb)
32222 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
32223 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
32224 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
32225 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
32226 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
32227 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
32228 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
32229 (gdb)
32230 @end smallexample
32231
32232 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
32233 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
32234
32235 @smallexample
32236 (gdb)
32237 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
32238 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
32239 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
32240 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
32241 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
32242 (gdb)
32243 @end smallexample
32244
32245 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
32246 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
32247 used as the non-printable character.
32248
32249 @smallexample
32250 (gdb)
32251 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
32252 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
32253 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
32254 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
32255 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32256 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32257 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32258 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32259 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
32260 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
32261 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
32262 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
32263 (gdb)
32264 @end smallexample
32265
32266 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
32267 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
32268
32269 @subsubheading Synopsis
32270
32271 @smallexample
32272 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
32273 @var{address} @var{count}
32274 @end smallexample
32275
32276 @noindent
32277 where:
32278
32279 @table @samp
32280 @item @var{address}
32281 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
32282 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
32283 quoted using the C convention.
32284
32285 @item @var{count}
32286 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
32287 literal.
32288
32289 @item @var{offset}
32290 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
32291 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
32292 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
32293 arithmetics itself.
32294
32295 @end table
32296
32297 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
32298 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
32299 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
32300 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
32301 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
32302 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
32303
32304 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
32305 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
32306 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
32307 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
32308 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
32309 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
32310 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
32311 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
32312
32313 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
32314 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
32315 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
32316 and has the following fields:
32317
32318 @table @code
32319 @item begin
32320 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
32321
32322 @item end
32323 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
32324
32325 @item offset
32326 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
32327 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
32328
32329 @item contents
32330 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
32331
32332 @end table
32333
32334
32335
32336 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32337
32338 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
32339
32340 @subsubheading Example
32341
32342 @smallexample
32343 (gdb)
32344 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
32345 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
32346 end="0xbffff15e",
32347 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
32348 (gdb)
32349 @end smallexample
32350
32351
32352 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
32353 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
32354
32355 @subsubheading Synopsis
32356
32357 @smallexample
32358 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
32359 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
32360 @end smallexample
32361
32362 @noindent
32363 where:
32364
32365 @table @samp
32366 @item @var{address}
32367 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
32368 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
32369 be quoted using the C convention.
32370
32371 @item @var{contents}
32372 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
32373 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
32374
32375 @item @var{count}
32376 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
32377 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
32378 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
32379 @var{count} memory units.
32380
32381 @end table
32382
32383 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32384
32385 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32386
32387 @subsubheading Example
32388
32389 @smallexample
32390 (gdb)
32391 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
32392 ^done
32393 (gdb)
32394 @end smallexample
32395
32396 @smallexample
32397 (gdb)
32398 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
32399 ^done
32400 (gdb)
32401 @end smallexample
32402
32403 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32404 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
32405 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
32406
32407 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
32408 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
32409
32410 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
32411 @findex -trace-find
32412
32413 @subsubheading Synopsis
32414
32415 @smallexample
32416 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
32417 @end smallexample
32418
32419 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
32420 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
32421 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
32422
32423 @table @samp
32424
32425 @item none
32426 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
32427
32428 @item frame-number
32429 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
32430 that index.
32431
32432 @item tracepoint-number
32433 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
32434 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
32435
32436 @item pc
32437 An address is required as parameter. Finds
32438 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
32439 address.
32440
32441 @item pc-inside-range
32442 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
32443 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
32444 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32445
32446 @item pc-outside-range
32447 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
32448 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
32449 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32450
32451 @item line
32452 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
32453 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
32454 the specified location.
32455
32456 @end table
32457
32458 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
32459 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
32460
32461 @table @samp
32462 @item found
32463 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
32464 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
32465
32466 @item traceframe
32467 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
32468 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32469
32470 @item tracepoint
32471 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
32472 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32473
32474 @item frame
32475 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
32476 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
32477 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
32478
32479 @end table
32480
32481 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32482
32483 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
32484
32485 @subheading -trace-define-variable
32486 @findex -trace-define-variable
32487
32488 @subsubheading Synopsis
32489
32490 @smallexample
32491 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
32492 @end smallexample
32493
32494 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
32495 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
32496 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
32497 with the @samp{$} character.
32498
32499 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32500
32501 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
32502
32503 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
32504 @findex -trace-frame-collected
32505
32506 @subsubheading Synopsis
32507
32508 @smallexample
32509 -trace-frame-collected
32510 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
32511 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
32512 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
32513 [--memory-contents]
32514 @end smallexample
32515
32516 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
32517 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
32518 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
32519 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
32520 See the output description table below for more details.
32521
32522 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
32523 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
32524 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
32525 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
32526 memory range and which is a computed expression.
32527
32528 For instance, if the actions were
32529 @smallexample
32530 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
32531 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
32532 @end smallexample
32533
32534 @noindent
32535 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
32536 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
32537 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
32538 objects would be computed expressions.
32539
32540 An example output would be:
32541
32542 @smallexample
32543 (gdb)
32544 -trace-frame-collected
32545 ^done,
32546 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
32547 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
32548 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
32549 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
32550 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
32551 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
32552 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
32553 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
32554 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
32555 ...
32556 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
32557 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
32558 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
32559 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
32560 (gdb)
32561 @end smallexample
32562
32563 Where:
32564
32565 @table @code
32566 @item explicit-variables
32567 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
32568 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
32569 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
32570 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
32571 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
32572 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
32573 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
32574 arrays, structures and unions.
32575
32576 @item computed-expressions
32577 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
32578 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
32579 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
32580 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
32581
32582 @item registers
32583 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
32584 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
32585 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
32586 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
32587 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
32588
32589 @item tvars
32590 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
32591 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
32592 current value are returned.
32593
32594 @item memory
32595 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
32596 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
32597 collected memory range and has the following fields:
32598
32599 @table @code
32600 @item address
32601 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
32602
32603 @item length
32604 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
32605
32606 @item contents
32607 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
32608 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
32609
32610 @end table
32611
32612 @end table
32613
32614 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32615
32616 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32617
32618 @subsubheading Example
32619
32620 @subheading -trace-list-variables
32621 @findex -trace-list-variables
32622
32623 @subsubheading Synopsis
32624
32625 @smallexample
32626 -trace-list-variables
32627 @end smallexample
32628
32629 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
32630 table has the following fields:
32631
32632 @table @samp
32633 @item name
32634 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
32635
32636 @item initial
32637 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
32638 field is always present.
32639
32640 @item current
32641 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
32642 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
32643 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
32644 presently running.
32645
32646 @end table
32647
32648 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32649
32650 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
32651
32652 @subsubheading Example
32653
32654 @smallexample
32655 (gdb)
32656 -trace-list-variables
32657 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
32658 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32659 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
32660 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
32661 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
32662 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
32663 (gdb)
32664 @end smallexample
32665
32666 @subheading -trace-save
32667 @findex -trace-save
32668
32669 @subsubheading Synopsis
32670
32671 @smallexample
32672 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
32673 @end smallexample
32674
32675 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
32676 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
32677 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
32678 to perform the save.
32679
32680 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
32681 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
32682 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
32683
32684 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32685
32686 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
32687
32688
32689 @subheading -trace-start
32690 @findex -trace-start
32691
32692 @subsubheading Synopsis
32693
32694 @smallexample
32695 -trace-start
32696 @end smallexample
32697
32698 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
32699 have any fields.
32700
32701 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32702
32703 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
32704
32705 @subheading -trace-status
32706 @findex -trace-status
32707
32708 @subsubheading Synopsis
32709
32710 @smallexample
32711 -trace-status
32712 @end smallexample
32713
32714 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
32715 the following fields:
32716
32717 @table @samp
32718
32719 @item supported
32720 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
32721 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
32722 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
32723 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
32724 started. This field is always present.
32725
32726 @item running
32727 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
32728 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
32729 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32730
32731 @item stop-reason
32732 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
32733 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
32734 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
32735 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
32736 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
32737 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
32738 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
32739 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
32740 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32741
32742 @item stopping-tracepoint
32743 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
32744 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
32745 @samp{passcount}.
32746
32747 @item frames
32748 @itemx frames-created
32749 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
32750 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
32751 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
32752 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
32753
32754 @item buffer-size
32755 @itemx buffer-free
32756 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
32757 remaining space. These fields are optional.
32758
32759 @item circular
32760 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
32761 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
32762 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
32763 and may fill up.
32764
32765 @item disconnected
32766 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
32767 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
32768 that the trace run will stop.
32769
32770 @item trace-file
32771 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
32772 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
32773
32774 @end table
32775
32776 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32777
32778 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
32779
32780 @subheading -trace-stop
32781 @findex -trace-stop
32782
32783 @subsubheading Synopsis
32784
32785 @smallexample
32786 -trace-stop
32787 @end smallexample
32788
32789 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
32790 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
32791 @samp{running} fields are not output.
32792
32793 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32794
32795 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
32796
32797
32798 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32799 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
32800 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
32801
32802
32803 @ignore
32804 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
32805 @findex -symbol-info-address
32806
32807 @subsubheading Synopsis
32808
32809 @smallexample
32810 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
32811 @end smallexample
32812
32813 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
32814
32815 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32816
32817 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
32818
32819 @subsubheading Example
32820 N.A.
32821
32822
32823 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
32824 @findex -symbol-info-file
32825
32826 @subsubheading Synopsis
32827
32828 @smallexample
32829 -symbol-info-file
32830 @end smallexample
32831
32832 Show the file for the symbol.
32833
32834 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32835
32836 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
32837 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
32838
32839 @subsubheading Example
32840 N.A.
32841
32842
32843 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
32844 @findex -symbol-info-function
32845
32846 @subsubheading Synopsis
32847
32848 @smallexample
32849 -symbol-info-function
32850 @end smallexample
32851
32852 Show which function the symbol lives in.
32853
32854 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32855
32856 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
32857
32858 @subsubheading Example
32859 N.A.
32860
32861
32862 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
32863 @findex -symbol-info-line
32864
32865 @subsubheading Synopsis
32866
32867 @smallexample
32868 -symbol-info-line
32869 @end smallexample
32870
32871 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
32872
32873 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32874
32875 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
32876 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
32877
32878 @subsubheading Example
32879 N.A.
32880
32881
32882 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
32883 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
32884
32885 @subsubheading Synopsis
32886
32887 @smallexample
32888 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
32889 @end smallexample
32890
32891 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
32892
32893 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32894
32895 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
32896
32897 @subsubheading Example
32898 N.A.
32899
32900
32901 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
32902 @findex -symbol-list-functions
32903
32904 @subsubheading Synopsis
32905
32906 @smallexample
32907 -symbol-list-functions
32908 @end smallexample
32909
32910 List the functions in the executable.
32911
32912 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32913
32914 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
32915 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32916
32917 @subsubheading Example
32918 N.A.
32919 @end ignore
32920
32921
32922 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
32923 @findex -symbol-list-lines
32924
32925 @subsubheading Synopsis
32926
32927 @smallexample
32928 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
32929 @end smallexample
32930
32931 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
32932 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
32933 ascending PC order.
32934
32935 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32936
32937 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32938
32939 @subsubheading Example
32940 @smallexample
32941 (gdb)
32942 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
32943 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
32944 (gdb)
32945 @end smallexample
32946
32947
32948 @ignore
32949 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
32950 @findex -symbol-list-types
32951
32952 @subsubheading Synopsis
32953
32954 @smallexample
32955 -symbol-list-types
32956 @end smallexample
32957
32958 List all the type names.
32959
32960 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32961
32962 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
32963 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32964
32965 @subsubheading Example
32966 N.A.
32967
32968
32969 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
32970 @findex -symbol-list-variables
32971
32972 @subsubheading Synopsis
32973
32974 @smallexample
32975 -symbol-list-variables
32976 @end smallexample
32977
32978 List all the global and static variable names.
32979
32980 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32981
32982 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32983
32984 @subsubheading Example
32985 N.A.
32986
32987
32988 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
32989 @findex -symbol-locate
32990
32991 @subsubheading Synopsis
32992
32993 @smallexample
32994 -symbol-locate
32995 @end smallexample
32996
32997 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32998
32999 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
33000
33001 @subsubheading Example
33002 N.A.
33003
33004
33005 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
33006 @findex -symbol-type
33007
33008 @subsubheading Synopsis
33009
33010 @smallexample
33011 -symbol-type @var{variable}
33012 @end smallexample
33013
33014 Show type of @var{variable}.
33015
33016 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33017
33018 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
33019 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
33020
33021 @subsubheading Example
33022 N.A.
33023 @end ignore
33024
33025
33026 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33027 @node GDB/MI File Commands
33028 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
33029
33030 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
33031 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
33032
33033 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
33034 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
33035
33036 @subsubheading Synopsis
33037
33038 @smallexample
33039 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
33040 @end smallexample
33041
33042 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
33043 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
33044 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
33045 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
33046 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
33047 notification.
33048
33049 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33050
33051 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
33052
33053 @subsubheading Example
33054
33055 @smallexample
33056 (gdb)
33057 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33058 ^done
33059 (gdb)
33060 @end smallexample
33061
33062
33063 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
33064 @findex -file-exec-file
33065
33066 @subsubheading Synopsis
33067
33068 @smallexample
33069 -file-exec-file @var{file}
33070 @end smallexample
33071
33072 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
33073 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
33074 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
33075 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
33076 notification.
33077
33078 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33079
33080 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
33081
33082 @subsubheading Example
33083
33084 @smallexample
33085 (gdb)
33086 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33087 ^done
33088 (gdb)
33089 @end smallexample
33090
33091
33092 @ignore
33093 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
33094 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
33095
33096 @subsubheading Synopsis
33097
33098 @smallexample
33099 -file-list-exec-sections
33100 @end smallexample
33101
33102 List the sections of the current executable file.
33103
33104 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33105
33106 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
33107 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
33108 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
33109
33110 @subsubheading Example
33111 N.A.
33112 @end ignore
33113
33114
33115 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
33116 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
33117
33118 @subsubheading Synopsis
33119
33120 @smallexample
33121 -file-list-exec-source-file
33122 @end smallexample
33123
33124 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
33125 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
33126 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
33127 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
33128
33129 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33130
33131 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
33132
33133 @subsubheading Example
33134
33135 @smallexample
33136 (gdb)
33137 123-file-list-exec-source-file
33138 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
33139 (gdb)
33140 @end smallexample
33141
33142
33143 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
33144 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
33145
33146 @subsubheading Synopsis
33147
33148 @smallexample
33149 -file-list-exec-source-files
33150 @end smallexample
33151
33152 List the source files for the current executable.
33153
33154 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
33155 name) of a source file.
33156
33157 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33158
33159 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
33160 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
33161
33162 @subsubheading Example
33163 @smallexample
33164 (gdb)
33165 -file-list-exec-source-files
33166 ^done,files=[
33167 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
33168 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
33169 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
33170 (gdb)
33171 @end smallexample
33172
33173 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
33174 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
33175
33176 @subsubheading Synopsis
33177
33178 @smallexample
33179 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
33180 @end smallexample
33181
33182 List the shared libraries in the program.
33183 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
33184 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
33185
33186 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33187
33188 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
33189 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
33190 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
33191 library. Each range has the following fields:
33192
33193 @table @samp
33194 @item from
33195 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
33196 @item to
33197 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
33198 @end table
33199
33200 @subsubheading Example
33201 @smallexample
33202 (gdb)
33203 -file-list-exec-source-files
33204 ^done,shared-libraries=[
33205 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
33206 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
33207 (gdb)
33208 @end smallexample
33209
33210
33211 @ignore
33212 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
33213 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
33214
33215 @subsubheading Synopsis
33216
33217 @smallexample
33218 -file-list-symbol-files
33219 @end smallexample
33220
33221 List symbol files.
33222
33223 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33224
33225 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
33226
33227 @subsubheading Example
33228 N.A.
33229 @end ignore
33230
33231
33232 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
33233 @findex -file-symbol-file
33234
33235 @subsubheading Synopsis
33236
33237 @smallexample
33238 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
33239 @end smallexample
33240
33241 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
33242 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
33243 produced, except for a completion notification.
33244
33245 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33246
33247 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
33248
33249 @subsubheading Example
33250
33251 @smallexample
33252 (gdb)
33253 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33254 ^done
33255 (gdb)
33256 @end smallexample
33257
33258 @ignore
33259 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33260 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
33261 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
33262
33263 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
33264
33265 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
33266
33267 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
33268
33269 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
33270
33271 @c @subheading -overlay-map
33272
33273 @c @subheading -overlay-off
33274
33275 @c @subheading -overlay-on
33276
33277 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
33278
33279 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33280 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
33281 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
33282
33283 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
33284
33285 @c @subheading -signal-handle
33286
33287 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
33288
33289 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
33290 @end ignore
33291
33292
33293 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33294 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
33295 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
33296
33297
33298 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
33299 @findex -target-attach
33300
33301 @subsubheading Synopsis
33302
33303 @smallexample
33304 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
33305 @end smallexample
33306
33307 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
33308 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
33309 group, the id previously returned by
33310 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
33311
33312 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33313
33314 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
33315
33316 @subsubheading Example
33317 @smallexample
33318 (gdb)
33319 -target-attach 34
33320 =thread-created,id="1"
33321 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
33322 ^done
33323 (gdb)
33324 @end smallexample
33325
33326 @ignore
33327 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
33328 @findex -target-compare-sections
33329
33330 @subsubheading Synopsis
33331
33332 @smallexample
33333 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
33334 @end smallexample
33335
33336 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
33337 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
33338
33339 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33340
33341 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
33342
33343 @subsubheading Example
33344 N.A.
33345 @end ignore
33346
33347
33348 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
33349 @findex -target-detach
33350
33351 @subsubheading Synopsis
33352
33353 @smallexample
33354 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
33355 @end smallexample
33356
33357 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
33358 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
33359 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
33360
33361 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33362
33363 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
33364
33365 @subsubheading Example
33366
33367 @smallexample
33368 (gdb)
33369 -target-detach
33370 ^done
33371 (gdb)
33372 @end smallexample
33373
33374
33375 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
33376 @findex -target-disconnect
33377
33378 @subsubheading Synopsis
33379
33380 @smallexample
33381 -target-disconnect
33382 @end smallexample
33383
33384 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
33385 generally not resumed.
33386
33387 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33388
33389 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
33390
33391 @subsubheading Example
33392
33393 @smallexample
33394 (gdb)
33395 -target-disconnect
33396 ^done
33397 (gdb)
33398 @end smallexample
33399
33400
33401 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
33402 @findex -target-download
33403
33404 @subsubheading Synopsis
33405
33406 @smallexample
33407 -target-download
33408 @end smallexample
33409
33410 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
33411 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
33412
33413 @table @samp
33414 @item section
33415 The name of the section.
33416 @item section-sent
33417 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
33418 @item section-size
33419 The size of the section.
33420 @item total-sent
33421 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
33422 @item total-size
33423 The size of the overall executable to download.
33424 @end table
33425
33426 @noindent
33427 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
33428 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
33429
33430 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
33431 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
33432
33433 @table @samp
33434 @item section
33435 The name of the section.
33436 @item section-size
33437 The size of the section.
33438 @item total-size
33439 The size of the overall executable to download.
33440 @end table
33441
33442 @noindent
33443 At the end, a summary is printed.
33444
33445 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33446
33447 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
33448
33449 @subsubheading Example
33450
33451 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
33452 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
33453
33454 @smallexample
33455 (gdb)
33456 -target-download
33457 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
33458 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
33459 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
33460 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
33461 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
33462 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
33463 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
33464 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
33465 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
33466 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
33467 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
33468 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
33469 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
33470 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
33471 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
33472 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
33473 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
33474 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
33475 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
33476 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
33477 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
33478 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
33479 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
33480 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
33481 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
33482 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
33483 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
33484 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33485 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33486 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
33487 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
33488 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
33489 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
33490 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
33491 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
33492 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
33493 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
33494 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
33495 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
33496 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
33497 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
33498 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
33499 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
33500 write-rate="429"
33501 (gdb)
33502 @end smallexample
33503
33504
33505 @ignore
33506 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
33507 @findex -target-exec-status
33508
33509 @subsubheading Synopsis
33510
33511 @smallexample
33512 -target-exec-status
33513 @end smallexample
33514
33515 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
33516 not, for instance).
33517
33518 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33519
33520 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
33521
33522 @subsubheading Example
33523 N.A.
33524
33525
33526 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
33527 @findex -target-list-available-targets
33528
33529 @subsubheading Synopsis
33530
33531 @smallexample
33532 -target-list-available-targets
33533 @end smallexample
33534
33535 List the possible targets to connect to.
33536
33537 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33538
33539 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
33540
33541 @subsubheading Example
33542 N.A.
33543
33544
33545 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
33546 @findex -target-list-current-targets
33547
33548 @subsubheading Synopsis
33549
33550 @smallexample
33551 -target-list-current-targets
33552 @end smallexample
33553
33554 Describe the current target.
33555
33556 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33557
33558 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
33559 other things).
33560
33561 @subsubheading Example
33562 N.A.
33563
33564
33565 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
33566 @findex -target-list-parameters
33567
33568 @subsubheading Synopsis
33569
33570 @smallexample
33571 -target-list-parameters
33572 @end smallexample
33573
33574 @c ????
33575 @end ignore
33576
33577 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33578
33579 No equivalent.
33580
33581 @subsubheading Example
33582 N.A.
33583
33584 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
33585 @findex -target-flash-erase
33586
33587 @subsubheading Synopsis
33588
33589 @smallexample
33590 -target-flash-erase
33591 @end smallexample
33592
33593 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
33594
33595 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
33596
33597 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
33598 addresses and memory region sizes.
33599
33600 @smallexample
33601 (gdb)
33602 -target-flash-erase
33603 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
33604 (gdb)
33605 @end smallexample
33606
33607 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
33608 @findex -target-select
33609
33610 @subsubheading Synopsis
33611
33612 @smallexample
33613 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
33614 @end smallexample
33615
33616 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
33617
33618 @table @samp
33619 @item @var{type}
33620 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
33621 @item @var{parameters}
33622 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
33623 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
33624 @end table
33625
33626 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
33627 which the target program is, in the following form:
33628
33629 @smallexample
33630 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
33631 args=[@var{arg list}]
33632 @end smallexample
33633
33634 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33635
33636 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
33637
33638 @subsubheading Example
33639
33640 @smallexample
33641 (gdb)
33642 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
33643 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
33644 (gdb)
33645 @end smallexample
33646
33647 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33648 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
33649 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
33650
33651
33652 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
33653 @findex -target-file-put
33654
33655 @subsubheading Synopsis
33656
33657 @smallexample
33658 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
33659 @end smallexample
33660
33661 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
33662 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
33663
33664 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33665
33666 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
33667
33668 @subsubheading Example
33669
33670 @smallexample
33671 (gdb)
33672 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
33673 ^done
33674 (gdb)
33675 @end smallexample
33676
33677
33678 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
33679 @findex -target-file-get
33680
33681 @subsubheading Synopsis
33682
33683 @smallexample
33684 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
33685 @end smallexample
33686
33687 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
33688 on the host system.
33689
33690 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33691
33692 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
33693
33694 @subsubheading Example
33695
33696 @smallexample
33697 (gdb)
33698 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
33699 ^done
33700 (gdb)
33701 @end smallexample
33702
33703
33704 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
33705 @findex -target-file-delete
33706
33707 @subsubheading Synopsis
33708
33709 @smallexample
33710 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
33711 @end smallexample
33712
33713 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
33714
33715 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33716
33717 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
33718
33719 @subsubheading Example
33720
33721 @smallexample
33722 (gdb)
33723 -target-file-delete remotefile
33724 ^done
33725 (gdb)
33726 @end smallexample
33727
33728
33729 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33730 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
33731 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33732
33733 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
33734 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
33735
33736 @subsubheading Synopsis
33737
33738 @smallexample
33739 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
33740 @end smallexample
33741
33742 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
33743 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
33744 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
33745
33746 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33747
33748 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
33749
33750 @subsubheading Result
33751
33752 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
33753 defined for each exception:
33754
33755 @table @samp
33756 @item name
33757 The name of the exception.
33758
33759 @item address
33760 The address of the exception.
33761
33762 @end table
33763
33764 @subsubheading Example
33765
33766 @smallexample
33767 -info-ada-exceptions aint
33768 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
33769 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
33770 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
33771 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
33772 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
33773 @end smallexample
33774
33775 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
33776
33777 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
33778 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
33779 Catchpoint Commands}.
33780
33781
33782 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33783 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
33784 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
33785
33786 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
33787 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
33788 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
33789 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
33790
33791 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
33792 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
33793 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
33794
33795 @subsubheading Synopsis
33796
33797 @smallexample
33798 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
33799 @end smallexample
33800
33801 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
33802
33803 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
33804 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
33805 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
33806 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
33807 dash.
33808
33809 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33810
33811 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33812
33813 @subsubheading Result
33814
33815 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
33816
33817 @table @samp
33818 @item exists
33819 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
33820 @code{"false"} otherwise.
33821
33822 @end table
33823
33824 @subsubheading Example
33825
33826 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
33827
33828 @smallexample
33829 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
33830 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
33831 @end smallexample
33832
33833 @noindent
33834 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
33835 to the debugger:
33836
33837 @smallexample
33838 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
33839 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
33840 @end smallexample
33841
33842 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
33843 @findex -list-features
33844 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
33845
33846 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
33847 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
33848 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
33849 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
33850 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
33851 startup.
33852
33853 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
33854 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
33855 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
33856 is given below.
33857
33858 Example output:
33859
33860 @smallexample
33861 (gdb) -list-features
33862 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
33863 @end smallexample
33864
33865 The current list of features is:
33866
33867 @ftable @samp
33868 @item frozen-varobjs
33869 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
33870 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
33871 of @code{-varobj-create}.
33872 @item pending-breakpoints
33873 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
33874 command.
33875 @item python
33876 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
33877 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
33878 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
33879 @item thread-info
33880 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
33881 @item data-read-memory-bytes
33882 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
33883 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
33884 @item breakpoint-notifications
33885 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
33886 CLI will be announced via async records.
33887 @item ada-task-info
33888 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
33889 @item language-option
33890 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
33891 option (@pxref{Context management}).
33892 @item info-gdb-mi-command
33893 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
33894 @item undefined-command-error-code
33895 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
33896 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
33897 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
33898 @item exec-run-start-option
33899 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
33900 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
33901 @item data-disassemble-a-option
33902 Indicates that the @code{-data-disassemble} command supports the @option{-a}
33903 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Data Manipulation}).
33904 @end ftable
33905
33906 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
33907 @findex -list-target-features
33908
33909 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
33910 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
33911 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
33912 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
33913 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
33914 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
33915 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
33916 Example output:
33917
33918 @smallexample
33919 (gdb) -list-target-features
33920 ^done,result=["async"]
33921 @end smallexample
33922
33923 The current list of features is:
33924
33925 @table @samp
33926 @item async
33927 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
33928 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
33929 while the target is running.
33930
33931 @item reverse
33932 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
33933 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33934
33935 @end table
33936
33937 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33938 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
33939 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33940
33941 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
33942
33943 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
33944 @findex -gdb-exit
33945
33946 @subsubheading Synopsis
33947
33948 @smallexample
33949 -gdb-exit
33950 @end smallexample
33951
33952 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
33953
33954 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33955
33956 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
33957
33958 @subsubheading Example
33959
33960 @smallexample
33961 (gdb)
33962 -gdb-exit
33963 ^exit
33964 @end smallexample
33965
33966
33967 @ignore
33968 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
33969 @findex -exec-abort
33970
33971 @subsubheading Synopsis
33972
33973 @smallexample
33974 -exec-abort
33975 @end smallexample
33976
33977 Kill the inferior running program.
33978
33979 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33980
33981 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
33982
33983 @subsubheading Example
33984 N.A.
33985 @end ignore
33986
33987
33988 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
33989 @findex -gdb-set
33990
33991 @subsubheading Synopsis
33992
33993 @smallexample
33994 -gdb-set
33995 @end smallexample
33996
33997 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
33998 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
33999
34000 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34001
34002 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
34003
34004 @subsubheading Example
34005
34006 @smallexample
34007 (gdb)
34008 -gdb-set $foo=3
34009 ^done
34010 (gdb)
34011 @end smallexample
34012
34013
34014 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
34015 @findex -gdb-show
34016
34017 @subsubheading Synopsis
34018
34019 @smallexample
34020 -gdb-show
34021 @end smallexample
34022
34023 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
34024
34025 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34026
34027 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
34028
34029 @subsubheading Example
34030
34031 @smallexample
34032 (gdb)
34033 -gdb-show annotate
34034 ^done,value="0"
34035 (gdb)
34036 @end smallexample
34037
34038 @c @subheading -gdb-source
34039
34040
34041 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
34042 @findex -gdb-version
34043
34044 @subsubheading Synopsis
34045
34046 @smallexample
34047 -gdb-version
34048 @end smallexample
34049
34050 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
34051
34052 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34053
34054 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
34055 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
34056
34057 @subsubheading Example
34058
34059 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
34060 @c box in TeX.
34061 @smallexample
34062 (gdb)
34063 -gdb-version
34064 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
34065 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34066 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
34067 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
34068 ~ certain conditions.
34069 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34070 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
34071 ~ details.
34072 ~This GDB was configured as
34073 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
34074 ^done
34075 (gdb)
34076 @end smallexample
34077
34078 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
34079 @findex -list-thread-groups
34080
34081 @subheading Synopsis
34082
34083 @smallexample
34084 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
34085 @end smallexample
34086
34087 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
34088 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
34089 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
34090 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
34091 top-level thread groups.
34092
34093 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
34094 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
34095 available on the target.
34096
34097 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
34098 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
34099 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
34100 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
34101 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
34102 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
34103 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
34104 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
34105
34106 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
34107 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
34108 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
34109 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
34110 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
34111 @samp{threads} field.
34112
34113 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
34114 the following caveats:
34115
34116 @itemize @bullet
34117 @item
34118 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
34119 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
34120 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
34121
34122 @item
34123 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
34124 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
34125 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
34126 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
34127 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
34128 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
34129
34130 @end itemize
34131
34132 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
34133 have the following fields:
34134
34135 @table @code
34136 @item id
34137 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
34138 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
34139 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
34140
34141 @item type
34142 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
34143 valid type.
34144
34145 @item pid
34146 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
34147 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
34148
34149 @item exit-code
34150 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
34151 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
34152 only if the process is not running.
34153
34154 @item num_children
34155 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
34156 absent for an available thread group.
34157
34158 @item threads
34159 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
34160 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
34161 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
34162
34163 @item cores
34164 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
34165 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
34166 such information is not available.
34167
34168 @item executable
34169 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
34170 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
34171 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
34172
34173 @end table
34174
34175 @subheading Example
34176
34177 @smallexample
34178 @value{GDBP}
34179 -list-thread-groups
34180 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
34181 -list-thread-groups 17
34182 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
34183 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
34184 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
34185 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
34186 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},state="running"@}]]
34187 -list-thread-groups --available
34188 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
34189 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
34190 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
34191 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
34192 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
34193 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
34194 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
34195 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
34196 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
34197 @end smallexample
34198
34199 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
34200 @findex -info-os
34201
34202 @subsubheading Synopsis
34203
34204 @smallexample
34205 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
34206 @end smallexample
34207
34208 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
34209 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
34210 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
34211 of data of that type.
34212
34213 The types of information available depend on the target operating
34214 system.
34215
34216 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34217
34218 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
34219
34220 @subsubheading Example
34221
34222 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
34223 like this:
34224
34225 @smallexample
34226 @value{GDBP}
34227 -info-os
34228 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
34229 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
34230 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
34231 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
34232 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
34233 col2="CPUs"@},
34234 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
34235 col2="File descriptors"@},
34236 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
34237 col2="Kernel modules"@},
34238 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
34239 col2="Message queues"@},
34240 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
34241 col2="Processes"@},
34242 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
34243 col2="Process groups"@},
34244 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
34245 col2="Semaphores"@},
34246 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
34247 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
34248 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
34249 col2="Sockets"@},
34250 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
34251 col2="Threads"@}]
34252 @value{GDBP}
34253 -info-os processes
34254 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
34255 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
34256 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
34257 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
34258 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
34259 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
34260 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
34261 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
34262 ...
34263 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
34264 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
34265 (gdb)
34266 @end smallexample
34267
34268 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
34269 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
34270 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
34271 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
34272 @code{info os} omits it.)
34273
34274 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
34275 @findex -add-inferior
34276
34277 @subheading Synopsis
34278
34279 @smallexample
34280 -add-inferior
34281 @end smallexample
34282
34283 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
34284 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
34285 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
34286 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
34287 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
34288 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
34289
34290 @subheading Example
34291
34292 @smallexample
34293 @value{GDBP}
34294 -add-inferior
34295 ^done,inferior="i3"
34296 @end smallexample
34297
34298 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
34299 @findex -interpreter-exec
34300
34301 @subheading Synopsis
34302
34303 @smallexample
34304 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
34305 @end smallexample
34306 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
34307
34308 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
34309
34310 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34311
34312 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
34313
34314 @subheading Example
34315
34316 @smallexample
34317 (gdb)
34318 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
34319 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
34320 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
34321 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
34322 ^done
34323 (gdb)
34324 @end smallexample
34325
34326 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
34327 @findex -inferior-tty-set
34328
34329 @subheading Synopsis
34330
34331 @smallexample
34332 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34333 @end smallexample
34334
34335 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
34336
34337 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34338
34339 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
34340
34341 @subheading Example
34342
34343 @smallexample
34344 (gdb)
34345 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34346 ^done
34347 (gdb)
34348 @end smallexample
34349
34350 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
34351 @findex -inferior-tty-show
34352
34353 @subheading Synopsis
34354
34355 @smallexample
34356 -inferior-tty-show
34357 @end smallexample
34358
34359 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
34360
34361 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34362
34363 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
34364
34365 @subheading Example
34366
34367 @smallexample
34368 (gdb)
34369 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34370 ^done
34371 (gdb)
34372 -inferior-tty-show
34373 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
34374 (gdb)
34375 @end smallexample
34376
34377 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
34378 @findex -enable-timings
34379
34380 @subheading Synopsis
34381
34382 @smallexample
34383 -enable-timings [yes | no]
34384 @end smallexample
34385
34386 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
34387 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
34388 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
34389 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
34390
34391 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34392
34393 No equivalent.
34394
34395 @subheading Example
34396
34397 @smallexample
34398 (gdb)
34399 -enable-timings
34400 ^done
34401 (gdb)
34402 -break-insert main
34403 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
34404 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
34405 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
34406 times="0"@},
34407 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
34408 (gdb)
34409 -enable-timings no
34410 ^done
34411 (gdb)
34412 -exec-run
34413 ^running
34414 (gdb)
34415 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
34416 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
34417 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
34418 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
34419 (gdb)
34420 @end smallexample
34421
34422 @node Annotations
34423 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
34424
34425 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
34426 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
34427 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
34428 relatively high level.
34429
34430 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
34431 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
34432
34433 @ignore
34434 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
34435 @end ignore
34436
34437 @menu
34438 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
34439 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
34440 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
34441 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
34442 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
34443 * Annotations for Running::
34444 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
34445 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
34446 @end menu
34447
34448 @node Annotations Overview
34449 @section What is an Annotation?
34450 @cindex annotations
34451
34452 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
34453 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
34454 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
34455 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
34456 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
34457 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
34458 cannot contain newline characters.
34459
34460 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
34461 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
34462 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
34463 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
34464 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
34465 means those three characters as output.
34466
34467 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
34468 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
34469 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
34470 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
34471 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
34472 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
34473 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
34474 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
34475 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
34476
34477 @table @code
34478 @kindex set annotate
34479 @item set annotate @var{level}
34480 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
34481 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
34482
34483 @item show annotate
34484 @kindex show annotate
34485 Show the current annotation level.
34486 @end table
34487
34488 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
34489
34490 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
34491
34492 @smallexample
34493 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
34494 GNU gdb 6.0
34495 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34496 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
34497 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
34498 under certain conditions.
34499 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34500 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
34501 for details.
34502 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
34503
34504 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34505 (@value{GDBP})
34506 ^Z^Zprompt
34507 @kbd{quit}
34508
34509 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34510 $
34511 @end smallexample
34512
34513 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
34514 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
34515 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
34516 output from @value{GDBN}.
34517
34518 @node Server Prefix
34519 @section The Server Prefix
34520 @cindex server prefix
34521
34522 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
34523 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
34524 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
34525 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
34526 a transparent manner.
34527
34528 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
34529 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
34530 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
34531 @code{print} command.
34532
34533 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
34534 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
34535
34536 @node Prompting
34537 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
34538
34539 @cindex annotations for prompts
34540 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
34541 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
34542 over, etc.
34543
34544 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
34545 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
34546 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
34547 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
34548 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
34549 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
34550 features the following annotations:
34551
34552 @smallexample
34553 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34554 ^Z^Zprompt
34555 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34556 @end smallexample
34557
34558 The input types are
34559
34560 @table @code
34561 @findex pre-prompt annotation
34562 @findex prompt annotation
34563 @findex post-prompt annotation
34564 @item prompt
34565 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
34566
34567 @findex pre-commands annotation
34568 @findex commands annotation
34569 @findex post-commands annotation
34570 @item commands
34571 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
34572 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
34573
34574 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
34575 @findex overload-choice annotation
34576 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
34577 @item overload-choice
34578 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
34579
34580 @findex pre-query annotation
34581 @findex query annotation
34582 @findex post-query annotation
34583 @item query
34584 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
34585
34586 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
34587 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
34588 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
34589 @item prompt-for-continue
34590 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
34591 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
34592 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
34593 presence of annotations.
34594 @end table
34595
34596 @node Errors
34597 @section Errors
34598 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
34599
34600 @findex quit annotation
34601 @smallexample
34602 ^Z^Zquit
34603 @end smallexample
34604
34605 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
34606
34607 @findex error annotation
34608 @smallexample
34609 ^Z^Zerror
34610 @end smallexample
34611
34612 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
34613
34614 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
34615 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
34616 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
34617 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
34618 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
34619 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
34620 to the top level.
34621
34622 @findex error-begin annotation
34623 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
34624
34625 @smallexample
34626 ^Z^Zerror-begin
34627 @end smallexample
34628
34629 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
34630 message.
34631
34632 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
34633 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
34634 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
34635
34636 @node Invalidation
34637 @section Invalidation Notices
34638
34639 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
34640 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
34641 changed.
34642
34643 @table @code
34644 @findex frames-invalid annotation
34645 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
34646
34647 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
34648 have changed.
34649
34650 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
34651 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
34652
34653 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
34654 deleted a breakpoint.
34655 @end table
34656
34657 @node Annotations for Running
34658 @section Running the Program
34659 @cindex annotations for running programs
34660
34661 @findex starting annotation
34662 @findex stopping annotation
34663 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
34664 @code{step} or @code{continue},
34665
34666 @smallexample
34667 ^Z^Zstarting
34668 @end smallexample
34669
34670 is output. When the program stops,
34671
34672 @smallexample
34673 ^Z^Zstopped
34674 @end smallexample
34675
34676 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
34677 annotations describe how the program stopped.
34678
34679 @table @code
34680 @findex exited annotation
34681 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
34682 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
34683 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
34684
34685 @findex signalled annotation
34686 @findex signal-name annotation
34687 @findex signal-name-end annotation
34688 @findex signal-string annotation
34689 @findex signal-string-end annotation
34690 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
34691 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
34692 annotation continues:
34693
34694 @smallexample
34695 @var{intro-text}
34696 ^Z^Zsignal-name
34697 @var{name}
34698 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
34699 @var{middle-text}
34700 ^Z^Zsignal-string
34701 @var{string}
34702 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
34703 @var{end-text}
34704 @end smallexample
34705
34706 @noindent
34707 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
34708 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
34709 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
34710 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
34711 user's benefit and have no particular format.
34712
34713 @findex signal annotation
34714 @item ^Z^Zsignal
34715 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
34716 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
34717 terminated with it.
34718
34719 @findex breakpoint annotation
34720 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
34721 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
34722
34723 @findex watchpoint annotation
34724 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
34725 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
34726 @end table
34727
34728 @node Source Annotations
34729 @section Displaying Source
34730 @cindex annotations for source display
34731
34732 @findex source annotation
34733 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
34734
34735 @smallexample
34736 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
34737 @end smallexample
34738
34739 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
34740 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
34741 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
34742 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
34743 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
34744 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
34745 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
34746 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
34747 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
34748 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
34749 depend on the language).
34750
34751 @node JIT Interface
34752 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
34753 @cindex just-in-time compilation
34754 @cindex JIT compilation interface
34755
34756 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
34757 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
34758 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
34759 performance while maintaining platform independence.
34760
34761 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
34762 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
34763 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
34764 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
34765 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
34766 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
34767
34768 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
34769 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
34770 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
34771 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
34772 LLVM JIT.
34773
34774 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
34775 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
34776 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
34777 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
34778 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
34779 out about additional code.
34780
34781 @menu
34782 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
34783 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
34784 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
34785 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
34786 @end menu
34787
34788 @node Declarations
34789 @section JIT Declarations
34790
34791 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
34792 implement the interface:
34793
34794 @smallexample
34795 typedef enum
34796 @{
34797 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
34798 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
34799 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
34800 @} jit_actions_t;
34801
34802 struct jit_code_entry
34803 @{
34804 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
34805 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
34806 const char *symfile_addr;
34807 uint64_t symfile_size;
34808 @};
34809
34810 struct jit_descriptor
34811 @{
34812 uint32_t version;
34813 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
34814 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
34815 uint32_t action_flag;
34816 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
34817 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
34818 @};
34819
34820 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
34821 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
34822
34823 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
34824 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
34825 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
34826 @end smallexample
34827
34828 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
34829 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
34830 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
34831
34832 @node Registering Code
34833 @section Registering Code
34834
34835 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
34836
34837 @itemize @bullet
34838 @item
34839 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
34840 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
34841
34842 @item
34843 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
34844 file.
34845
34846 @item
34847 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
34848
34849 @item
34850 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
34851
34852 @item
34853 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
34854 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34855 @end itemize
34856
34857 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
34858 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
34859 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
34860 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
34861
34862 @node Unregistering Code
34863 @section Unregistering Code
34864
34865 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
34866
34867 @itemize @bullet
34868 @item
34869 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
34870
34871 @item
34872 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
34873
34874 @item
34875 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
34876 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34877 @end itemize
34878
34879 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
34880 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
34881
34882 @node Custom Debug Info
34883 @section Custom Debug Info
34884 @cindex custom JIT debug info
34885 @cindex JIT debug info reader
34886
34887 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
34888 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
34889 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
34890 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
34891 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
34892 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
34893 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
34894 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
34895 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
34896
34897 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
34898 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
34899 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
34900 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
34901 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
34902 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
34903 compiler.
34904
34905 @menu
34906 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
34907 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
34908 @end menu
34909
34910 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34911 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34912 @kindex jit-reader-load
34913 @kindex jit-reader-unload
34914
34915 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
34916 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
34917
34918 @table @code
34919 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
34920 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
34921 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
34922 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
34923 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
34924 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
34925 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
34926
34927 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
34928 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
34929 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
34930 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
34931 @code{jit-reader-load}.
34932
34933 @item jit-reader-unload
34934 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
34935
34936 @end table
34937
34938 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34939 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34940 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
34941
34942 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
34943 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
34944
34945 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
34946 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
34947 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
34948 the system include directory.
34949
34950 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
34951 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
34952 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
34953
34954 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
34955 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
34956
34957 @findex gdb_init_reader
34958 @smallexample
34959 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
34960 @end smallexample
34961
34962 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
34963
34964 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
34965 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
34966 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
34967 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
34968 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
34969 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
34970
34971 @smallexample
34972 struct gdb_reader_funcs
34973 @{
34974 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
34975 int reader_version;
34976
34977 /* For use by the reader. */
34978 void *priv_data;
34979
34980 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
34981 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
34982 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
34983 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
34984 @};
34985 @end smallexample
34986
34987 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
34988 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
34989
34990 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
34991 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
34992 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
34993 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
34994 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
34995 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
34996 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
34997 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
34998 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
34999 target's address space.
35000
35001 @node In-Process Agent
35002 @chapter In-Process Agent
35003 @cindex debugging agent
35004 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
35005 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
35006 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
35007 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
35008 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
35009 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
35010 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
35011 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
35012 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
35013 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
35014 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
35015 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
35016 behavior without interrupting it.
35017
35018 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
35019 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
35020 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
35021 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
35022 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
35023 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
35024 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
35025 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
35026 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
35027
35028 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
35029 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
35030 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
35031 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
35032
35033 @anchor{Control Agent}
35034 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
35035 debugging with the following commands:
35036
35037 @table @code
35038 @kindex set agent on
35039 @item set agent on
35040 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
35041 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
35042 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
35043 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
35044 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
35045 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
35046
35047 @kindex set agent off
35048 @item set agent off
35049 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
35050 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
35051
35052 @kindex show agent
35053 @item show agent
35054 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
35055 the in-process agent.
35056 @end table
35057
35058 @menu
35059 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
35060 @end menu
35061
35062 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
35063 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
35064 @cindex in-process agent protocol
35065
35066 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
35067 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
35068 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
35069 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
35070 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
35071 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
35072 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
35073 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
35074 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
35075
35076 @menu
35077 * IPA Protocol Objects::
35078 * IPA Protocol Commands::
35079 @end menu
35080
35081 @node IPA Protocol Objects
35082 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
35083 @cindex ipa protocol objects
35084
35085 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
35086 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
35087
35088 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
35089 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
35090 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
35091 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
35092
35093 @enumerate
35094 @item
35095 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
35096 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
35097 @item
35098 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
35099 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
35100 the other one.
35101 @end enumerate
35102
35103 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
35104
35105 @enumerate
35106 @item
35107 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
35108 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
35109 @anchor{agent expression object}
35110 @item
35111 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
35112 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
35113 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
35114 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
35115 @item
35116 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
35117 @anchor{tracepoint object}
35118
35119 @end enumerate
35120
35121 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
35122 object:
35123
35124 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
35125 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
35126 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
35127 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
35128 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
35129 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
35130 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35131 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
35132 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
35133 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
35134 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
35135 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
35136 memory address for collecting.
35137 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
35138 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35139 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
35140 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35141 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
35142 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35143 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
35144 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
35145 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
35146 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
35147 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
35148 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
35149 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
35150 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
35151 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
35152 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
35153 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
35154 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
35155 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
35156 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
35157 @ref{agent expression object}
35158 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
35159 @ref{agent expression object}
35160 @item actions @tab variable
35161 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
35162 @end multitable
35163
35164 @node IPA Protocol Commands
35165 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
35166 @cindex ipa protocol commands
35167
35168 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
35169 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
35170
35171 @table @samp
35172
35173 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
35174 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
35175 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
35176 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
35177 in IPA finally.
35178
35179 Replies:
35180 @table @samp
35181 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
35182 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
35183 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
35184 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
35185 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
35186 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
35187 @item E @var{NN}
35188 for an error
35189
35190 @end table
35191
35192 @item close
35193 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
35194 is about to kill inferiors.
35195
35196 @item qTfSTM
35197 @xref{qTfSTM}.
35198 @item qTsSTM
35199 @xref{qTsSTM}.
35200 @item qTSTMat
35201 @xref{qTSTMat}.
35202 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
35203 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
35204
35205 Replies:
35206 @table @samp
35207 @item E @var{NN}
35208 for an error
35209 @end table
35210 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
35211 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
35212 @end table
35213
35214 @node GDB Bugs
35215 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
35216 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
35217 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
35218
35219 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
35220
35221 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
35222 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
35223 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
35224 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
35225
35226 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
35227 information that enables us to fix the bug.
35228
35229 @menu
35230 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
35231 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
35232 @end menu
35233
35234 @node Bug Criteria
35235 @section Have You Found a Bug?
35236 @cindex bug criteria
35237
35238 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
35239
35240 @itemize @bullet
35241 @cindex fatal signal
35242 @cindex debugger crash
35243 @cindex crash of debugger
35244 @item
35245 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
35246 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
35247
35248 @cindex error on valid input
35249 @item
35250 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
35251 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
35252 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
35253
35254 @cindex invalid input
35255 @item
35256 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
35257 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
35258 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
35259 for traditional practice''.
35260
35261 @item
35262 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
35263 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
35264 @end itemize
35265
35266 @node Bug Reporting
35267 @section How to Report Bugs
35268 @cindex bug reports
35269 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
35270
35271 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
35272 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
35273 contact that organization first.
35274
35275 You can find contact information for many support companies and
35276 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
35277 distribution.
35278 @c should add a web page ref...
35279
35280 @ifset BUGURL
35281 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
35282 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
35283 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
35284 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
35285 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
35286 be used.
35287
35288 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
35289 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
35290 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
35291 @samp{bug-gdb}.
35292
35293 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
35294 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
35295 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
35296 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
35297 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
35298 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
35299 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
35300 bug reports to the mailing list.
35301 @end ifset
35302 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
35303 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
35304 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
35305 @end ifclear
35306 @end ifset
35307
35308 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
35309 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
35310 fact or leave it out, state it!
35311
35312 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
35313 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
35314 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
35315 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
35316 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
35317 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
35318 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
35319 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
35320 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
35321
35322 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
35323 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
35324 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
35325 self-contained.
35326
35327 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
35328 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
35329 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
35330 bugs properly.
35331
35332 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
35333
35334 @itemize @bullet
35335 @item
35336 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
35337 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
35338 version}.
35339
35340 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
35341 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
35342
35343 @item
35344 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
35345 version number.
35346
35347 @item
35348 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
35349 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
35350 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
35351 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
35352
35353 @item
35354 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
35355 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
35356
35357 @item
35358 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
35359 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
35360 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
35361 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
35362 those compilers.
35363
35364 @item
35365 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
35366 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
35367 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
35368 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
35369
35370 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
35371 and then we might not encounter the bug.
35372
35373 @item
35374 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
35375 reproduce the bug.
35376
35377 @item
35378 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
35379 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
35380
35381 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
35382 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
35383 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
35384 a chance to make a mistake.
35385
35386 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
35387 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
35388 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
35389 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
35390 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
35391 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
35392 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
35393 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
35394
35395 @pindex script
35396 @cindex recording a session script
35397 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
35398 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
35399 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
35400 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
35401
35402 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
35403 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
35404
35405 @item
35406 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
35407 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
35408 it by context, not by line number.
35409
35410 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
35411 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
35412
35413 @end itemize
35414
35415 Here are some things that are not necessary:
35416
35417 @itemize @bullet
35418 @item
35419 A description of the envelope of the bug.
35420
35421 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
35422 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
35423 changes will not affect it.
35424
35425 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
35426 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
35427 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
35428 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
35429
35430 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
35431 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
35432 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
35433 less time, and so on.
35434
35435 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
35436 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
35437
35438 @item
35439 A patch for the bug.
35440
35441 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
35442 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
35443 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
35444 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
35445
35446 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
35447 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
35448 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
35449 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
35450
35451 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
35452 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
35453 help us to understand.
35454
35455 @item
35456 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
35457
35458 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
35459 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
35460 @end itemize
35461
35462 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
35463 @c and consists of the two following files:
35464 @c rluser.texi
35465 @c hsuser.texi
35466 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
35467 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
35468 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
35469 @include rluser.texi
35470 @include hsuser.texi
35471 @end ifclear
35472
35473 @node In Memoriam
35474 @appendix In Memoriam
35475
35476 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
35477 contributors:
35478
35479 @table @code
35480 @item Fred Fish
35481 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
35482 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
35483 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
35484
35485 @item Michael Snyder
35486 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
35487 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
35488 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
35489 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
35490 @end table
35491
35492 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
35493 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
35494
35495 @node Formatting Documentation
35496 @appendix Formatting Documentation
35497
35498 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
35499 @cindex reference card
35500 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
35501 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
35502 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
35503 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
35504 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
35505 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
35506
35507 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
35508 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
35509
35510 @smallexample
35511 make refcard.dvi
35512 @end smallexample
35513
35514 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
35515 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
35516 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
35517 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
35518 your @sc{dvi} output program.
35519
35520 @cindex documentation
35521
35522 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
35523 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
35524 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
35525 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
35526 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
35527 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
35528
35529 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
35530 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
35531 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
35532 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
35533 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
35534 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
35535 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
35536 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
35537
35538 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
35539 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
35540 @code{makeinfo}.
35541
35542 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
35543 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
35544 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
35545
35546 @smallexample
35547 cd gdb
35548 make gdb.info
35549 @end smallexample
35550
35551 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
35552 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
35553 Texinfo definitions file.
35554
35555 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
35556 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
35557 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
35558 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
35559 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
35560 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
35561 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
35562
35563 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
35564 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
35565 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
35566 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
35567 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
35568 directory.
35569
35570 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
35571 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
35572 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
35573 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
35574
35575 @smallexample
35576 make gdb.dvi
35577 @end smallexample
35578
35579 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
35580
35581 @node Installing GDB
35582 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
35583 @cindex installation
35584
35585 @menu
35586 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
35587 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
35588 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
35589 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
35590 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
35591 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
35592 @end menu
35593
35594 @node Requirements
35595 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
35596 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
35597
35598 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
35599 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
35600
35601 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
35602 @table @asis
35603 @item C@t{++}11 compiler
35604 @value{GDBN} is written in C@t{++}11. It should be buildable with any
35605 recent C@t{++}11 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
35606
35607 @item GNU make
35608 @value{GDBN}'s build system relies on features only found in the GNU
35609 make program. Other variants of @code{make} will not work.
35610 @end table
35611
35612 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
35613 @table @asis
35614 @item Expat
35615 @anchor{Expat}
35616 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
35617 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
35618 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
35619 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
35620 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
35621 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
35622
35623 Expat is used for:
35624
35625 @itemize @bullet
35626 @item
35627 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
35628 @item
35629 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
35630 @item
35631 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
35632 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
35633 @item
35634 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
35635 @item
35636 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
35637 @item
35638 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
35639 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
35640 @end itemize
35641
35642 @item Guile
35643 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using GNU Guile. @xref{Guile}. By
35644 default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Guile libraries are
35645 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35646 @code{--with-guile} option to request Guile, and pass either the Guile
35647 version number or the file name of the relevant @code{pkg-config}
35648 program to choose a particular version of Guile.
35649
35650 @item iconv
35651 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
35652 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
35653 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
35654 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
35655
35656 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
35657 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to
35658 find it. This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies
35659 the directory that contains the @code{iconv} program. This program is
35660 run in order to make a list of the available character sets.
35661
35662 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If
35663 Libiconv is installed in a standard place, @value{GDBN} will
35664 automatically use it if it is needed. If you have previously
35665 installed Libiconv in a non-standard place, you can use the
35666 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to @file{configure}.
35667
35668 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
35669 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
35670 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
35671 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
35672 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
35673 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
35674 Libiconv, unpack it inside the top-level directory of the @value{GDBN}
35675 source tree, and then rename the directory holding the Libiconv source
35676 code to @samp{libiconv}.
35677
35678 @item lzma
35679 @value{GDBN} can support debugging sections that are compressed with
35680 the LZMA library. @xref{MiniDebugInfo}. If this library is not
35681 included with your operating system, you can find it in the xz package
35682 at @url{http://tukaani.org/xz/}. If the LZMA library is available in
35683 the usual place, then the @file{configure} script will use it
35684 automatically. If it is installed in an unusual path, you can use the
35685 @option{--with-lzma-prefix} option to specify its location.
35686
35687 @item MPFR
35688 @anchor{MPFR}
35689 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
35690 library. This library may be included with your operating system
35691 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35692 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
35693 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
35694 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
35695 option to specify its location.
35696
35697 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
35698 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
35699 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
35700 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
35701
35702 @item Python
35703 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using Python language. @xref{Python}.
35704 By default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Python libraries are
35705 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35706 @code{--with-python} option to request Python, and pass either the
35707 file name of the relevant @code{python} executable, or the name of the
35708 directory in which Python is installed, to choose a particular
35709 installation of Python.
35710
35711 @item zlib
35712 @cindex compressed debug sections
35713 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
35714 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
35715 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
35716 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
35717 information in such binaries.
35718
35719 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
35720 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35721 @url{http://zlib.net}.
35722 @end table
35723
35724 @node Running Configure
35725 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
35726 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
35727 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
35728 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
35729 build the @code{gdb} program.
35730 @iftex
35731 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
35732 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
35733 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
35734 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
35735 @end iftex
35736
35737 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
35738 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
35739 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
35740
35741 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
35742 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
35743
35744 @table @code
35745 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
35746 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
35747
35748 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
35749 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
35750
35751 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
35752 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
35753
35754 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
35755 @sc{gnu} include files
35756
35757 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
35758 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
35759
35760 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
35761 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
35762
35763 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
35764 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
35765 @end table
35766
35767 There may be other subdirectories as well.
35768
35769 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
35770 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
35771 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
35772
35773 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
35774 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
35775 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
35776 argument.
35777
35778 For example:
35779
35780 @smallexample
35781 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35782 ./configure
35783 make
35784 @end smallexample
35785
35786 Running @samp{configure} and then running @code{make} builds the
35787 included supporting libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured
35788 source files, and the binaries, are left in the corresponding source
35789 directories.
35790
35791 @need 750
35792 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
35793 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
35794 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
35795
35796 @smallexample
35797 sh configure
35798 @end smallexample
35799
35800 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
35801 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
35802 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
35803 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
35804 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
35805 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
35806 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
35807 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
35808 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35809
35810 You can install @code{@value{GDBN}} anywhere. The best way to do this
35811 is to pass the @code{--prefix} option to @code{configure}, and then
35812 install it with @code{make install}.
35813
35814 @node Separate Objdir
35815 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
35816
35817 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
35818 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
35819 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
35820 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
35821 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
35822 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
35823 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
35824 program specified there.
35825
35826 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
35827 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
35828 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
35829 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
35830 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
35831 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
35832
35833 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
35834 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
35835
35836 @smallexample
35837 @group
35838 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35839 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
35840 cd ../gdb-sun4
35841 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure
35842 make
35843 @end group
35844 @end smallexample
35845
35846 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
35847 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
35848 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
35849 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
35850 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
35851 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
35852
35853 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
35854 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
35855 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
35856 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
35857 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35858
35859 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
35860 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
35861 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
35862 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
35863 You specify a cross-debugging target by
35864 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
35865
35866 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
35867 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
35868 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
35869
35870 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
35871 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
35872 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
35873 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
35874 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
35875
35876 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
35877 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
35878 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
35879 with each other.
35880
35881 @node Config Names
35882 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
35883
35884 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
35885 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
35886 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
35887 of information in the following pattern:
35888
35889 @smallexample
35890 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
35891 @end smallexample
35892
35893 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
35894 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
35895 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
35896
35897 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
35898 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
35899 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
35900 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
35901 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
35902 abbreviations---for example:
35903
35904 @smallexample
35905 % sh config.sub i386-linux
35906 i386-pc-linux-gnu
35907 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
35908 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
35909 % sh config.sub hp9k700
35910 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
35911 % sh config.sub sun4
35912 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
35913 % sh config.sub sun3
35914 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
35915 % sh config.sub i986v
35916 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
35917 @end smallexample
35918
35919 @noindent
35920 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
35921 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
35922
35923 @node Configure Options
35924 @section @file{configure} Options
35925
35926 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
35927 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure}
35928 also has several other options not listed here. @inforef{Running
35929 configure scripts,,autoconf.info}, for a full
35930 explanation of @file{configure}.
35931
35932 @smallexample
35933 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
35934 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35935 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35936 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
35937 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
35938 @end smallexample
35939
35940 @noindent
35941 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
35942 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
35943 @samp{--}.
35944
35945 @table @code
35946 @item --help
35947 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
35948
35949 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
35950 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
35951 @file{@var{dir}}.
35952
35953 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
35954 Configure the source to install programs under directory
35955 @file{@var{dir}}.
35956
35957 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
35958 @need 2000
35959 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
35960 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
35961 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
35962 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
35963 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
35964 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
35965 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
35966 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
35967 @var{dirname}.
35968
35969 @item --target=@var{target}
35970 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
35971 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
35972 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
35973
35974 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available
35975 targets. Also see the @code{--enable-targets} option, below.
35976 @end table
35977
35978 There are many other options that are specific to @value{GDBN}. This
35979 lists just the most common ones; there are some very specialized
35980 options not described here.
35981
35982 @table @code
35983 @item --enable-targets=@r{[}@var{target}@r{]}@dots{}
35984 @itemx --enable-targets=all
35985 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the
35986 specified list of targets. The special value @samp{all} configures
35987 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs running on any target it supports.
35988
35989 @item --with-gdb-datadir=@var{path}
35990 Set the @value{GDBN}-specific data directory. @value{GDBN} will look
35991 here for certain supporting files or scripts. This defaults to the
35992 @file{gdb} subdirectory of @samp{datadi} (which can be set using
35993 @code{--datadir}).
35994
35995 @item --with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}
35996 Sets up the default source path substitution rule so that directory
35997 names recorded in debug information will be automatically adjusted for
35998 any directory under @var{dir}. @var{dir} should be a subdirectory of
35999 @value{GDBN}'s configured prefix, the one mentioned in the
36000 @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix} options to configure. This
36001 option is useful if GDB is supposed to be moved to a different place
36002 after it is built.
36003
36004 @item --enable-64-bit-bfd
36005 Enable 64-bit support in BFD on 32-bit hosts.
36006
36007 @item --disable-gdbmi
36008 Build @value{GDBN} without the GDB/MI machine interface
36009 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
36010
36011 @item --enable-tui
36012 Build @value{GDBN} with the text-mode full-screen user interface
36013 (TUI). Requires a curses library (ncurses and cursesX are also
36014 supported).
36015
36016 @item --with-curses
36017 Use the curses library instead of the termcap library, for text-mode
36018 terminal operations.
36019
36020 @item --with-libunwind-ia64
36021 Use the libunwind library for unwinding function call stack on ia64
36022 target platforms. See http://www.nongnu.org/libunwind/index.html for
36023 details.
36024
36025 @item --with-system-readline
36026 Use the readline library installed on the host, rather than the
36027 library supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
36028
36029 @item --with-system-zlib
36030 Use the zlib library installed on the host, rather than the library
36031 supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
36032
36033 @item --with-expat
36034 Build @value{GDBN} with Expat, a library for XML parsing. (Done by
36035 default if libexpat is installed and found at configure time.) This
36036 library is used to read XML files supplied with @value{GDBN}. If it
36037 is unavailable, some features, such as remote protocol memory maps,
36038 target descriptions, and shared library lists, that are based on XML
36039 files, will not be available in @value{GDBN}. If your host does not
36040 have libexpat installed, you can get the latest version from
36041 `http://expat.sourceforge.net'.
36042
36043 @item --with-libiconv-prefix@r{[}=@var{dir}@r{]}
36044
36045 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU libiconv, a character set encoding
36046 conversion library. This is not done by default, as on GNU systems
36047 the @code{iconv} that is built in to the C library is sufficient. If
36048 your host does not have a working @code{iconv}, you can get the latest
36049 version of GNU iconv from `https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/'.
36050
36051 @value{GDBN}'s build system also supports building GNU libiconv as
36052 part of the overall build. @xref{Requirements}.
36053
36054 @item --with-lzma
36055 Build @value{GDBN} with LZMA, a compression library. (Done by default
36056 if liblzma is installed and found at configure time.) LZMA is used by
36057 @value{GDBN}'s "mini debuginfo" feature, which is only useful on
36058 platforms using the ELF object file format. If your host does not
36059 have liblzma installed, you can get the latest version from
36060 `https://tukaani.org/xz/'.
36061
36062 @item --with-mpfr
36063 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU MPFR, a library for multiple-precision
36064 floating-point computation with correct rounding. (Done by default if
36065 GNU MPFR is installed and found at configure time.) This library is
36066 used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during expression
36067 evaluation when the target uses different floating-point formats than
36068 the host. If GNU MPFR is not available, @value{GDBN} will fall back
36069 to using host floating-point arithmetic. If your host does not have
36070 GNU MPFR installed, you can get the latest version from
36071 `http://www.mpfr.org'.
36072
36073 @item --with-python@r{[}=@var{python}@r{]}
36074 Build @value{GDBN} with Python scripting support. (Done by default if
36075 libpython is present and found at configure time.) Python makes
36076 @value{GDBN} scripting much more powerful than the restricted CLI
36077 scripting language. If your host does not have Python installed, you
36078 can find it on `http://www.python.org/download/'. The oldest version
36079 of Python supported by GDB is 2.6. The optional argument @var{python}
36080 is used to find the Python headers and libraries. It can be either
36081 the name of a Python executable, or the name of the directory in which
36082 Python is installed.
36083
36084 @item --with-guile[=GUILE]'
36085 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU Guile scripting support. (Done by default
36086 if libguile is present and found at configure time.) If your host
36087 does not have Guile installed, you can find it at
36088 `https://www.gnu.org/software/guile/'. The optional argument GUILE
36089 can be a version number, which will cause @code{configure} to try to
36090 use that version of Guile; or the file name of a @code{pkg-config}
36091 executable, which will be queried to find the information needed to
36092 compile and link against Guile.
36093
36094 @item --without-included-regex
36095 Don't use the regex library included with @value{GDBN} (as part of the
36096 libiberty library). This is the default on hosts with version 2 of
36097 the GNU C library.
36098
36099 @item --with-sysroot=@var{dir}
36100 Use @var{dir} as the default system root directory for libraries whose
36101 file names begin with @file{/lib}' or @file{/usr/lib'}. (The value of
36102 @var{dir} can be modified at run time by using the @command{set
36103 sysroot} command.) If @var{dir} is under the @value{GDBN} configured
36104 prefix (set with @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix options}, the
36105 default system root will be automatically adjusted if and when
36106 @value{GDBN} is moved to a different location.
36107
36108 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
36109 Configure @value{GDBN} to automatically load a system-wide init file.
36110 @var{file} should be an absolute file name. If @var{file} is in a
36111 directory under the configured prefix, and @value{GDBN} is moved to
36112 another location after being built, the location of the system-wide
36113 init file will be adjusted accordingly.
36114
36115 @item --enable-build-warnings
36116 When building the @value{GDBN} sources, ask the compiler to warn about
36117 any code which looks even vaguely suspicious. It passes many
36118 different warning flags, depending on the exact version of the
36119 compiler you are using.
36120
36121 @item --enable-werror
36122 Treat compiler warnings as werrors. It adds the @code{-Werror} flag
36123 to the compiler, which will fail the compilation if the compiler
36124 outputs any warning messages.
36125
36126 @item --enable-ubsan
36127 Enable the GCC undefined behavior sanitizer. This is disabled by
36128 default, but passing @code{--enable-ubsan=yes} or
36129 @code{--enable-ubsan=auto} to @code{configure} will enable it. The
36130 undefined behavior sanitizer checks for C@t{++} undefined behavior.
36131 It has a performance cost, so if you are looking at @value{GDBN}'s
36132 performance, you should disable it. The undefined behavior sanitizer
36133 was first introduced in GCC 4.9.
36134 @end table
36135
36136 @node System-wide configuration
36137 @section System-wide configuration and settings
36138 @cindex system-wide init file
36139
36140 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
36141 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
36142 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
36143
36144 Here is the corresponding configure option:
36145
36146 @table @code
36147 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
36148 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
36149 @var{file}.
36150 @end table
36151
36152 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
36153 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
36154
36155 @itemize @bullet
36156 @item
36157 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
36158 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
36159 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
36160 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
36161 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
36162 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
36163
36164 @item
36165 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
36166 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
36167 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
36168 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
36169 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
36170 @end itemize
36171
36172 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
36173 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
36174 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
36175 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
36176 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
36177 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
36178 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
36179 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
36180 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
36181 reread.
36182
36183 @menu
36184 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
36185 @end menu
36186
36187 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
36188 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
36189 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
36190
36191 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
36192 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
36193 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
36194 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
36195 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
36196 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
36197
36198 The following scripts are currently available:
36199 @itemize @bullet
36200
36201 @item @file{elinos.py}
36202 @pindex elinos.py
36203 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
36204 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
36205 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
36206 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
36207 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
36208 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
36209
36210 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
36211 @pindex wrs-linux.py
36212 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
36213 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
36214 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
36215 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
36216
36217 @end itemize
36218
36219 @node Maintenance Commands
36220 @appendix Maintenance Commands
36221 @cindex maintenance commands
36222 @cindex internal commands
36223
36224 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
36225 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
36226 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
36227 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
36228 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
36229
36230 @table @code
36231 @kindex maint agent
36232 @kindex maint agent-eval
36233 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
36234 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
36235 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
36236 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
36237 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
36238 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
36239 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
36240 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
36241 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
36242 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
36243 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
36244 addition and return the sum.
36245 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
36246 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
36247
36248 @kindex maint agent-printf
36249 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
36250 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
36251 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
36252 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
36253 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
36254
36255 @kindex maint info breakpoints
36256 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
36257 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
36258 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
36259 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
36260 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
36261 is shown:
36262
36263 @table @code
36264 @item breakpoint
36265 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
36266
36267 @item watchpoint
36268 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
36269
36270 @item longjmp
36271 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
36272 @code{longjmp} calls.
36273
36274 @item longjmp resume
36275 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
36276
36277 @item until
36278 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
36279
36280 @item finish
36281 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
36282
36283 @item shlib events
36284 Shared library events.
36285
36286 @end table
36287
36288 @kindex maint info btrace
36289 @item maint info btrace
36290 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
36291
36292 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
36293 @item maint btrace packet-history
36294 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
36295 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
36296 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
36297 recording format.
36298
36299 @table @code
36300 @item bts
36301 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
36302 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
36303
36304 @table @asis
36305 @item Block number
36306 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
36307 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
36308 @item Highest @samp{PC}
36309 @end table
36310
36311 @item pt
36312 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
36313 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
36314 information is printed:
36315
36316 @table @asis
36317 @item Packet number
36318 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
36319 @item Trace offset
36320 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
36321 @item Packet opcode and payload
36322 @end table
36323 @end table
36324
36325 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
36326 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
36327 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
36328 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
36329 needed.
36330
36331 @kindex maint btrace clear
36332 @item maint btrace clear
36333 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
36334 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
36335
36336 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
36337 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
36338 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
36339 buffer.
36340
36341 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
36342 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
36343 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
36344 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
36345 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
36346 packet history.
36347
36348 @kindex set displaced-stepping
36349 @kindex show displaced-stepping
36350 @cindex displaced stepping support
36351 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
36352 @item set displaced-stepping
36353 @itemx show displaced-stepping
36354 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
36355 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
36356 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
36357 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
36358 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
36359
36360 @table @code
36361 @item set displaced-stepping on
36362 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
36363 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
36364
36365 @item set displaced-stepping off
36366 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
36367 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
36368
36369 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
36370 @item set displaced-stepping auto
36371 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
36372 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
36373 architecture supports displaced stepping.
36374 @end table
36375
36376 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
36377 @item maint check-psymtabs
36378 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
36379 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
36380
36381 @kindex maint check-symtabs
36382 @item maint check-symtabs
36383 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
36384
36385 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
36386 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
36387 Expand symbol tables.
36388 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
36389 names matching @var{regexp}.
36390
36391 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
36392 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36393 @cindex demangler crashes
36394 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
36395 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36396 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
36397 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
36398 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
36399 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
36400 option to terminate the current session.
36401
36402 @kindex maint cplus first_component
36403 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
36404 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
36405
36406 @kindex maint cplus namespace
36407 @item maint cplus namespace
36408 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
36409
36410 @kindex maint deprecate
36411 @kindex maint undeprecate
36412 @cindex deprecated commands
36413 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
36414 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
36415 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
36416 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
36417 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
36418 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
36419 the replacement as part of the warning.
36420
36421 @kindex maint dump-me
36422 @item maint dump-me
36423 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
36424 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
36425 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
36426 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
36427
36428 @kindex maint internal-error
36429 @kindex maint internal-warning
36430 @kindex maint demangler-warning
36431 @cindex demangler crashes
36432 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36433 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36434 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36435
36436 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
36437 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
36438 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
36439 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
36440 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
36441 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
36442 @value{GDBN} session.
36443
36444 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
36445 used as the text of the error or warning message.
36446
36447 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
36448
36449 @smallexample
36450 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
36451 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
36452 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
36453 debugging may prove unreliable.
36454 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36455 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36456 (@value{GDBP})
36457 @end smallexample
36458
36459 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
36460 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
36461 @cindex demangler crashes
36462
36463 @kindex maint set internal-error
36464 @kindex maint show internal-error
36465 @kindex maint set internal-warning
36466 @kindex maint show internal-warning
36467 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
36468 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
36469 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36470 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
36471 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36472 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
36473 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36474 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
36475 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
36476 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
36477 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
36478 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
36479 described in the table below.
36480
36481 @table @samp
36482 @item quit
36483 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36484 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
36485
36486 @item corefile
36487 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36488 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
36489 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
36490 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
36491 disabled.
36492 @end table
36493
36494 @kindex maint packet
36495 @item maint packet @var{text}
36496 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
36497 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
36498 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
36499 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
36500 checksum.
36501
36502 @kindex maint print architecture
36503 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36504 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
36505 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
36506
36507 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36508 @item maint print c-tdesc
36509 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
36510 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
36511 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
36512 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
36513 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
36514 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
36515 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
36516 modify XML target descriptions.
36517
36518 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
36519 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
36520 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
36521 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
36522
36523 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
36524 @kindex maint check libthread-db
36525 @item maint check libthread-db
36526 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
36527 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
36528 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
36529 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
36530 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
36531 on some platforms when debugging core files.
36532
36533 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
36534 @item maint print dummy-frames
36535 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
36536
36537 @smallexample
36538 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
36539 @dots{}
36540 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
36541 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
36542 58 return (a + b);
36543 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
36544 @dots{}
36545 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
36546 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
36547 (@value{GDBP})
36548 @end smallexample
36549
36550 Takes an optional file parameter.
36551
36552 @kindex maint print registers
36553 @kindex maint print raw-registers
36554 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
36555 @kindex maint print register-groups
36556 @kindex maint print remote-registers
36557 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36558 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36559 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36560 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36561 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36562 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
36563
36564 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
36565 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
36566 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
36567 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
36568 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
36569 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
36570 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
36571 and offsets in the `G' packets.
36572
36573 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
36574 write the information.
36575
36576 @kindex maint print reggroups
36577 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36578 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
36579 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
36580 information.
36581
36582 The register groups info looks like this:
36583
36584 @smallexample
36585 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
36586 Group Type
36587 general user
36588 float user
36589 all user
36590 vector user
36591 system user
36592 save internal
36593 restore internal
36594 @end smallexample
36595
36596 @kindex flushregs
36597 @item flushregs
36598 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
36599
36600 @kindex maint print objfiles
36601 @cindex info for known object files
36602 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
36603 Print a dump of all known object files.
36604 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
36605 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
36606 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
36607
36608 @kindex maint print user-registers
36609 @cindex user registers
36610 @item maint print user-registers
36611 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
36612 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
36613 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
36614 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
36615 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
36616 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
36617 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
36618
36619 @kindex maint print section-scripts
36620 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
36621 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
36622 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
36623 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
36624 matching @var{regexp}.
36625 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
36626 and the full path if known.
36627 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
36628
36629 @kindex maint print statistics
36630 @cindex bcache statistics
36631 @item maint print statistics
36632 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
36633 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
36634 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
36635 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
36636 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
36637 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
36638 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
36639 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
36640 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
36641 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
36642 lengths.
36643
36644 @kindex maint print target-stack
36645 @cindex target stack description
36646 @item maint print target-stack
36647 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
36648 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
36649 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
36650 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
36651 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
36652 address.
36653
36654 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
36655 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
36656
36657 @kindex maint print type
36658 @cindex type chain of a data type
36659 @item maint print type @var{expr}
36660 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
36661 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
36662 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
36663 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
36664 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
36665
36666 @kindex maint selftest
36667 @cindex self tests
36668 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
36669 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
36670 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
36671 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
36672 name will by ran.
36673
36674 @kindex "maint info selftests"
36675 @cindex self tests
36676 @item maint info selftests
36677 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
36678
36679 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36680 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36681 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36682 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36683 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
36684 information.
36685
36686 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
36687 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
36688 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
36689 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
36690 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
36691 always see the disassembly form.
36692
36693 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
36694
36695 @smallexample
36696 (gdb) info addr argc
36697 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
36698 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
36699 @end smallexample
36700
36701 For more information on these expressions, see
36702 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
36703
36704 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36705 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36706 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36707 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36708 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
36709
36710 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
36711 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
36712 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
36713 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
36714 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
36715 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
36716 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
36717 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
36718 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
36719
36720 @kindex maint set dwarf unwinders
36721 @kindex maint show dwarf unwinders
36722 @item maint set dwarf unwinders
36723 @itemx maint show dwarf unwinders
36724 Control use of the DWARF frame unwinders.
36725
36726 @cindex DWARF frame unwinders
36727 Many targets that support DWARF debugging use @value{GDBN}'s DWARF
36728 frame unwinders to build the backtrace. Many of these targets will
36729 also have a second mechanism for building the backtrace for use in
36730 cases where DWARF information is not available, this second mechanism
36731 is often an analysis of a function's prologue.
36732
36733 In order to extend testing coverage of the second level stack
36734 unwinding mechanisms it is helpful to be able to disable the DWARF
36735 stack unwinders, this can be done with this switch.
36736
36737 In normal use of @value{GDBN} disabling the DWARF unwinders is not
36738 advisable, there are cases that are better handled through DWARF than
36739 prologue analysis, and the debug experience is likely to be better
36740 with the DWARF frame unwinders enabled.
36741
36742 If DWARF frame unwinders are not supported for a particular target
36743 architecture, then enabling this flag does not cause them to be used.
36744 @kindex maint set profile
36745 @kindex maint show profile
36746 @cindex profiling GDB
36747 @item maint set profile
36748 @itemx maint show profile
36749 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
36750
36751 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
36752 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
36753 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
36754 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
36755 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
36756 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
36757 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
36758
36759 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
36760 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
36761
36762 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
36763 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
36764 @cindex hardware debug registers
36765 @item maint set show-debug-regs
36766 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
36767 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
36768 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
36769 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
36770 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
36771 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
36772
36773 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
36774 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
36775 @item maint set show-all-tib
36776 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
36777 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
36778 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
36779 command.
36780
36781 @kindex maint set target-async
36782 @kindex maint show target-async
36783 @item maint set target-async
36784 @itemx maint show target-async
36785 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
36786 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
36787 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
36788 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
36789
36790 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
36791 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
36792 @item maint set target-non-stop
36793 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
36794
36795 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
36796 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
36797 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
36798 if supported by the target.
36799
36800 @table @code
36801 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
36802 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
36803 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
36804
36805 @item maint set target-non-stop on
36806 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
36807 does not indicate support.
36808
36809 @item maint set target-non-stop off
36810 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
36811 target supports it.
36812 @end table
36813
36814 @kindex maint set per-command
36815 @kindex maint show per-command
36816 @item maint set per-command
36817 @itemx maint show per-command
36818 @cindex resources used by commands
36819
36820 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
36821 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
36822
36823 @table @code
36824 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
36825 @itemx maint show per-command space
36826 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
36827 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
36828 took, following the command's own output.
36829 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36830 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36831
36832 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
36833 @itemx maint show per-command time
36834 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
36835 for each command.
36836 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
36837 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
36838 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
36839 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
36840 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
36841 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
36842 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
36843 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
36844 spent by the program been debugged.
36845 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36846 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36847
36848 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
36849 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
36850 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
36851 for each command.
36852 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
36853
36854 @enumerate a
36855 @item
36856 number of symbol tables
36857 @item
36858 number of primary symbol tables
36859 @item
36860 number of blocks in the blockvector
36861 @end enumerate
36862 @end table
36863
36864 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
36865 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
36866 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
36867 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
36868 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
36869 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
36870 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
36871 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
36872 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
36873 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
36874
36875 @kindex maint space
36876 @cindex memory used by commands
36877 @item maint space @var{value}
36878 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
36879 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36880
36881 @kindex maint time
36882 @cindex time of command execution
36883 @item maint time @var{value}
36884 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
36885 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36886
36887 @kindex maint translate-address
36888 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
36889 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
36890 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
36891 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
36892 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
36893 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
36894 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
36895
36896 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
36897 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
36898 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
36899
36900 @end table
36901
36902 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
36903 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
36904
36905 @table @code
36906 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
36907 @kindex set watchdog
36908 @cindex watchdog timer
36909 @cindex timeout for commands
36910 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
36911 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
36912 reports and error and the command is aborted.
36913
36914 @item show watchdog
36915 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
36916 @end table
36917
36918 @node Remote Protocol
36919 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
36920
36921 @menu
36922 * Overview::
36923 * Packets::
36924 * Stop Reply Packets::
36925 * General Query Packets::
36926 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
36927 * Tracepoint Packets::
36928 * Host I/O Packets::
36929 * Interrupts::
36930 * Notification Packets::
36931 * Remote Non-Stop::
36932 * Packet Acknowledgment::
36933 * Examples::
36934 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
36935 * Library List Format::
36936 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
36937 * Memory Map Format::
36938 * Thread List Format::
36939 * Traceframe Info Format::
36940 * Branch Trace Format::
36941 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
36942 @end menu
36943
36944 @node Overview
36945 @section Overview
36946
36947 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
36948 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
36949 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
36950 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
36951
36952 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
36953 transmitted and received data, respectively.
36954
36955 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
36956 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
36957 @cindex remote serial protocol
36958 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
36959 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
36960 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
36961 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
36962 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
36963
36964 @smallexample
36965 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36966 @end smallexample
36967 @noindent
36968
36969 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
36970 @noindent
36971 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
36972 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
36973 eight bit unsigned checksum).
36974
36975 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
36976 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
36977
36978 @smallexample
36979 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36980 @end smallexample
36981
36982 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
36983 @noindent
36984 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
36985 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
36986 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
36987
36988 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
36989 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
36990 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
36991 retransmission):
36992
36993 @smallexample
36994 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36995 <- @code{+}
36996 @end smallexample
36997 @noindent
36998
36999 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
37000 once a connection is established.
37001 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
37002
37003 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
37004 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
37005 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
37006 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
37007 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
37008 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
37009 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
37010
37011 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
37012 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
37013 exceptions).
37014
37015 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
37016 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
37017 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
37018 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
37019
37020 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
37021 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
37022 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
37023
37024 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
37025 @anchor{Binary Data}
37026 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
37027 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
37028 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
37029 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
37030 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
37031 binary data.
37032
37033 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
37034 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
37035 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
37036 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
37037 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
37038 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
37039 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
37040 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
37041 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
37042 (described next).
37043
37044 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
37045 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
37046 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
37047 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
37048 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
37049 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
37050 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
37051 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
37052 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
37053 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
37054 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
37055 3}} more times.
37056
37057 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
37058 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
37059 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
37060 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
37061 @samp{0*"00}.
37062
37063 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
37064 error number. That number is not well defined.
37065
37066 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
37067 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
37068 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
37069 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
37070 on that response.
37071
37072 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
37073 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
37074 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
37075 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
37076 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
37077 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
37078
37079 @node Packets
37080 @section Packets
37081
37082 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
37083 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
37084 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
37085 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
37086
37087 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
37088 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
37089 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
37090 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
37091 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
37092 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
37093 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
37094 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
37095 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
37096 @var{baz}.
37097
37098 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
37099 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
37100 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
37101 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
37102 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
37103 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
37104 pick any thread.
37105
37106 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
37107 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
37108 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
37109 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
37110 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
37111 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
37112 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
37113 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
37114 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
37115 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
37116 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
37117 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
37118 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
37119
37120 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
37121 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
37122 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
37123 more information.
37124
37125 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
37126 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
37127
37128 Here are the packet descriptions.
37129
37130 @table @samp
37131
37132 @item !
37133 @cindex @samp{!} packet
37134 @anchor{extended mode}
37135 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
37136 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
37137 debugged.
37138
37139 Reply:
37140 @table @samp
37141 @item OK
37142 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
37143 @end table
37144
37145 @item ?
37146 @cindex @samp{?} packet
37147 @anchor{? packet}
37148 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
37149 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
37150 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
37151
37152 Reply:
37153 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37154
37155 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
37156 @cindex @samp{A} packet
37157 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
37158 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
37159 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
37160
37161 Reply:
37162 @table @samp
37163 @item OK
37164 The arguments were set.
37165 @item E @var{NN}
37166 An error occurred.
37167 @end table
37168
37169 @item b @var{baud}
37170 @cindex @samp{b} packet
37171 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
37172 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
37173
37174 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
37175 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
37176 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
37177
37178 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
37179 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
37180 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
37181 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
37182 of view, nothing actually happened.}
37183
37184 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
37185 @cindex @samp{B} packet
37186 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
37187 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
37188
37189 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
37190 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
37191
37192 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
37193 @anchor{bc}
37194 @item bc
37195 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
37196 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
37197
37198 Reply:
37199 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37200
37201 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
37202 @anchor{bs}
37203 @item bs
37204 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
37205 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
37206
37207 Reply:
37208 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37209
37210 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
37211 @cindex @samp{c} packet
37212 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
37213 is omitted, resume at current address.
37214
37215 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37216 packet}.
37217
37218 Reply:
37219 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37220
37221 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
37222 @cindex @samp{C} packet
37223 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
37224 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
37225
37226 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37227 packet}.
37228
37229 Reply:
37230 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37231
37232 @item d
37233 @cindex @samp{d} packet
37234 Toggle debug flag.
37235
37236 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
37237 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
37238
37239 @item D
37240 @itemx D;@var{pid}
37241 @cindex @samp{D} packet
37242 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
37243 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
37244 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
37245
37246 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
37247 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
37248 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
37249 big-endian hex string.
37250
37251 Reply:
37252 @table @samp
37253 @item OK
37254 for success
37255 @item E @var{NN}
37256 for an error
37257 @end table
37258
37259 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
37260 @cindex @samp{F} packet
37261 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
37262 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
37263 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
37264
37265 @item g
37266 @anchor{read registers packet}
37267 @cindex @samp{g} packet
37268 Read general registers.
37269
37270 Reply:
37271 @table @samp
37272 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37273 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
37274 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
37275 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
37276 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
37277 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
37278
37279 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
37280 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
37281 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
37282 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
37283 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
37284 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
37285 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
37286 have been collected, and both have zero value:
37287
37288 @smallexample
37289 -> @code{g}
37290 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
37291 @end smallexample
37292
37293 @item E @var{NN}
37294 for an error.
37295 @end table
37296
37297 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
37298 @cindex @samp{G} packet
37299 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
37300 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
37301
37302 Reply:
37303 @table @samp
37304 @item OK
37305 for success
37306 @item E @var{NN}
37307 for an error
37308 @end table
37309
37310 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
37311 @cindex @samp{H} packet
37312 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
37313 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
37314 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
37315 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
37316 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
37317 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
37318 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37319
37320 Reply:
37321 @table @samp
37322 @item OK
37323 for success
37324 @item E @var{NN}
37325 for an error
37326 @end table
37327
37328 @c FIXME: JTC:
37329 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
37330 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
37331 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
37332 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
37333 @c described. For example:
37334 @c
37335 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37336 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
37337 @c otherwise returns current registers.
37338 @c
37339 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37340 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
37341 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
37342
37343 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
37344 @anchor{cycle step packet}
37345 @cindex @samp{i} packet
37346 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
37347 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
37348 step starting at that address.
37349
37350 @item I
37351 @cindex @samp{I} packet
37352 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
37353 step packet}.
37354
37355 @item k
37356 @cindex @samp{k} packet
37357 Kill request.
37358
37359 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
37360
37361 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
37362 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
37363
37364 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
37365
37366 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
37367 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
37368 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
37369
37370 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
37371 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
37372 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
37373
37374 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
37375 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
37376 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
37377 (@pxref{? packet}).
37378
37379 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
37380 @cindex @samp{m} packet
37381 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
37382 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
37383 any particular boundary.
37384
37385 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
37386 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
37387 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
37388 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
37389 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
37390 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
37391 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
37392 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
37393
37394 Reply:
37395 @table @samp
37396 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37397 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37398 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
37399 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
37400 @item E @var{NN}
37401 @var{NN} is errno
37402 @end table
37403
37404 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37405 @cindex @samp{M} packet
37406 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
37407 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
37408 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37409
37410 Reply:
37411 @table @samp
37412 @item OK
37413 for success
37414 @item E @var{NN}
37415 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
37416 written).
37417 @end table
37418
37419 @item p @var{n}
37420 @cindex @samp{p} packet
37421 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
37422 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
37423 register value is encoded.
37424
37425 Reply:
37426 @table @samp
37427 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37428 the register's value
37429 @item E @var{NN}
37430 for an error
37431 @item @w{}
37432 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
37433 @end table
37434
37435 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
37436 @anchor{write register packet}
37437 @cindex @samp{P} packet
37438 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
37439 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
37440 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
37441
37442 Reply:
37443 @table @samp
37444 @item OK
37445 for success
37446 @item E @var{NN}
37447 for an error
37448 @end table
37449
37450 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37451 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37452 @cindex @samp{q} packet
37453 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
37454 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
37455 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
37456
37457 @item r
37458 @cindex @samp{r} packet
37459 Reset the entire system.
37460
37461 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
37462
37463 @item R @var{XX}
37464 @cindex @samp{R} packet
37465 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
37466 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37467
37468 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
37469
37470 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
37471 @cindex @samp{s} packet
37472 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
37473 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
37474
37475 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37476 packet}.
37477
37478 Reply:
37479 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37480
37481 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
37482 @anchor{step with signal packet}
37483 @cindex @samp{S} packet
37484 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
37485 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
37486
37487 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37488 packet}.
37489
37490 Reply:
37491 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37492
37493 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
37494 @cindex @samp{t} packet
37495 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
37496 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
37497 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
37498
37499 @item T @var{thread-id}
37500 @cindex @samp{T} packet
37501 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
37502
37503 Reply:
37504 @table @samp
37505 @item OK
37506 thread is still alive
37507 @item E @var{NN}
37508 thread is dead
37509 @end table
37510
37511 @item v
37512 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
37513 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
37514
37515 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
37516 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
37517 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
37518 The process ID is a
37519 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
37520 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
37521 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
37522
37523 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
37524 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
37525 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
37526 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
37527 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
37528 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
37529 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
37530 @c stopping or restarting threads.
37531
37532 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37533
37534 Reply:
37535 @table @samp
37536 @item E @var{nn}
37537 for an error
37538 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37539 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37540 @item OK
37541 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
37542 @end table
37543
37544 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
37545 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
37546 @anchor{vCont packet}
37547 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
37548
37549 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
37550 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
37551 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
37552 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
37553 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
37554 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
37555 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
37556 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
37557 error.
37558
37559 Currently supported actions are:
37560
37561 @table @samp
37562 @item c
37563 Continue.
37564 @item C @var{sig}
37565 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37566 @item s
37567 Step.
37568 @item S @var{sig}
37569 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37570 @item t
37571 Stop.
37572 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
37573 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
37574 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
37575 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
37576 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
37577 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
37578
37579 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
37580 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
37581 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
37582 jumps to @var{start}).
37583
37584 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
37585 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
37586 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
37587
37588 @end table
37589
37590 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
37591 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
37592 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
37593
37594 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
37595 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
37596 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
37597 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
37598 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
37599 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
37600 as an implementation detail.
37601
37602 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
37603 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
37604 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
37605 stopped.
37606
37607 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
37608 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
37609 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
37610
37611 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
37612 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
37613
37614 Reply:
37615 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37616
37617 @item vCont?
37618 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
37619 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
37620
37621 Reply:
37622 @table @samp
37623 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
37624 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
37625 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
37626 @item @w{}
37627 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
37628 @end table
37629
37630 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
37631 @item vCtrlC
37632 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
37633 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
37634 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
37635 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
37636 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
37637 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
37638 variant.
37639
37640 Reply:
37641 @table @samp
37642 @item E @var{nn}
37643 for an error
37644 @item OK
37645 for success
37646 @end table
37647
37648 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
37649 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
37650 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
37651 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
37652
37653 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
37654 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
37655 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
37656 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
37657 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
37658 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
37659 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
37660 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
37661 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37662 packet is received.
37663
37664 Reply:
37665 @table @samp
37666 @item OK
37667 for success
37668 @item E @var{NN}
37669 for an error
37670 @end table
37671
37672 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37673 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
37674 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
37675 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
37676 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
37677 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
37678 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
37679 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
37680 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
37681 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
37682 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
37683 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
37684
37685
37686 Reply:
37687 @table @samp
37688 @item OK
37689 for success
37690 @item E.memtype
37691 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
37692 @item E @var{NN}
37693 for an error
37694 @end table
37695
37696 @item vFlashDone
37697 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
37698 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
37699 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
37700 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
37701 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
37702 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37703 request is completed.
37704
37705 @item vKill;@var{pid}
37706 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
37707 @anchor{vKill packet}
37708 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
37709 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
37710 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
37711 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
37712
37713 Reply:
37714 @table @samp
37715 @item E @var{nn}
37716 for an error
37717 @item OK
37718 for success
37719 @end table
37720
37721 @item vMustReplyEmpty
37722 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
37723 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
37724 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
37725 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
37726
37727 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
37728 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
37729 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
37730 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
37731 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
37732 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
37733
37734 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
37735 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
37736 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
37737 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
37738 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
37739 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
37740 state.
37741
37742 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
37743
37744 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37745
37746 Reply:
37747 @table @samp
37748 @item E @var{nn}
37749 for an error
37750 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37751 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37752 @end table
37753
37754 @item vStopped
37755 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
37756 @xref{Notification Packets}.
37757
37758 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37759 @anchor{X packet}
37760 @cindex @samp{X} packet
37761 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
37762 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
37763 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
37764 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37765
37766 Reply:
37767 @table @samp
37768 @item OK
37769 for success
37770 @item E @var{NN}
37771 for an error
37772 @end table
37773
37774 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37775 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37776 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
37777 @cindex @samp{z} packet
37778 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
37779 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
37780 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
37781
37782 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
37783 separately.
37784
37785 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
37786 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
37787 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
37788 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
37789 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
37790 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
37791
37792 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37793 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37794 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
37795 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
37796 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
37797 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
37798
37799 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
37800 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
37801 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
37802 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
37803 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
37804 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
37805 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
37806 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
37807 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
37808 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
37809 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
37810 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
37811 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37812
37813 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
37814 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
37815
37816 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
37817 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
37818
37819 @table @samp
37820
37821 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37822 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37823 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
37824
37825 @end table
37826
37827 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
37828 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37829 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
37830 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
37831 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
37832 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
37833 separators. Each expression has the following form:
37834
37835 @table @samp
37836
37837 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37838 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37839 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
37840
37841 @end table
37842
37843 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
37844 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
37845 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
37846 target, is not defined.}
37847
37848 Reply:
37849 @table @samp
37850 @item OK
37851 success
37852 @item @w{}
37853 not supported
37854 @item E @var{NN}
37855 for an error
37856 @end table
37857
37858 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37859 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37860 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
37861 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
37862 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
37863 address @var{addr}.
37864
37865 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
37866 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
37867 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
37868 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
37869
37870 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
37871 movement.}
37872
37873 Reply:
37874 @table @samp
37875 @item OK
37876 success
37877 @item @w{}
37878 not supported
37879 @item E @var{NN}
37880 for an error
37881 @end table
37882
37883 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37884 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37885 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
37886 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
37887 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37888 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37889
37890 Reply:
37891 @table @samp
37892 @item OK
37893 success
37894 @item @w{}
37895 not supported
37896 @item E @var{NN}
37897 for an error
37898 @end table
37899
37900 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37901 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37902 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
37903 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
37904 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37905 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37906
37907 Reply:
37908 @table @samp
37909 @item OK
37910 success
37911 @item @w{}
37912 not supported
37913 @item E @var{NN}
37914 for an error
37915 @end table
37916
37917 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37918 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37919 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
37920 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
37921 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37922 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37923
37924 Reply:
37925 @table @samp
37926 @item OK
37927 success
37928 @item @w{}
37929 not supported
37930 @item E @var{NN}
37931 for an error
37932 @end table
37933
37934 @end table
37935
37936 @node Stop Reply Packets
37937 @section Stop Reply Packets
37938 @cindex stop reply packets
37939
37940 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
37941 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
37942 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
37943 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
37944 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
37945 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
37946 @value{GDBN} source code.
37947
37948 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
37949 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
37950 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
37951
37952 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
37953 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
37954 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
37955 components.
37956
37957 @table @samp
37958
37959 @item S @var{AA}
37960 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37961 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
37962 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
37963
37964 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
37965 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
37966 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37967 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
37968 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
37969 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
37970 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
37971 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
37972
37973 @itemize @bullet
37974 @item
37975 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
37976 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
37977 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
37978 two-digit hex number.
37979
37980 @item
37981 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
37982 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37983
37984 @item
37985 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
37986 the core on which the stop event was detected.
37987
37988 @item
37989 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
37990 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
37991 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
37992 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
37993
37994 @item
37995 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
37996 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
37997 future.
37998 @end itemize
37999
38000 The currently defined stop reasons are:
38001
38002 @table @samp
38003 @item watch
38004 @itemx rwatch
38005 @itemx awatch
38006 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
38007 hex.
38008
38009 @item syscall_entry
38010 @itemx syscall_return
38011 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
38012 syscall number, in hex.
38013
38014 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
38015 @item library
38016 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
38017 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
38018 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
38019
38020 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
38021 @item replaylog
38022 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
38023 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
38024 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
38025 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
38026 for more information.
38027
38028 @item swbreak
38029 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
38030 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
38031 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
38032 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
38033 part must be left empty.
38034
38035 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
38036 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
38037 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
38038 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
38039 address.
38040
38041 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38042 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38043 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38044 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38045 indicating support.
38046
38047 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
38048
38049 @item hwbreak
38050 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
38051 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
38052
38053 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
38054 apply.
38055
38056 @cindex fork events, remote reply
38057 @item fork
38058 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
38059 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
38060 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
38061 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
38062 fork events.
38063
38064 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38065 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38066 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38067 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38068 indicating support.
38069
38070 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
38071 @item vfork
38072 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
38073 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
38074 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
38075 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
38076 vfork events.
38077
38078 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38079 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38080 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38081 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38082 indicating support.
38083
38084 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
38085 @item vforkdone
38086 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
38087 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
38088 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
38089 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
38090 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
38091
38092 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38093 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38094 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38095 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38096 indicating support.
38097
38098 @cindex exec events, remote reply
38099 @item exec
38100 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
38101 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
38102 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
38103
38104 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38105 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38106 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38107 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38108 indicating support.
38109
38110 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
38111 @anchor{thread create event}
38112 @item create
38113 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
38114 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
38115 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
38116 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
38117 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
38118 @var{r} part is ignored.
38119
38120 @end table
38121
38122 @item W @var{AA}
38123 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
38124 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
38125 applicable to certain targets.
38126
38127 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
38128 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
38129 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
38130 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
38131 hex strings.
38132
38133 @item X @var{AA}
38134 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
38135 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
38136
38137 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
38138 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
38139 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
38140 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
38141 hex strings.
38142
38143 @anchor{thread exit event}
38144 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
38145 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
38146
38147 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
38148 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
38149 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
38150 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
38151
38152 @item N
38153 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
38154 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
38155 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
38156 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
38157 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
38158 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
38159 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
38160 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
38161 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
38162 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
38163 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
38164 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
38165 support.
38166
38167 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
38168 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
38169 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
38170 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
38171 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
38172
38173 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
38174 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
38175 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
38176 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
38177 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
38178 system calls.
38179
38180 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
38181 this very system call.
38182
38183 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
38184 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
38185 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
38186 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38187 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
38188 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
38189
38190 @end table
38191
38192 @node General Query Packets
38193 @section General Query Packets
38194 @cindex remote query requests
38195
38196 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
38197 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
38198 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
38199 sending information to and from the stub.
38200
38201 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
38202 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
38203 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
38204 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
38205 conventions:
38206
38207 @itemize @bullet
38208 @item
38209 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
38210 @item
38211 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
38212 letter.
38213 @item
38214 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
38215 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
38216 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
38217 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
38218 @end itemize
38219
38220 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
38221 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
38222 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
38223 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
38224 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
38225 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
38226 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
38227 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
38228 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
38229 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
38230 packet.}.
38231
38232 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
38233 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
38234 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
38235 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
38236 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
38237
38238 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
38239
38240 @table @samp
38241
38242 @item QAgent:1
38243 @itemx QAgent:0
38244 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
38245 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
38246
38247 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
38248 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
38249 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
38250 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
38251 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
38252 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
38253 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
38254 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
38255 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
38256 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
38257 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
38258
38259 @item qC
38260 @cindex current thread, remote request
38261 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
38262 Return the current thread ID.
38263
38264 Reply:
38265 @table @samp
38266 @item QC @var{thread-id}
38267 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
38268 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
38269 @item @r{(anything else)}
38270 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
38271 @end table
38272
38273 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
38274 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
38275 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
38276 @anchor{qCRC packet}
38277 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
38278 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
38279 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
38280 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
38281
38282 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
38283 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
38284 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
38285 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
38286 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
38287 detect trailing zeros.
38288
38289 Reply:
38290 @table @samp
38291 @item E @var{NN}
38292 An error (such as memory fault)
38293 @item C @var{crc32}
38294 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
38295 @end table
38296
38297 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
38298 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
38299 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
38300 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
38301 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
38302 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
38303 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
38304 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
38305 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
38306 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
38307 randomization.
38308
38309 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38310
38311 Reply:
38312 @table @samp
38313 @item OK
38314 The request succeeded.
38315
38316 @item E @var{nn}
38317 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38318
38319 @item @w{}
38320 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
38321 by the stub.
38322 @end table
38323
38324 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38325 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38326 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
38327 address space randomization.
38328
38329 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
38330 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
38331 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
38332 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
38333 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
38334 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
38335 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
38336 inferior using a shell or not.
38337
38338 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
38339 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
38340 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
38341 values are considered an error.
38342
38343 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38344 mode}).
38345
38346 Reply:
38347 @table @samp
38348 @item OK
38349 The request succeeded.
38350
38351 @item E @var{nn}
38352 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38353 @end table
38354
38355 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38356 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38357 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38358 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
38359
38360 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
38361 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
38362
38363 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
38364 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
38365 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
38366 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
38367 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
38368 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
38369 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
38370 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
38371 environment}).
38372
38373 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
38374 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
38375 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
38376 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
38377 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
38378 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
38379 not be present.
38380
38381 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38382 mode}).
38383
38384 Reply:
38385 @table @samp
38386 @item OK
38387 The request succeeded.
38388 @end table
38389
38390 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38391 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38392 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38393 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38394 inferior.
38395
38396 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
38397 @pxref{set environment}.
38398
38399 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
38400 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
38401 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
38402 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
38403 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
38404 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
38405 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
38406 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
38407
38408 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
38409 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
38410
38411 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38412 mode}).
38413
38414 Reply:
38415 @table @samp
38416 @item OK
38417 The request succeeded.
38418 @end table
38419
38420 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38421 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38422 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38423 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38424 inferior.
38425
38426 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
38427 @pxref{unset environment}.
38428
38429 @item QEnvironmentReset
38430 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
38431 @cindex reset environment, remote request
38432 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
38433 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
38434 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
38435 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
38436 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
38437 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
38438 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
38439 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
38440 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
38441
38442 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38443 mode}).
38444
38445 Reply:
38446 @table @samp
38447 @item OK
38448 The request succeeded.
38449 @end table
38450
38451 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38452 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38453 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38454 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38455 inferior.
38456
38457 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
38458 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
38459 @cindex set working directory, remote request
38460 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
38461 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
38462 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
38463
38464 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
38465 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
38466 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
38467 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
38468 directory to its original, empty value.
38469
38470 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38471 mode}).
38472
38473 Reply:
38474 @table @samp
38475 @item OK
38476 The request succeeded.
38477 @end table
38478
38479 @item qfThreadInfo
38480 @itemx qsThreadInfo
38481 @cindex list active threads, remote request
38482 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
38483 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
38484 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
38485 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
38486 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
38487 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
38488 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
38489 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
38490
38491 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
38492
38493 Reply:
38494 @table @samp
38495 @item m @var{thread-id}
38496 A single thread ID
38497 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
38498 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
38499 @item l
38500 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38501 @end table
38502
38503 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38504 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
38505 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
38506 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
38507 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
38508 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
38509 fields.
38510
38511 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
38512 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
38513 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
38514 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
38515 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
38516
38517 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
38518 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
38519 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
38520 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
38521 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
38522
38523 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
38524 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
38525
38526 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
38527 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
38528 information associated with the variable.)
38529
38530 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
38531 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
38532 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
38533 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
38534 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
38535 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
38536
38537 Reply:
38538 @table @samp
38539 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38540 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
38541 local storage requested.
38542
38543 @item E @var{nn}
38544 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38545
38546 @item @w{}
38547 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38548 @end table
38549
38550 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
38551 @cindex get thread information block address
38552 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
38553 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
38554
38555 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
38556
38557 Reply:
38558 @table @samp
38559 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38560 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
38561 thread information block.
38562
38563 @item E @var{nn}
38564 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
38565 address could not be retrieved.
38566
38567 @item @w{}
38568 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38569 @end table
38570
38571 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
38572 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
38573 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
38574 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
38575 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
38576 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
38577 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
38578
38579 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
38580
38581 Reply:
38582 @table @samp
38583 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
38584 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
38585 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
38586 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
38587 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
38588 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
38589 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
38590 @end table
38591
38592 @item qOffsets
38593 @cindex section offsets, remote request
38594 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
38595 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
38596 image.
38597
38598 Reply:
38599 @table @samp
38600 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
38601 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
38602 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
38603 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
38604 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
38605 segments by the supplied offsets.
38606
38607 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
38608 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
38609 to the @code{Bss} section.}
38610
38611 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
38612 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
38613 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
38614 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
38615 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
38616 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
38617 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
38618 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
38619 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
38620 @end table
38621
38622 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
38623 @cindex thread information, remote request
38624 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
38625 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
38626 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
38627 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
38628
38629 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
38630 (see below).
38631
38632 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
38633
38634 @item QNonStop:1
38635 @itemx QNonStop:0
38636 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
38637 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
38638 @anchor{QNonStop}
38639 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
38640 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
38641
38642 Reply:
38643 @table @samp
38644 @item OK
38645 The request succeeded.
38646
38647 @item E @var{nn}
38648 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38649
38650 @item @w{}
38651 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
38652 the stub.
38653 @end table
38654
38655 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38656 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38657 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
38658 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
38659
38660 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
38661 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
38662 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
38663 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38664 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
38665 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
38666 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
38667
38668 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
38669 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
38670 is listed, every system call should be reported.
38671
38672 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
38673 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
38674 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
38675 report the requested syscalls.
38676
38677 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
38678 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38679
38680 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
38681 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
38682 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
38683 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
38684
38685 Reply:
38686 @table @samp
38687 @item OK
38688 The request succeeded.
38689
38690 @item E @var{nn}
38691 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
38692
38693 @item @w{}
38694 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
38695 the stub.
38696 @end table
38697
38698 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
38699 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
38700 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38701 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38702
38703 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38704 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
38705 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38706 @anchor{QPassSignals}
38707 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
38708 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38709 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38710 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
38711 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
38712 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
38713 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
38714 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
38715 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
38716
38717 Reply:
38718 @table @samp
38719 @item OK
38720 The request succeeded.
38721
38722 @item E @var{nn}
38723 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38724
38725 @item @w{}
38726 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
38727 the stub.
38728 @end table
38729
38730 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
38731 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
38732 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38733 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38734
38735 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38736 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
38737 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
38738 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
38739 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
38740 Others should be silently discarded.
38741
38742 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
38743 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
38744 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
38745 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
38746 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
38747 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
38748 signals.
38749
38750 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
38751 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
38752
38753 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38754 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38755 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
38756 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
38757 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38758
38759 Reply:
38760 @table @samp
38761 @item OK
38762 The request succeeded.
38763
38764 @item E @var{nn}
38765 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38766
38767 @item @w{}
38768 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
38769 by the stub.
38770 @end table
38771
38772 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
38773 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
38774 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38775 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38776
38777 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
38778 @item QThreadEvents:1
38779 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
38780 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
38781 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
38782
38783 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
38784 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
38785 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
38786 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
38787 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
38788 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
38789 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
38790 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
38791 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
38792 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38793
38794 Reply:
38795 @table @samp
38796 @item OK
38797 The request succeeded.
38798
38799 @item E @var{nn}
38800 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38801
38802 @item @w{}
38803 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
38804 the stub.
38805 @end table
38806
38807 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
38808 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
38809
38810 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
38811 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
38812 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
38813 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
38814 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
38815 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
38816 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
38817 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
38818 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
38819
38820 Reply:
38821 @table @samp
38822 @item OK
38823 A command response with no output.
38824 @item @var{OUTPUT}
38825 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
38826 @item E @var{NN}
38827 Indicate a badly formed request.
38828 @item @w{}
38829 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
38830 @end table
38831
38832 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
38833 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38834 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38835 packets.)
38836
38837 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
38838 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
38839 @ifnotinfo
38840 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
38841 @end ifnotinfo
38842 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
38843 @anchor{qSearch memory}
38844 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
38845 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
38846 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
38847
38848 Reply:
38849 @table @samp
38850 @item 0
38851 The pattern was not found.
38852 @item 1,address
38853 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
38854 @item E @var{NN}
38855 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
38856 @item @w{}
38857 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
38858 @end table
38859
38860 @item QStartNoAckMode
38861 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
38862 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
38863 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
38864 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
38865
38866 Reply:
38867 @table @samp
38868 @item OK
38869 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
38870 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
38871 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
38872 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
38873 @item @w{}
38874 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
38875 @end table
38876
38877 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
38878 @cindex supported packets, remote query
38879 @cindex features of the remote protocol
38880 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
38881 @anchor{qSupported}
38882 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
38883 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
38884 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
38885 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
38886 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
38887 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
38888 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
38889 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
38890 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
38891 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
38892 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
38893 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
38894 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
38895 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
38896
38897 Reply:
38898 @table @samp
38899 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
38900 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
38901 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
38902 possible forms).
38903 @item @w{}
38904 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
38905 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
38906 @end table
38907
38908 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
38909 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
38910 are:
38911
38912 @table @samp
38913 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
38914 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
38915 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
38916 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
38917 @item @var{name}+
38918 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
38919 need an associated value.
38920 @item @var{name}-
38921 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
38922 @item @var{name}?
38923 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
38924 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
38925 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
38926 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
38927 @end table
38928
38929 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
38930 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
38931 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
38932 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
38933 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
38934
38935 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
38936 are defined:
38937
38938 @table @samp
38939 @item multiprocess
38940 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
38941 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38942 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38943 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38944 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
38945
38946 @item xmlRegisters
38947 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
38948 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
38949 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
38950 description.
38951
38952 @item qRelocInsn
38953 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
38954 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38955 instruction reply packet}).
38956
38957 @item swbreak
38958 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
38959 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38960
38961 @item hwbreak
38962 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
38963 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38964
38965 @item fork-events
38966 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
38967 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38968 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38969 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38970
38971 @item vfork-events
38972 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
38973 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38974 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38975 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38976
38977 @item exec-events
38978 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
38979 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38980 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38981 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38982
38983 @item vContSupported
38984 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
38985 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
38986 @end table
38987
38988 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
38989 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
38990 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
38991 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
38992 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
38993 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
38994 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
38995 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
38996 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
38997 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
38998 all the features it supports.
38999
39000 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
39001 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
39002
39003 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
39004 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
39005 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
39006 form response.
39007
39008 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
39009 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
39010 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
39011 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
39012
39013 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
39014 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
39015 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
39016 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
39017 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
39018
39019 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
39020
39021 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
39022 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
39023 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
39024 @item Feature Name
39025 @tab Value Required
39026 @tab Default
39027 @tab Probe Allowed
39028
39029 @item @samp{PacketSize}
39030 @tab Yes
39031 @tab @samp{-}
39032 @tab No
39033
39034 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
39035 @tab No
39036 @tab @samp{-}
39037 @tab Yes
39038
39039 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39040 @tab No
39041 @tab @samp{-}
39042 @tab Yes
39043
39044 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39045 @tab No
39046 @tab @samp{-}
39047 @tab Yes
39048
39049 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
39050 @tab No
39051 @tab @samp{-}
39052 @tab Yes
39053
39054 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
39055 @tab No
39056 @tab @samp{-}
39057 @tab Yes
39058
39059 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39060 @tab No
39061 @tab @samp{-}
39062 @tab Yes
39063
39064 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
39065 @tab No
39066 @tab @samp{-}
39067 @tab Yes
39068
39069 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
39070 @tab No
39071 @tab @samp{-}
39072 @tab No
39073
39074 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
39075 @tab No
39076 @tab @samp{-}
39077 @tab Yes
39078
39079 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
39080 @tab No
39081 @tab @samp{-}
39082 @tab Yes
39083
39084 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
39085 @tab No
39086 @tab @samp{-}
39087 @tab Yes
39088
39089 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
39090 @tab No
39091 @tab @samp{-}
39092 @tab Yes
39093
39094 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
39095 @tab No
39096 @tab @samp{-}
39097 @tab Yes
39098
39099 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
39100 @tab No
39101 @tab @samp{-}
39102 @tab Yes
39103
39104 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
39105 @tab No
39106 @tab @samp{-}
39107 @tab Yes
39108
39109 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39110 @tab No
39111 @tab @samp{-}
39112 @tab Yes
39113
39114 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
39115 @tab No
39116 @tab @samp{-}
39117 @tab Yes
39118
39119 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
39120 @tab No
39121 @tab @samp{-}
39122 @tab Yes
39123
39124 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
39125 @tab Yes
39126 @tab @samp{-}
39127 @tab Yes
39128
39129 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
39130 @tab Yes
39131 @tab @samp{-}
39132 @tab Yes
39133
39134 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
39135 @tab Yes
39136 @tab @samp{-}
39137 @tab Yes
39138
39139 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
39140 @tab Yes
39141 @tab @samp{-}
39142 @tab Yes
39143
39144 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
39145 @tab Yes
39146 @tab @samp{-}
39147 @tab Yes
39148
39149 @item @samp{QNonStop}
39150 @tab No
39151 @tab @samp{-}
39152 @tab Yes
39153
39154 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
39155 @tab No
39156 @tab @samp{-}
39157 @tab Yes
39158
39159 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
39160 @tab No
39161 @tab @samp{-}
39162 @tab Yes
39163
39164 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
39165 @tab No
39166 @tab @samp{-}
39167 @tab Yes
39168
39169 @item @samp{multiprocess}
39170 @tab No
39171 @tab @samp{-}
39172 @tab No
39173
39174 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
39175 @tab No
39176 @tab @samp{-}
39177 @tab No
39178
39179 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
39180 @tab No
39181 @tab @samp{-}
39182 @tab No
39183
39184 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
39185 @tab No
39186 @tab @samp{-}
39187 @tab No
39188
39189 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
39190 @tab No
39191 @tab @samp{-}
39192 @tab No
39193
39194 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
39195 @tab No
39196 @tab @samp{-}
39197 @tab No
39198
39199 @item @samp{QAgent}
39200 @tab No
39201 @tab @samp{-}
39202 @tab No
39203
39204 @item @samp{QAllow}
39205 @tab No
39206 @tab @samp{-}
39207 @tab No
39208
39209 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
39210 @tab No
39211 @tab @samp{-}
39212 @tab No
39213
39214 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
39215 @tab No
39216 @tab @samp{-}
39217 @tab No
39218
39219 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
39220 @tab No
39221 @tab @samp{-}
39222 @tab No
39223
39224 @item @samp{tracenz}
39225 @tab No
39226 @tab @samp{-}
39227 @tab No
39228
39229 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
39230 @tab No
39231 @tab @samp{-}
39232 @tab No
39233
39234 @item @samp{swbreak}
39235 @tab No
39236 @tab @samp{-}
39237 @tab No
39238
39239 @item @samp{hwbreak}
39240 @tab No
39241 @tab @samp{-}
39242 @tab No
39243
39244 @item @samp{fork-events}
39245 @tab No
39246 @tab @samp{-}
39247 @tab No
39248
39249 @item @samp{vfork-events}
39250 @tab No
39251 @tab @samp{-}
39252 @tab No
39253
39254 @item @samp{exec-events}
39255 @tab No
39256 @tab @samp{-}
39257 @tab No
39258
39259 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
39260 @tab No
39261 @tab @samp{-}
39262 @tab No
39263
39264 @item @samp{no-resumed}
39265 @tab No
39266 @tab @samp{-}
39267 @tab No
39268
39269 @end multitable
39270
39271 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
39272
39273 @table @samp
39274 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
39275 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
39276 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
39277 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
39278 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
39279 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
39280 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
39281 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
39282 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
39283 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
39284
39285 @item qXfer:auxv:read
39286 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
39287 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
39288
39289 @item qXfer:btrace:read
39290 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39291 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
39292
39293 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
39294 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39295 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
39296
39297 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
39298 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
39299 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
39300
39301 @item qXfer:features:read
39302 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
39303 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
39304
39305 @item qXfer:libraries:read
39306 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
39307 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
39308
39309 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
39310 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
39311 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
39312
39313 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
39314 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
39315 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
39316 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
39317
39318 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
39319 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
39320 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
39321
39322 @item qXfer:sdata:read
39323 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
39324 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
39325
39326 @item qXfer:spu:read
39327 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
39328 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
39329
39330 @item qXfer:spu:write
39331 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
39332 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
39333
39334 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
39335 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
39336 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
39337
39338 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
39339 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
39340 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
39341
39342 @item qXfer:threads:read
39343 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39344 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
39345
39346 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
39347 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39348 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
39349
39350 @item qXfer:uib:read
39351 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
39352 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
39353
39354 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
39355 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
39356 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
39357
39358 @item QNonStop
39359 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
39360 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
39361
39362 @item QCatchSyscalls
39363 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
39364 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
39365
39366 @item QPassSignals
39367 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
39368 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
39369
39370 @item QStartNoAckMode
39371 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
39372 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
39373
39374 @item multiprocess
39375 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
39376 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
39377 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
39378 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
39379 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
39380 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
39381 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
39382 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
39383 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
39384 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
39385 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
39386
39387 @item qXfer:osdata:read
39388 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
39389 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
39390
39391 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
39392 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
39393 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
39394 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
39395
39396 @item ConditionalTracepoints
39397 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
39398 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
39399
39400 @item ReverseContinue
39401 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
39402 (@pxref{bc}).
39403
39404 @item ReverseStep
39405 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
39406 (@pxref{bs}).
39407
39408 @item TracepointSource
39409 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
39410 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
39411
39412 @item QAgent
39413 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
39414
39415 @item QAllow
39416 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
39417
39418 @item QDisableRandomization
39419 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
39420
39421 @item StaticTracepoint
39422 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
39423 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
39424
39425 @item InstallInTrace
39426 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
39427 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
39428
39429 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
39430 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
39431 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
39432 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
39433
39434 @item QTBuffer:size
39435 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
39436 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
39437
39438 @item tracenz
39439 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
39440 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
39441 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
39442
39443 @item BreakpointCommands
39444 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
39445 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
39446 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
39447
39448 @item Qbtrace:off
39449 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
39450
39451 @item Qbtrace:bts
39452 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
39453
39454 @item Qbtrace:pt
39455 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
39456
39457 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
39458 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
39459
39460 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
39461 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
39462
39463 @item swbreak
39464 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
39465 breakpoints.
39466
39467 @item hwbreak
39468 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
39469 breakpoints.
39470
39471 @item fork-events
39472 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
39473
39474 @item vfork-events
39475 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
39476 and vforkdone events.
39477
39478 @item exec-events
39479 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
39480
39481 @item vContSupported
39482 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
39483 @samp{vCont?} packet.
39484
39485 @item QThreadEvents
39486 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
39487
39488 @item no-resumed
39489 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
39490
39491 @end table
39492
39493 @item qSymbol::
39494 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
39495 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
39496 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
39497 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
39498
39499 Reply:
39500 @table @samp
39501 @item OK
39502 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39503 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39504 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
39505 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
39506 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
39507 below.
39508 @end table
39509
39510 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
39511 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
39512
39513 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
39514 target has previously requested.
39515
39516 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
39517 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
39518 will be empty.
39519
39520 Reply:
39521 @table @samp
39522 @item OK
39523 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39524 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39525 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
39526 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
39527 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
39528 @end table
39529
39530 @item qTBuffer
39531 @itemx QTBuffer
39532 @itemx QTDisconnected
39533 @itemx QTDP
39534 @itemx QTDPsrc
39535 @itemx QTDV
39536 @itemx qTfP
39537 @itemx qTfV
39538 @itemx QTFrame
39539 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
39540
39541 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39542
39543 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
39544 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
39545 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
39546 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
39547 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
39548 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
39549 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
39550 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
39551 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
39552 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
39553 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
39554
39555 Reply:
39556 @table @samp
39557 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
39558 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
39559 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
39560 the thread's attributes.
39561 @end table
39562
39563 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
39564 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
39565 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
39566 packets.)
39567
39568 @item QTNotes
39569 @itemx qTP
39570 @itemx QTSave
39571 @itemx qTsP
39572 @itemx qTsV
39573 @itemx QTStart
39574 @itemx QTStop
39575 @itemx QTEnable
39576 @itemx QTDisable
39577 @itemx QTinit
39578 @itemx QTro
39579 @itemx qTStatus
39580 @itemx qTV
39581 @itemx qTfSTM
39582 @itemx qTsSTM
39583 @itemx qTSTMat
39584 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39585
39586 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39587 @cindex read special object, remote request
39588 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
39589 @anchor{qXfer read}
39590 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
39591 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
39592 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
39593 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
39594 additional details about what data to access.
39595
39596 Reply:
39597 @table @samp
39598 @item m @var{data}
39599 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
39600 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
39601 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
39602 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
39603 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
39604 request.
39605
39606 @item l @var{data}
39607 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
39608 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
39609 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
39610
39611 @item l
39612 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
39613 There is no more data to be read.
39614
39615 @item E00
39616 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39617
39618 @item E @var{nn}
39619 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
39620 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39621
39622 @item @w{}
39623 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
39624 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
39625 @end table
39626
39627 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39628 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39629 formats, listed above.
39630
39631 @table @samp
39632 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39633 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
39634 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
39635 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
39636
39637 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39638 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39639
39640 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39641 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
39642
39643 Return a description of the current branch trace.
39644 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
39645 packet may have one of the following values:
39646
39647 @table @code
39648 @item all
39649 Returns all available branch trace.
39650
39651 @item new
39652 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
39653 the last read request.
39654
39655 @item delta
39656 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
39657 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
39658 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
39659 used to stitch traces together.
39660
39661 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
39662 @end table
39663
39664 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39665 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39666
39667 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39668 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
39669
39670 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
39671 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
39672
39673 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39674 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39675
39676 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39677 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
39678 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
39679 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
39680 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
39681 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
39682 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
39683
39684 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39685 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39686
39687 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39688 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
39689 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
39690 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
39691 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
39692
39693 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39694 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39695
39696 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39697 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
39698 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
39699 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39700 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39701
39702 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
39703 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
39704 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
39705
39706 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39707 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39708
39709 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39710 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
39711 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
39712 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
39713 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
39714 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
39715 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39716 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
39717
39718 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
39719 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
39720
39721 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39722 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39723
39724 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
39725 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
39726 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
39727 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
39728
39729 @table @code
39730 @item start=@var{address}
39731 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39732 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
39733 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
39734 chosen as the starting point.
39735
39736 @item prev=@var{address}
39737 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39738 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
39739 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
39740 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
39741 exists prior to the starting point.
39742
39743 @end table
39744
39745 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
39746 ignored.
39747
39748 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39749 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
39750 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
39751 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39752 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39753
39754 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39755 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39756
39757 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39758 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
39759
39760 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
39761 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
39762 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
39763 Action Lists}.
39764
39765 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39766 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39767 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39768
39769 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39770 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
39771 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
39772 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39773 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39774
39775 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39776 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39777 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39778
39779 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39780 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
39781 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39782 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
39783 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39784 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39785 in that context to be accessed.
39786
39787 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39788 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39789 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39790
39791 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39792 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
39793 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
39794 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39795 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39796
39797 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39798 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39799
39800 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39801 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
39802
39803 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
39804 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
39805 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39806
39807 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39808 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39809
39810 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39811 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
39812
39813 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
39814 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
39815
39816 This packet is not probed by default.
39817
39818 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39819 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
39820 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
39821 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
39822 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
39823
39824 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39825 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39826
39827 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39828 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
39829 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
39830 @xref{Operating System Information}.
39831
39832 @end table
39833
39834 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39835 @cindex write data into object, remote request
39836 @anchor{qXfer write}
39837 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
39838 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
39839 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
39840 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
39841 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
39842 to access.
39843
39844 Reply:
39845 @table @samp
39846 @item @var{nn}
39847 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
39848 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
39849
39850 @item E00
39851 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39852
39853 @item E @var{nn}
39854 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
39855 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39856
39857 @item @w{}
39858 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
39859 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
39860 @end table
39861
39862 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39863 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39864 formats, listed above.
39865
39866 @table @samp
39867 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39868 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
39869 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
39870 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39871 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
39872
39873 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39874 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39875 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39876
39877 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39878 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
39879 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39880 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
39881 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39882 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39883 in that context to be accessed.
39884
39885 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39886 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39887 @end table
39888
39889 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
39890 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
39891 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
39892 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
39893 must respond with an empty packet.
39894
39895 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
39896 @cindex query attached, remote request
39897 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
39898 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
39899 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
39900 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
39901 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
39902 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
39903 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
39904
39905 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
39906 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
39907 the @code{quit} command.
39908
39909 Reply:
39910 @table @samp
39911 @item 1
39912 The remote server attached to an existing process.
39913 @item 0
39914 The remote server created a new process.
39915 @item E @var{NN}
39916 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39917 @end table
39918
39919 @item Qbtrace:bts
39920 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
39921
39922 Reply:
39923 @table @samp
39924 @item OK
39925 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39926 @item E.errtext
39927 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39928 @end table
39929
39930 @item Qbtrace:pt
39931 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
39932
39933 Reply:
39934 @table @samp
39935 @item OK
39936 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39937 @item E.errtext
39938 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39939 @end table
39940
39941 @item Qbtrace:off
39942 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
39943
39944 Reply:
39945 @table @samp
39946 @item OK
39947 Branch tracing has been disabled.
39948 @item E.errtext
39949 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39950 @end table
39951
39952 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
39953 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39954 btrace recording method in bts format.
39955
39956 Reply:
39957 @table @samp
39958 @item OK
39959 The ring buffer size has been set.
39960 @item E.errtext
39961 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39962 @end table
39963
39964 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
39965 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39966 btrace recording method in pt format.
39967
39968 Reply:
39969 @table @samp
39970 @item OK
39971 The ring buffer size has been set.
39972 @item E.errtext
39973 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39974 @end table
39975
39976 @end table
39977
39978 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39979 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39980
39981 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
39982 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
39983 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
39984
39985 @menu
39986 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
39987 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
39988 @end menu
39989
39990 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
39991 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
39992
39993 @menu
39994 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
39995 @end menu
39996
39997 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
39998 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
39999 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
40000
40001 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
40002
40003 @table @r
40004
40005 @item 2
40006 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
40007
40008 @item 3
40009 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
40010
40011 @item 4
40012 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
40013
40014 @end table
40015
40016 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
40017 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
40018
40019 @menu
40020 * MIPS Register packet Format::
40021 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
40022 @end menu
40023
40024 @node MIPS Register packet Format
40025 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
40026 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
40027
40028 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
40029 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
40030 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
40031 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
40032 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
40033 most-significant -- least-significant.
40034
40035 @table @r
40036
40037 @item MIPS32
40038 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
40039 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
40040 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
40041
40042 @item MIPS64
40043 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
40044 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
40045 as @code{MIPS32}.
40046
40047 @end table
40048
40049 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
40050 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
40051 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
40052
40053 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
40054
40055 @table @r
40056
40057 @item 2
40058 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
40059
40060 @item 3
40061 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
40062
40063 @item 4
40064 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
40065
40066 @item 5
40067 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
40068
40069 @end table
40070
40071 @node Tracepoint Packets
40072 @section Tracepoint Packets
40073 @cindex tracepoint packets
40074 @cindex packets, tracepoint
40075
40076 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
40077 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
40078
40079 @table @samp
40080
40081 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
40082 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
40083 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
40084 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
40085 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
40086 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
40087 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
40088 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
40089 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
40090 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
40091 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
40092 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
40093 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
40094 actions.
40095
40096 Replies:
40097 @table @samp
40098 @item OK
40099 The packet was understood and carried out.
40100 @item qRelocInsn
40101 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
40102 @item @w{}
40103 The packet was not recognized.
40104 @end table
40105
40106 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
40107 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
40108 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
40109 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
40110 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
40111 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
40112 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
40113
40114 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
40115 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
40116 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
40117 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
40118 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
40119 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
40120 tracepoint actions.
40121
40122 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
40123 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
40124 following forms:
40125
40126 @table @samp
40127
40128 @item R @var{mask}
40129 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
40130 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
40131 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
40132 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
40133 not fit in a 32-bit word.
40134
40135 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
40136 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
40137 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
40138 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
40139 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
40140 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
40141 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
40142
40143 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
40144 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
40145 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
40146 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
40147 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
40148 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
40149 packet).
40150
40151 @end table
40152
40153 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
40154 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
40155 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
40156 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
40157 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
40158 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
40159 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
40160 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
40161
40162 Replies:
40163 @table @samp
40164 @item OK
40165 The packet was understood and carried out.
40166 @item qRelocInsn
40167 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
40168 @item @w{}
40169 The packet was not recognized.
40170 @end table
40171
40172 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
40173 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
40174 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
40175 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
40176 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
40177 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
40178 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
40179 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
40180
40181 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
40182 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
40183 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
40184 fit in a single packet.
40185 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
40186 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
40187
40188 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
40189 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
40190 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
40191 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
40192
40193 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
40194 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
40195 query packets.
40196
40197 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
40198 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
40199 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
40200 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
40201 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
40202 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
40203 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
40204 be found.
40205
40206 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
40207 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
40208 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
40209 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
40210 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
40211 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
40212 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
40213 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
40214 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
40215 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
40216 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
40217 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
40218 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
40219 variable.
40220
40221 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
40222 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
40223 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
40224 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
40225 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
40226
40227 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
40228 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
40229 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
40230 one of the following forms:
40231
40232 @table @samp
40233 @item F @var{f}
40234 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
40235 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
40236 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
40237
40238 @item T @var{t}
40239 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
40240 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
40241
40242 @end table
40243
40244 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
40245 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40246 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
40247 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
40248
40249 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
40250 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40251 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
40252 is a hexadecimal number.
40253
40254 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
40255 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40256 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
40257 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
40258 numbers.
40259
40260 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
40261 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
40262 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
40263
40264 @item qTMinFTPILen
40265 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
40266 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
40267 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
40268 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
40269 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
40270 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
40271 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
40272 arrange for that.
40273
40274 Replies:
40275
40276 @table @samp
40277 @item 0
40278 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
40279 @item @var{length}
40280 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
40281 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
40282 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
40283 regardless of size.
40284 @item E
40285 An error has occurred.
40286 @item @w{}
40287 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
40288 @end table
40289
40290 @item QTStart
40291 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
40292 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
40293 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
40294 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
40295 instruction reply packet}).
40296
40297 @item QTStop
40298 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
40299 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
40300
40301 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
40302 @anchor{QTEnable}
40303 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
40304 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
40305 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
40306 of data from it will resume.
40307
40308 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
40309 @anchor{QTDisable}
40310 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
40311 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
40312 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
40313 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
40314
40315 @item QTinit
40316 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
40317 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
40318
40319 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
40320 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
40321 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
40322 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
40323 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
40324
40325 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
40326 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
40327 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
40328 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
40329
40330 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
40331 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
40332 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
40333 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
40334 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
40335 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
40336
40337 @item qTStatus
40338 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
40339 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
40340
40341 The reply has the form:
40342
40343 @table @samp
40344
40345 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
40346 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
40347 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
40348 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
40349
40350 @end table
40351
40352 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
40353 explanations as one of the optional fields:
40354
40355 @table @samp
40356
40357 @item tnotrun:0
40358 No trace has been run yet.
40359
40360 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
40361 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
40362 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
40363 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
40364 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
40365
40366 @item tfull:0
40367 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
40368
40369 @item tdisconnected:0
40370 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
40371
40372 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
40373 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
40374
40375 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
40376 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
40377 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
40378 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
40379 is hex encoded.
40380
40381 @item tunknown:0
40382 The trace stopped for some other reason.
40383
40384 @end table
40385
40386 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
40387 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
40388 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
40389 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
40390 trace.
40391
40392 @table @samp
40393
40394 @item tframes:@var{n}
40395 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
40396
40397 @item tcreated:@var{n}
40398 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
40399 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
40400
40401 @item tsize:@var{n}
40402 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
40403
40404 @item tfree:@var{n}
40405 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
40406
40407 @item circular:@var{n}
40408 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
40409 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
40410 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
40411 and may fill up.
40412
40413 @item disconn:@var{n}
40414 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
40415 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
40416 that the trace run will stop.
40417
40418 @end table
40419
40420 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
40421 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
40422 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
40423 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
40424 address @var{addr}.
40425
40426 Replies:
40427 @table @samp
40428 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
40429 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
40430 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
40431 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
40432 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
40433
40434 @end table
40435
40436 @item qTV:@var{var}
40437 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
40438 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
40439 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
40440
40441 Replies:
40442 @table @samp
40443 @item V@var{value}
40444 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
40445 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
40446 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
40447 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
40448 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
40449 program is running.
40450
40451 @item U
40452 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
40453 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
40454 was not collected.
40455 @end table
40456
40457 @item qTfP
40458 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
40459 @itemx qTsP
40460 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
40461 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
40462 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
40463 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
40464 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
40465 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
40466
40467 @item qTfV
40468 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
40469 @itemx qTsV
40470 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
40471 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
40472 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
40473 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
40474 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
40475 trace state variables.
40476
40477 @item qTfSTM
40478 @itemx qTsSTM
40479 @anchor{qTfSTM}
40480 @anchor{qTsSTM}
40481 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
40482 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
40483 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
40484 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
40485 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
40486 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
40487
40488 Reply:
40489 @table @samp
40490 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
40491 A single marker
40492 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
40493 a comma-separated list of markers
40494 @item l
40495 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
40496 @item E @var{nn}
40497 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
40498 @item @w{}
40499 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
40500 stub.
40501 @end table
40502
40503 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
40504 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
40505
40506 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
40507 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
40508 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
40509 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
40510 @dfn{last}).
40511
40512 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
40513 @anchor{qTSTMat}
40514 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
40515 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
40516 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
40517 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
40518 tracepoint markers.
40519
40520 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
40521 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
40522 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
40523 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
40524 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
40525 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
40526
40527 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
40528 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
40529 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
40530 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
40531 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
40532 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
40533 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
40534 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
40535 available.
40536
40537 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
40538 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
40539 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
40540
40541 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
40542 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
40543 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
40544 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
40545 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
40546 use whatever size it prefers.
40547
40548 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
40549 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
40550 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
40551 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
40552 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
40553
40554 @end table
40555
40556 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
40557 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
40558 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
40559 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
40560 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
40561 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
40562 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
40563 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
40564 it had executed in the original location.
40565
40566 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
40567 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
40568 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
40569 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
40570 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
40571 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
40572 format of the request is:
40573
40574 @table @samp
40575 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
40576
40577 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
40578 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
40579 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
40580 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
40581 memory starting at @var{to}.
40582 @end table
40583
40584 Replies:
40585 @table @samp
40586 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
40587 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
40588 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
40589 @item E @var{NN}
40590 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
40591 relocating the instruction.
40592 @end table
40593
40594 @node Host I/O Packets
40595 @section Host I/O Packets
40596 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
40597 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
40598
40599 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
40600 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
40601 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
40602 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
40603 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
40604 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
40605 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
40606 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
40607 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
40608 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
40609
40610 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
40611 its arguments. They have this format:
40612
40613 @table @samp
40614
40615 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
40616 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
40617 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
40618 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
40619 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
40620 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
40621 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
40622 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
40623 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
40624
40625 @end table
40626
40627 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
40628
40629 @table @samp
40630
40631 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
40632 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
40633 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
40634 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
40635 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
40636 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
40637 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
40638 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
40639 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
40640 @var{attachment}.
40641
40642 @item @w{}
40643 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
40644
40645 @end table
40646
40647 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
40648
40649 @table @samp
40650 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
40651 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
40652 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
40653 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
40654 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
40655 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
40656 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
40657
40658 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
40659 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
40660 -1 if an error occurs.
40661
40662 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
40663 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
40664 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
40665 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
40666 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
40667 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
40668 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
40669 @var{count} was zero.
40670
40671 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40672 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40673 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40674 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40675 some characters were escaped.
40676
40677 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
40678 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
40679 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
40680 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
40681 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
40682 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
40683 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
40684 error occurred.
40685
40686 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
40687 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
40688 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
40689 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
40690 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
40691 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
40692
40693 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
40694 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
40695 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
40696
40697 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
40698 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
40699 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
40700
40701 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40702 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40703 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40704 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40705 some characters were escaped.
40706
40707 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
40708 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
40709 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
40710 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
40711 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
40712 inferior(s).
40713
40714 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
40715 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
40716 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
40717 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
40718 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
40719 operation.
40720
40721 @end table
40722
40723 @node Interrupts
40724 @section Interrupts
40725 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
40726 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
40727
40728 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
40729 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
40730 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
40731 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
40732
40733 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
40734 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
40735 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
40736 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
40737 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
40738
40739 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
40740 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
40741 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
40742 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
40743 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
40744 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
40745 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
40746 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
40747
40748 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
40749 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
40750 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
40751
40752 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
40753 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
40754 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
40755 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
40756 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
40757 @code{0x03}.
40758
40759 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
40760 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
40761 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
40762 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
40763 currently-executing threads and processes.
40764 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
40765 running program, it should send one of the stop
40766 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
40767 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
40768 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
40769 Interrupts received while the
40770 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
40771 it is resumed next time.
40772
40773 @node Notification Packets
40774 @section Notification Packets
40775 @cindex notification packets
40776 @cindex packets, notification
40777
40778 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
40779 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
40780 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
40781 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
40782 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
40783 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
40784 is not a problem.
40785
40786 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
40787 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
40788 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
40789 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
40790 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
40791 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
40792 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
40793
40794 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
40795 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
40796
40797 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
40798 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
40799 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
40800 not they understand it.
40801
40802 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
40803 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
40804 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
40805 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
40806 recipients.
40807
40808 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
40809 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
40810 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
40811 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
40812 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
40813
40814 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
40815 @table @samp
40816 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
40817 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
40818 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
40819 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
40820 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
40821 @item @var{ack}
40822 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
40823 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
40824 @end table
40825
40826 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
40827 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
40828
40829 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
40830 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
40831 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
40832 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
40833 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
40834 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
40835 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
40836 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
40837 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
40838 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
40839
40840 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
40841 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
40842 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
40843 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
40844 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
40845 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
40846
40847 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
40848 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
40849 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
40850 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
40851 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
40852
40853 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
40854 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
40855 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
40856 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
40857 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
40858 normally.
40859
40860 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
40861 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
40862 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
40863 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
40864 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
40865 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
40866 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
40867 the process shall be repeated.
40868
40869 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
40870 following example:
40871 @smallexample
40872 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
40873 @code{...}
40874 -> @code{vStopped}
40875 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
40876 -> @code{vStopped}
40877 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
40878 -> @code{vStopped}
40879 <- @code{OK}
40880 @end smallexample
40881
40882 The following notifications are defined:
40883 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
40884
40885 @item Notification
40886 @tab Ack
40887 @tab Event
40888 @tab Description
40889
40890 @item Stop
40891 @tab vStopped
40892 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
40893 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
40894 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
40895 @value{GDBN}.
40896 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
40897
40898 @end multitable
40899
40900 @node Remote Non-Stop
40901 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
40902
40903 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
40904 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
40905 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
40906 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40907
40908 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
40909 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
40910 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
40911 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
40912 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
40913 probe the target state after a mode change.
40914
40915 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
40916 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
40917 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
40918 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
40919 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
40920 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
40921 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
40922 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
40923 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
40924 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
40925 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
40926
40927 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
40928 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
40929 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
40930 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
40931 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
40932 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
40933 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
40934 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
40935 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
40936 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
40937 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
40938 @samp{OK}.
40939
40940 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
40941 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
40942 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
40943 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
40944 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
40945 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
40946 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
40947 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
40948 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
40949 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
40950 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
40951 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
40952 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
40953
40954 @node Packet Acknowledgment
40955 @section Packet Acknowledgment
40956
40957 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40958 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40959 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
40960 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
40961 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
40962 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
40963 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
40964
40965 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
40966 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
40967 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
40968 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
40969 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
40970
40971 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
40972 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
40973 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
40974 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
40975
40976 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
40977 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
40978 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
40979 @pxref{qSupported}.
40980 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
40981 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
40982 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
40983 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
40984 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
40985 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
40986 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
40987
40988 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
40989 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
40990 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
40991 connection.
40992 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
40993 new connection is established,
40994 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
40995 for the current connection, once disabled.
40996
40997 @node Examples
40998 @section Examples
40999
41000 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
41001 does not get any direct output:
41002
41003 @smallexample
41004 -> @code{R00}
41005 <- @code{+}
41006 @emph{target restarts}
41007 -> @code{?}
41008 <- @code{+}
41009 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
41010 -> @code{+}
41011 @end smallexample
41012
41013 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
41014
41015 @smallexample
41016 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
41017 <- @code{+}
41018 -> @code{s}
41019 <- @code{+}
41020 @emph{time passes}
41021 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
41022 -> @code{+}
41023 -> @code{g}
41024 <- @code{+}
41025 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
41026 -> @code{+}
41027 @end smallexample
41028
41029 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
41030 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
41031 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
41032
41033 @menu
41034 * File-I/O Overview::
41035 * Protocol Basics::
41036 * The F Request Packet::
41037 * The F Reply Packet::
41038 * The Ctrl-C Message::
41039 * Console I/O::
41040 * List of Supported Calls::
41041 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
41042 * Constants::
41043 * File-I/O Examples::
41044 @end menu
41045
41046 @node File-I/O Overview
41047 @subsection File-I/O Overview
41048 @cindex file-i/o overview
41049
41050 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
41051 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
41052 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
41053 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
41054 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
41055 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
41056
41057 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
41058 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
41059 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
41060 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
41061 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
41062
41063 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
41064 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
41065 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
41066 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
41067 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
41068 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
41069 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
41070
41071 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
41072 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
41073 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
41074 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
41075 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
41076
41077 @smallexample
41078 (@value{GDBP}) continue
41079 <- target requests 'system call X'
41080 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
41081 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
41082 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
41083 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
41084 @end smallexample
41085
41086 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
41087 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
41088 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
41089 system are not supported by this protocol.
41090
41091 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
41092
41093 @node Protocol Basics
41094 @subsection Protocol Basics
41095 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
41096
41097 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
41098 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
41099 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
41100 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
41101 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
41102 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
41103 to call the appropriate host system call:
41104
41105 @itemize @bullet
41106 @item
41107 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
41108
41109 @item
41110 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
41111 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
41112 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
41113 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
41114
41115 @end itemize
41116
41117 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
41118
41119 @itemize @bullet
41120 @item
41121 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
41122 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
41123 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
41124 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
41125 packet.
41126
41127 @item
41128 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
41129 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
41130
41131 @item
41132 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
41133
41134 @item
41135 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
41136
41137 @item
41138 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
41139 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
41140 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
41141 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
41142 packet.
41143
41144 @end itemize
41145
41146 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
41147 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
41148
41149 @itemize @bullet
41150 @item
41151 Return value.
41152
41153 @item
41154 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
41155
41156 @item
41157 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
41158
41159 @end itemize
41160
41161 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
41162 the latest continue or step action.
41163
41164 @node The F Request Packet
41165 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
41166 @cindex file-i/o request packet
41167 @cindex @code{F} request packet
41168
41169 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
41170
41171 @table @samp
41172 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
41173
41174 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
41175 This is just the name of the function.
41176
41177 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
41178 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
41179 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
41180 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
41181 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
41182 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
41183 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
41184
41185 @end table
41186
41187
41188
41189 @node The F Reply Packet
41190 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
41191 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
41192 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
41193
41194 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
41195
41196 @table @samp
41197
41198 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
41199
41200 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
41201
41202 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
41203 representation.
41204 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
41205
41206 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
41207 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
41208 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
41209
41210 @smallexample
41211 F0,0,C
41212 @end smallexample
41213
41214 @noindent
41215 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
41216
41217 @smallexample
41218 F-1,4,C
41219 @end smallexample
41220
41221 @noindent
41222 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
41223
41224 @end table
41225
41226
41227 @node The Ctrl-C Message
41228 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
41229 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
41230
41231 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
41232 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
41233 the target should behave as if it had
41234 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
41235 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
41236 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
41237 packet.
41238
41239 It's important for the target to know in which
41240 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
41241
41242 @itemize @bullet
41243 @item
41244 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
41245
41246 @item
41247 The system call on the host has been finished.
41248
41249 @end itemize
41250
41251 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
41252 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
41253 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
41254 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
41255 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
41256 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
41257
41258 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
41259 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
41260 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
41261 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
41262 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
41263 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
41264 or the full action has been completed.
41265
41266 @node Console I/O
41267 @subsection Console I/O
41268 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
41269
41270 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
41271 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
41272 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
41273 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
41274 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
41275 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
41276 conditions is met:
41277
41278 @itemize @bullet
41279 @item
41280 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
41281 @code{read}
41282 system call is treated as finished.
41283
41284 @item
41285 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
41286 newline.
41287
41288 @item
41289 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
41290 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
41291
41292 @end itemize
41293
41294 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
41295 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
41296 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
41297 is stopped at the user's request.
41298
41299
41300 @node List of Supported Calls
41301 @subsection List of Supported Calls
41302 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
41303
41304 @menu
41305 * open::
41306 * close::
41307 * read::
41308 * write::
41309 * lseek::
41310 * rename::
41311 * unlink::
41312 * stat/fstat::
41313 * gettimeofday::
41314 * isatty::
41315 * system::
41316 @end menu
41317
41318 @node open
41319 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
41320 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
41321
41322 @table @asis
41323 @item Synopsis:
41324 @smallexample
41325 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
41326 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
41327 @end smallexample
41328
41329 @item Request:
41330 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
41331
41332 @noindent
41333 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41334
41335 @table @code
41336 @item O_CREAT
41337 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
41338 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
41339 are concerned.
41340
41341 @item O_EXCL
41342 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
41343 an error and open() fails.
41344
41345 @item O_TRUNC
41346 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
41347 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
41348 truncated to zero length.
41349
41350 @item O_APPEND
41351 The file is opened in append mode.
41352
41353 @item O_RDONLY
41354 The file is opened for reading only.
41355
41356 @item O_WRONLY
41357 The file is opened for writing only.
41358
41359 @item O_RDWR
41360 The file is opened for reading and writing.
41361 @end table
41362
41363 @noindent
41364 Other bits are silently ignored.
41365
41366
41367 @noindent
41368 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41369
41370 @table @code
41371 @item S_IRUSR
41372 User has read permission.
41373
41374 @item S_IWUSR
41375 User has write permission.
41376
41377 @item S_IRGRP
41378 Group has read permission.
41379
41380 @item S_IWGRP
41381 Group has write permission.
41382
41383 @item S_IROTH
41384 Others have read permission.
41385
41386 @item S_IWOTH
41387 Others have write permission.
41388 @end table
41389
41390 @noindent
41391 Other bits are silently ignored.
41392
41393
41394 @item Return value:
41395 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
41396 occurred.
41397
41398 @item Errors:
41399
41400 @table @code
41401 @item EEXIST
41402 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
41403
41404 @item EISDIR
41405 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
41406
41407 @item EACCES
41408 The requested access is not allowed.
41409
41410 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41411 @var{pathname} was too long.
41412
41413 @item ENOENT
41414 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41415
41416 @item ENODEV
41417 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
41418
41419 @item EROFS
41420 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
41421 write access was requested.
41422
41423 @item EFAULT
41424 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
41425
41426 @item ENOSPC
41427 No space on device to create the file.
41428
41429 @item EMFILE
41430 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
41431
41432 @item ENFILE
41433 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
41434 has been reached.
41435
41436 @item EINTR
41437 The call was interrupted by the user.
41438 @end table
41439
41440 @end table
41441
41442 @node close
41443 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
41444 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
41445
41446 @table @asis
41447 @item Synopsis:
41448 @smallexample
41449 int close(int fd);
41450 @end smallexample
41451
41452 @item Request:
41453 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
41454
41455 @item Return value:
41456 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
41457
41458 @item Errors:
41459
41460 @table @code
41461 @item EBADF
41462 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
41463
41464 @item EINTR
41465 The call was interrupted by the user.
41466 @end table
41467
41468 @end table
41469
41470 @node read
41471 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
41472 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
41473
41474 @table @asis
41475 @item Synopsis:
41476 @smallexample
41477 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
41478 @end smallexample
41479
41480 @item Request:
41481 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41482
41483 @item Return value:
41484 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
41485 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
41486 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
41487
41488 @item Errors:
41489
41490 @table @code
41491 @item EBADF
41492 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41493 reading.
41494
41495 @item EFAULT
41496 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41497
41498 @item EINTR
41499 The call was interrupted by the user.
41500 @end table
41501
41502 @end table
41503
41504 @node write
41505 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
41506 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
41507
41508 @table @asis
41509 @item Synopsis:
41510 @smallexample
41511 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
41512 @end smallexample
41513
41514 @item Request:
41515 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41516
41517 @item Return value:
41518 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
41519 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
41520 is returned.
41521
41522 @item Errors:
41523
41524 @table @code
41525 @item EBADF
41526 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41527 writing.
41528
41529 @item EFAULT
41530 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41531
41532 @item EFBIG
41533 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
41534 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
41535
41536 @item ENOSPC
41537 No space on device to write the data.
41538
41539 @item EINTR
41540 The call was interrupted by the user.
41541 @end table
41542
41543 @end table
41544
41545 @node lseek
41546 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
41547 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
41548
41549 @table @asis
41550 @item Synopsis:
41551 @smallexample
41552 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
41553 @end smallexample
41554
41555 @item Request:
41556 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
41557
41558 @var{flag} is one of:
41559
41560 @table @code
41561 @item SEEK_SET
41562 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
41563
41564 @item SEEK_CUR
41565 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
41566 bytes.
41567
41568 @item SEEK_END
41569 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
41570 bytes.
41571 @end table
41572
41573 @item Return value:
41574 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
41575 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
41576 value of -1 is returned.
41577
41578 @item Errors:
41579
41580 @table @code
41581 @item EBADF
41582 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
41583
41584 @item ESPIPE
41585 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
41586
41587 @item EINVAL
41588 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
41589
41590 @item EINTR
41591 The call was interrupted by the user.
41592 @end table
41593
41594 @end table
41595
41596 @node rename
41597 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
41598 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
41599
41600 @table @asis
41601 @item Synopsis:
41602 @smallexample
41603 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
41604 @end smallexample
41605
41606 @item Request:
41607 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
41608
41609 @item Return value:
41610 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41611
41612 @item Errors:
41613
41614 @table @code
41615 @item EISDIR
41616 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
41617 directory.
41618
41619 @item EEXIST
41620 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
41621
41622 @item EBUSY
41623 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
41624 process.
41625
41626 @item EINVAL
41627 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
41628 of itself.
41629
41630 @item ENOTDIR
41631 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
41632 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
41633 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
41634
41635 @item EFAULT
41636 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
41637
41638 @item EACCES
41639 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41640
41641 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41642
41643 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
41644
41645 @item ENOENT
41646 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
41647
41648 @item EROFS
41649 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41650
41651 @item ENOSPC
41652 The device containing the file has no room for the new
41653 directory entry.
41654
41655 @item EINTR
41656 The call was interrupted by the user.
41657 @end table
41658
41659 @end table
41660
41661 @node unlink
41662 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
41663 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
41664
41665 @table @asis
41666 @item Synopsis:
41667 @smallexample
41668 int unlink(const char *pathname);
41669 @end smallexample
41670
41671 @item Request:
41672 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
41673
41674 @item Return value:
41675 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41676
41677 @item Errors:
41678
41679 @table @code
41680 @item EACCES
41681 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41682
41683 @item EPERM
41684 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
41685
41686 @item EBUSY
41687 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
41688 being used by another process.
41689
41690 @item EFAULT
41691 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41692
41693 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41694 @var{pathname} was too long.
41695
41696 @item ENOENT
41697 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41698
41699 @item ENOTDIR
41700 A component of the path is not a directory.
41701
41702 @item EROFS
41703 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41704
41705 @item EINTR
41706 The call was interrupted by the user.
41707 @end table
41708
41709 @end table
41710
41711 @node stat/fstat
41712 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
41713 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
41714 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
41715
41716 @table @asis
41717 @item Synopsis:
41718 @smallexample
41719 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
41720 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
41721 @end smallexample
41722
41723 @item Request:
41724 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
41725 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
41726
41727 @item Return value:
41728 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41729
41730 @item Errors:
41731
41732 @table @code
41733 @item EBADF
41734 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
41735
41736 @item ENOENT
41737 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
41738 path is an empty string.
41739
41740 @item ENOTDIR
41741 A component of the path is not a directory.
41742
41743 @item EFAULT
41744 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41745
41746 @item EACCES
41747 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41748
41749 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41750 @var{pathname} was too long.
41751
41752 @item EINTR
41753 The call was interrupted by the user.
41754 @end table
41755
41756 @end table
41757
41758 @node gettimeofday
41759 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
41760 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
41761
41762 @table @asis
41763 @item Synopsis:
41764 @smallexample
41765 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
41766 @end smallexample
41767
41768 @item Request:
41769 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
41770
41771 @item Return value:
41772 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
41773
41774 @item Errors:
41775
41776 @table @code
41777 @item EINVAL
41778 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
41779
41780 @item EFAULT
41781 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41782 @end table
41783
41784 @end table
41785
41786 @node isatty
41787 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
41788 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
41789
41790 @table @asis
41791 @item Synopsis:
41792 @smallexample
41793 int isatty(int fd);
41794 @end smallexample
41795
41796 @item Request:
41797 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
41798
41799 @item Return value:
41800 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
41801
41802 @item Errors:
41803
41804 @table @code
41805 @item EINTR
41806 The call was interrupted by the user.
41807 @end table
41808
41809 @end table
41810
41811 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
41812 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
41813 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
41814 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
41815 needed.
41816
41817
41818 @node system
41819 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
41820 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
41821
41822 @table @asis
41823 @item Synopsis:
41824 @smallexample
41825 int system(const char *command);
41826 @end smallexample
41827
41828 @item Request:
41829 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
41830
41831 @item Return value:
41832 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
41833 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
41834 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
41835 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
41836 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
41837 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
41838 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
41839
41840 @item Errors:
41841
41842 @table @code
41843 @item EINTR
41844 The call was interrupted by the user.
41845 @end table
41846
41847 @end table
41848
41849 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
41850 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
41851 the host is simplified before it's returned
41852 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
41853 is discarded, and the return value consists
41854 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
41855
41856 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
41857 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
41858 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
41859
41860 @table @code
41861 @item set remote system-call-allowed
41862 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
41863 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
41864 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
41865
41866 @item show remote system-call-allowed
41867 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
41868 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
41869 protocol.
41870 @end table
41871
41872 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41873 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41874 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41875
41876 @menu
41877 * Integral Datatypes::
41878 * Pointer Values::
41879 * Memory Transfer::
41880 * struct stat::
41881 * struct timeval::
41882 @end menu
41883
41884 @node Integral Datatypes
41885 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
41886 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41887
41888 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
41889 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
41890 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
41891
41892 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
41893 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
41894
41895 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
41896
41897 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
41898 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
41899
41900 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
41901
41902 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
41903 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
41904 byte order.
41905
41906 @node Pointer Values
41907 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
41908 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
41909
41910 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
41911 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
41912 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
41913 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
41914
41915 @smallexample
41916 @code{1aaf/12}
41917 @end smallexample
41918
41919 @noindent
41920 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
41921 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
41922 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
41923 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
41924
41925 @smallexample
41926 @code{123456/d}
41927 @end smallexample
41928
41929 @node Memory Transfer
41930 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
41931 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
41932
41933 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
41934 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
41935 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
41936 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
41937 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
41938 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
41939 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
41940
41941
41942 @node struct stat
41943 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
41944 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
41945
41946 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
41947 is defined as follows:
41948
41949 @smallexample
41950 struct stat @{
41951 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
41952 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
41953 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
41954 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
41955 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
41956 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
41957 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
41958 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
41959 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
41960 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
41961 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
41962 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
41963 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
41964 @};
41965 @end smallexample
41966
41967 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41968 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41969 structure is of size 64 bytes.
41970
41971 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
41972 range of values.
41973
41974 @table @code
41975
41976 @item st_dev
41977 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
41978
41979 @item st_ino
41980 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41981
41982 @item st_mode
41983 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
41984 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
41985
41986 @item st_uid
41987 @itemx st_gid
41988 @itemx st_rdev
41989 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41990
41991 @item st_atime
41992 @itemx st_mtime
41993 @itemx st_ctime
41994 These values have a host and file system dependent
41995 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
41996 support exact timing values.
41997 @end table
41998
41999 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
42000 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
42001 continuing.
42002
42003 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
42004 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
42005 get truncated on the target.
42006
42007 @node struct timeval
42008 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
42009 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
42010
42011 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
42012 is defined as follows:
42013
42014 @smallexample
42015 struct timeval @{
42016 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
42017 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
42018 @};
42019 @end smallexample
42020
42021 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
42022 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
42023 structure is of size 8 bytes.
42024
42025 @node Constants
42026 @subsection Constants
42027 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
42028
42029 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
42030 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
42031 values before and after the call as needed.
42032
42033 @menu
42034 * Open Flags::
42035 * mode_t Values::
42036 * Errno Values::
42037 * Lseek Flags::
42038 * Limits::
42039 @end menu
42040
42041 @node Open Flags
42042 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
42043 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
42044
42045 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
42046
42047 @smallexample
42048 O_RDONLY 0x0
42049 O_WRONLY 0x1
42050 O_RDWR 0x2
42051 O_APPEND 0x8
42052 O_CREAT 0x200
42053 O_TRUNC 0x400
42054 O_EXCL 0x800
42055 @end smallexample
42056
42057 @node mode_t Values
42058 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
42059 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
42060
42061 All values are given in octal representation.
42062
42063 @smallexample
42064 S_IFREG 0100000
42065 S_IFDIR 040000
42066 S_IRUSR 0400
42067 S_IWUSR 0200
42068 S_IXUSR 0100
42069 S_IRGRP 040
42070 S_IWGRP 020
42071 S_IXGRP 010
42072 S_IROTH 04
42073 S_IWOTH 02
42074 S_IXOTH 01
42075 @end smallexample
42076
42077 @node Errno Values
42078 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
42079 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
42080
42081 All values are given in decimal representation.
42082
42083 @smallexample
42084 EPERM 1
42085 ENOENT 2
42086 EINTR 4
42087 EBADF 9
42088 EACCES 13
42089 EFAULT 14
42090 EBUSY 16
42091 EEXIST 17
42092 ENODEV 19
42093 ENOTDIR 20
42094 EISDIR 21
42095 EINVAL 22
42096 ENFILE 23
42097 EMFILE 24
42098 EFBIG 27
42099 ENOSPC 28
42100 ESPIPE 29
42101 EROFS 30
42102 ENAMETOOLONG 91
42103 EUNKNOWN 9999
42104 @end smallexample
42105
42106 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
42107 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
42108
42109 @node Lseek Flags
42110 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
42111 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
42112
42113 @smallexample
42114 SEEK_SET 0
42115 SEEK_CUR 1
42116 SEEK_END 2
42117 @end smallexample
42118
42119 @node Limits
42120 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
42121 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
42122
42123 All values are given in decimal representation.
42124
42125 @smallexample
42126 INT_MIN -2147483648
42127 INT_MAX 2147483647
42128 UINT_MAX 4294967295
42129 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
42130 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
42131 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
42132 @end smallexample
42133
42134 @node File-I/O Examples
42135 @subsection File-I/O Examples
42136 @cindex file-i/o examples
42137
42138 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
42139 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
42140
42141 @smallexample
42142 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
42143 @emph{request memory read from target}
42144 -> @code{m1234,6}
42145 <- XXXXXX
42146 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
42147 -> @code{F6}
42148 @end smallexample
42149
42150 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
42151 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
42152
42153 @smallexample
42154 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42155 @emph{request memory write to target}
42156 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
42157 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
42158 -> @code{F6}
42159 @end smallexample
42160
42161 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
42162 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
42163
42164 @smallexample
42165 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42166 -> @code{F-1,9}
42167 @end smallexample
42168
42169 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
42170 host is called:
42171
42172 @smallexample
42173 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42174 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
42175 <- @code{T02}
42176 @end smallexample
42177
42178 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
42179 host is called:
42180
42181 @smallexample
42182 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42183 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
42184 <- @code{T02}
42185 @end smallexample
42186
42187 @node Library List Format
42188 @section Library List Format
42189 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
42190
42191 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
42192 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
42193 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
42194 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
42195 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
42196 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
42197 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
42198 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
42199 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
42200 are loaded.
42201
42202 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
42203 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
42204 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
42205 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
42206
42207 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
42208 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
42209 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
42210 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
42211 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
42212 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
42213
42214 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42215 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
42216
42217 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
42218 offset, looks like this:
42219
42220 @smallexample
42221 <library-list>
42222 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
42223 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
42224 </library>
42225 </library-list>
42226 @end smallexample
42227
42228 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
42229 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
42230
42231 @smallexample
42232 <library-list>
42233 <library name="sharedlib.o">
42234 <section address="0x10000000"/>
42235 <section address="0x20000000"/>
42236 <section address="0x30000000"/>
42237 </library>
42238 </library-list>
42239 @end smallexample
42240
42241 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
42242
42243 @smallexample
42244 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
42245 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
42246 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42247 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
42248 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
42249 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
42250 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
42251 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
42252 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
42253 @end smallexample
42254
42255 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
42256 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
42257 section for each library.
42258
42259 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
42260 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
42261 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
42262
42263 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
42264 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
42265 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
42266 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
42267
42268 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
42269 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
42270 target, the following parameters are reported:
42271
42272 @itemize @minus
42273 @item
42274 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
42275 @code{struct link_map}.
42276 @item
42277 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
42278 (Thread Local Storage) access.
42279 @item
42280 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
42281 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
42282 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
42283 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
42284 @item
42285 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
42286 @end itemize
42287
42288 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
42289 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
42290 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
42291
42292 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42293 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
42294
42295 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
42296 looks like this:
42297
42298 @smallexample
42299 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
42300 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
42301 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
42302 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
42303 l_ld="0x152350"/>
42304 </library-list-svr>
42305 @end smallexample
42306
42307 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
42308
42309 @smallexample
42310 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
42311 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
42312 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42313 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
42314 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
42315 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
42316 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
42317 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
42318 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
42319 @end smallexample
42320
42321 @node Memory Map Format
42322 @section Memory Map Format
42323 @cindex memory map format
42324
42325 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
42326 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
42327 memory map.
42328
42329 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
42330 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
42331 lists memory regions.
42332
42333 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42334 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
42335
42336 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42337
42338 @smallexample
42339 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42340 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
42341 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42342 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
42343 <memory-map>
42344 region...
42345 </memory-map>
42346 @end smallexample
42347
42348 Each region can be either:
42349
42350 @itemize
42351
42352 @item
42353 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
42354 bytes from there:
42355
42356 @smallexample
42357 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42358 @end smallexample
42359
42360
42361 @item
42362 A region of read-only memory:
42363
42364 @smallexample
42365 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42366 @end smallexample
42367
42368
42369 @item
42370 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
42371 bytes in length:
42372
42373 @smallexample
42374 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
42375 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
42376 </memory>
42377 @end smallexample
42378
42379 @end itemize
42380
42381 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
42382 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
42383 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
42384
42385 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
42386
42387 @smallexample
42388 <!-- ................................................... -->
42389 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
42390 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
42391 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
42392 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
42393 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
42394 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
42395 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
42396 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
42397 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
42398 and its type, or device. -->
42399 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
42400 start CDATA #REQUIRED
42401 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42402 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
42403 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
42404 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
42405 @end smallexample
42406
42407 @node Thread List Format
42408 @section Thread List Format
42409 @cindex thread list format
42410
42411 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
42412 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
42413 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
42414 the following structure:
42415
42416 @smallexample
42417 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42418 <threads>
42419 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
42420 ... description ...
42421 </thread>
42422 </threads>
42423 @end smallexample
42424
42425 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
42426 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
42427 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
42428 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
42429 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
42430 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
42431 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
42432 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
42433
42434
42435 @node Traceframe Info Format
42436 @section Traceframe Info Format
42437 @cindex traceframe info format
42438
42439 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
42440 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
42441 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
42442 collected in a traceframe.
42443
42444 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
42445 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
42446
42447 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42448 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42449
42450 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42451
42452 @smallexample
42453 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42454 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
42455 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42456 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
42457 <traceframe-info>
42458 block...
42459 </traceframe-info>
42460 @end smallexample
42461
42462 Each traceframe block can be either:
42463
42464 @itemize
42465
42466 @item
42467 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
42468 @var{length} bytes from there:
42469
42470 @smallexample
42471 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42472 @end smallexample
42473
42474 @item
42475 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
42476 collected:
42477
42478 @smallexample
42479 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
42480 @end smallexample
42481
42482 @end itemize
42483
42484 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
42485
42486 @smallexample
42487 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
42488 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42489
42490 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
42491 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
42492 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42493 <!ELEMENT tvar>
42494 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
42495 @end smallexample
42496
42497 @node Branch Trace Format
42498 @section Branch Trace Format
42499 @cindex branch trace format
42500
42501 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
42502 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
42503 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
42504 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
42505
42506 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
42507 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
42508
42509 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42510 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42511
42512 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42513
42514 @smallexample
42515 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42516 <!DOCTYPE btrace
42517 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
42518 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
42519 <btrace>
42520 block...
42521 </btrace>
42522 @end smallexample
42523
42524 @itemize
42525
42526 @item
42527 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
42528 and ending at @var{end}:
42529
42530 @smallexample
42531 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
42532 @end smallexample
42533
42534 @end itemize
42535
42536 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
42537
42538 @smallexample
42539 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
42540 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42541
42542 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
42543 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
42544 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
42545
42546 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
42547
42548 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
42549
42550 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
42551 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
42552 family CDATA #REQUIRED
42553 model CDATA #REQUIRED
42554 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
42555
42556 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
42557 @end smallexample
42558
42559 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
42560 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
42561 @cindex branch trace configuration format
42562
42563 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
42564 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
42565 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
42566
42567 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
42568 settings for that format. The following information is described:
42569
42570 @table @code
42571 @item bts
42572 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
42573 @table @code
42574 @item size
42575 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
42576 @end table
42577 @item pt
42578 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
42579 PT}) format.
42580 @table @code
42581 @item size
42582 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
42583 @end table
42584 @end table
42585
42586 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42587 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42588
42589 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
42590
42591 @smallexample
42592 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
42593 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42594
42595 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
42596 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42597
42598 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
42599 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42600 @end smallexample
42601
42602 @include agentexpr.texi
42603
42604 @node Target Descriptions
42605 @appendix Target Descriptions
42606 @cindex target descriptions
42607
42608 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
42609 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
42610 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
42611 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
42612 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
42613 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
42614 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
42615
42616 @itemize @bullet
42617 @item
42618 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
42619 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
42620 @item
42621 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
42622 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
42623 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
42624 @item
42625 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
42626 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
42627 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
42628 @end itemize
42629
42630 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
42631 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
42632 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
42633 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
42634 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
42635
42636 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42637 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
42638
42639 @menu
42640 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
42641 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
42642 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
42643 descriptions.
42644 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
42645 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
42646 @end menu
42647
42648 @node Retrieving Descriptions
42649 @section Retrieving Descriptions
42650
42651 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
42652 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
42653 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
42654 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
42655 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
42656 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
42657 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
42658 Format}.
42659
42660 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
42661 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
42662 specify a file are:
42663
42664 @table @code
42665 @cindex set tdesc filename
42666 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
42667 Read the target description from @var{path}.
42668
42669 @cindex unset tdesc filename
42670 @item unset tdesc filename
42671 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
42672 will use the description supplied by the current target.
42673
42674 @cindex show tdesc filename
42675 @item show tdesc filename
42676 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
42677 @end table
42678
42679
42680 @node Target Description Format
42681 @section Target Description Format
42682 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
42683
42684 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
42685 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
42686 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
42687 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
42688 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
42689 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
42690 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
42691
42692 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
42693 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
42694 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
42695 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
42696 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
42697
42698 Here is a simple target description:
42699
42700 @smallexample
42701 <target version="1.0">
42702 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
42703 </target>
42704 @end smallexample
42705
42706 @noindent
42707 This minimal description only says that the target uses
42708 the x86-64 architecture.
42709
42710 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
42711 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
42712 are explained further below.
42713
42714 @smallexample
42715 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42716 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
42717 <target version="1.0">
42718 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
42719 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
42720 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
42721 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
42722 </target>
42723 @end smallexample
42724
42725 @noindent
42726 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
42727 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
42728 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
42729 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
42730 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
42731 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
42732 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
42733 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
42734 the version mismatch.
42735
42736 @subsection Inclusion
42737 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
42738 @cindex XInclude
42739 @ifnotinfo
42740 @cindex <xi:include>
42741 @end ifnotinfo
42742
42743 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
42744 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
42745 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
42746 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
42747 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
42748
42749 @smallexample
42750 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
42751 @end smallexample
42752
42753 @noindent
42754 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
42755 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
42756 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
42757 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
42758 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
42759 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
42760 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
42761 original description.
42762
42763 @subsection Architecture
42764 @cindex <architecture>
42765
42766 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
42767
42768 @smallexample
42769 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
42770 @end smallexample
42771
42772 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42773 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42774
42775 @subsection OS ABI
42776 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
42777
42778 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42779 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42780
42781 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
42782
42783 @smallexample
42784 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
42785 @end smallexample
42786
42787 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
42788 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
42789
42790 @subsection Compatible Architecture
42791 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
42792
42793 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42794 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42795
42796 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
42797
42798 @smallexample
42799 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
42800 @end smallexample
42801
42802 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42803 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42804
42805 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
42806 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
42807 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
42808 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
42809 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
42810 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
42811 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
42812
42813 @smallexample
42814 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
42815 <compatible>spu</compatible>
42816 @end smallexample
42817
42818 @subsection Features
42819 @cindex <feature>
42820
42821 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
42822 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
42823 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
42824 has this form:
42825
42826 @smallexample
42827 <feature name="@var{name}">
42828 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
42829 @var{reg}@dots{}
42830 </feature>
42831 @end smallexample
42832
42833 @noindent
42834 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
42835 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
42836 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
42837 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
42838
42839 @subsection Types
42840
42841 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
42842 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
42843 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
42844 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
42845 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
42846 and enum types.
42847
42848 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
42849 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
42850 Types must be defined before they are used.
42851
42852 @cindex <vector>
42853 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
42854 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
42855 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
42856 @var{count}:
42857
42858 @smallexample
42859 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
42860 @end smallexample
42861
42862 @cindex <union>
42863 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
42864 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
42865 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
42866 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
42867
42868 @smallexample
42869 <union id="@var{id}">
42870 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42871 @dots{}
42872 </union>
42873 @end smallexample
42874
42875 @cindex <struct>
42876 @cindex <flags>
42877 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
42878 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
42879 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
42880 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
42881 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
42882 specified.
42883
42884 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
42885
42886 @smallexample
42887 <struct id="@var{id}">
42888 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42889 @dots{}
42890 </struct>
42891 @end smallexample
42892
42893 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
42894 No implicit padding is added.
42895
42896 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
42897
42898 @smallexample
42899 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42900 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42901 @dots{}
42902 </struct>
42903 @end smallexample
42904
42905 @smallexample
42906 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42907 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42908 @dots{}
42909 </flags>
42910 @end smallexample
42911
42912 The @var{name} value is required.
42913 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
42914 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
42915 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
42916
42917 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
42918 is optional.
42919 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
42920 and zero represents the least significant bit.
42921
42922 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
42923 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
42924
42925 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
42926
42927 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
42928 defining them with @samp{struct}:
42929
42930 @itemize @bullet
42931 @item
42932 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
42933 @item
42934 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
42935 @end itemize
42936
42937 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
42938 defining them with @samp{flags}:
42939
42940 @itemize @bullet
42941 @item
42942 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
42943
42944 @smallexample
42945 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
42946 $1 = 42
42947 @end smallexample
42948
42949 @end itemize
42950
42951 @subsection Registers
42952 @cindex <reg>
42953
42954 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
42955
42956 @smallexample
42957 <reg name="@var{name}"
42958 bitsize="@var{size}"
42959 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
42960 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
42961 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
42962 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
42963 @end smallexample
42964
42965 @noindent
42966 The components are as follows:
42967
42968 @table @var
42969
42970 @item name
42971 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
42972
42973 @item bitsize
42974 The register's size, in bits.
42975
42976 @item regnum
42977 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
42978 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
42979 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
42980 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
42981 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
42982 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
42983 in order of increasing register number.
42984
42985 @item save-restore
42986 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
42987 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
42988 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
42989 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
42990 ABI.
42991
42992 @item type
42993 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
42994 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
42995 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
42996 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
42997 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
42998 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
42999
43000 @item group
43001 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
43002 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
43003 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
43004 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
43005 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
43006 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
43007 @code{info registers}.
43008
43009 @end table
43010
43011 @node Predefined Target Types
43012 @section Predefined Target Types
43013 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
43014
43015 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
43016 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
43017 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
43018 types. The currently supported types are:
43019
43020 @table @code
43021
43022 @item bool
43023 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
43024
43025 @item int8
43026 @itemx int16
43027 @itemx int24
43028 @itemx int32
43029 @itemx int64
43030 @itemx int128
43031 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
43032
43033 @item uint8
43034 @itemx uint16
43035 @itemx uint24
43036 @itemx uint32
43037 @itemx uint64
43038 @itemx uint128
43039 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
43040
43041 @item code_ptr
43042 @itemx data_ptr
43043 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
43044 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
43045 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
43046 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
43047 may be marked as data pointers.
43048
43049 @item ieee_single
43050 Single precision IEEE floating point.
43051
43052 @item ieee_double
43053 Double precision IEEE floating point.
43054
43055 @item arm_fpa_ext
43056 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
43057
43058 @item i387_ext
43059 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
43060
43061 @item i386_eflags
43062 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
43063
43064 @item i386_mxcsr
43065 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
43066
43067 @end table
43068
43069 @node Enum Target Types
43070 @section Enum Target Types
43071 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
43072
43073 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
43074 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
43075
43076 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
43077
43078 @smallexample
43079 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
43080 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
43081 @dots{}
43082 </enum>
43083 @end smallexample
43084
43085 Enums must be defined before they are used.
43086
43087 @smallexample
43088 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
43089 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
43090 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
43091 </enum>
43092 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
43093 <field name="X" start="0"/>
43094 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
43095 </flags>
43096 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
43097 @end smallexample
43098
43099 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
43100 would be printed as:
43101
43102 @smallexample
43103 (gdb) info register flags
43104 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
43105 @end smallexample
43106
43107 @node Standard Target Features
43108 @section Standard Target Features
43109 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
43110
43111 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
43112 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
43113 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
43114 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
43115 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
43116 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
43117 can recognize them.
43118
43119 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
43120 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
43121 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
43122 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
43123 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
43124 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
43125 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
43126 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
43127
43128 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
43129 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
43130 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
43131
43132 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
43133 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
43134 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
43135 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
43136
43137 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
43138 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
43139 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
43140
43141 @menu
43142 * AArch64 Features::
43143 * ARC Features::
43144 * ARM Features::
43145 * i386 Features::
43146 * MicroBlaze Features::
43147 * MIPS Features::
43148 * M68K Features::
43149 * NDS32 Features::
43150 * Nios II Features::
43151 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
43152 * PowerPC Features::
43153 * RISC-V Features::
43154 * S/390 and System z Features::
43155 * Sparc Features::
43156 * TIC6x Features::
43157 @end menu
43158
43159
43160 @node AArch64 Features
43161 @subsection AArch64 Features
43162 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
43163
43164 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
43165 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
43166 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
43167
43168 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
43169 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
43170 and @samp{fpcr}.
43171
43172 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
43173 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
43174 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
43175
43176 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.pauth} feature is optional. If present,
43177 it should contain registers @samp{pauth_dmask} and @samp{pauth_cmask}.
43178
43179 @node ARC Features
43180 @subsection ARC Features
43181 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
43182
43183 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
43184 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
43185 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
43186 that one of the core registers features is present.
43187 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
43188
43189 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
43190 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
43191 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
43192 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
43193 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
43194 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
43195 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
43196
43197 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
43198 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
43199 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
43200 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
43201 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
43202 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
43203
43204 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
43205 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
43206 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
43207 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
43208 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
43209 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
43210 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
43211 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
43212 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
43213 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
43214
43215 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
43216 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
43217
43218 @node ARM Features
43219 @subsection ARM Features
43220 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
43221
43222 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
43223 ARM targets.
43224 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
43225 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
43226
43227 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
43228 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
43229 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
43230 and @samp{xpsr}.
43231
43232 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
43233 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
43234
43235 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
43236 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
43237 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
43238 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
43239
43240 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
43241 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
43242 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
43243 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
43244 halves of the double-precision registers.
43245
43246 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
43247 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
43248 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
43249 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
43250 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
43251 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
43252
43253 @node i386 Features
43254 @subsection i386 Features
43255 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
43256
43257 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
43258 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43259
43260 @itemize @minus
43261 @item
43262 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
43263 @item
43264 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
43265 @item
43266 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
43267 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
43268 @item
43269 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
43270 @item
43271 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
43272 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
43273 @end itemize
43274
43275 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
43276
43277 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
43278 describe registers:
43279
43280 @itemize @minus
43281 @item
43282 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
43283 @item
43284 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
43285 @item
43286 @samp{mxcsr}
43287 @end itemize
43288
43289 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
43290 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
43291 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
43292
43293 @itemize @minus
43294 @item
43295 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
43296 @item
43297 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
43298 @end itemize
43299
43300 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
43301 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
43302
43303 @itemize @minus
43304 @item
43305 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
43306 @item
43307 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
43308 @end itemize
43309
43310 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
43311 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
43312
43313 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
43314 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
43315
43316 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
43317 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
43318 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
43319
43320 @itemize @minus
43321 @item
43322 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43323 @end itemize
43324
43325 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
43326
43327 @itemize @minus
43328 @item
43329 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43330 @end itemize
43331
43332 It should
43333 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
43334
43335 @itemize @minus
43336 @item
43337 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
43338 @item
43339 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
43340 @end itemize
43341
43342 It should
43343 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
43344
43345 @itemize @minus
43346 @item
43347 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43348 @end itemize
43349
43350 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
43351 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
43352 valid for i386 and amd64.
43353
43354 @node MicroBlaze Features
43355 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
43356 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
43357
43358 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
43359 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43360 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
43361 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
43362 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
43363
43364 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
43365 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
43366
43367 @node MIPS Features
43368 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
43369 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
43370
43371 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
43372 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
43373 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
43374 on the target.
43375
43376 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
43377 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
43378 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43379
43380 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
43381 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
43382 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
43383 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43384
43385 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
43386 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
43387 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
43388 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43389
43390 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
43391 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
43392 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
43393
43394 @node M68K Features
43395 @subsection M68K Features
43396 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
43397
43398 @table @code
43399 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
43400 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
43401 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
43402 One of those features must be always present.
43403 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
43404 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
43405 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
43406 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
43407
43408 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
43409 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
43410 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
43411 @samp{fpiaddr}.
43412 @end table
43413
43414 @node NDS32 Features
43415 @subsection NDS32 Features
43416 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
43417
43418 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
43419 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
43420 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
43421 and @samp{pc}.
43422
43423 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
43424 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
43425 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
43426 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
43427
43428 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
43429 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
43430 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
43431 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
43432 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
43433 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
43434 support to it could be totally removed some day.
43435
43436 @node Nios II Features
43437 @subsection Nios II Features
43438 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
43439
43440 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
43441 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
43442 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
43443 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
43444 @samp{mpuacc}).
43445
43446 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
43447 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
43448 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
43449
43450 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
43451 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
43452 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
43453
43454 @node PowerPC Features
43455 @subsection PowerPC Features
43456 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
43457
43458 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
43459 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43460 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
43461 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43462
43463 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
43464 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
43465
43466 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
43467 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr}, and
43468 @samp{vrsave}. @value{GDBN} will define pseudo-registers @samp{v0}
43469 through @samp{v31} as aliases for the corresponding @samp{vrX}
43470 registers.
43471
43472 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
43473 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN} will
43474 combine these registers with the floating point registers (@samp{f0}
43475 through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0} through
43476 @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0} through
43477 @samp{vs63}, the set of vector-scalar registers for POWER7.
43478 Therefore, this feature requires both @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} and
43479 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec}.
43480
43481 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
43482 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
43483 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
43484 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
43485 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
43486 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
43487 user.
43488
43489 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ppr} feature is optional. It should
43490 contain the 64-bit register @samp{ppr}.
43491
43492 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.dscr} feature is optional. It should
43493 contain the 64-bit register @samp{dscr}.
43494
43495 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.tar} feature is optional. It should
43496 contain the 64-bit register @samp{tar}.
43497
43498 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ebb} feature is optional. It should
43499 contain registers @samp{bescr}, @samp{ebbhr} and @samp{ebbrr}, all
43500 64-bit wide.
43501
43502 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.linux.pmu} feature is optional. It should
43503 contain registers @samp{mmcr0}, @samp{mmcr2}, @samp{siar}, @samp{sdar}
43504 and @samp{sier}, all 64-bit wide. This is the subset of the isa 2.07
43505 server PMU registers provided by @sc{gnu}/Linux.
43506
43507 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.spr} feature is optional. It should
43508 contain registers @samp{tfhar}, @samp{texasr} and @samp{tfiar}, all
43509 64-bit wide.
43510
43511 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.core} feature is optional. It should
43512 contain the checkpointed general-purpose registers @samp{cr0} through
43513 @samp{cr31}, as well as the checkpointed registers @samp{clr} and
43514 @samp{cctr}. These registers may all be either 32-bit or 64-bit
43515 depending on the target. It should also contain the checkpointed
43516 registers @samp{ccr} and @samp{cxer}, which should both be 32-bit
43517 wide.
43518
43519 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu} feature is optional. It should
43520 contain the checkpointed 64-bit floating-point registers @samp{cf0}
43521 through @samp{cf31}, as well as the checkpointed 64-bit register
43522 @samp{cfpscr}.
43523
43524 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} feature is optional. It
43525 should contain the checkpointed altivec registers @samp{cvr0} through
43526 @samp{cvr31}, all 128-bit wide. It should also contain the
43527 checkpointed registers @samp{cvscr} and @samp{cvrsave}, both 32-bit
43528 wide.
43529
43530 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.vsx} feature is optional. It should
43531 contain registers @samp{cvs0h} through @samp{cvs31h}. @value{GDBN}
43532 will combine these registers with the checkpointed floating point
43533 registers (@samp{cf0} through @samp{cf31}) and the checkpointed
43534 altivec registers (@samp{cvr0} through @samp{cvr31}) to present the
43535 128-bit wide checkpointed vector-scalar registers @samp{cvs0} through
43536 @samp{cvs63}. Therefore, this feature requires both
43537 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} and
43538 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu}.
43539
43540 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.ppr} feature is optional. It should
43541 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cppr}.
43542
43543 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.dscr} feature is optional. It should
43544 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cdscr}.
43545
43546 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.tar} feature is optional. It should
43547 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{ctar}.
43548
43549
43550 @node RISC-V Features
43551 @subsection RISC-V Features
43552 @cindex target descriptions, RISC-V Features
43553
43554 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.cpu} feature is required for RISC-V
43555 targets. It should contain the registers @samp{x0} through
43556 @samp{x31}, and @samp{pc}. Either the architectural names (@samp{x0},
43557 @samp{x1}, etc) can be used, or the ABI names (@samp{zero}, @samp{ra},
43558 etc).
43559
43560 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.fpu} feature is optional. If present, it
43561 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fflags},
43562 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr}. As with the cpu feature, either the
43563 architectural register names, or the ABI names can be used.
43564
43565 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.virtual} feature is optional. If present,
43566 it should contain registers that are not backed by real registers on
43567 the target, but are instead virtual, where the register value is
43568 derived from other target state. In many ways these are like
43569 @value{GDBN}s pseudo-registers, except implemented by the target.
43570 Currently the only register expected in this set is the one byte
43571 @samp{priv} register that contains the target's privilege level in the
43572 least significant two bits.
43573
43574 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.csr} feature is optional. If present, it
43575 should contain all of the target's standard CSRs. Standard CSRs are
43576 those defined in the RISC-V specification documents. There is some
43577 overlap between this feature and the fpu feature; the @samp{fflags},
43578 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr} registers could be in either feature. The
43579 expectation is that these registers will be in the fpu feature if the
43580 target has floating point hardware, but can be moved into the csr
43581 feature if the target has the floating point control registers, but no
43582 other floating point hardware.
43583
43584 @node S/390 and System z Features
43585 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
43586 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
43587 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
43588
43589 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
43590 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
43591 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
43592 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
43593 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
43594 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
43595 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
43596 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
43597 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
43598
43599 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
43600 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
43601 @samp{fpc}.
43602
43603 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
43604 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
43605
43606 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
43607 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
43608 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
43609 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
43610 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
43611 32-bit wide.
43612
43613 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
43614 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
43615 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
43616
43617 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
43618 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
43619 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
43620 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
43621 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
43622 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
43623 @samp{v31}.
43624
43625 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
43626 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
43627 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
43628
43629 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
43630 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
43631 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
43632
43633 @node Sparc Features
43634 @subsection Sparc Features
43635 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
43636 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
43637 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43638 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43639
43640 @itemize @minus
43641 @item
43642 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
43643 @item
43644 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
43645 @item
43646 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
43647 @item
43648 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
43649 @end itemize
43650
43651 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43652
43653 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43654 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43655
43656 @itemize @minus
43657 @item
43658 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
43659 @item
43660 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
43661 @end itemize
43662
43663 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43664 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43665
43666 @itemize @minus
43667 @item
43668 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
43669 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
43670 @item
43671 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
43672 for sparc64
43673 @end itemize
43674
43675 @node TIC6x Features
43676 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
43677 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
43678 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
43679 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
43680 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
43681 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
43682
43683 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
43684 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
43685 through @samp{B31}.
43686
43687 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
43688 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
43689
43690 @node Operating System Information
43691 @appendix Operating System Information
43692 @cindex operating system information
43693
43694 @menu
43695 * Process list::
43696 @end menu
43697
43698 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
43699 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
43700 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
43701 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
43702 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
43703 on a different aspect of target.
43704
43705 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
43706 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
43707 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
43708 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
43709
43710 @node Process list
43711 @appendixsection Process list
43712 @cindex operating system information, process list
43713
43714 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
43715 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
43716 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
43717 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
43718
43719 An example document is:
43720
43721 @smallexample
43722 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43723 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
43724 <osdata type="processes">
43725 <item>
43726 <column name="pid">1</column>
43727 <column name="user">root</column>
43728 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
43729 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
43730 </item>
43731 </osdata>
43732 @end smallexample
43733
43734 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
43735 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
43736 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
43737 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
43738 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
43739 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
43740 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
43741
43742 @node Trace File Format
43743 @appendix Trace File Format
43744 @cindex trace file format
43745
43746 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
43747 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
43748
43749 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
43750 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
43751 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
43752 in the future.
43753
43754 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
43755 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
43756 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
43757 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
43758 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
43759 of this section.
43760
43761 @table @code
43762 @item R @var{size}
43763 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
43764 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
43765 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
43766 a single trace file.
43767
43768 @item status @var{status}
43769 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
43770 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
43771 file.
43772
43773 @item tp @var{payload}
43774 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43775 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
43776 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43777 reply packets.
43778
43779 @item tsv @var{payload}
43780 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43781 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
43782 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43783 reply packets.
43784
43785 @item tdesc @var{payload}
43786 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
43787 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
43788 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
43789 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
43790 file. Includes are not allowed.
43791
43792 @end table
43793
43794 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
43795 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
43796 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
43797 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
43798 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
43799 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
43800 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
43801 endianness.
43802
43803 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
43804
43805 @table @code
43806 @item R @var{bytes}
43807 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
43808 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
43809 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
43810
43811 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
43812 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
43813 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
43814 @var{length} bytes.
43815
43816 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
43817 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
43818 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
43819
43820 @end table
43821
43822 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
43823 of blocks.
43824
43825 @node Index Section Format
43826 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
43827 @cindex .gdb_index section format
43828 @cindex index section format
43829
43830 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
43831 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
43832 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
43833 description.
43834
43835 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
43836 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
43837 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
43838 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
43839 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
43840 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
43841
43842 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
43843
43844 @enumerate
43845 @item
43846 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
43847 unless otherwise noted:
43848
43849 @enumerate
43850 @item
43851 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
43852 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
43853 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
43854 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
43855 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
43856 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
43857 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
43858
43859 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
43860 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
43861 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
43862 currently not flagged as deprecated.
43863
43864 @item
43865 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
43866
43867 @item
43868 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
43869 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
43870 to the next offset.
43871
43872 @item
43873 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
43874
43875 @item
43876 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
43877
43878 @item
43879 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
43880 @end enumerate
43881
43882 @item
43883 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
43884 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
43885 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
43886 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
43887 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
43888 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
43889 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
43890 CU indices.
43891
43892 @item
43893 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
43894 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
43895 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
43896 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
43897
43898 @item
43899 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
43900 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
43901
43902 @enumerate
43903 @item
43904 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
43905
43906 @item
43907 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
43908 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
43909
43910 @item
43911 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
43912 @end enumerate
43913
43914 @item
43915 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
43916 the hash table is always a power of 2.
43917
43918 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
43919 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
43920 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
43921 constant pool.
43922
43923 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
43924 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
43925 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
43926
43927 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
43928 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
43929 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
43930 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
43931 index version:
43932
43933 @table @asis
43934 @item Version 4
43935 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
43936
43937 @item Versions 5 to 7
43938 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
43939 @end table
43940
43941 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
43942
43943 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
43944 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
43945 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
43946 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
43947 collision.
43948
43949 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
43950 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
43951 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
43952 the code.
43953
43954 @item
43955 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
43956 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
43957 strings.
43958
43959 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
43960 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
43961 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
43962 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
43963 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
43964 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
43965
43966 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
43967 @end enumerate
43968
43969 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
43970 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
43971 CU index+attributes value for each use.
43972
43973 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
43974 (bit 0 = LSB):
43975
43976 @table @asis
43977
43978 @item Bits 0-23
43979 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
43980 @item Bits 24-27
43981 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
43982 @item Bits 28-30
43983 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
43984
43985 @table @asis
43986 @item 0
43987 This value is reserved and should not be used.
43988 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
43989 with previous versions of the index.
43990 @item 1
43991 The symbol is a type.
43992 @item 2
43993 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
43994 @item 3
43995 The symbol is a function.
43996 @item 4
43997 Any other kind of symbol.
43998 @item 5,6,7
43999 These values are reserved.
44000 @end table
44001
44002 @item Bit 31
44003 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
44004
44005 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
44006 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
44007 @value{GDBN} sources.
44008
44009 @end table
44010
44011 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
44012 global/static attributes in the index.
44013
44014 @smallexample
44015 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
44016 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
44017 switch (die->tag)
44018 @{
44019 case DW_TAG_typedef:
44020 case DW_TAG_base_type:
44021 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
44022 kind = TYPE;
44023 is_static = 1;
44024 break;
44025 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
44026 kind = VARIABLE;
44027 is_static = language != CPLUS;
44028 break;
44029 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
44030 kind = FUNCTION;
44031 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
44032 break;
44033 case DW_TAG_constant:
44034 kind = VARIABLE;
44035 is_static = ! is_external;
44036 break;
44037 case DW_TAG_variable:
44038 kind = VARIABLE;
44039 is_static = ! is_external;
44040 break;
44041 case DW_TAG_namespace:
44042 kind = TYPE;
44043 is_static = 0;
44044 break;
44045 case DW_TAG_class_type:
44046 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
44047 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
44048 case DW_TAG_union_type:
44049 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
44050 kind = TYPE;
44051 is_static = language != CPLUS;
44052 break;
44053 default:
44054 assert (0);
44055 @}
44056 @end smallexample
44057
44058 @node Man Pages
44059 @appendix Manual pages
44060 @cindex Man pages
44061
44062 @menu
44063 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
44064 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
44065 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
44066 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
44067 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
44068 @end menu
44069
44070 @node gdb man
44071 @heading gdb man
44072
44073 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
44074
44075 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
44076 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
44077 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
44078 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
44079 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
44080 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
44081 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
44082 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
44083 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
44084 @c man end
44085
44086 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
44087 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
44088 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
44089 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
44090
44091 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
44092 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
44093
44094 @itemize @bullet
44095 @item
44096 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
44097
44098 @item
44099 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
44100
44101 @item
44102 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
44103
44104 @item
44105 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
44106 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
44107 @end itemize
44108
44109 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
44110 Modula-2.
44111
44112 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
44113 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
44114 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
44115 by using the command @code{help}.
44116
44117 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
44118 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
44119 executable program as the argument:
44120
44121 @smallexample
44122 gdb program
44123 @end smallexample
44124
44125 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
44126
44127 @smallexample
44128 gdb program core
44129 @end smallexample
44130
44131 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
44132 to debug a running process:
44133
44134 @smallexample
44135 gdb program 1234
44136 gdb -p 1234
44137 @end smallexample
44138
44139 @noindent
44140 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
44141 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
44142 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
44143
44144 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
44145
44146 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
44147 @table @env
44148 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
44149 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
44150
44151 @item run [@var{arglist}]
44152 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
44153
44154 @item bt
44155 Backtrace: display the program stack.
44156
44157 @item print @var{expr}
44158 Display the value of an expression.
44159
44160 @item c
44161 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
44162
44163 @item next
44164 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
44165 function calls in the line.
44166
44167 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
44168 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
44169
44170 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
44171 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
44172
44173 @item step
44174 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
44175 function calls in the line.
44176
44177 @item help [@var{name}]
44178 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
44179 about using @value{GDBN}.
44180
44181 @item quit
44182 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
44183 @end table
44184
44185 @ifset man
44186 For full details on @value{GDBN},
44187 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44188 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
44189 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
44190 @end ifset
44191 @c man end
44192
44193 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
44194 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
44195 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
44196 encountered with no
44197 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
44198 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
44199 Many options have
44200 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
44201 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
44202 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
44203 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
44204 more usual convention.)
44205
44206 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
44207 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
44208 option is used.
44209
44210 @table @env
44211 @item -help
44212 @itemx -h
44213 List all options, with brief explanations.
44214
44215 @item -symbols=@var{file}
44216 @itemx -s @var{file}
44217 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
44218
44219 @item -write
44220 Enable writing into executable and core files.
44221
44222 @item -exec=@var{file}
44223 @itemx -e @var{file}
44224 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
44225 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
44226 dump.
44227
44228 @item -se=@var{file}
44229 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
44230 file.
44231
44232 @item -core=@var{file}
44233 @itemx -c @var{file}
44234 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
44235
44236 @item -command=@var{file}
44237 @itemx -x @var{file}
44238 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
44239
44240 @item -ex @var{command}
44241 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
44242
44243 @item -directory=@var{directory}
44244 @itemx -d @var{directory}
44245 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
44246
44247 @item -nh
44248 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
44249
44250 @item -nx
44251 @itemx -n
44252 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
44253
44254 @item -quiet
44255 @itemx -q
44256 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
44257 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
44258
44259 @item -batch
44260 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
44261 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
44262 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
44263 commands in the command files.
44264
44265 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
44266 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
44267 more useful, the message
44268
44269 @smallexample
44270 Program exited normally.
44271 @end smallexample
44272
44273 @noindent
44274 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
44275 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
44276
44277 @item -cd=@var{directory}
44278 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
44279 instead of the current directory.
44280
44281 @item -fullname
44282 @itemx -f
44283 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
44284 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
44285 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
44286 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
44287 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
44288 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
44289 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
44290 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
44291
44292 @item -b @var{bps}
44293 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
44294 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
44295
44296 @item -tty=@var{device}
44297 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
44298 @end table
44299 @c man end
44300
44301 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
44302 @ifset man
44303 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44304 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44305 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44306
44307 @smallexample
44308 info gdb
44309 @end smallexample
44310
44311 @noindent
44312 should give you access to the complete manual.
44313
44314 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44315 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44316 @end ifset
44317 @c man end
44318
44319 @node gdbserver man
44320 @heading gdbserver man
44321
44322 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
44323 @format
44324 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
44325 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
44326
44327 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44328
44329 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44330 @c man end
44331 @end format
44332
44333 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
44334 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
44335 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
44336
44337 @ifclear man
44338 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
44339 @end ifclear
44340 @ifset man
44341 Usage (server (target) side):
44342 @end ifset
44343
44344 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
44345 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
44346 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
44347 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
44348
44349 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
44350 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
44351 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
44352
44353 @smallexample
44354 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
44355 @end smallexample
44356
44357 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
44358
44359 @smallexample
44360 @ifset man
44361 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
44362 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
44363 @end ifset
44364 @ifclear man
44365 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
44366 @end ifclear
44367 @end smallexample
44368
44369 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
44370 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
44371 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
44372
44373 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
44374
44375 @smallexample
44376 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
44377 @end smallexample
44378
44379 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
44380 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
44381 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
44382 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
44383 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
44384 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
44385 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
44386 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
44387 print an error message and exit.
44388
44389 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
44390 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
44391
44392 @smallexample
44393 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44394 @end smallexample
44395
44396 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44397 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44398
44399 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44400 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
44401 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
44402 the program you want to debug.
44403
44404 @smallexample
44405 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44406 @end smallexample
44407
44408 @ifclear man
44409 @subheading Usage (host side)
44410 @end ifclear
44411 @ifset man
44412 Usage (host side):
44413 @end ifset
44414
44415 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
44416 @value{GDBN} needs to examine its symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
44417 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
44418 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
44419 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
44420 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
44421 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
44422 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
44423 descriptor. For example:
44424
44425 @smallexample
44426 @ifset man
44427 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
44428 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
44429 @end ifset
44430 @ifclear man
44431 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
44432 @end ifclear
44433 @end smallexample
44434
44435 @noindent
44436 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
44437
44438 @smallexample
44439 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
44440 @end smallexample
44441
44442 @noindent
44443 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
44444 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
44445 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
44446 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
44447 `Connection refused'.
44448
44449 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
44450 described in
44451 @ifset man
44452 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
44453 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
44454 @end ifset
44455 @ifclear man
44456 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
44457 @end ifclear
44458 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
44459
44460 @smallexample
44461 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
44462 @end smallexample
44463
44464 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
44465 case.
44466 @c man end
44467
44468 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
44469 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
44470
44471 @itemize @bullet
44472
44473 @item
44474 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
44475
44476 @smallexample
44477 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
44478 @end smallexample
44479
44480 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
44481 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
44482 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
44483 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
44484 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
44485 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
44486 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44487
44488 @item
44489 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
44490 program:
44491
44492 @smallexample
44493 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44494 @end smallexample
44495
44496 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
44497 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
44498 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
44499 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44500
44501 @item
44502 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
44503
44504 @smallexample
44505 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44506 @end smallexample
44507
44508 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
44509 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
44510 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
44511 debug several processes in the same session.
44512 @end itemize
44513
44514 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
44515
44516 @table @env
44517
44518 @item --help
44519 List all options, with brief explanations.
44520
44521 @item --version
44522 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
44523
44524 @item --attach
44525 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
44526
44527 @smallexample
44528 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44529 @end smallexample
44530
44531 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44532 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44533
44534 @item --multi
44535 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44536 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
44537 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
44538 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
44539
44540 @smallexample
44541 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44542 @end smallexample
44543
44544 @item --debug
44545 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
44546 process.
44547 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44548 the developers.
44549
44550 @item --remote-debug
44551 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
44552 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44553 the developers.
44554
44555 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
44556 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
44557 of debugging output.
44558 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
44559
44560 @item --wrapper
44561 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
44562 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
44563 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
44564 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
44565
44566 @item --once
44567 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
44568 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
44569 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
44570 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
44571
44572 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
44573
44574 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
44575 @c QDisableRandomization.
44576
44577 @end table
44578 @c man end
44579
44580 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
44581 @ifset man
44582 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44583 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44584 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44585
44586 @smallexample
44587 info gdb
44588 @end smallexample
44589
44590 should give you access to the complete manual.
44591
44592 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44593 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44594 @end ifset
44595 @c man end
44596
44597 @node gcore man
44598 @heading gcore
44599
44600 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
44601
44602 @format
44603 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
44604 gcore [-a] [-o @var{prefix}] @var{pid1} [@var{pid2}...@var{pidN}]
44605 @c man end
44606 @end format
44607
44608 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
44609 Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs
44610 @var{pid1}, @var{pid2}, etc. A core file produced by @command{gcore}
44611 is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process crashes
44612 (and when @kbd{ulimit -c} was used to set up an appropriate core dump
44613 limit). However, unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} finishes
44614 its job the program remains running without any change.
44615 @c man end
44616
44617 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
44618 @table @env
44619 @item -a
44620 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
44621 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
44622 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
44623 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
44624 dump-excluded-mappings}).
44625
44626 @item -o @var{prefix}
44627 The optional argument @var{prefix} specifies the prefix to be used
44628 when composing the file names of the core dumps. The file name is
44629 composed as @file{@var{prefix}.@var{pid}}, where @var{pid} is the
44630 process ID of the running program being analyzed by @command{gcore}.
44631 If not specified, @var{prefix} defaults to @var{gcore}.
44632 @end table
44633 @c man end
44634
44635 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
44636 @ifset man
44637 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44638 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44639 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44640
44641 @smallexample
44642 info gdb
44643 @end smallexample
44644
44645 @noindent
44646 should give you access to the complete manual.
44647
44648 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44649 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44650 @end ifset
44651 @c man end
44652
44653 @node gdbinit man
44654 @heading gdbinit
44655
44656 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
44657
44658 @format
44659 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
44660 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44661 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44662 @end ifset
44663
44664 ~/.gdbinit
44665
44666 ./.gdbinit
44667 @c man end
44668 @end format
44669
44670 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
44671 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
44672 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
44673 described in
44674 @ifset man
44675 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
44676 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
44677 @end ifset
44678 @ifclear man
44679 @ref{Sequences}.
44680 @end ifclear
44681
44682 Please read more in
44683 @ifset man
44684 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
44685 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
44686 @end ifset
44687 @ifclear man
44688 @ref{Startup}.
44689 @end ifclear
44690
44691 @table @env
44692 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44693 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44694 @end ifset
44695 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44696 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
44697 @end ifclear
44698 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44699 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
44700 See more in
44701 @ifset man
44702 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
44703 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
44704 @end ifset
44705 @ifclear man
44706 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
44707 @end ifclear
44708
44709 @item ~/.gdbinit
44710 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44711 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
44712
44713 @item ./.gdbinit
44714 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
44715 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
44716 See more in
44717 @ifset man
44718 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
44719 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
44720 @end ifset
44721 @ifclear man
44722 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
44723 @end ifclear
44724 @end table
44725 @c man end
44726
44727 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
44728 @ifset man
44729 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
44730
44731 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44732 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44733 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44734
44735 @smallexample
44736 info gdb
44737 @end smallexample
44738
44739 should give you access to the complete manual.
44740
44741 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44742 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44743 @end ifset
44744 @c man end
44745
44746 @node gdb-add-index man
44747 @heading gdb-add-index
44748 @pindex gdb-add-index
44749 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
44750
44751 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
44752
44753 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
44754 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
44755 @c man end
44756
44757 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
44758 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
44759 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
44760 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
44761 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
44762 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
44763
44764 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
44765 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
44766 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
44767 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
44768 named @code{.debug_*}).
44769
44770 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
44771 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
44772 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
44773 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
44774
44775 See more in
44776 @ifset man
44777 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
44778 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
44779 @end ifset
44780 @ifclear man
44781 @ref{Index Files}.
44782 @end ifclear
44783 @c man end
44784
44785 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
44786 @ifset man
44787 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44788 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44789 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44790
44791 @smallexample
44792 info gdb
44793 @end smallexample
44794
44795 should give you access to the complete manual.
44796
44797 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44798 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44799 @end ifset
44800 @c man end
44801
44802 @include gpl.texi
44803
44804 @node GNU Free Documentation License
44805 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
44806 @include fdl.texi
44807
44808 @node Concept Index
44809 @unnumbered Concept Index
44810
44811 @printindex cp
44812
44813 @node Command and Variable Index
44814 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
44815
44816 @printindex fn
44817
44818 @tex
44819 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
44820 % meantime:
44821 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
44822 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
44823 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
44824 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
44825 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
44826 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
44827 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
44828 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
44829 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
44830 \page\colophon
44831 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
44832 @end tex
44833
44834 @bye